Factory Workshop Manual
Make
Dodge
Model
Ram 2500 4wd
Engine and year
Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999)
Please navigate through the PDF using the options
provided by OnlyManuals.com on the sidebar.
This manual was submitted by
Anonymous
Date
1st January 2018
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Locations
8w-10-2
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Antitheft Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 9
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 10
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 11
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 12
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 13
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 14
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 15
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 16
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 17
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 18
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 19
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 20
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 21
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 22
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 23
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 24
Antitheft Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 25
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 26
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 27
Antitheft Relay: Connector Views
Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Antitheft
Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 28
Security Relay
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Radio/Stereo Noise Filter Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation
Radio/Stereo Noise Filter Relay: Description and Operation
FILTER, CHOKE, AND SPEAKER RELAY
DESCRIPTION Models equipped with the Infinity premium speaker package have a filter, choke,
and speaker relay unit. The filter, choke, and speaker relay unit is mounted to the lower instrument
panel center brace, inboard of the Central Timer Module (CTM) and directly above the 16-way data
link connector. The filter, choke, and speaker relay unit can be accessed for service without
instrument panel disassembly or removal.
The filter, choke, and speaker relay unit should be checked if there is no sound output noted from
the speakers. The filter, choke, and speaker relay unit cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if faulty
or damaged, the unit must be replaced.
OPERATION The filter, choke, and speaker relay unit is used to control the supply of fused battery
current to the front door speaker-mounted dual amplifiers. The speaker relay is energized by a
fused 12 volt output from the radio receiver whenever the radio is turned on.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Radio/Stereo Noise Filter Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 32
Radio/Stereo Noise Filter Relay: Testing and Inspection
The filter, choke and speaker relay is used to switch power to the individual speaker amplifiers
used with the Infinity premium speaker package. The choke and relay are serviced only as a unit. If
all of the speakers lack bass or low frequency response, the filter, choke and speaker relay unit
should be considered suspect. However, before replacement make the following checks of the
filter, choke and speaker relay circuits.
1. Check the fused B(+) fuse in the junction block. If OK, go to Step 2.If not OK, replace the faulty
fuse. 2. Check for battery voltage at the fused B(+) fuse in the junction block. If OK, go to Step 3. If
not OK, repair the open fused B(+) circuit to the
battery as required.
3. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the filter, choke and speaker relay
unit. Check for battery voltage at the fused B(+)
circuit cavity of the instrument panel wire harness connector for the filter, choke and speaker relay
unit. If OK, go to Step 4. If not OK, repair the open fused B(+) circuit to the junction block fuse as
required.
4. Probe the ground circuit cavity of the instrument panel wire harness connector for the filter,
choke and speaker relay unit. Check for continuity to a
good ground. There should be continuity. If OK, go to Step 5. If not OK, repair the open ground
circuit to ground as required.
5. Turn the ignition switch to the On position and turn the radio on. Check for battery voltage at the
radio 12 volt output circuit cavity of the
instrument panel wire harness connector for the filter, choke and speaker relay unit. If OK, go to
Step 6. If not OK, repair the open radio 12 volt output circuit to the radio as required.
6. Turn the radio and ignition switches to the Off position. Reconnect the instrument panel wire
harness connector to the filter, choke and speaker
relay unit. Check for battery voltage at the amplified speaker (+) circuit cavity of the instrument
panel wire harness connector for the filter, choke and speaker relay unit. There should be zero
volts. Turn the ignition and radio switches to the On position. There should now be battery voltage.
If OK, repair the open amplified speaker (+) circuits to the speaker-mounted amplifiers as required.
If not OK, replace the faulty filter, choke and speaker relay unit.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Radio/Stereo Noise Filter Relay > Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 33
Radio/Stereo Noise Filter Relay: Service and Repair
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
REMOVAL 1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
Filter, Choke And Speaker Relay Remove/Install
2. Reach under the driver side of the instrument panel near the 16-way data link connector and
inboard of the ash receiver to access the filter, choke
and speaker relay.
3. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the filter, choke and speaker relay
wire harness connector. 4. Remove the two screws that secure the filter, choke, and speaker relay
mounting bracket to the instrument panel center brace. 5. Remove the filter, choke, and speaker
relay unit from under the instrument panel.
INSTALLATION 1. Position the filter, choke, and speaker relay unit under the instrument panel. 2.
Install and tighten the two screws that secure the filter, choke, and speaker relay mounting bracket
to the instrument panel center brace. Tighten the
screws to 2.7 Nm (24 in lbs).
3. Reconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector to the filter, choke and speaker relay
wire harness connector. 4. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Specifications
Electronic Brake Control Module: Specifications
WITH RWAL ANTILOCK BRAKES:
Mounting Screws
..............................................................................................................................................................
2.5 - 3.5 Nm (22 - 31 inch lbs.)
WITH 4-WHEEL ANTILOCK BRAKES:
Mounting Screws .................................................................................................................................
................................ 4 - 4.7 Nm (36 - 42 inch lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Control Modules, PDC, and Relays
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Control Modules, PDC, and Relays > Page 40
Electronic Brake Control Module: Locations EBC 2
Controller Antilock Brakes (CAB) EBC 2
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Locations > Control Modules, PDC, and Relays > Page 41
Electronic Brake Control Module: Locations EBC 325
Controller Antilock Brakes (CAB) EBC 32 5
EBC-325
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Connector Plug C1
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams Connector Plug C1
Connector Pin Identification
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Connector Plug C1 > Page 44
Electronic Brake Control Module: Diagrams Connector Plug C2
Connector Pin Identification
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Controller Antilock Brake (CAB)
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation Controller Antilock Brake (CAB)
The controller antilock brake module is used to monitor wheel speeds and modulates (control)
hydraulic pressure in each brake channel. The modulated hydraulic pressure is used to prevent
wheel lock up during braking. The CAB also provides a vehicle speed signal (VSS) to the
powertrain control module.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Controller Antilock Brake (CAB) > Page 47
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation With Four Wheel Antilock Brakes
CAB/HCU
The CAB is mounted on the top of the hydraulic control unit.
The CAB operates the ABS system and is separate from other vehicle electrical circuits. CAB
voltage source is through the ignition switch in the RUN position.
The CAB contains dual microprocessors. A logic block in each microprocessor receives identical
sensor signals. These signals are processed and compared simultaneously.
The CAB contains a self check program that illuminates the ABS warning light when a system fault
is detected. Faults are stored in a diagnostic program memory and are accessible with the DRB
scan tool.
ABS faults remain in memory until cleared, or until after the vehicle is started approximately 50
times. Stored faults are not erased if the battery is disconnected.
NOTE: If the CAB needs to be replaced, the rear axle type and tire revolutions per mile must be
programmed into the new CAB. For axle type refer to Transmission and Drivetrain. For tire
revolutions per mile refer to Steering and Suspension.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Description and Operation > Controller Antilock Brake (CAB) > Page 48
Electronic Brake Control Module: Description and Operation With Rear Wheel Antilock Brakes
RWAL CAB
The Controller Antilock Brakes (CAB) is a microprocessor which handles testing, monitoring and
controlling the ABS brake system operation. The CAB functions are: Perform self-test diagnostics.
- Monitor the RWAL brake system for proper operation.
- Control the RWAL valve solenoids.
NOTE: If the CAB needs to be replaced, the rear axle type and tire revolutions per mile must be
programmed into the new CAB. For axle type refer to Transmission and Drivetrain. For tire
revolutions per mile refer to Steering and Suspension.
SYSTEM SELF-TEST
When the ignition switch is turned-on the microprocessor RAM and ROM are tested. If an error
occurs during the test, a DTC will be set into the RAM memory. However it is possible the DTC will
not be stored in memory if the error has occurred in the RAM module were the DTC's are stored.
Also it is possible a DTC may not be stored if the error has occurred in the ROM which signals the
RAM to store the DTC.
CAB INPUTS
The CAB continuously monitors the speed of the differential ring gear by monitoring signals
generated by the rear wheel speed sensor. The CAB determines a wheel locking tendency when it
recognizes the ring gear decelerating too rapidly. The CAB monitors the following inputs to
determine when a wheel locking tendency may exists: -
Rear Wheel Speed Sensor
- Brake Lamp Switch
- Brake Warning Lamp Switch
- Reset Switch
- 4WD Switch (If equipped)
CAB OUTPUTS
The CAB controls the following outputs for antilock braking and brake warning information: RWAL Valve
- ABS Warning Lamp
- Brake Warning Lamp
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Antilock Control Assembly Replacement
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair Antilock Control Assembly Replacement
NOTE: If the antilock control assembly needs to be replaced, the rear axle type and tire revolutions
per mile must be programmed into the new CAB. For axle type refer to Transmission and
Drivetrain. For tire revolutions per mile refer to Steering and Suspension.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable. 2. Push the harness connector locks to release the locks,
then remove the connectors from the CAB.
Brake Lines
3. Disconnect brake lines from HCU. 4. Remove the two mounting bolts on either side of the
assembly which attach the assembly to the mounting bracket. 5. Tilt the assembly upward were the
brake lines attach and remove the assembly from the mounting bracket.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the assembly into the mounting bracket. 2. Install the mounting bolts and tighten to 12 Nm
(102 inch lbs.). 3. Connect the CAB harnesses. 4. Connect the brake lines to the HCU. Tighten
brake line fittings to 19 - 23 Nm (170 - 200 inch lbs.). 5. Connect battery. 6. Bleed brake system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Antilock Control Assembly Replacement > Page 51
Electronic Brake Control Module: Service and Repair Controller Antilock Brake (CAB) Replacement
Four Wheel Antilock Brake System
NOTE: If the CAB needs to be replaced, the rear axle type and tire revolutions per mile must be
programmed into the new CAB. For axle type refer to Transmission and Drivetrain. For tire
revolutions per mile refer to Steering and Suspension.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect battery negative cable.
Harness Connector Locks
2. Push the harness connector locks to release the locks, then remove the connectors from the
CAB.
Pump Motor Connector
3. Disconnect the pump motor connector.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Antilock Control Assembly Replacement > Page 52
Controller Mounting Screws
4. Remove screws attaching CAB to the HCU. 5. Remove the CAB.
INSTALLATION
1. Place the CAB onto the HCU.
NOTE: Insure the CAB seal is in position before installation.
2. Install the mounting screws and tighten to 4 - 4.7 Nm (36 - 42 inch lbs.). 3. Connect the pump
motor harness. 4. Connect the harnesses to the CAB and lock the connectors. 5. Connect battery.
Rear Wheel Antilock Brake System
NOTE: If the CAB needs to be replaced, the rear axle type and tire revolutions per mile must be
programmed into the new CAB. For axle type refer to Transmission and Drivetrain. For tire
revolutions per mile refer to Steering and Suspension.
REMOVAL
CAB Harness Connections
1. Pull up on the CAB harness connector lock release and remove the connector from the
controller. 2. Remove the RWAL valve harness connector from the controller.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Brakes and Traction Control > Electronic Brake
Control Module > Component Information > Service and Repair > Antilock Control Assembly Replacement > Page 53
CAB Mounting Screws
3. Remove the controller mounting screws, and remove the controller from the mounting bracket.
INSTALLATION
1. Position the controller on the bracket and install the mounting screws. Tighten the screws to 2.5 3.5 Nm (22 - 31 inch lbs.). 2. Install the RWAL valve harness connector into the controller. 3. Install
the CAB harness connector into the controller and push down on the connector lock.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Blower Motor Relay: Component Locations
8w-10-2
The blower motor relay is located in the PDC in the engine compartment.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 59
Blower Motor Relay: Connector Locations
Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 60
Blower Motor Relay
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 61
Blower Motor Relay: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The blower motor relay is an International Standards Organization (ISO)-type relay. The relay is an
electromechanical device that switches battery current from a fuse in the Power Distribution Center
(PDC) directly to the blower motor. The relay is energized when the relay coil is provided a voltage
signal by the ignition switch. This arrangement reduces the amount of battery current that must flow
through the ignition switch.
The blower motor relay control circuit is protected by a fuse located in the junction block. When the
relay is de-energized, the blower motor receives no battery current. See Blower Motor Relay in the
Diagnosis and Testing for more information.
The blower motor relay is located in the PDC in the engine compartment. Refer to the PDC label
for blower motor relay identification and location.
The blower motor relay cannot be repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 62
Blower Motor Relay: Testing and Inspection
Relay Test
Blower Motor Relay
The blower motor relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). Remove the blower
motor relay from the PDC to perform the following tests: 1. A relay in the de-energized position
should have continuity between terminals 87A and 30, and no continuity between terminals 87 and
30. If OK,
go to Step 2. If not OK, replace the faulty relay.
2. Resistance between terminals 85 and 86 (electromagnet) should be 75 ± 5 ohms. If OK, go to
Step 3. If not OK, replace the faulty relay. 3. Connect a battery to terminals 85 and 86. There
should now be continuity between terminals 30 and 87, and no continuity between terminals 87A
and 30. If OK, see Relay Circuit Test in the Diagnosis and Testing. If not OK, replace the faulty
relay.
Relay Circuit Test
1. The relay common feed terminal cavity (30) is connected to fused battery feed directly from a
fuse in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), and
should be hot at all times. Check for battery voltage at the PDC cavity for relay terminal 30. If OK,
go to Step 2. If not OK, repair the open circuit to the PDC fuse as required.
2. The relay normally closed terminal cavity (87A) is not used for this application. Go to Step 3. 3.
The relay normally open terminal cavity (87) is connected to the blower motor. When the relay is
energized, terminal 87 is connected to terminal
30 and provides full battery current to the blower motor feed circuit. There should be continuity
between the PDC cavity for terminal 87 and the blower motor relay output circuit cavity of the
blower motor wire harness connector at all times. If OK, go to Step 4. If not OK, repair the open
circuit to the blower motor as required.
4. The coil battery terminal cavity (86) is connected to the ignition switch. When the ignition switch
is placed in the On position, fused ignition
switch output is directed from a fuse in the junction block to the relay electromagnetic coil to
energize the relay There should be battery voltage at the PDC cavity for relay terminal 86 with the
ignition switch in the On position. If OK, go to Step 5. If not OK, repair the open circuit to the
junction block fuse as required.
5. The coil ground terminal cavity (85) is connected to ground. This terminal supplies the ground for
the relay electromagnetic coil. There should be
continuity between the PDC cavity for relay terminal 85 and a good ground at all times. If not OK,
repair the open circuit as required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Blower Motor Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 63
Blower Motor Relay: Service and Repair
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
Power Distribution Center
2. Remove the cover from the Power Distribution Center (PDC). 3. Refer to the label on the PDC
for blower motor relay identification and location. 4. Unplug the blower motor relay from the PDC. 5.
Install the blower motor relay by aligning the relay terminals with the cavities in the PDC and
pushing the relay firmly into place. 6. Install the PDC cover. 7. Connect the battery negative cable.
8. Test the relay operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations
Compressor Clutch Relay: Component Locations
8w-10-2
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 68
Power Distribution Center
The compressor clutch relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) in the engine
compartment.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 69
Compressor Clutch Relay: Connector Locations
Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 70
A/C Compressor Clutch Relay
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Description and Operation > A/C Compressor Clutch Relay Description
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation A/C Compressor Clutch Relay Description
SYSTEM OPERATION
The compressor clutch relay is a International Standards Organization (ISO) micro-relay. The
terminal designations and functions are the same as a conventional ISO relay. However, the
micro-relay terminal orientation (footprint) is different, the current capacity is lower, and the relay
case dimensions are smaller than those of the conventional ISO relay
The compressor clutch relay is a electromechanical device that switches battery current to the
compressor clutch coil when the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) grounds the coil side of the
relay. The PCM responds to inputs from the heater-A/C mode control switch, the low pressure
cycling clutch switch, and the high pressure cut-off switch. See Compressor Clutch Relay in the
Diagnosis and Testing for more information.
The compressor clutch relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) in the engine
compartment. Refer to the PDC label for relay identification and location.
The compressor clutch relay cannot be repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Description and Operation > A/C Compressor Clutch Relay Description > Page 73
Compressor Clutch Relay: Description and Operation A/C Compressor Clutch Relay-PCM Output
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) CLUTCH RELAY - PCM OUTPUT
Power Distribution Center (PDC)
The A/C relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). Refer to label on PDC cover for
relay location.
The powertrain control module (PCM) activates the A/C compressor through the A/C clutch relay.
The PCM regulates A/C compressor operation by switching the ground circuit for the A/C clutch
relay on and off.
When the PCM receives a request for A/C, it will adjust idle air control (IAC) motor position. This is
done to increase idle speed. The PCM will then activate the A/C clutch through the A/C clutch
relay. The PCM adjusts idle air control (IAC) stepper motor position to compensate for increased
engine load from the A/C compressor.
By switching the ground path for the relay on and oft, the PCM is able to cycle the A/C compressor
clutch. This is based on changes in engine operating conditions. If, during A/C operation, the PCM
senses low idle speeds or a wide open throttle condition, it will de-energize the relay. This prevents
A/C clutch engagement. The relay will remain de-energized until the idle speed increases or the
wide open throttle condition exceeds 15 seconds or no longer exists. The PCM will also
de-energize the relay if coolant temperature exceeds 125 °C (257 °F) or low or high system
pressure exists.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 74
Compressor Clutch Relay: Testing and Inspection
Relay Test
Compressor Clutch Relay
The compressor clutch relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). Refer to the PDC
label for relay identification and location. Remove the relay from the PDC to perform the following
tests: 1. A relay in the de-energized position should have continuity between terminals 87A and 30,
and no continuity between terminals 87 and 30. If OK,
go to Step 2. If not OK, replace the faulty relay.
2. Resistance between terminals 85 and 86 (electromagnet) should be 75 ± 5 ohms. If OK, go to
Step 3. If not OK, replace the faulty relay 3. Connect a battery to terminals 85 and 86. There should
now be continuity between terminals 30 and 87, and no continuity between terminals 87A
and 30. If OK, see Relay Circuit Test in the Diagnosis and Testing. If not OK, replace the faulty
relay
Relay Circuit Test
1. The relay common feed terminal cavity (30) is connected to fused battery feed. There should be
battery voltage at the cavity for relay terminal 30
at all times. If OK, go to Step 2. If not OK, repair the open circuit to the fuse in the PDC as required.
2. The relay normally closed terminal (87A) is not used in this application. Go to Step 3. 3. The
relay normally open terminal cavity (87) is connected to the compressor clutch coil. There should
be continuity between this cavity and the
A/C compressor clutch relay output circuit cavity of the compressor clutch coil wire harness
connector. If OK, go to Step 4. If not OK, repair the open circuit as required.
4. The relay coil battery terminal (86) is connected to the fused ignition switch output (run/start)
circuit. There should be battery voltage at the cavity
for relay terminal 86 with the ignition switch in the On position. If OK, go to Step 5. If not OK, repair
the open circuit to the fuse in the junction block as required.
5. The coil ground terminal cavity (85) is switched to ground through the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM). There should be continuity between
this cavity and the A/C compressor clutch relay control circuit cavity of the PCM wire harness
connector C (gray) at all times. If not OK, repair the open circuit as required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - HVAC > Compressor Clutch Relay > Component
Information > Description and Operation > Page 75
Compressor Clutch Relay: Service and Repair
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
Power Distribution Center
2. Remove the cover from the Power Distribution Center (PDC). 3. Refer to the label on the PDC
for compressor clutch relay identification and location. 4. Unplug the compressor clutch relay from
the PDC. 5. Install the compressor clutch relay by aligning the relay terminals with the cavities in
the PDC and pushing the relay firmly into place. 6. Install the PDC cover. 7. Connect the battery
negative cable. 8. Test the relay operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Specifications
Audible Warning Device Control Module: Specifications
Tighten the two screws that secure the CTM to the mounting bracket on the inboard side of
instrument panel steering column opening to 1.6 Nm (15 in lbs).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Specifications > Page 80
Audible Warning Device Control Module: Locations
Central Time Module (Base) Remove/Install
Central Time Module (High-Line) Remove/Install
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Audible Warning Device Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 83
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 84
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 85
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 86
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 87
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 88
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 89
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 90
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 91
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 92
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 93
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 94
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 95
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 96
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 97
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 98
Audible Warning Device Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 99
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 100
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 101
Audible Warning Device Control Module: Connector Views
Central Timer Module C1 (Integrated Electronic Module)
Central Timer Module C2
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 102
Audible Warning Device Control Module: Electrical Diagrams
Central Timer Module
8w-45-2
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 103
8w-45-3
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 104
8w-45-4
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 105
8w-45-5
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 106
8w-45-6
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 107
8w-45-7 (IEM)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 108
8w-45-8 (IEM)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 109
8w-45-9 (IEM)
NOTE: To view sheets referred to in these diagrams, see Complete Body and Chassis Diagrams
See: Diagrams/Electrical Diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 110
Central Timer Module System
Central Timer Module System
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 111
Audible Warning Device Control Module: Service Precautions
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY
.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 112
Audible Warning Device Control Module: Description and Operation
The Ram Truck utilizes a Central Timer Module (CTM). This system is available in a Base or High
line configuration. The Base (IEM) configuration does not communicate on the CCD bus and will
not be addressed. The CTM will handle most of the electronic timing and chime functions for the
systems on the truck. For example: the halo lamp around the key cylinder is timed out after 30
seconds. This is a typical CTM function. The High line CTM provides the following features:
- Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)
- Chime
- Courtesy Lamp controls/Illuminated Entry
- Power Door Locks
- Speed Sensitive Intermittent Wipers
- Enhanced Accident Response
- Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS)
The CTM is located on the right side of the steering column behind the kneeblocker on a metal
bracket welded to the instrument panel. It contains a white 8-way and a green 14-way connector.
For additional information on the Central Timer Module, refer to Powertrain Management /
Computers and Control Systems / Body Control Module. See: Relays and Modules - Powertrain
Management/Relays and Modules - Computers and Control Systems/Central Timer
Module/Description and Operation
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 113
Audible Warning Device Control Module: Testing and Inspection
For additional testing and inspection information please refer to Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/ See: Relays and Modules - Powertrain
Management/Relays and Modules - Computers and Control Systems/Central Timer Module
NOTE: The following tests may not prove conclusive in the diagnosis of the high-line version of the
Central Timer Module (CTM). The most reliable, efficient, and accurate means to diagnose the
high-line CTM requires the use of a DRB scan tool and the proper Diagnostic Procedures.
1. Check the fuses in the junction block. If OK, go to Step 2.If not OK, repair the shorted circuit or
component as required and replace the faulty
fuse.
2. Check for battery voltage at the fuse in the junction block. If OK, go to Step 3. If not OK, repair
the open circuit to the Power Distribution Center
(PDC) as required.
3. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Remove the Central Timer Module (CTM)
from its mounting bracket to access the CTM wire
harness connectors. Refer to Central Timer Module in the Replacement of Instrument Panel
Systems for the procedures.
4. Unplug the wire harness connectors from the CTM. Check the wire harness connectors and the
receptacles in the CTM for loose, corroded, or
damaged terminals and pins. If OK, go to Step 5. If not OK, repair as required.
5. Probe the ground circuit cavity of the 14-way CTM wire harness connector and check for
continuity to a good ground. Repeat the check between
the ground circuit cavity of the 18-way CTM wire harness connector and a good ground. In each
case, there should be continuity. If OK, go to Step 6. If not OK, repair the open circuit(s) to ground
as required.
6. Connect the battery negative cable. Check for battery voltage at the fused B(+) circuit cavity of
the 14-way CTM wire harness connector. If OK,
go to Step 7. If not OK, repair the open circuit to the junction block as required.
7. Probe the door lock switch output (lock) circuit cavity of the 18-way CTM wire harness connector
and check for battery voltage as you actuate
each power lock switch to the Lock position. If OK, go to Step 8. If not OK, repair the open circuit
from either or both power lock switch(es) to the CTM as required.
8. Probe the door lock switch output (unlock) circuit cavity of the 18-way CTM wire harness
connector and check for battery voltage as you actuate
each power lock switch to the Unlock position. If OK, go to Step 9. If not OK, repair the open circuit
from either or both power lock switch(es) to the CTM as required.
9. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Reinstall the wire harness connectors to the
CTM. Connect the battery negative cable.
Back-probe the door lock driver circuit cavity of the 18-way CTM wire harness connector and check
for battery voltage as either power lock switch is moved to the Lock position. Repeat the test
pressing the Lock button of the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter. If OK, go to Step 10. If
not OK using the power lock switch, but OK with the RKE transmitter, see Power Lock Switch in the
Diagnosis and Testing. If not OK using the RKE transmitter, but OK with the power lock switch, see
Remote Keyless Entry Transmitter in the Diagnosis and Testing. If not OK, with the power lock
switch or the RKE transmitter, replace the faulty CTM.
10. Back-probe the door unlock driver circuit cavity of the 18-way CTM wire harness connector and
check for battery voltage as the power lock
switch is moved to the Unlock position. Repeat the test pressing the Unlock button of the RKE
transmitter. If OK, see Power Lock Motor in the Diagnosis and Testing. If not OK using the power
lock switch, but OK with the RKE transmitter, see Power Lock Switch in the Diagnosis and Testing.
If not OK using the RKE transmitter, but OK with the power lock switch, see Remote Keyless Entry
Transmitter in the Diagnosis and Testing. If not OK, with the power lock switch or the RKE
transmitter, replace the faulty CTM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 114
Audible Warning Device Control Module: Service and Repair
Before replacing a high-line Central Timer Module (CTM), use a DRB scan tool to determine the
current settings for the CTM programmable features. These settings should be duplicated in the
replacement CTM using the DRB scan tool, before returning the vehicle to service.
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
REMOVAL 1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the steering column
opening cover from the instrument panel. Refer to Steering Column Opening Cover in the
Replacement for the
procedures.
Central Time Module (Base) Remove/Install
Central Time Module (High-Line) Remove/Install
3. Remove the two screws that secure the Central Timer Module (CTM) to the bracket on the
inboard side of the instrument panel steering column
opening.
4. Pull the CTM into the instrument panel steering column opening far enough to access the
instrument panel wire harness connector(s). 5. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness
connector(s) (one connector for the base CTM, two connectors for high-line CTM) from the CTM
connector receptacle(s).
6. Remove the CTM from the instrument panel.
INSTALLATION 1. Position the CTM in the instrument panel steering column opening. 2.
Reconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector(s) (one connector for the base CTM, two
connectors for high-line CTM) to the CTM
connector receptacle(s).
3. Position the CTM to the mounting bracket on the inboard side of the instrument panel steering
column opening.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Instrument Panel > Audible Warning Device
Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 115
4. Install and tighten the two screws that secure the CTM to the mounting bracket on the inboard
side of instrument panel steering column opening.
Tighten the screws to 1.6 Nm (15 in lbs).
5. Install the steering column opening cover onto the instrument panel. Refer to Steering Column
Opening Cover in the Replacement for the
procedures.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
NOTE: If a new high-line Central Timer Module is installed, the programmable features must be
enabled and/or disabled to the customer's preferred settings. Use a DRB scan tool and the proper
Diagnostic Procedures to perform these operations.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Locations
Daytime Running Lamp Module (DRLM)
The Daytime Running Lamp Module (DRLM) is located in the engine compartment on the left
fender wheelhouse.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 120
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Description and Operation
GENERAL INFORMATION
The daytime running lamps are controlled by the Daytime Running Lamp Module (DRLM). The
DRLM is located in the engine compartment on the left fender wheelhouse. The DRLM allows the
high beam headlamps to illuminate at a reduced intensity when the engine is running with the
headlamp switch OFF. The Daytime running lamps will go out when the headlamp switch is turned
to the headlamps on position. The passing light feature will flash bright high beams while the
daytime running lamps are activated.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Daytime Running Lamp
Control Unit > Component Information > Locations > Page 121
Daytime Running Lamp Control Unit: Service and Repair
Daytime Running Lamp Module (DRLM)
REMOVAL
1. Release hood latch an open hood. 2. Disengage wire connector from DRLM. 3. Remove screws
attaching DRLM to left front inner fender panel. 4. Separate DRLM from fender.
INSTALLATION
1. Position DRLM on fender. 2. Install screws attaching DRLM to left front inner fender panel. 3.
Engage wire connector to DRLM. 4. Close hood.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
8w-10-2
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 125
Fog/Driving Lamp Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Fog/Driving Lamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 126
Fog Lamp Relay
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Headlamp Relay: Locations
Power Distribution Center
The headlamp (or security) relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), in the engine
compartment.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 130
Headlamp Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 131
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 132
Headlamp Relay: Service Precautions
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 133
Headlamp Relay: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The headlamp (or security) relay is a International Standards Organization (ISO) micro-relay. The
terminal designations and functions are the same as a conventional ISO relay. However, the
micro-relay terminal orientation (or footprint) is different, current capacity is lower, and the relay
case dimensions are smaller than those of the conventional ISO relay.
The headlamp relay is a electromechanical device that switches battery current to the headlamps
when the high-line Central Timer Module (CTM) grounds the relay coil. See Headlamp Relay in the
Diagnosis and Testing for more information.
The headlamp (or security) relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), in the engine
compartment. Refer to the PDC label for relay identification and location.
The headlamp relay cannot be repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 134
Headlamp Relay: Testing and Inspection
The headlamp (or security) relay and the horn relay are located in the Power Distribution Center
(PDC) in the engine compartment. Each of these relays can be tested as described in the following
procedure, however the circuits they are used in do vary.
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
Relay Terminals
Remove the relay from the PDC as described to perform the following tests:
1. A relay in the de-energized position should have continuity between terminals 87A and 30, and
no continuity between terminals 87 and 30. If OK,
go to Step 2.If not OK, replace the faulty relay
2. Resistance between terminals 85 and 86 (electromagnet) should be 75 ± 5 ohms. If OK, go to
Step 3. If not OK, replace the faulty relay. 3. Connect a battery to terminals 85 and 86. There
should now be continuity between terminals 30 and 87, and no continuity between terminals 87A
and 30. If OK, test the relay circuits. If not OK, replace the faulty relay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 135
Headlamp Relay: Service and Repair
Power Distribution Center
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the cover from the Power
Distribution Center (PDC). 3. Refer to the label on the PDC for headlamp (or security) relay
identification and location. 4. Unplug the headlamp relay from the PDC. 5. Install the headlamp
relay by aligning the relay terminals with the cavities in the PDC and pushing the relay firmly into
place. 6. Install the PDC cover. 7. Connect the battery negative cable. 8. Test the relay operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > High Beam Relay >
Component Information > Locations
8w-10-2
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > High Beam Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 139
High Beam Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > High Beam Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 140
Quad High Beam Relay
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations
Horn Relay: Locations
8w-10-2
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Locations > Page 144
Power Distribution Center
The horn relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) in the engine compartment.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Horn Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 147
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 148
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 149
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 150
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 151
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 152
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 153
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 154
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 155
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 156
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 157
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 158
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 159
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 160
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 161
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 162
Horn Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 163
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 164
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 165
Horn Relay: Connector Views
Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 166
Horn Relay
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 167
Horn Relay: Service Precautions
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO RESTRAINT SYSTEMS /
AIRBAG SYSTEMS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY
.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 168
Horn Relay: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The horn relay is a electromechanical device that switches battery current to the horn when the
horn switch grounds the relay coil. The horn relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC)
in the engine compartment. If a problem is encountered with a continuously sounding horn, it can
usually be quickly resolved by removing the horn relay from the PDC until further diagnosis is
completed. See the fuse and relay layout label affixed to the inside surface of the PDC cover for
horn relay identification and location.
The horn relay is a International Standards Organization (ISO) micro-relay. Relays conforming to
the ISO specifications have common physical dimensions, current capacities, terminal patterns,
and terminal functions. The ISO micro-relay terminal functions are the same as a conventional ISO
relay. However, the ISO micro-relay terminal pattern (or footprint) is different, the current capacity
is lower, and the physical dimensions are smaller than those of the conventional ISO relay.
The horn relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), in the engine compartment. Refer
to the PDC label for relay identification and location.
If a problem is encountered with a continuously sounding horn, it can usually be quickly resolved by
removing the horn relay from the PDC until further diagnosis is completed.
The horn relay cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if faulty or damaged, it must be replaced.
OPERATION
The ISO relay consists of an electromagnetic coil, a resistor or diode, and three (two fixed and one
movable) electrical contacts. The movable (common feed) relay contact is held against one of the
fixed contacts (normally dosed) by spring pressure. When the electromagnetic coil is energized, it
draws the movable contact away from the normally closed fixed contact, and holds it against the
other (normally open) fixed contact.
When the electromagnetic coil is de-energized, spring pressure returns the movable contact to the
normally closed position. The resistor or diode is connected in parallel with the electromagnetic coil
in the relay, and helps to dissipate voltage spikes that are produced when the coil is de-energized.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 169
Horn Relay: Testing and Inspection
Horn Relay
The horn relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) behind the battery on the driver
side of the engine compartment. If a problem is encountered with a continuously sounding horn, it
can usually be quickly resolved by removing the horn relay from the PDC until further diagnosis is
completed. See the fuse and relay layout label affixed to the inside surface of the PDC cover for
horn relay identification and location.
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
For additional testing and inspection information please refer to Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/ See: Relays and Modules - Powertrain
Management/Relays and Modules - Computers and Control Systems/Central Timer Module
1. Remove the horn relay from the PDC. Refer to Horn Relay in the Replacement for the
procedures. 2. A relay in the de-energized position should have continuity between terminals 87A
and 30, and no continuity between terminals 87 and 30. If OK,
go to Step 3. If not OK, replace the faulty relay.
3. Resistance between terminals 85 and 86 (electromagnet) should be 75 ± 5 ohms. If OK, go to
Step 4. If not OK, replace the faulty relay 4. Connect a battery to terminals 85 and 86. There should
now be continuity between terminals 30 and 87, and no continuity between terminals 87A
and 30. If OK, perform the Relay Circuit Test that follows. If not OK, replace the faulty relay
Relay Circuit Test 1. The relay common feed terminal cavity (30) is connected to battery voltage
and should be hot at all times. If OK, go to Step 2.If not OK, repair the
open circuit to the fuse in the PDC as required.
2. The relay normally closed terminal (87A) is connected to terminal 30 in the de-energized
position, but is not used for this application. Go to Step
3.
3. The relay normally open terminal (87) is connected to the common feed terminal (30) in the
energized position. This terminal supplies battery
voltage to the horn(s). There should be continuity between the cavity for relay terminal 87 and the
horn relay output circuit cavity of each horn wire harness connector at all times. If OK, go to Step 4.
If not OK, repair the open circuit to the horn(s) as required.
4. The coil battery terminal (86) is connected to the electromagnet in the relay It is connected to
battery voltage and should be hot at all times. Check
for battery voltage at the cavity for relay terminal 86. If OK, go to Step 5. If not OK, repair the open
circuit to the fuse in the PDC as required.
5. The coil ground terminal (85) is connected to the electromagnet in the relay. It is grounded
through the horn switch when the horn switch is
depressed. On vehicles equipped with the Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS), the horn relay
coil ground terminal can also be grounded by the Central Timer Module (CTM) in response to
certain inputs related to the VTSS or Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) system. Check for continuity to
ground at the cavity for relay terminal 85. There should be continuity with the horn switch
depressed, and no continuity with the horn switch released. If not OK, refer to Horn Switch in the
Diagnosis and Testing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Horn Relay > Component
Information > Diagrams > Page 170
Horn Relay: Service and Repair
Power Distribution Center
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the cover from the Power
Distribution Center (PDC). 3. See the fuse and relay layout label affixed to the underside of the
PDC cover for horn relay identification and location. 4. Remove the horn relay from the PDC.
INSTALLATION
1. See the fuse and relay layout label affixed to the underside of the PDC cover for the proper horn
relay location. 2. Position the horn relay in the proper receptacle in the PDC. 3. Align the horn relay
terminals with the terminal cavities in the PDC receptacle. 4. Push down firmly on the horn relay
until the terminals are fully seated in the terminal cavities in the PDC receptacle. 5. Install the cover
onto the PDC. 6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Interior Lighting Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 175
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 176
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 177
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 178
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 179
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 180
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 181
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 182
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 183
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 184
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 185
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 186
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 187
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 188
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 189
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 190
Interior Lighting Module: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 191
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Interior Lighting Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 192
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations
8w-10-2
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 196
Trailer Lighting Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Lighting and Horns > Trailer Lighting Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 197
Trailer Tow Relay
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Junction Block
Junction Block
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Power and Ground Distribution > Relay Box >
Component Information > Diagrams > Junction Block > Page 203
Spare Relay
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Wiper Module - CTM Mandatory PROM Update
Technical Service Bulletin # 08-43-99 Date: 991217
Wiper Module - CTM Mandatory PROM Update
NUMBER: 08-43-99
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Dec. 17, 1999
SUBJECT: Central Timer Module Software Update When A Wiper Module Is Replaced
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Central Timer
Module (CTM) with new software (EEPROM changes).
MODELS: 1998 - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Trucks
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY.
DISCUSSION: Due to a design change in MOPAR replacement wiper modules, the CTM must be
updated with new software in order to allow the wiper module to function properly. This following
Repair Procedure must be performed any time the wiper module is replaced.
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
1 CH6OOO Scan Tool (DRB III)
1 CH7035 General Purpose Interface Bus Cable (GPIB)
1 CH7OOO/7001 J1962 Cable
1 CH7025 DIN Power Cable
1 MDS2
NOTE:
THE MDS2 AND DRB III ARE REQUIRED TO PERFORM PART OF THIS REPAIR. THE MDS2
SYSTEM MUST BE OPERATING AT CIS CD2046 OR HIGHER. THE DRB III MUST BE
OPERATING AT VERSION LEVEL 30.9 OR HIGHER.
POLICY: Reimbursabie within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-19-22-90 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: FM - Flash Module
CTM Flash With Vehicle Connected to DRBIII and MDS2
1. Log onto the MDS2 system.
2. Connect the MDS2 (Mopar Diagnostic System) to the DRB III (Scan Tool) with the GPIB cable.
Connect the DRB III to the vehicle with the J1962 cable and switch the ignition key to "ON".
3. Use the arrow keys and select option # 2, "CONNECT TO MDS1 OR MDS2," on the DRB III
MAIN MENU SCREEN.
4. Use the arrow keys and select option # 2, "RUN MDS2 APPLICATION," on the DRB III.
NOTE:
ONCE MDS2, DRB III, AND VEHICLE COMMUNICATION HAS BEEN ESTABLISHED, THE
"CANNOT READ VIN FROM DRB III" MESSAGE (ON THE MDS2) WILL BE REPLACED BY THE
VEHICLE VIN. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON ON THE MDS2 TO REQUEST A MDS2 SESSION
FOR THE VEHICLE VIN INDICATED. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON WHEN ASKED TO BEGIN
SESSION.
5. Push the FLASH tab on the MDS2.
NOTE:
A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS
OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST
SOFTWARE LEVELS AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Wiper Module - CTM Mandatory PROM Update > Page 210
6. Select "READ PART NUMBERS FROM VEHICLE" and click "SHOW UPDATES" on the MDS2.
NOTE:
A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS
OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST
SOFTWARE LEVELS AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN.
7. Select the new CTM software part number with the light pen and click UPDATE CONTROLLER
SOFTWARE.
8. The MDS2 and DRB III will download software files to the DRB Ill® and program CTM in
approximately 30 seconds.
9. When MDS2 status box reads "Check DRB Screen For Important Instructions," proceed with the
instructions identified on the DRB III screen.
CTM Flash With DRBIII In Disconnected Mode
1. Log onto the MDS2 system.
2. A MDS2 session can be started by either entering the VIN or by selecting the appropriate Year,
Model, and Engine.
CAUTION:
MDS2 SYSTEM SOFTWARE OPERATING AT CIS CD2046 WILL NOT DISPLAY ANY
AVAILABLE CTM FLASHES WHEN A SESSION IS STARTED BY SELECTING YEAR, MODEL,
AND ENGINE FOR 1998 5.9L CUMMINS 16 (12 VALVE ENGINE). SELECT THE 1998 5.9L 24
VALVE CUMMINS ENGINE IF IT BECOMES NECESSARY TO FLASH A CTM ON A 1998 5.9L
CUMMINS 16 (12 VALVE ENGINE). ALL SUBSEQUENT (CIS CD2047 OR HIGHER) MDS2
RELEASES WILL FUNCTION PROPERLY.
3. Connect the DRB III to the MDS2 (Mopar Diagnostic System) with the GPIB cable and the DIN
cable.
4. Use the arrow keys and select option # 2, "CONNECT TO MDS1 OR MDS2," on the DRB III
MAIN MENU SCREEN
5. Use the arrow keys and select option # 2, "RUN MDS2 APPLICATION," on the DRB III.
6. Once the vehicle information has been entered, push the FLASH tab on the MDS2.
NOTE:
A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS
OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST
SOFTWARE LEVELS AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN.
7. Using the light pen, scroll to the bottom of the list of available flashes and select all available
CTM software part numbers, then click DOWNLOAD SOFTWARE TO DRB III. It will take less than
one minute to download the software into the DRB III.
NOTE:
PART NUMBERS LISTED ARE SOFTWARE PART NUMBERS ONLY AND MAY NOT MATCH
THE ACTUAL CTM PART NUMBER IDENTIFIED ON THE CTM. IN ADDITION, THE SOFTWARE
PART NUMBER WILL NOT MATCH THE SOFTWARE VERSION NUMBER THAT WILL BE
IDENTIFIED WHEN USING DRB III "STAND ALONE" MODE TO COMMUNICATE TO THE CTM.
8. Once the software has been downloaded, a dialog box will appear identifying that the download
was successful. Select OK.
9. Disconnect the DRB III from the MDS2 and connect the DRB III to the vehicle.
10. Connect the DRB III to the vehicle and switch the ignition key to the RUN position.
11. Use the arrow keys and select option # 2, "CONNECT TO MDS1 OR MDS2," on the DRB III
MAIN MENU SCREEN.
12. Use the arrow keys and select option # 2, "RUN MDS2 APPLICATION," on the DRB III.
13. Wait for the "MDS2 diagnostic mode" menu to appear on the DRB III.
14. Use the arrow keys and select option # 2, "PROGRAM VEHICLE CONTROLLERS," from the
DRB III menu screen.
15. If the vehicle is equipped with a CTM, the CTM software part number will be displayed on the
DRB III. Select the CTM flash software part number.
16. Use the Page FWD key on the DRB III to download the software into the CTM. A status screen
will display "UPDATE IN PROGRESS" as the software is downloaded into the CTM.
17. To have the DRB III properly verify the CTM software part number, turn the ignition key to OFF
when prompted by DRB III.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Wiper Module - CTM Mandatory PROM Update > Page 211
18. Turn the ignition key to back to RUN when the prompted by DRB III. The DRB III will then
confirm that the download was successful by displaying the message CTM REPROGRAMMING
WAS SUCCESSFUL.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Vehicle Damage Warnings
Central Timer Module: Service Precautions Vehicle Damage Warnings
Before disconnecting any control module, make sure the ignition is OFF. Failure to do so could
damage the module.
When testing voltage or continuity at any control module, use the terminal side (not the wire end) of
the connector. Do not probe a wire through the insulation; this will damage it and eventually cause
it to fail because of corrosion.
Be careful when performing electrical tests so as to prevent accidental shorting of terminals. Such
mistakes can damage fuses or components. Also, a second code could be set, making diagnosis of
the original problem more difficult.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Vehicle Damage Warnings > Page 214
Central Timer Module: Service Precautions Road Testing A Complaint Vehicle
Some complaints will require a test drive as part of the repair verification procedure. The purpose
of the test drive is to try to duplicate the diagnostic code or symptom condition.
CAUTION: BEFORE ROAD TESTING A VEHICLE, BE SURE THAT ALL COMPONENTS ARE
REASSEMBLED.DURING THE TEST DRIVE, DO NOT TRY TO READ THE DRB SCREEN
WHILE IN MOTION. DO NOT HANG THE DRB FROM THE REAR VIEW MIRROR OR OPERATE
IT YOURSELF. HAVE AN ASSISTANT AVAILABLE TO OPERATE THE DRB.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Service
Precautions > Page 215
Central Timer Module: Application and ID
ACM Airbag Control Module
AECM Airbag Electronic Control Module
ASDM Airbag System Diagnostic Module
CCD Chrysler Collision Detection (vehicle communications bus)
CTM Central Timer Module
DAB
Driver Airbag
DLC Data Link Connector
IEM Integrated Electronic Module also called Low Line or Base Central Timer Module
JB Junction Block
MIC Mechanical Instrument Cluster
PAB Passenger Airbag
PCM Powertrain Control Module
PDC Power Distribution Center
RKE Remote Keyless Entry
SCTM Seat Belt Control Timer Module
SQUIB also called Initiator (located in rear of airbag module)
VTSS Vehicle Theft Security System
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System
Central Timer Module: Description and Operation Airbag System
Airbag System Description
The Airbag Control Module (ACM) is secured to a bracket on the floor panel transmission tunnel
below the instrument panel inside the vehicle. The ACM mounting bracket also serves as the
instrument; panel center support. The ACM contains a microprocessor, the impact sensor, and
energy storage capacitor. The microprocessor contains the air-bag system logic. The ACM system
logic includes On-Board Diagnostics (OBD) capability, and communicates with the instrument
cluster circuitry on the Chrysler Collision Detection (CCD) data bus to control the airbag indicator
lamp.
The microprocessor in the ACM monitors the impact sensor signal and the airbag system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ACM detects a monitored system fault, it sends
messages to the instrument cluster on the CCD data bus to turn ON the airbag indicator lamp. A
pre-programmed decision algorithm in the ACM microprocessor determines when the deceleration
rate signaled by the impact sensor indicates an impact that is severe enough to require airbag
system protection. when the programmed conditions are met, the ACM sends and electrical signal
to deploy the airbag system components.
Only one impact sensor is used in this airbag system. The impact sensor is an accelerometer that
senses the rate of the vehicle deceleration, which provides verification of the direction and severity
of an impact. The impact sensor is calibrated for the specific vehicle, and is only serviced as a unit
with the ACM.
The ACM also contains an energy-storage capacitor. This capacitor stores enough electrical
energy to deploy the airbags, for one second following a battery disconnect or failure during and
impact. The purpose of the capacitor is to provide airbag system protection in a severe secondary
impact if the initial impact has damaged or disconnected the battery, but was not severe enough to
deploy the airbags.
THE AIRBAG SYSTEM IS A SENSITIVE,COMPLEX ELECTROMECHANICAL UNIT.BEFORE
ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED STEERING
WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU MUST FIRST
DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE ROUND CABLE. THEN WAIT TWO
MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO CHARGE BEFORE FURTHER SYSTEM
SERVICE. THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO
DO THIS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE
PERSONAL INJURY. NEVER STRIKE OR KICK THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE, AS IT CAN
DAMAGE THE IMPACT SENSOR OR AFFECT ITS CALIBRATION. IF AN AIRBAG CONTROL
MODULE IS ACCIDENTALLY DROPPED DURING SERVICE, THE MODULE MUST BE
SCRAPPED AND REPLACED WITH A NEW UNIT.
The AIRBAG warning lamp is the only point at which the customer can observe "symptoms" of a
system malfunction. Whenever the ignition key is turned to the "RUN" or "START" position, the MIC
performs a lamp check by turning the AIRBAG warning lamp ON for 6-8 seconds. If the lamp
remains OFF; it means that the ACM has checked the system and found it to be free of discernible
malfunctions. If the lamp remains ON, there could be an active fault in the system or the MIC lamp
circuit may be internally shorted to ground, If the lamp comes on and stays ON for a period longer
than 6-8 seconds then goes OFF; there is usually an intermittent problem in the system.
The MIC monitors the airbag warning lamp and seat belt warning lamp during the bulb check for a
defective bulb or lamp driver circuit. The MIC tests the airbag lamp during the cluster bulb check
and substitutes the seat belt lamp if the airbag lamp is defective. If the airbag lamp is defective the
MIC will turn the seat belt light ON and OFF approximately 30 times to warn the driver that the
airbag lamp is defective. The lamp status is sent to the ACM continuously via a CCD bus message.
The seat belt lamp acts as a backup in the event that the AIRBAG lamp is defective. This
information is sent to the ACM continuously via a CCD bus message.
Perform the WARNING LAMP BULB OR DRIVER procedure in this book to find the cause of any
customer complaint regarding the AIRBAG warning lamp, such as:
- warning lamp does not illuminate
- warning lamp stays illuminated with no active DTC's
Club cab and quad cab models of this vehicle are equipped with a structural seat belt system. The
structural seat belt system includes a Seatbelt Control Timer Module (SCTM). The SCTM has a
hardwired input to the ACM. If a fault input form the SCTM is detected, or the SCTM is not
connected, the ACM sends a message to the instrument cluster on the CCD data bus to turn ON
the seat belt reminder lamp. See Seat Belt Control Timer Module.
ACM cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
Driver Airbag Module (DAB)
The airbag protective trim cover is the most visible part of the driver side airbag system. The
module is mounted directly to the steering wheel. Located under the trim cover are the horn switch,
the airbag cushion, and the airbag cushion supporting components. The airbag module includes a
housing to which the cushion and inflator are attached and sealed. The airbag module cannot be
repaired, and must be replaced if deployed or in any way damaged. The inflator assembly is
mounted to the back of the airbag module. The inflator seals the hole in the airbag cushion so it
can discharge the gas it produces directly into the cushion when supplied with the proper electrical
signal. The protective trim cover is fitted to the front of the airbag module and forms a decorative
cover in the center of the steering wheel. Upon airbag deployment, this cover will split at a
predetermined breakout line.
THE AIRBAG MODULE INFLATOR ASSEMBLY CONTAINS SODIUM AND POTASSIUM
NITRATE. THESE MATERIALS ARE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 218
POISONOUS AND EXTREMELY FLAMMABLE. CONTACT WITH ACID, WATER, OR HEAVY
METALS MAY PRODUCE HARMFUL AND IRRITATING GASES (SODIUM HYDROXIDE IS
FORMED IN THE PRESENCE OF MOISTURE) OR COMBUSTIBLE COMPOUNDS. IN
ADDITION, THE PASSENGER AIRBAG MODULE CONTAINS ARGON GAS PRESSURIZED
OVER 2500 PSI. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO DISMANTLE AN AIRBAG MODULE OR TAMPER WITH
ITS INFLATOR. DO NOT PUNCTURE, INCINERATE, OR BRING INTO CONTACT WITH
ELECTRICITY. DO NOT STORE AT TEMPERATURE EXCEEDING 93°C (200°F).
Clockspring
The clockspring is mounted on the steering column behind the steering wheel. This assembly
consists of a plastic housing which contains a flat, ribbon-like, electrically conductive tape that
winds and unwinds with the steering wheel rotation. The clockspring is used to maintain a
continuous electrical circuit between the instrument panel wire harness and the driver side airbag
module, the horn switch, and the vehicle speed control switches ON vehicles that are so equipped.
The clockspring must be properly centered when it is installed on the steering column following any
service removal, or it will be damaged.
The clockspring cannot be repaired; it must be replaced.
Passenger Airbag Module (PAB)
The airbag door in the instrument panel top cover above the glove box is the most visible part of
the passenger side airbag system. Located under the airbag door is the airbag cushion and it's
supporting components. The airbag module includes a housing to which the cushion and inflator
are attached and sealed. The airbag module includes a housing to which the cushion and inflator
are attached and sealed. The airbag module cannot be repaired, and must be replaced if deployed
or in any way damaged. The inflator assembly is mounted to the back of the airbag module. The
inflator includes a small canister of highly compressed argon gas. The inflator seals the hole in the
airbag cushion so it can discharge the compressed gas it contains directly into the cushion when
supplied with the proper electrical signal. The airbag door has a living hinge at the top, which is
secured to the instrument panel top cover. The door also has predetermined breakout lines
concealed beneath its decorative cover. Upon airbag deployment, the airbag door will split at the
breakout lines and the door will pivot out of the way.
The airbag module is secured at the bottom to the steel structural base of the instrument panel
above the glove box opening. The airbag door is serviced as a unit with the passenger side airbag
module, and includes the two passenger heating and air conditioning panel outlet housings.
Following an airbag deployment, the airbag module and the instrument panel assembly must be
replaced.
Passenger Airbag On/Off Switch
A passenger Airbag On/Off Switch located on the instrument panel allows the passenger airbag
module to be turned OFF when certain child restraint devices are being used in the right front
seating position. The switch is equipped with a key cylinder so that the switch position can only be
changed using an ignition key. When the ignition switch is in the On position and the passenger
side airbag is OFF, a Light-Emitting Diode (LED) illuminates an "Off" indicator lamp on the
faceplate of the switch.
The passenger side airbag ON/OFF switch is located on the instrument panel. To turn OFF the
passenger side airbag, turn the key actuator switch from the vertical position to a slanted position
(pointing to the "Off" light indicator), approximately 45 degrees clockwise, remove the key
completely from the switch and verify that the switch actuator hole stays in the new position (45
degrees clockwise from vertical). The switch is spring loaded to the "ON" position. It will return to
the "ON" position unless you remove the key. When the IGNITION is ON, this procedure will
illuminate the "OFF" light indicator on the passenger airbag ON/OFF switch.
To re-enable the passenger side airbag, reverse the procedure above so that the key switch
actuator is returned to a vertical position.
NOTE:
Do not turn ignition ON with key in Switch. Do not turn switch with ignition ON. Do not leave key in
switch. Do not leave the key in the key actuator under any condition.
THE KEY MUST ALWAYS BE REMOVED FROM THE PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF SWITCH
KEY CYLINDER AFTER THE SWITCH HAS BEEN USED.
The Passenger Airbag On/Off Switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if faulty or damaged, the
switch must be replaced
THE AIRBAG MODULE INFLATOR ASSEMBLY CONTAINS SODIUM AZIDE AND POTASSIUM
NITRATE. THESE MATERIALS ARE POISONOUS AND EXTREMELY FLAMMABLE. CONTACT
WITH ACID, WATER, OR HEAVY METALS MAY PRODUCE HARMFUL AND IRRITATING
GASES (SODIUM HYDROXIDE IS FORMED IN THE PRESENCE OF MOISTURE) OR
COMBUSTIBLE COMPOUNDS. IN ADDITION, THE PASSENGER AIRBAG MODULE CONTAINS
ARGON GAS PRESSURIZED TO OVER 2500 PSI. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO DISMANTLE AN
AIRBAG MODULE OR TAMPER WITH ITS INFLATOR. DO NOT PUNCTURE, INCINERATE, OR
BRING INTO CONTACT WITH ELECTRICITY DO NOT STORE AT TEMPERATURE
EXCEEDING 93°C (200°F). REPLACE AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS ONLY WITH PARTS
SPECIFIED IN THE CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS CATALOG. SUBSTITUTE PARTS MAY
APPEAR INTERCHANGEABLE, BUT INTERNAL DIFFERENCES MAY RESULT IN INFERIOR
OCCUPANT PROTECTION. THE FASTENERS, SCREWS, AND BOLTS ORIGINALLY USED
FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS HAVE SPECIAL COATINGS AND ARE
SPECIFICALLY DESIGNED FOR THE AIRBAG BAG SYSTEM. THEY MUST NEVER BE
REPLACED
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 219
WITH ANY SUBSTITUTES. ANY TIME A NEW FASTENER IS NEEDED, REPLACE IT WITH THE
CORRECT FASTENERS PROVIDED IN HE SERVICE PACKAGE OR SPECIFIED IN THE
CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS CATALOG.
Seat Belt Control Timer Module
The Seat Belt Control Timer Module (SCTM) is secured to a bracket underneath the front edge of
the front seat center cushion. The SCTM mounting bracket also serves as the support for the
slide-out seat cup holder unit. The SCTM controls the supply of battery current to both of the front
seat belt retractor latch solenoids. The SCTM contains an electromechanical Gravity (G)-sensor
and an electronic timer circuit. The SCTM monitors the ignition switch state and both door jamb
switches through hard-wired inputs. In response to those inputs, the SCTM controls hard-wired
outputs to both seat belt retractor latch solenoids. The SCTM also sends diagnostic outputs to the
Airbag Control Module (ACM) over a hard-wired fault circuit.
The SCTM provides battery current to energize the seat belt retractor latch solenoids whenever the
ignition switch is in the On or Accessory position, unless the G-sensor input indicates a vehicle
condition that requires the set belt retractor to be latched. When the seat belt retractor latch
solenoids are energized the retractor spools are unlatched, and the seat belt webbing can be
extracted from the retractor. When the solenoids are deenergized the retractor spools latch,
preventing the seat belt webbing from being extracted further from the retractor. This logic ensures
that the seat belts will latch and/or remain latched if battery power is lost during a vehicle collision.
The electromechanical G-sensor within the SCTM monitors the rate of vehicle acceleration and
de-acceleration in any horizontal direction. The G-sensor also responds to the horizontal attitude of
the vehicle, If the G-sensor monitors a gravity force of greater than about 0.7G in any horizontal
direction, or the vehicle is tilted in any direction at an angle of greater than about 45 degrees, the
SCTM will de-energize (lock) the seat belt retractor latch solenoids.
The SCTM electronic timer circuit provides the vehicle occupants with the ability to extract the seat
belt webbing from the retractor spool for a time period of about 30 minutes after the ignition switch
is turned to the Off position. The electronic timer circuit also monitors the state of the door jamb
switches, and unlatches the seat belt retractors after either door jamb switch cycles from open to
closed or from closed to open. Each time the SCTM receives and input indicating a change in the
state of a monitored switch, the 30 minute unlatch timer starts again. The timer also is used to
de-energize the retractor latch solenoids after about 30 minutes, and prevent the battery from being
drained while the vehicle is not being driven.
The hard wired SCTM output to the ACM is used to indicate whether a fault condition is present in
the structural seat belt control system. The ACM monitors the input from the SCTM and sends the
proper messages to the instrument cluster on the Chrysler Collision Detection (CCD) data bus to
turn the seat belt reminder lamp ON or OFF. If the ACM receives a fault input or does not detect
any input from the SCTM, it sets a fault code and sends messages to the instrument cluster to turn
the lamp ON.
The SCTM cannot be repaired. If faulty or damaged, it must be replaced.
Seat Belt Control System Test Mode
The structural seat belt control system has a test mode feature. This feature allows the seat belt
control system to be tested from proper operation while the vehicle is stationary by overriding the
normal Seat Belt Control Timer Module (SCTM) control functions. The seat belt system and the
airbag system must be tested for proper operation following the service of any seat belt control
system or airbag system component. See Airbag Systems for more information on testing of the
airbag system. This test mode will confirm the following: Both door jamb switches and their input circuits to the SCTM are functional.
- The fused B(+), fused ignition switch output (RUN/ACC), and ground circuits to the SCTM are
functional.
- The SCTM fault circuit to the Airbag Control Module (ACM), the ACM, the Chrysler Collision
Detection (CCD) data bus, and the seat belt reminder lamp in the instrument cluster are functional.
- Both seat belt retractor latch solenoids and their circuits are functional and can be activated by
the SCTM.
To initiate the structural seat belt control system test mode, proceed as follows:
1. If the structural seat belt controls system test mode has not been performed previously within the
past 72 hours, reset the SCTM by removing the
Ignition-Off Draw (IOD) fuse from the junction block, the reinstalling it. (Ignition must be OFF).
2. Sit in the driver side front seat of the vehicle and close all doors.
3. Push in the cigar lighter, turn the windshield wipers on "HIGH".
4. Within five seconds the ignition switch must be cycled On, Off, On, Off, On, Off, and then finally
back to On position. Leave the ignition switch
in the On position for the remainder of this procedure. This action enters the seat belt control
system into its test mode for a maximum of five minutes. After five minutes, the seat belt control
system will automatically return to its normal operating mode.
5. The seat belt reminder lamp should light shortly after entering the test mode to confirm that the
seat belt control system is in the test mode, and
that the seat belt control system fault circuit is functional. If the lamp fails to light, use a DRB scan
tool and the proper Diagnostic Procedures to diagnose the SCTM fault circuit to the ACM, the
ACM, and the CCD data bus.
6. Open the driver side front door. Check that both the passenger and driver side outboard front
seat belt retractors are unlatched by slowly pulling
the seat belt webbing out of the retractor. If only one retractor is unlatched, the latched retractor
and circuit must be diagnosed. See Seat Belt Control System in the appropriate service manual for
more information. If both retractors are latched, see Seat Belt Control Timer Module in the
Diagnosis and Testing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 220
7. Close the drive side from door. Check that both the passenger and driver side outboard front
seat belt retractors are latched by slowly pulling the
seat belt webbing out of the retractor. If only one retractor is latched, the unlatched retractor and
circuit must be diagnosed. See Seat Belt Retractor latch Solenoid in the Diagnosis and Testing. If
both retractors are unlatched, see Seat Belt Control Timer Module in the Diagnosis and Testing.
8. Repeat steps # 6 and # 7, but open and close the passenger side front door instead of the driver
side.
9. Turn the ignition switch to the Off position. This will cause the seat belt control system to exit its
test mode and return to normal operation.
10. Turn the ignition switch back to the On position. The seat belt reminder and airbag indicator
lamps should turn OFF shortly after their normal
display functions (about six and seven seconds, respectively). If either lamp remains lighted, use a
DRB scan tool and the proper Diagnostic Procedures to diagnose the SCTM fault circuit to the
ACM, the airbag system, the ACM, and the CCD data bus.
11. If the seat belt control system test mode has timed out prior to completion of the tests (about
five minutes after the test was initiated), go back to
step # 2.
The SCTM is programmed to consider certain parameters as an indication of a faulty Gravity
(G)-sensor. In some peculiar vehicle use situations these parameters may be exceeded, causing
the seat belt reminder lamp to illuminate indicating an SCTM fault, and them extinguish for no
apparent reason. The following parameters should be considered if an intermittent seat belt
reminder lamp illumination complaint is being diagnosed, and the test mode reveals no problems
with the structural seat belt control system operation.
- If the SCTM monitors ten ignition cycles without input from the G-sensor indicating that the
vehicle has accelerated or decelerated sufficiently to require the seat belts to be latched. An
ignition cycle is defined as: The ignition switch turned to the On position for at least thirty minutes,
followed by the ignition switch being turned to the Off position. The SCTM considers this a
G-sensor fault because it would normally be expected that the seat belts would require latching at
some point while driving, within ten ignition cycles. The SCTM will discontinue the fault signal and
reset the ignition cycle counter to zero as soon as it sees a "normal" G-sensor input.
- If the SCTM monitors that the G-sensor input has required the seat belts to remain latched for
more than about four seconds. The SCTM will discontinue the fault signal as soon as it sees a
"normal" G-sensor input.
Airbag Diagnostic Trouble Codes
The Airbag Control Module may report any of the following diagnostic trouble codes.
Airbag diagnostic trouble codes consist of active and stored codes. If more than one code exists,
diagnostic priority should be give to the active codes.
Active diagnostic trouble codes for the airbag system are not permanent and will change the
moment the reasoning for the code is corrected. In certain test procedures, diagnostic trouble
codes are used as a diagnostic tool.
For these codes, replace the Airbag Control Module (ACM) even if set intermittently.
- ACM ACCELEROMETER......FIRING CAPACITOR LOW
- AECM OUTPUT DRIVER CIRCUIT OPEN......LOGIC CAPACITOR LOW
- AECM INTERNAL DIAGNOSTIC CODE # 1......SAFING SENSOR SHORTED
- WARNING LAMP DRIVER ERROR
For these codes, refer to the appropriate diagnostic procedure:
- Cluster Message Mismatch
- Driver Squib Circuit Open
- Driver Squib Circuit Shorted
- Driver Squib Circuit Shorted to Battery
- Driver Squib Circuit Shorted to Ground
- Loss of Ignition Run Only
- Loss of Ignition Run/Start
- No Cluster CCD Message
- Missing or Invalid VIN
- Passenger Squib Circuit Open
- Passenger Squib Circuit Shorted
- Passenger Squib Circuit Shorted to Battery
- Passenger Squib Circuit Shorted to Ground
- SCTM Failure
- SCTM Message Mismatch
- VIN Mismatch
- Warning Lamp Bulb or Driver
Active Codes
The code becomes active as soon as the malfunction is detected or key-OFF, whichever occurs
first. An active trouble code indicates an on-going malfunction. This means that the defect is
currently there every time the airbag control module checks that circuit/function. It is impossible to
erase an
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 221
active code; active codes automatically erase by themselves when the reason for the code has
been corrected.
With the exception of the warning lamp trouble codes or malfunctions, when a malfunction is
detected, the airbag lamp remains lit for a maximum of 12 seconds or as long as the malfunction is
present.
The seat belt lamp replaces the airbag lamp if the airbag lamp is defective. The seat belt lamp
pulses ON and OFF 30 times if the airbag warning lamp is defective.
Stored Codes
Airbag codes are automatically stored in the ACM's memory as soon as the malfunction is
detected. The exception is the "Loss of Ignition Run Only" code which is an active code only.
A "stored" code indicates there was an active code present at some time. However, the code
currently may not be present as an active code, although another active code could be.
When a trouble code occurs, the airbag warning lamp illuminates for 2 seconds minimum (even if
the problem existed for less than 2 seconds). The code is stored, along with the time in minutes it
was active, and the number of times the ignition has been cycled since the problem was last
detected.
The minimum time shown for any code will be one minute, even if the code was actually present for
less than one minute. Thus, the time shown for a code that was present for two minutes 2 seconds,
for example, would be three minutes.
If a malfunction is detected a diagnostic trouble code is stored and will remain stored as long as the
malfunction exists. When and if the malfunction ceases to exist, an ignition cycle count will be
initiated for that code. If the ignition cycle count reaches 100 without a reoccurrence of the same
malfunction, the diagnostic trouble code is erased and that ignition cycle counter is reset to zero. If
the malfunction reoccurs before the count reaches 100, then the ignition cycle counter will be reset
and the diagnostic trouble code will continue to be a stored code.
If a malfunction is not active while performing a diagnostic test procedure, the active code
diagnostic test will not locate the source of the problem. In this case, the stored code can indicate
an area to inspect.
If no obvious problems are found, erase stored codes, and with the ignition "ON" wiggle the wire
harness and connectors, rotate the steering wheel from stop to stop. Recheck for codes
periodically as you work through the system. This procedure may uncover a malfunction that is
difficult to locate.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 222
Central Timer Module: Description and Operation Interior Lighting
The courtesy lights are controlled by the CTM. The door switches are inputs to the CTM and the
courtesy lights are outputs. The glove box lamp and the ash receiver lamp (if equipped) are not
controlled by the CTM, They are hardwired to individual switches and fuses. The ignition key halo
lamp is controlled by the CTM and will remain ON for thirty seconds after the door is closed.
The highline CTM also provides for illuminated entry option. If the CTM detects an unlock signal
from the RKE transmitter, a door disarm switch input or the door jamb switch input, the interior
courtesy lights will be turned ON. The illuminated entry function is canceled if the CTM senses and
ignition "ON" condition or the "lock" command from a valid key fob.
If a door is left open or the dome lamp switch is left in the "ON" position for more than fifteen
minutes, the CTM will extinguish the lamps to avoid discharging the battery. If the lamps are turned
ON by rotation of the headlamp panel dimmer switch, the CTM will not be able to turn them OFF.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 223
Central Timer Module: Description and Operation Central Timer Module
Central Timer Module Description
CENTRAL TIMER MODULE
DESCRIPTION
Two versions of the Central Timer Module (CTM) are available on this vehicle, a base version and
a high-line version. The base version of the CTM is used on base models of the vehicle. It is also
sometimes referred to as the Integrated Electronic Module (IEM). The base version of the CTM
combines the functions of a chime/buzzer module, an intermittent wipe module, and an ignition
lamp time delay relay in a single unit. The base version CTM does not communicate on the CCD
bus.
The high-line version of the CTM is used on high-line vehicles. The high-line CTM provides all of
the functions of the base version CTM, but also is used to control and integrate many of the
additional electronic functions and features included on the high-line models. The high-line version
of the CTM contains a central processing unit and interfaces with other modules in the vehicle on
the Chrysler Collision Detection (CCD) data bus network.
The CCD data bus network allows the sharing of sensor information. This helps to reduce wire
harness complexity reduce internal controller hardware and reduce component sensor current
loads. At the same time, this system provides increased reliability, enhanced diagnostics, and
allows the addition of many new feature capabilities.
One of the features that the high-line CTM supports and controls is the Vehicle Theft Security
System (VTSS). In the VTSS, the CTM receives hard-wired inputs from the door jamb, door lock
cylinder, and ignition switches. The programming in the CTM allows it to process the information
from these inputs and send control outputs to energize or de-energize the headlamp (or security)
relay, horn relay, and the security lamp. The CTM also sends CCD data bus messages to the
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to control the engine no-run feature of the VTSS.
The CTM is located on the right side of the steering column behind the kneeblocker on a metal
bracket welded to the instrument panel. It contains a white 8-way and a green 14-way connector.
For diagnosis of the high-line version of the CTM or the CCD data bus, the use of a DRB scan tool
and the proper Diagnostic Procedures are recommended. The CTM cannot be repaired and, if
faulty or damaged, it must be replaced.
The high-line Central Timer Module (CTM) can also control some features of the audio system
when the vehicle is equipped with the optional RAZ radio receiver and remote radio switches. A
high-line CTM is used on high-line versions of this vehicle. The CTM combines the functions of a
chime/buzzer module, an intermittent wipe module, an illuminated entry module, a remote keyless
entry module, and a vehicle theft security system module in a single unit.
The high-line CTM also controls and integrates many of the additional electronic functions and
features included on models with this option. The RAZ radio receiver with a remote radio switch
option is one of the features that the CTM controls. The CTM is programmed to send switch status
messages over the Chrysler Collision Detection (CCD) data bus to control the volume, seek, and
pre-set station advance functions of the RAZ radio receiver. The CTM monitors the status of the
remote radio switches located on the steering wheel through a hard wired circuit. The CTM then
sends the proper switch status messages to the radio receiver. The electronic circuitry within the
radio receiver responds to the switch status messages it receives by adjusting the radio settings as
requested.
Refer to Remote Radio Switch Description and Operation for more information on this component.
See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc/Radio/Stereo/Remote
Switch
In addition radio receivers connected to the CCD data bus have several audio system functions
that can be diagnosed using a DRB scan tool. Refer to the proper Diagnostic Procedures for more
information on DRB testing of the audio systems.
The high-line Central Timer Module (CTM) can also operate the horn system. A high-line CTM is
used on high-line versions of this vehicle. The CTM combines the functions of a chime/buzzer
module, an intermittent wipe module, an illuminated entry module, a remote keyless entry module,
and a vehicle theft security system module in a single unit.
The high-line CTM also controls and integrates many of the additional electronic functions and
features included on models with this option. The horn relay is one of the hard wired outputs of the
CTM. The high-line CTM is programmed to energize or deenergize the horn relay in response to
certain inputs from the Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS) and/or the Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) system.
Refer to Vehicle Theft Security System Description and Operation for more information on the
VTSS. Refer to Power Lock Systems / Remote Keyless Entry System Description and Operation
for more information on the RKE system. See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and
Alarm Systems/Keyless Entry/Description and Operation
Both the base and the high-line versions of the CTM support the intermittent wipe and
wipe-after-wash features, but only the high-line CTM supports the speed sensitive intermittent
wipe. The intermit-tent wipe relay is one of the outputs that both the base and the high-line versions
of the CTM can control. Each CTM is programmed to energize or de-energize the intermittent wipe
relay in response to certain inputs from the windshield wiper and washer switches and from the
windshield wiper motor park switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 224
For the speed sensitive intermittent wipe feature, the high-line CTM also uses vehicle speed
messages, which are received on the CCD data bus from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
See Wiper System Testing and Inspection for diagnosis of the base version of the CTM. See:
Wiper and Washer Systems/Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of the high-line version of the CTM or the CCD data bus, refer to Body Control
Module Testing and Inspection. See: Testing and Inspection
The CTM cannot be repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must be replaced.
The high-line CTM controls features and functions of the power lock, illuminated entry, and Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) systems. The high-line CTM receives hard-wired inputs from the power lock
switches, CCD message inputs from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) and Airbag Control
Module (ACM), and coded radio frequency inputs from the RKE transmitters. In response to those
and many other inputs, the internal programming of the CTM sends the proper outputs to control
the power lock motors, the headlamp (or security) and horn relays, and the courtesy lamps.
Some of the features and functions of the power lock, illuminated entry and RKE systems made
possible because of the communication of the CTM on the CCD data bus network include:
- A door-lock inhibit feature which prevents the power lock system from being energized with a
power door lock switch if the key is in the ignition and/or the headlamps are on. However, the locks
can still be operated manually, with a key or energized with the RKE transmitter.
- A Panic Mode feature which can provide additional personal security and protection. When the
Panic button on the RKE transmitter is depressed the vehicle horn will pulse, the headlights will
flash, and the interior lights will illuminate on the vehicle for about three minutes, or until the Panic
button is depressed a second time. A vehicle speed of about 24 kilometers-per-hour (15
miles-per-hour) will also cancel the panic mode.
- An enhanced accident response feature will unlock both doors, then prevent the power door locks
from locking the doors for a predetermined time interval, after receiving a CCD message from the
ACM indicating a frontal impact of the vehicle requiring airbag deployment. This feature will also
turn on the courtesy lamps ten seconds after receiving the ACM deployment message, if the CCD
vehicle speed message from the PCM indicates that the vehicle is not moving. Of course, these
responses are dependent upon functional battery power and wiring circuitry following the impact.
- Rolling door locks is a programmable feature of the power lock system. This feature will
automatically lock all of the doors after the vehicle reaches a speed of about 24
kilometers-per-hour (15 miles-per hour) or greater. This feature will also lock the doors if a door is
opened, then closed again, at any speed above 24 kilometers-per-hour (15 miles-per-hour).
- A programmable feature of the RKE system is the enabling or disabling of the horn chirp following
activation of the RKE Lock function. This feature can be enabled or disabled and, if enabled, the
horn chirp duration (twenty or forty milliseconds) can be selected.
Both versions of the CTM are mounted under the driver side end of the instrument panel, inboard
of the instrument panel steering column opening. Refer to Central Timer Module Replacement of
Instrument Panel Systems for the service procedures.
The programmable features of the CTM can be enabled or disabled using the DRB scan tool as
described in the proper Diagnostic Procedures. For diagnosis of the high-line version of the CTM or
of the CCD data bus, a DRB scan tool and the proper Diagnostic Procedures are recommended.
The CTM cannot be repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must be replaced.
OPERATION
Some of the functions and features that the CTM supports or controls include: Chimes for the following conditions:
- Headlamps on with ignition off and driver door open warning
- Key in ignition with ignition off and driver door open warning
- ABS lamp warning (if the vehicle is so equipped)
- Airbag lamp warning
- Check engine lamp warning
- Check gauges lamp warning
- Low fuel lamp warning
- Low washer fluid lamp warning
- Seat belt reminder lamp warning
- Transmission oil temperature lamp warning (automatic transmission)
- Courtesy lamp time-out (high-line only)
- Ignition key lamp timer
- Intermittent wipe control
- Enhanced accident response (high-line only)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 225
- Horn chirp upon door lock with RKE (programmable) (high-line only)
- Illuminated entry (high-line only)
- Power door lock control (high-line only)
- Power lock inhibit (high-line only)
- Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) (high-line only)
- Remote radio switches (high-line only)
- Rolling door locks (programmable) (high-line only)
- Speed sensitive intermittent wipe (high-line only)
- Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS) (high-line only) (if the vehicle is so equipped)
- Wipe after wash (high-line only).
CENTRAL TIMER MODULE DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
Door Disarm Switch Failure Door lock Switch Failure Door Unlock Switch Failure Wiper Park
Switch Failure EEPROM Checksum Failure Internal ROM Test Failure
Central Timer Module Diagnostic Trouble Codes
Door Disarm Switch Failure Door lock Switch Failure Door Unlock Switch Failure Wiper Park
Switch Failure EEPROM Checksum Failure Internal ROM Test Failure
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 226
Central Timer Module: Description and Operation Chime System
The chime system is built into the CTM. The system also supports an external chime request from
the instrument cluster. This feature allows the instrument cluster to request a chime from the CTM
for gauge problems and tell tale warnings. The CTM chime functions will have priority over the MIC
chime requests. There are two chime rates, Low; 50 chimes per minute for reminders and High; 80
chimes per minute for serious conditions that require immediate attention. The high rate chime
sounds when the key is left in the ignition and the driver doors is open or the headlights are left ON.
The low rate chime sounds for any of the other conditions. There is a variable rate feature that
allows the chime to sound continuously for key-in and headlamp warning as long as the door is
open. The seat belt warning chime is activated for 4 to 6 seconds, and all other chime conditions
will activate the chime once at the same time the warning light on the cluster is illuminated.
The chime will sound for the following conditions:
High Rate Key in Ignition Warning ignition OFF, key in ignition, drivers door open
- Ignition OFF, headlamps ON, drivers door open Low Rate
- Seat belt warning-6 seconds after key ON (6 to 8 chimes) or until belt is buckled
- Airbag lamp illuminated (3 times after prove-out)
- Anti-lock lamp illuminated (2 chimes after prove- out if equipped)
- Check engine lamp illuminated (2 chimes after prove-out)
- Check gauges lamp illuminated (2 chimes)
- Engine Temp High--when gauge enters red zone (2 chimes)
- Low fuel- when fuel level reaches /8 tank (2 chimes)
- Low washer fluid (2 chimes)
- Wait to start (diesel only) (2 chimes)
- Water in fuel (diesel only) ( 2 chimes)
If the ignition switch is turned to the run/start/acc position and the driver's door is closed, then
opened, the warning chime is defeated. This allows the doors to be open without the warning
chime constantly sounding. The CTM stays in this mode until the ignition switch is turned to the
"OFF" position, then normal function will be restored. (Highline CTM only).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 227
Central Timer Module: Description and Operation
Airbag System Description
The Airbag Control Module (ACM) is secured to a bracket on the floor panel transmission tunnel
below the instrument panel inside the vehicle. The ACM mounting bracket also serves as the
instrument; panel center support. The ACM contains a microprocessor, the impact sensor, and
energy storage capacitor. The microprocessor contains the air-bag system logic. The ACM system
logic includes On-Board Diagnostics (OBD) capability, and communicates with the instrument
cluster circuitry on the Chrysler Collision Detection (CCD) data bus to control the airbag indicator
lamp.
The microprocessor in the ACM monitors the impact sensor signal and the airbag system electrical
circuits to determine the system readiness. If the ACM detects a monitored system fault, it sends
messages to the instrument cluster on the CCD data bus to turn ON the airbag indicator lamp. A
pre-programmed decision algorithm in the ACM microprocessor determines when the deceleration
rate signaled by the impact sensor indicates an impact that is severe enough to require airbag
system protection. when the programmed conditions are met, the ACM sends and electrical signal
to deploy the airbag system components.
Only one impact sensor is used in this airbag system. The impact sensor is an accelerometer that
senses the rate of the vehicle deceleration, which provides verification of the direction and severity
of an impact. The impact sensor is calibrated for the specific vehicle, and is only serviced as a unit
with the ACM.
The ACM also contains an energy-storage capacitor. This capacitor stores enough electrical
energy to deploy the airbags, for one second following a battery disconnect or failure during and
impact. The purpose of the capacitor is to provide airbag system protection in a severe secondary
impact if the initial impact has damaged or disconnected the battery, but was not severe enough to
deploy the airbags.
THE AIRBAG SYSTEM IS A SENSITIVE,COMPLEX ELECTROMECHANICAL UNIT.BEFORE
ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED STEERING
WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU MUST FIRST
DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE ROUND CABLE. THEN WAIT TWO
MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO CHARGE BEFORE FURTHER SYSTEM
SERVICE. THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO
DO THIS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE
PERSONAL INJURY. NEVER STRIKE OR KICK THE AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE, AS IT CAN
DAMAGE THE IMPACT SENSOR OR AFFECT ITS CALIBRATION. IF AN AIRBAG CONTROL
MODULE IS ACCIDENTALLY DROPPED DURING SERVICE, THE MODULE MUST BE
SCRAPPED AND REPLACED WITH A NEW UNIT.
The AIRBAG warning lamp is the only point at which the customer can observe "symptoms" of a
system malfunction. Whenever the ignition key is turned to the "RUN" or "START" position, the MIC
performs a lamp check by turning the AIRBAG warning lamp ON for 6-8 seconds. If the lamp
remains OFF; it means that the ACM has checked the system and found it to be free of discernible
malfunctions. If the lamp remains ON, there could be an active fault in the system or the MIC lamp
circuit may be internally shorted to ground, If the lamp comes on and stays ON for a period longer
than 6-8 seconds then goes OFF; there is usually an intermittent problem in the system.
The MIC monitors the airbag warning lamp and seat belt warning lamp during the bulb check for a
defective bulb or lamp driver circuit. The MIC tests the airbag lamp during the cluster bulb check
and substitutes the seat belt lamp if the airbag lamp is defective. If the airbag lamp is defective the
MIC will turn the seat belt light ON and OFF approximately 30 times to warn the driver that the
airbag lamp is defective. The lamp status is sent to the ACM continuously via a CCD bus message.
The seat belt lamp acts as a backup in the event that the AIRBAG lamp is defective. This
information is sent to the ACM continuously via a CCD bus message.
Perform the WARNING LAMP BULB OR DRIVER procedure in this book to find the cause of any
customer complaint regarding the AIRBAG warning lamp, such as:
- warning lamp does not illuminate
- warning lamp stays illuminated with no active DTC's
Club cab and quad cab models of this vehicle are equipped with a structural seat belt system. The
structural seat belt system includes a Seatbelt Control Timer Module (SCTM). The SCTM has a
hardwired input to the ACM. If a fault input form the SCTM is detected, or the SCTM is not
connected, the ACM sends a message to the instrument cluster on the CCD data bus to turn ON
the seat belt reminder lamp. See Seat Belt Control Timer Module.
ACM cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
Driver Airbag Module (DAB)
The airbag protective trim cover is the most visible part of the driver side airbag system. The
module is mounted directly to the steering wheel. Located under the trim cover are the horn switch,
the airbag cushion, and the airbag cushion supporting components. The airbag module includes a
housing to which the cushion and inflator are attached and sealed. The airbag module cannot be
repaired, and must be replaced if deployed or in any way damaged. The inflator assembly is
mounted to the back of the airbag module. The inflator seals the hole in the airbag cushion so it
can discharge the gas it produces directly into the cushion when supplied with the proper electrical
signal. The protective trim cover is fitted to the front of the airbag module and forms a decorative
cover in the center of the steering wheel. Upon airbag deployment, this cover will split at a
predetermined breakout line.
THE AIRBAG MODULE INFLATOR ASSEMBLY CONTAINS SODIUM AND POTASSIUM
NITRATE. THESE MATERIALS ARE POISONOUS AND EXTREMELY FLAMMABLE. CONTACT
WITH ACID, WATER, OR HEAVY METALS MAY PRODUCE HARMFUL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 228
AND IRRITATING GASES (SODIUM HYDROXIDE IS FORMED IN THE PRESENCE OF
MOISTURE) OR COMBUSTIBLE COMPOUNDS. IN ADDITION, THE PASSENGER AIRBAG
MODULE CONTAINS ARGON GAS PRESSURIZED OVER 2500 PSI. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO
DISMANTLE AN AIRBAG MODULE OR TAMPER WITH ITS INFLATOR. DO NOT PUNCTURE,
INCINERATE, OR BRING INTO CONTACT WITH ELECTRICITY. DO NOT STORE AT
TEMPERATURE EXCEEDING 93°C (200°F).
Clockspring
The clockspring is mounted on the steering column behind the steering wheel. This assembly
consists of a plastic housing which contains a flat, ribbon-like, electrically conductive tape that
winds and unwinds with the steering wheel rotation. The clockspring is used to maintain a
continuous electrical circuit between the instrument panel wire harness and the driver side airbag
module, the horn switch, and the vehicle speed control switches ON vehicles that are so equipped.
The clockspring must be properly centered when it is installed on the steering column following any
service removal, or it will be damaged.
The clockspring cannot be repaired; it must be replaced.
Passenger Airbag Module (PAB)
The airbag door in the instrument panel top cover above the glove box is the most visible part of
the passenger side airbag system. Located under the airbag door is the airbag cushion and it's
supporting components. The airbag module includes a housing to which the cushion and inflator
are attached and sealed. The airbag module includes a housing to which the cushion and inflator
are attached and sealed. The airbag module cannot be repaired, and must be replaced if deployed
or in any way damaged. The inflator assembly is mounted to the back of the airbag module. The
inflator includes a small canister of highly compressed argon gas. The inflator seals the hole in the
airbag cushion so it can discharge the compressed gas it contains directly into the cushion when
supplied with the proper electrical signal. The airbag door has a living hinge at the top, which is
secured to the instrument panel top cover. The door also has predetermined breakout lines
concealed beneath its decorative cover. Upon airbag deployment, the airbag door will split at the
breakout lines and the door will pivot out of the way.
The airbag module is secured at the bottom to the steel structural base of the instrument panel
above the glove box opening. The airbag door is serviced as a unit with the passenger side airbag
module, and includes the two passenger heating and air conditioning panel outlet housings.
Following an airbag deployment, the airbag module and the instrument panel assembly must be
replaced.
Passenger Airbag On/Off Switch
A passenger Airbag On/Off Switch located on the instrument panel allows the passenger airbag
module to be turned OFF when certain child restraint devices are being used in the right front
seating position. The switch is equipped with a key cylinder so that the switch position can only be
changed using an ignition key. When the ignition switch is in the On position and the passenger
side airbag is OFF, a Light-Emitting Diode (LED) illuminates an "Off" indicator lamp on the
faceplate of the switch.
The passenger side airbag ON/OFF switch is located on the instrument panel. To turn OFF the
passenger side airbag, turn the key actuator switch from the vertical position to a slanted position
(pointing to the "Off" light indicator), approximately 45 degrees clockwise, remove the key
completely from the switch and verify that the switch actuator hole stays in the new position (45
degrees clockwise from vertical). The switch is spring loaded to the "ON" position. It will return to
the "ON" position unless you remove the key. When the IGNITION is ON, this procedure will
illuminate the "OFF" light indicator on the passenger airbag ON/OFF switch.
To re-enable the passenger side airbag, reverse the procedure above so that the key switch
actuator is returned to a vertical position.
NOTE:
Do not turn ignition ON with key in Switch. Do not turn switch with ignition ON. Do not leave key in
switch. Do not leave the key in the key actuator under any condition.
THE KEY MUST ALWAYS BE REMOVED FROM THE PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF SWITCH
KEY CYLINDER AFTER THE SWITCH HAS BEEN USED.
The Passenger Airbag On/Off Switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if faulty or damaged, the
switch must be replaced
THE AIRBAG MODULE INFLATOR ASSEMBLY CONTAINS SODIUM AZIDE AND POTASSIUM
NITRATE. THESE MATERIALS ARE POISONOUS AND EXTREMELY FLAMMABLE. CONTACT
WITH ACID, WATER, OR HEAVY METALS MAY PRODUCE HARMFUL AND IRRITATING
GASES (SODIUM HYDROXIDE IS FORMED IN THE PRESENCE OF MOISTURE) OR
COMBUSTIBLE COMPOUNDS. IN ADDITION, THE PASSENGER AIRBAG MODULE CONTAINS
ARGON GAS PRESSURIZED TO OVER 2500 PSI. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO DISMANTLE AN
AIRBAG MODULE OR TAMPER WITH ITS INFLATOR. DO NOT PUNCTURE, INCINERATE, OR
BRING INTO CONTACT WITH ELECTRICITY DO NOT STORE AT TEMPERATURE
EXCEEDING 93°C (200°F). REPLACE AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS ONLY WITH PARTS
SPECIFIED IN THE CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS CATALOG. SUBSTITUTE PARTS MAY
APPEAR INTERCHANGEABLE, BUT INTERNAL DIFFERENCES MAY RESULT IN INFERIOR
OCCUPANT PROTECTION. THE FASTENERS, SCREWS, AND BOLTS ORIGINALLY USED
FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS HAVE SPECIAL COATINGS AND ARE
SPECIFICALLY DESIGNED FOR THE AIRBAG BAG SYSTEM. THEY MUST NEVER BE
REPLACED WITH ANY SUBSTITUTES. ANY TIME A NEW FASTENER IS NEEDED, REPLACE
IT WITH THE CORRECT FASTENERS
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 229
PROVIDED IN HE SERVICE PACKAGE OR SPECIFIED IN THE CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS
CATALOG.
Seat Belt Control Timer Module
The Seat Belt Control Timer Module (SCTM) is secured to a bracket underneath the front edge of
the front seat center cushion. The SCTM mounting bracket also serves as the support for the
slide-out seat cup holder unit. The SCTM controls the supply of battery current to both of the front
seat belt retractor latch solenoids. The SCTM contains an electromechanical Gravity (G)-sensor
and an electronic timer circuit. The SCTM monitors the ignition switch state and both door jamb
switches through hard-wired inputs. In response to those inputs, the SCTM controls hard-wired
outputs to both seat belt retractor latch solenoids. The SCTM also sends diagnostic outputs to the
Airbag Control Module (ACM) over a hard-wired fault circuit.
The SCTM provides battery current to energize the seat belt retractor latch solenoids whenever the
ignition switch is in the On or Accessory position, unless the G-sensor input indicates a vehicle
condition that requires the set belt retractor to be latched. When the seat belt retractor latch
solenoids are energized the retractor spools are unlatched, and the seat belt webbing can be
extracted from the retractor. When the solenoids are deenergized the retractor spools latch,
preventing the seat belt webbing from being extracted further from the retractor. This logic ensures
that the seat belts will latch and/or remain latched if battery power is lost during a vehicle collision.
The electromechanical G-sensor within the SCTM monitors the rate of vehicle acceleration and
de-acceleration in any horizontal direction. The G-sensor also responds to the horizontal attitude of
the vehicle, If the G-sensor monitors a gravity force of greater than about 0.7G in any horizontal
direction, or the vehicle is tilted in any direction at an angle of greater than about 45 degrees, the
SCTM will de-energize (lock) the seat belt retractor latch solenoids.
The SCTM electronic timer circuit provides the vehicle occupants with the ability to extract the seat
belt webbing from the retractor spool for a time period of about 30 minutes after the ignition switch
is turned to the Off position. The electronic timer circuit also monitors the state of the door jamb
switches, and unlatches the seat belt retractors after either door jamb switch cycles from open to
closed or from closed to open. Each time the SCTM receives and input indicating a change in the
state of a monitored switch, the 30 minute unlatch timer starts again. The timer also is used to
de-energize the retractor latch solenoids after about 30 minutes, and prevent the battery from being
drained while the vehicle is not being driven.
The hard wired SCTM output to the ACM is used to indicate whether a fault condition is present in
the structural seat belt control system. The ACM monitors the input from the SCTM and sends the
proper messages to the instrument cluster on the Chrysler Collision Detection (CCD) data bus to
turn the seat belt reminder lamp ON or OFF. If the ACM receives a fault input or does not detect
any input from the SCTM, it sets a fault code and sends messages to the instrument cluster to turn
the lamp ON.
The SCTM cannot be repaired. If faulty or damaged, it must be replaced.
Seat Belt Control System Test Mode
The structural seat belt control system has a test mode feature. This feature allows the seat belt
control system to be tested from proper operation while the vehicle is stationary by overriding the
normal Seat Belt Control Timer Module (SCTM) control functions. The seat belt system and the
airbag system must be tested for proper operation following the service of any seat belt control
system or airbag system component. See Airbag Systems for more information on testing of the
airbag system. This test mode will confirm the following: Both door jamb switches and their input circuits to the SCTM are functional.
- The fused B(+), fused ignition switch output (RUN/ACC), and ground circuits to the SCTM are
functional.
- The SCTM fault circuit to the Airbag Control Module (ACM), the ACM, the Chrysler Collision
Detection (CCD) data bus, and the seat belt reminder lamp in the instrument cluster are functional.
- Both seat belt retractor latch solenoids and their circuits are functional and can be activated by
the SCTM.
To initiate the structural seat belt control system test mode, proceed as follows:
1. If the structural seat belt controls system test mode has not been performed previously within the
past 72 hours, reset the SCTM by removing the
Ignition-Off Draw (IOD) fuse from the junction block, the reinstalling it. (Ignition must be OFF).
2. Sit in the driver side front seat of the vehicle and close all doors.
3. Push in the cigar lighter, turn the windshield wipers on "HIGH".
4. Within five seconds the ignition switch must be cycled On, Off, On, Off, On, Off, and then finally
back to On position. Leave the ignition switch
in the On position for the remainder of this procedure. This action enters the seat belt control
system into its test mode for a maximum of five minutes. After five minutes, the seat belt control
system will automatically return to its normal operating mode.
5. The seat belt reminder lamp should light shortly after entering the test mode to confirm that the
seat belt control system is in the test mode, and
that the seat belt control system fault circuit is functional. If the lamp fails to light, use a DRB scan
tool and the proper Diagnostic Procedures to diagnose the SCTM fault circuit to the ACM, the
ACM, and the CCD data bus.
6. Open the driver side front door. Check that both the passenger and driver side outboard front
seat belt retractors are unlatched by slowly pulling
the seat belt webbing out of the retractor. If only one retractor is unlatched, the latched retractor
and circuit must be diagnosed. See Seat Belt Control System in the appropriate service manual for
more information. If both retractors are latched, see Seat Belt Control Timer Module in the
Diagnosis and Testing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 230
7. Close the drive side from door. Check that both the passenger and driver side outboard front
seat belt retractors are latched by slowly pulling the
seat belt webbing out of the retractor. If only one retractor is latched, the unlatched retractor and
circuit must be diagnosed. See Seat Belt Retractor latch Solenoid in the Diagnosis and Testing. If
both retractors are unlatched, see Seat Belt Control Timer Module in the Diagnosis and Testing.
8. Repeat steps # 6 and # 7, but open and close the passenger side front door instead of the driver
side.
9. Turn the ignition switch to the Off position. This will cause the seat belt control system to exit its
test mode and return to normal operation.
10. Turn the ignition switch back to the On position. The seat belt reminder and airbag indicator
lamps should turn OFF shortly after their normal
display functions (about six and seven seconds, respectively). If either lamp remains lighted, use a
DRB scan tool and the proper Diagnostic Procedures to diagnose the SCTM fault circuit to the
ACM, the airbag system, the ACM, and the CCD data bus.
11. If the seat belt control system test mode has timed out prior to completion of the tests (about
five minutes after the test was initiated), go back to
step # 2.
The SCTM is programmed to consider certain parameters as an indication of a faulty Gravity
(G)-sensor. In some peculiar vehicle use situations these parameters may be exceeded, causing
the seat belt reminder lamp to illuminate indicating an SCTM fault, and them extinguish for no
apparent reason. The following parameters should be considered if an intermittent seat belt
reminder lamp illumination complaint is being diagnosed, and the test mode reveals no problems
with the structural seat belt control system operation.
- If the SCTM monitors ten ignition cycles without input from the G-sensor indicating that the
vehicle has accelerated or decelerated sufficiently to require the seat belts to be latched. An
ignition cycle is defined as: The ignition switch turned to the On position for at least thirty minutes,
followed by the ignition switch being turned to the Off position. The SCTM considers this a
G-sensor fault because it would normally be expected that the seat belts would require latching at
some point while driving, within ten ignition cycles. The SCTM will discontinue the fault signal and
reset the ignition cycle counter to zero as soon as it sees a "normal" G-sensor input.
- If the SCTM monitors that the G-sensor input has required the seat belts to remain latched for
more than about four seconds. The SCTM will discontinue the fault signal as soon as it sees a
"normal" G-sensor input.
Airbag Diagnostic Trouble Codes
The Airbag Control Module may report any of the following diagnostic trouble codes.
Airbag diagnostic trouble codes consist of active and stored codes. If more than one code exists,
diagnostic priority should be give to the active codes.
Active diagnostic trouble codes for the airbag system are not permanent and will change the
moment the reasoning for the code is corrected. In certain test procedures, diagnostic trouble
codes are used as a diagnostic tool.
For these codes, replace the Airbag Control Module (ACM) even if set intermittently.
- ACM ACCELEROMETER......FIRING CAPACITOR LOW
- AECM OUTPUT DRIVER CIRCUIT OPEN......LOGIC CAPACITOR LOW
- AECM INTERNAL DIAGNOSTIC CODE # 1......SAFING SENSOR SHORTED
- WARNING LAMP DRIVER ERROR
For these codes, refer to the appropriate diagnostic procedure:
- Cluster Message Mismatch
- Driver Squib Circuit Open
- Driver Squib Circuit Shorted
- Driver Squib Circuit Shorted to Battery
- Driver Squib Circuit Shorted to Ground
- Loss of Ignition Run Only
- Loss of Ignition Run/Start
- No Cluster CCD Message
- Missing or Invalid VIN
- Passenger Squib Circuit Open
- Passenger Squib Circuit Shorted
- Passenger Squib Circuit Shorted to Battery
- Passenger Squib Circuit Shorted to Ground
- SCTM Failure
- SCTM Message Mismatch
- VIN Mismatch
- Warning Lamp Bulb or Driver
Active Codes
The code becomes active as soon as the malfunction is detected or key-OFF, whichever occurs
first. An active trouble code indicates an on-going malfunction. This means that the defect is
currently there every time the airbag control module checks that circuit/function. It is impossible to
erase an
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 231
active code; active codes automatically erase by themselves when the reason for the code has
been corrected.
With the exception of the warning lamp trouble codes or malfunctions, when a malfunction is
detected, the airbag lamp remains lit for a maximum of 12 seconds or as long as the malfunction is
present.
The seat belt lamp replaces the airbag lamp if the airbag lamp is defective. The seat belt lamp
pulses ON and OFF 30 times if the airbag warning lamp is defective.
Stored Codes
Airbag codes are automatically stored in the ACM's memory as soon as the malfunction is
detected. The exception is the "Loss of Ignition Run Only" code which is an active code only.
A "stored" code indicates there was an active code present at some time. However, the code
currently may not be present as an active code, although another active code could be.
When a trouble code occurs, the airbag warning lamp illuminates for 2 seconds minimum (even if
the problem existed for less than 2 seconds). The code is stored, along with the time in minutes it
was active, and the number of times the ignition has been cycled since the problem was last
detected.
The minimum time shown for any code will be one minute, even if the code was actually present for
less than one minute. Thus, the time shown for a code that was present for two minutes 2 seconds,
for example, would be three minutes.
If a malfunction is detected a diagnostic trouble code is stored and will remain stored as long as the
malfunction exists. When and if the malfunction ceases to exist, an ignition cycle count will be
initiated for that code. If the ignition cycle count reaches 100 without a reoccurrence of the same
malfunction, the diagnostic trouble code is erased and that ignition cycle counter is reset to zero. If
the malfunction reoccurs before the count reaches 100, then the ignition cycle counter will be reset
and the diagnostic trouble code will continue to be a stored code.
If a malfunction is not active while performing a diagnostic test procedure, the active code
diagnostic test will not locate the source of the problem. In this case, the stored code can indicate
an area to inspect.
If no obvious problems are found, erase stored codes, and with the ignition "ON" wiggle the wire
harness and connectors, rotate the steering wheel from stop to stop. Recheck for codes
periodically as you work through the system. This procedure may uncover a malfunction that is
difficult to locate.
Interior Lighting
The courtesy lights are controlled by the CTM. The door switches are inputs to the CTM and the
courtesy lights are outputs. The glove box lamp and the ash receiver lamp (if equipped) are not
controlled by the CTM, They are hardwired to individual switches and fuses. The ignition key halo
lamp is controlled by the CTM and will remain ON for thirty seconds after the door is closed.
The highline CTM also provides for illuminated entry option. If the CTM detects an unlock signal
from the RKE transmitter, a door disarm switch input or the door jamb switch input, the interior
courtesy lights will be turned ON. The illuminated entry function is canceled if the CTM senses and
ignition "ON" condition or the "lock" command from a valid key fob.
If a door is left open or the dome lamp switch is left in the "ON" position for more than fifteen
minutes, the CTM will extinguish the lamps to avoid discharging the battery. If the lamps are turned
ON by rotation of the headlamp panel dimmer switch, the CTM will not be able to turn them OFF.
Central Timer Module Description
CENTRAL TIMER MODULE
DESCRIPTION
Two versions of the Central Timer Module (CTM) are available on this vehicle, a base version and
a high-line version. The base version of the CTM is used on base models of the vehicle. It is also
sometimes referred to as the Integrated Electronic Module (IEM). The base version of the CTM
combines the functions of a chime/buzzer module, an intermittent wipe module, and an ignition
lamp time delay relay in a single unit. The base version CTM does not communicate on the CCD
bus.
The high-line version of the CTM is used on high-line vehicles. The high-line CTM provides all of
the functions of the base version CTM, but also is used to control and integrate many of the
additional electronic functions and features included on the high-line models. The high-line version
of the CTM contains a central processing unit and interfaces with other modules in the vehicle on
the Chrysler Collision Detection (CCD) data bus network.
The CCD data bus network allows the sharing of sensor information. This helps to reduce wire
harness complexity reduce internal controller hardware and reduce component sensor current
loads. At the same time, this system provides increased reliability, enhanced diagnostics, and
allows the addition of many new feature capabilities.
One of the features that the high-line CTM supports and controls is the Vehicle Theft Security
System (VTSS). In the VTSS, the CTM receives hard-wired inputs from the door jamb, door lock
cylinder, and ignition switches. The programming in the CTM allows it to process the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 232
information from these inputs and send control outputs to energize or de-energize the headlamp (or
security) relay, horn relay, and the security lamp. The CTM also sends CCD data bus messages to
the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to control the engine no-run feature of the VTSS.
The CTM is located on the right side of the steering column behind the kneeblocker on a metal
bracket welded to the instrument panel. It contains a white 8-way and a green 14-way connector.
For diagnosis of the high-line version of the CTM or the CCD data bus, the use of a DRB scan tool
and the proper Diagnostic Procedures are recommended. The CTM cannot be repaired and, if
faulty or damaged, it must be replaced.
The high-line Central Timer Module (CTM) can also control some features of the audio system
when the vehicle is equipped with the optional RAZ radio receiver and remote radio switches. A
high-line CTM is used on high-line versions of this vehicle. The CTM combines the functions of a
chime/buzzer module, an intermittent wipe module, an illuminated entry module, a remote keyless
entry module, and a vehicle theft security system module in a single unit.
The high-line CTM also controls and integrates many of the additional electronic functions and
features included on models with this option. The RAZ radio receiver with a remote radio switch
option is one of the features that the CTM controls. The CTM is programmed to send switch status
messages over the Chrysler Collision Detection (CCD) data bus to control the volume, seek, and
pre-set station advance functions of the RAZ radio receiver. The CTM monitors the status of the
remote radio switches located on the steering wheel through a hard wired circuit. The CTM then
sends the proper switch status messages to the radio receiver. The electronic circuitry within the
radio receiver responds to the switch status messages it receives by adjusting the radio settings as
requested.
Refer to Remote Radio Switch Description and Operation for more information on this component.
See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Radio, Stereo, and Compact Disc/Radio/Stereo/Remote
Switch
In addition radio receivers connected to the CCD data bus have several audio system functions
that can be diagnosed using a DRB scan tool. Refer to the proper Diagnostic Procedures for more
information on DRB testing of the audio systems.
The high-line Central Timer Module (CTM) can also operate the horn system. A high-line CTM is
used on high-line versions of this vehicle. The CTM combines the functions of a chime/buzzer
module, an intermittent wipe module, an illuminated entry module, a remote keyless entry module,
and a vehicle theft security system module in a single unit.
The high-line CTM also controls and integrates many of the additional electronic functions and
features included on models with this option. The horn relay is one of the hard wired outputs of the
CTM. The high-line CTM is programmed to energize or deenergize the horn relay in response to
certain inputs from the Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS) and/or the Remote Keyless Entry
(RKE) system.
Refer to Vehicle Theft Security System Description and Operation for more information on the
VTSS. Refer to Power Lock Systems / Remote Keyless Entry System Description and Operation
for more information on the RKE system. See: Accessories and Optional Equipment/Antitheft and
Alarm Systems/Keyless Entry/Description and Operation
Both the base and the high-line versions of the CTM support the intermittent wipe and
wipe-after-wash features, but only the high-line CTM supports the speed sensitive intermittent
wipe. The intermit-tent wipe relay is one of the outputs that both the base and the high-line versions
of the CTM can control. Each CTM is programmed to energize or de-energize the intermittent wipe
relay in response to certain inputs from the windshield wiper and washer switches and from the
windshield wiper motor park switch.
For the speed sensitive intermittent wipe feature, the high-line CTM also uses vehicle speed
messages, which are received on the CCD data bus from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM).
See Wiper System Testing and Inspection for diagnosis of the base version of the CTM. See:
Wiper and Washer Systems/Testing and Inspection
For diagnosis of the high-line version of the CTM or the CCD data bus, refer to Body Control
Module Testing and Inspection. See: Testing and Inspection
The CTM cannot be repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must be replaced.
The high-line CTM controls features and functions of the power lock, illuminated entry, and Remote
Keyless Entry (RKE) systems. The high-line CTM receives hard-wired inputs from the power lock
switches, CCD message inputs from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) and Airbag Control
Module (ACM), and coded radio frequency inputs from the RKE transmitters. In response to those
and many other inputs, the internal programming of the CTM sends the proper outputs to control
the power lock motors, the headlamp (or security) and horn relays, and the courtesy lamps.
Some of the features and functions of the power lock, illuminated entry and RKE systems made
possible because of the communication of the CTM on the CCD data bus network include:
- A door-lock inhibit feature which prevents the power lock system from being energized with a
power door lock switch if the key is in the ignition and/or the headlamps are on. However, the locks
can still be operated manually, with a key or energized with the RKE transmitter.
- A Panic Mode feature which can provide additional personal security and protection. When the
Panic button on the RKE transmitter is
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 233
depressed the vehicle horn will pulse, the headlights will flash, and the interior lights will illuminate
on the vehicle for about three minutes, or until the Panic button is depressed a second time. A
vehicle speed of about 24 kilometers-per-hour (15 miles-per-hour) will also cancel the panic mode.
- An enhanced accident response feature will unlock both doors, then prevent the power door locks
from locking the doors for a predetermined time interval, after receiving a CCD message from the
ACM indicating a frontal impact of the vehicle requiring airbag deployment. This feature will also
turn on the courtesy lamps ten seconds after receiving the ACM deployment message, if the CCD
vehicle speed message from the PCM indicates that the vehicle is not moving. Of course, these
responses are dependent upon functional battery power and wiring circuitry following the impact.
- Rolling door locks is a programmable feature of the power lock system. This feature will
automatically lock all of the doors after the vehicle reaches a speed of about 24
kilometers-per-hour (15 miles-per hour) or greater. This feature will also lock the doors if a door is
opened, then closed again, at any speed above 24 kilometers-per-hour (15 miles-per-hour).
- A programmable feature of the RKE system is the enabling or disabling of the horn chirp following
activation of the RKE Lock function. This feature can be enabled or disabled and, if enabled, the
horn chirp duration (twenty or forty milliseconds) can be selected.
Both versions of the CTM are mounted under the driver side end of the instrument panel, inboard
of the instrument panel steering column opening. Refer to Central Timer Module Replacement of
Instrument Panel Systems for the service procedures.
The programmable features of the CTM can be enabled or disabled using the DRB scan tool as
described in the proper Diagnostic Procedures. For diagnosis of the high-line version of the CTM or
of the CCD data bus, a DRB scan tool and the proper Diagnostic Procedures are recommended.
The CTM cannot be repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must be replaced.
OPERATION
Some of the functions and features that the CTM supports or controls include: Chimes for the following conditions:
- Headlamps on with ignition off and driver door open warning
- Key in ignition with ignition off and driver door open warning
- ABS lamp warning (if the vehicle is so equipped)
- Airbag lamp warning
- Check engine lamp warning
- Check gauges lamp warning
- Low fuel lamp warning
- Low washer fluid lamp warning
- Seat belt reminder lamp warning
- Transmission oil temperature lamp warning (automatic transmission)
- Courtesy lamp time-out (high-line only)
- Ignition key lamp timer
- Intermittent wipe control
- Enhanced accident response (high-line only)
- Horn chirp upon door lock with RKE (programmable) (high-line only)
- Illuminated entry (high-line only)
- Power door lock control (high-line only)
- Power lock inhibit (high-line only)
- Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) (high-line only)
- Remote radio switches (high-line only)
- Rolling door locks (programmable) (high-line only)
- Speed sensitive intermittent wipe (high-line only)
- Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS) (high-line only) (if the vehicle is so equipped)
- Wipe after wash (high-line only).
CENTRAL TIMER MODULE DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES
Door Disarm Switch Failure Door lock Switch Failure Door Unlock Switch Failure Wiper Park
Switch Failure EEPROM Checksum Failure Internal ROM Test Failure
Central Timer Module Diagnostic Trouble Codes
Door Disarm Switch Failure Door lock Switch Failure Door Unlock Switch Failure Wiper Park
Switch Failure
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 234
EEPROM Checksum Failure Internal ROM Test Failure
Chime System
The chime system is built into the CTM. The system also supports an external chime request from
the instrument cluster. This feature allows the instrument cluster to request a chime from the CTM
for gauge problems and tell tale warnings. The CTM chime functions will have priority over the MIC
chime requests. There are two chime rates, Low; 50 chimes per minute for reminders and High; 80
chimes per minute for serious conditions that require immediate attention. The high rate chime
sounds when the key is left in the ignition and the driver doors is open or the headlights are left ON.
The low rate chime sounds for any of the other conditions. There is a variable rate feature that
allows the chime to sound continuously for key-in and headlamp warning as long as the door is
open. The seat belt warning chime is activated for 4 to 6 seconds, and all other chime conditions
will activate the chime once at the same time the warning light on the cluster is illuminated.
The chime will sound for the following conditions:
High Rate Key in Ignition Warning ignition OFF, key in ignition, drivers door open
- Ignition OFF, headlamps ON, drivers door open Low Rate
- Seat belt warning-6 seconds after key ON (6 to 8 chimes) or until belt is buckled
- Airbag lamp illuminated (3 times after prove-out)
- Anti-lock lamp illuminated (2 chimes after prove- out if equipped)
- Check engine lamp illuminated (2 chimes after prove-out)
- Check gauges lamp illuminated (2 chimes)
- Engine Temp High--when gauge enters red zone (2 chimes)
- Low fuel- when fuel level reaches /8 tank (2 chimes)
- Low washer fluid (2 chimes)
- Wait to start (diesel only) (2 chimes)
- Water in fuel (diesel only) ( 2 chimes)
If the ignition switch is turned to the run/start/acc position and the driver's door is closed, then
opened, the warning chime is defeated. This allows the doors to be open without the warning
chime constantly sounding. The CTM stays in this mode until the ignition switch is turned to the
"OFF" position, then normal function will be restored. (Highline CTM only).
Compass Mini-Trip Computer (CMTC)
This system, located in the overhead console, displays information on outside temperature,
compass direction and trip information.
Compass And Temperature Display
This display provides the outside temperature in °F or °C and one of eight compass readings to
indicate the direction of the vehicle is facing. Trip Odometer (ODO)--Shows the distance traveled in
miles or km since the last reset.
Average Fuel Economy (AVE ECO)
Shows the average fuel economy in MPG (miles per gallon) or L/100 Km since the last reset.
Distance to Empty (DTE)
Shows the estimated distance that can be traveled with the fuel remaining in the tank. This level
calculated using the MPG multiplied by the Fuel Tank Level.
Elapsed Time (ET)
Shows the accumulated ignition on time whenever the CMTC is powered up until a reset takes
place.
Step Button
Press this button to cycle through all the mini-trip computer displays.
US/M Button
Press this button to convert all vehicle displays from US to Metric and vice versa.
To Reset the Display
Press the Step and US/M buttons simultaneously for at least two seconds and all resettable
conditions will be reset. This will occur only if a resettable function (AVG ECO, ECO, ET) is
currently being displayed.
Automatic Compass Calibration
This compass is self calibrating which eliminates the need to manually activate the switches on the
compass. When the vehicle is new, the compass may appear erratic and the CAL symbol will be
displayed. Calibration is automatically detected when the vehicle is drive in a circle at a constant
speed between 5 and 11 mph. The diameter of circle should be between 30 and 90 feet,
Calibration should take place in an area free of metal and metallic objects and away from power
lines. When the calibration process is completed, the CAL light will go OFF and the compass will
function normally.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 235
Compass Variance
Compass Variance is the difference between Magnetic North and Geographic North. In some areas
of the country, the difference between Magnetic and Geographic North is great enough to cause
the compass to give false readings. If this occurs, the compass variance must be set.
To set the variance: Turn the ignition ON and set display to Comp./Temp. Simultaneously press
both the US/M and STEP button for 0 to 2 seconds. The VAR indicator will light up and the current
zone number will be displayed. Press STEP button to select the proper variance zone as shown on
the map. After 5 seconds of inactivity, the displayed zone will be automatically set, and normal
operation will resume.
Diagnostics
CTM is fully addressable with the DRB III and it is the recommended method for diagnosis. The
CTM reports 6 Diagnostic Trouble Codes. All of the inputs to the CTM can be read with the DRB
and the outputs can be actuated. If the inputs are OK and the outputs can be cycled with the DRB,
the problem is usually the Central Timer Module.
DRB III Error Messages and Blank Screen
Under normal operation, the DRB will display one of only two error messages:
- User-Requested WARM Boot or User-Requested COLD Boot.
If the DRB should display any other error message, record the entire display and call the MDS
Hotline, or call for information and assistance at 1-800-825-8737. This is a sample of such an error
message display:
Ver: 2.14
date: 26 Jul93 file:
key_itf.cc
date: Jul 26 993 line:
548
err: Ox1
User-Requested COLD Boot
Press MORE to switch between this display and the application screen. Press F4 when done
noting information.
DRB III does not power up (Blank Screen)
If the LED's do not light or no sound is emitted at start up, check for loose cable connections or a
bad cable. Check the vehicle battery voltage (data link connector cavity 6). A minimum of volts is
required to adequately power the DRB.
If all connections are proper between the DRB and the vehicle or other devices, and the vehicle
battery is fully charged, an inoperative DRB may be the result of faulty cable or vehicle wiring.
DRB III
Display is not visible
Low temperatures will affect the visibility of the display. Adjust the contrast to compensate for this
condition.
Enhanced Accident Response (Highline CTM Only)
If the Airbag Control Module (ACM) deploys the airbags, a message is transmitted over the CCD
bus to the CTM module to unlock the doors. The interior lights will be turned ON seconds after
getting zero speed message on the CCD bus.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 236
In addition to unlocking the doors, the lock feature will be disabled for a predetermined amount of
time following the deployment. Once the ignition key has been cycled to the "OFF" position, normal
operation will resume. This is a programmable feature.
General Information
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION AND FUNCTIONAL OPERATION
The body system on the 1999 Ram Truck consists of three modules that communicate over the
CCD bus (Chrysler Collision Detection multiplex system). There are three additional modules, two
types of Powertrain Control Modules (PCM)and the Controller Anti-Lock Brake (CAB) that are not
part of the body system, but do utilize the CCD bus for communication. The CAB also utilizes the
CCD bus for diagnostics. The PCM sends and receives messages on the CCD bus, however
diagnostics are performed through the Serial Communication Interface or SCI, the same as last
year. All of the information about the functioning of all the systems is organized, controlled, and
communicated by the CCD bus, which is described (CCD Bus) in this general information.
Through the CCD bus, information about the operation of vehicle components and circuits is
relayed quickly to the appropriate module(s). All modules receive all the information transmitted on
the bus even though a module may not require all the information to perform it's function. It will only
respond to messages "addressed" to it through a binary coding process. This method of data
transmission significantly reduces the complexity of the wiring in the vehicle and the size of wiring
harnesses.
Gauges
The instrument cluster will not store any DTCs. Because the Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
gathers all the gauge information and sends it to the cluster via the bus, it is the controller's
responsibility to monitor these inputs and store DTCs for them. For this reason the first item to be
checked regarding a gauge problem (except oil pressure) should be the engine controller for any
DTCs relating to the gauge in question.
There are DTCs associated with all the gauges except for the oil pressure gauge. When diagnosing
gauges, the input that is used for the gauge message (fuel level sender for example) must be valid.
Because of OBD II requirements, most of the information used for monitoring the OBD II system
happens to be the same information used by the controller to formulate the gauge bus messages.
OBD II Requirements State that the fuel level sender must be checked for rationality. This includes
determining if the sending unit voltage is too high or too low or if the voltage hasn't changed over
time. If the PCM has determined that the sender information isn't valid, it will send a diagnostic
trouble code. The presence or absence of the fuel level sending code in the PCM is and important
factor to determine whether a fuel gauge problem is in the sending unit or the cluster.
The same situation is used in all cluster diagnostics related to gauge operation with the exception
of the oil pressure gauge. OBD II requirements do not include oil pressure monitoring. Therefore,
oil pressure diagnostics would dictate that a mechanical oil pressure gauge be attached to the
engine for absolute verification of oil pressure readings.
Hard Wired Lamps
The cluster contains several hard wired lamps described earlier. These lamps are set up in two
configurations. Either the cluster supplies power and ground is supplied by the circuit being
monitored or the lamp is supplied ground by the cluster and power comes from a module or other
device. Refer to the schematic for the specific details on the lamp in question. Verification of the
bulb filament may be required in cases of an inoperative lamp. This will require removal of the
cluster and the bulb in question.
NOTE: ALL RED WARNING LAMPS EXCEPT THE WAIT TO START LAMP ARE LIGHT
EMITTING DIODES (LED). LED'S ARE NOT REPLACEABLE, IF DEFECTIVE THE INSTRUMENT
CLUSTER MUST BE REPLACED.
CCD Controlled Lamps
The cluster contains several CCD controlled lamps as described earlier. These lamps are part of
the diagnostic self-test. When entering the self-test mode, operation of these lamps can be
observed. If the bulb fails to operate during the self-test and the bulb filament is good, the cluster
assembly will need to be replaced.
NOTE: A FLASHING SEAT BELT LAMP INDICATES THAT THE AIRBAG WARNING LAMP IS
NOT OPERATING PROPERLY.
Lamps (CCD)
The cluster via CCD messages controls the following lamps. They are actuated during the self-test
procedure.
ABS lamp Brake Warning Low Fuel Warning-Internally Controlled by the Cluster not CCD Airbag
Upshift (if equipped) Check Engine Check Gauges Cruise Control Lamp Trans Temp O/D Off (if
equipped)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 237
Water in Fuel Maintenance Required (5.9 Heavy Duty Only)
NOTE: THE SEAT BELT AND LOW WASHER SWITCH AND BRAKE WARNING LAMP ARE
HARDWIRED TO THE CLUSTER. THE CLUSTER THEN DECIDES IF THE LAMP SHOULD BE
ILLUMINATED.
Lamps (Hardwired)
The following lamps are hardwired in the cluster and are not part of the self-test.
Full Time 4WD Seat Belt ABS (amber) High Beam Left Turn Signal Right Turn Signal Security (if
equipped) Low Wash Wait to Start
Mechanical Instrument Cluster Description
The Ram Truck MIC is available in 2 different versions, low line and high line. The lowline cluster
has seventeen indicators lamps and the highline has eighteen indicators lamps. The gauges are
positioned with information received by the cluster over the CCD bus from the PCM. Some of the
warning lamps are hardwired and the cluster using the CCD bus information controls some. The
MIC is hardwired to he CTM to provide the warning lamp announcement chimes.
There is a self test available for the cluster that will actuate all the gauges at their calibration points.
The test will not run if the cluster sees engine RPM or vehicle speed. This test will light all CCD
controlled lamps for verification of lamp operation. It also forces the odometer Vacuum Fluorescent
Display (VFD) to perform a segment check. The self test routine can be entered by pushing and
holding the trip reset button while rotating the ignition key from the "OFF" to the "ON" position.
When the word "chec" appears release the knob and the test will continue.
The cluster will provide bus bias and termination and the engine controller provides a second
termination. If the cluster is disconnected the bus will not be biased.
The cluster will be service as an assembly. There will be limited parts available, bulbs and sockets,
the front lens, the trip odometer stem cover and the rear cover assembly. No internal parts of the
cluster will be serviced.
Normal Operation
At key ON, the cluster will light the low fuel, seat belt, check gauges, and airbag. As the key is
turned farther towards the start position, the check engine, ABS (if equipped) and brake warning
lamp will illuminate. The liquid crystal display (VFD) will indicate the mileage stored inside the
cluster. If there is a bus failure and the cluster cannot receive distance pulses from the engine
controller, the cluster will display the last mileage stored until the ignition is turned OFF. If the
cluster is receiving bus messages but is unable to display odometer information because of an
internal failure, the odometer display will be blank. Dimming is handled by the potentiometer that
controls instrumentation illumination. Also, if there is a CCD bus failure, "no bus" will be displayed
on the odometer 20 seconds after the vehicle is started.
Power Door Lock System
The Central Timer Module (CTM) controls the door lock actuator assemblies to handle locking and
unlocking with the key fob or interior switch. There is also a door lock inhibit feature that prevents
power locking of the doors if the ignition is OFF and the key is in the ignition. Automatic or rolling
locks are included as a DRB programmable feature. If the vehicle is moving approximately 5 mph
and approximately degrees of throttle opening is seen by the PCM, (the PCM will send this info to
the CTM via the CCD bus) indicating acceleration, the CTM will cycle the lock actuators.
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) /Vehicle Theft Security System (VTSS)
The highline CTM provides for Remote Keyless Entry (RKE). The base CTM is not able to provide
these functions. The presence of this option dictates that the vehicle is equipped with a high line
CTM. The VTSS system monitors the door jamb switches and ignition switch to detect
unauthorized entry into the vehicle. Once the vehicle is "armed", any one of these inputs can cause
the VTSS system to be tripped. Once tripped, the horn and lights will pulse for 3 minutes and if an
attempt is made to start the engine, it will start and stall. If the trigger condition is still present, the
lights will continue to flash and return to the "armed" state. The cause of the last 4 alarm triggers is
stored by the CTM and may be retrieved by the DRB. The system may be disarmed by either an
unlock command from a valid RKE key fob or by using a key in either door. Both front door key
cylinders are equipped with disarm switches. There is also a VTSS led on the overhead console
that provides information to the driver about the state of the vehicle theft system.
The RKE system is placed in the programming mode by the DRB. The system will store up to four
key fob codes. Through the DRB, programming of one key fob without deleting the others is
possible. If the key fob is stole, all the fob codes stored previously may be erased to provide the
owner of the vehicle with an extra sense of security.
Trouble Codes
Short to Battery - Either or both of the bus wires are shorted to the battery potential.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > Airbag System > Page 238
Short to 5 Volts - Either or both of the bus wires are shorted to a 5 volt potential.
Short to Ground - Either or both of the bus wires are shorted to ground.
Bus (+) & (-) Shorted Together - The two bus wires are shorted together.
No Termination - The bus system has lost connection with all of its terminators. The Instrument
Cluster (MIC) and Powertrain Controller (PCM) supply termination for the 1999 Ram Trucks.
Bus Bias Level Too Low - Either or both of the bus wire potentials are significantly below their
normal 2.5 volts.
Bus Bias Level Too High - Either or both of the bus wire potentials are significantly above their
normal 2.5 volts.
No Bus Bias - The bus system has lost connection with all modules that provide basis. The
Instrument Cluster (MIC) provides the CCD bus bias for the 1999 Ram Trucks.
Bus (+) Open - The bus (+) wire has lost connection with termination and/or bias.
Bus (-) Open - The bus (-) wire has lost connection with termination and/or bias.
Not Receiving Bus Messages Correctly - The DRB cannot communicate over the bus and does not
know why.
Vehicle Communication
Chrysler Collision Detection multiplex system (CCD) bus consists of a twisted pair of wires. These
wires run from one module to another. They receive and deliver coded information between the
modules. The information is coded to identify the message as well as the importance of the
message. Where there are multiple messages trying to access the CCD bus at one time, the code
determines the message that has the higher priority, and is then allowed to access the bus first.
The tow wires of the twisted pair that make up the CCD multiplex system are called "bus +" (bus
plus) and "bus -" (bus minus) respectively. Each wire has a measurable voltage level of roughly 2.5
volts. In order to maintain the 2.5 volts on each line and provide a means of transportation for the
coded messages, there is a voltage divider network located in the module that supplies bus bias or
voltage. Along with the module that supplies bias, some modules provide termination. Bias is the
voltage necessary to make the bus operational. At least one point of termination is necessary,
some systems use more than one. Some modules are capable of biasing and terminating the bus
by themselves. Termination in the circuitry (a 20 ohm resistor placed across the bus) is required to
complete the voltage divider network circuit and also provide some electromagnetic protection for
the bus. Without termination, voltage on the bus goes approximately 5 volts on one wire and 0 volts
on the other wire. In the 1999 Ram Truck, the instrument cluster supplies bus bias and termination
and the PCM supplies and additional point of termination.
NOTE: COMMUNICATION OVER THE BUS IS ESSENTIAL TO THE PROPER OPERATION OF
THE VEHICLES ON-BOARD DIAGNOSTIC SYSTEMS AND THE DRB. PROBLEMS WITH THE
OPERATION OF THE BUS OR DRB MUST BE CORRECTED BEFORE PROCEEDING WITH
DIAGNOSTIC TESTING.
Wiper System
The Ram truck equipped with a high line CTM will utilize speed sensitive intermittent wipers. Only a
high line CTM will be able to support this feature. A base CTM (IEM) will provide for intermittent
wipers without the speed sensitive feature. The low and high speeds are controlled through the
wiper stalk switch. The intermittent portion of the wiper control is handled by the CTM through the
intermittent wiper relay. When the module detects a decrease in delay time as selected by the
driven an immediate wipe of the windshield takes place and the new delay interval is implemented.
This feature is present on both the base and highline CTM.
When the vehicle is moving at speeds at or below 10 mph, the delay time ranges from 1 to 36
seconds. When the speed rises above 10 mph, the delay times are cut in half for a range of 1/2 to
8 seconds. The speed signal is provided to the CTM from the PCM over the CCD bus.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes
Central Timer Module: Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 241
Central Timer Module: Symptom Related Diagnostic Procedures
AM/FM Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* AM/FM SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Balance Dial Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* BALANCE DIAL INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
CASS Error
SYMPTOM
CASS ERROR
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective radio - CASS error
CD Eject Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* CD EJECT SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
CD Error
SYMPTOM
CD ERROR
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective radio - CD error
Equalizer Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* EQUALIZER INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
External CD Changer (If Equipped)
SYMPTOM
* EXTERNAL CD CHANGER (IF EQUIPPED)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- CD Cable assembly Defective
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 242
- CD Changer Defective
- Defective radio
Fader Dial Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* FADER DIAL INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
FF/RW Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* FF/RW SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Hour/Minute Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* HOUR/MINUTE SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
No Sound From All Speakers
SYMPTOM
* NO SOUND FROM ALL SPEAKERS
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Open radio choke output circuit
- Open ground circuit
- Open power antenna relay output CKT - radio / radio choke
- Open radio 12v output circuit
- Power antenna relay output CKT - short to ground
- Defective radio
- Defective radio choke relay
No Sound From One Speaker
SYMPTOM
* NO SOUND FROM ONE SPEAKER
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Speaker (-) circuit open
- Rear speaker (+) circuit open
- Rear speaker (-) circuit open
- Defective front door speaker (+) INOP
- Defective front door speaker (-) INOP
- Front door speaker (+) circuit open
- Front door speaker (-) circuit open
- Front door speaker amp (+) faulty
- Front door speaker amp (-) faulty
- Front door speaker defective
- Radio (+) defective
- Radio (-) defective
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 243
No Sound From Right/Left Side Speakers
SYMPTOM
* NO SOUND FROM RIGHT/LEFT SIDE SPEAKERS
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Open ground circuit
- Open radio choke output CKT
- Radio DTC'S present
- Defective front door speaker
Pause/Play Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* PAUSE/PLAY SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Poor Sound Quality All Speakers
SYMPTOM
* POOR SOUND QUALITY ALL SPEAKERS
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Antenna connector connection Defective
- Ground circuit open
- Radio choke output circuit Defective
- Radio choke relay connection Defective
- Power antenna relay CKT Defective
- Radio connections Defective
- Radio relay output Defective
- Radio Defective
Poor Sound Quality From One Speaker
SYMPTOM
* POOR SOUND QUALITY FROM ONE SPEAKER
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Speaker (+) circuit open
- Speaker (-) circuit open
- Speaker defective
- Radio (-) circuit defective
- Door speaker defective
- Radio (+) circuit defective
PWR Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* PWR SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Radio Error
SYMPTOM
RADIO ERROR
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective radio - radio error
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 244
Remote Steering Wheel Switches (If Equipped)
SYMPTOM
* REMOTE STEERING WHEEL SWITCHES (IF EQUIPPED)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- MUX control clockspring Defective
- Radio control circuit Defective open
- Radio control MUX circuit open
- Radio control switch ground circuit open
- Radio MUX Control circuit Defective
- Remote control switch Defective
- No response CCD bus failure
- Central timer module Defective
Scan Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* SCAN SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Seek Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* SEEK SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Set Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* SET SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Shorted Front Channel
SYMPTOM
SHORTED FRONT CHANNEL
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Left front SPKR (+) circuit short to ground
- Left front SPKR (-) circuit short to ground
- Right front door speaker Defective
- Right front SPKR (-) circuit short to ground
- Left front door speaker Defective
- Right front SPKR (+) circuit short to ground
- Right rear speaker (+) CKT- short to ground
- Right rear speaker (-) CKT- short to ground
- Defective radio
Shorted Left Channel
SYMPTOM
SHORTED LEFT CHANNEL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 245
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Left front door speaker defective
- Left front SPKR (+) circuit short to ground
- Left front SPKR (-) circuit short to ground
- Left rear speaker (+) CKT- short to ground
- Left rear speaker (-) CKT- short to ground
- Defective radio
Shorted Rear Channel
SYMPTOM
SHORTED REAR CHANNEL
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Left front door speaker defective
- Right front door speaker defective
- Left rear speaker (+) CKT-short to ground
- Left rear speaker (-) CKT-short to ground
- Right rear speaker (+) CKT-short to ground
- Right rear speaker (-) CKT-short to ground
- Defective radio
Shorted Right Channel
SYMPTOM
SHORTED RIGHT CHANNEL
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Right front door speaker defective
- Right front SPKR (+) circuit short to ground
- Right front SPKR (-) circuit short to ground
- Right rear speaker (+) CKT-short to ground
- Right rear speaker (-) CKT-short to ground
- Defective radio
Tape Eject Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* TAPE EJECT SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Tune Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* TUNE SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Volume/Time Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* VOL/TIME SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 246
1-5 Presets Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Chime Inoperative - Engine Temperature Critical
SYMPTOM
* CHIME INOPERATIVE - ENGINE TEMPERATURE CRITICAL
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Tone request circuit open
- Instrument cluster tone request output defective
- CTM fails chime test
- PCM DTC coolant temp check
Chime Inoperative - Key In Ignition & LF Door Open
SYMPTOM
* CHIME INOPERATIVE - KEY IN IGNITION & LF DOOR OPEN
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Key in ignition switch sense ckt open
- Ignition SW - key in switch open
- CTM no chime to key in ignition
- CTM not responding to key in switch
Chime Inoperative at All Times
SYMPTOM
* CHIME INOPERATIVE AT ALL TIMES
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- CTM fails internal chime test
Chime Inoperative With Exterior Lamps On
SYMPTOM
* CHIME INOPERATIVE WITH EXTERIOR LAMPS ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Key in ignition switch sense circuit short to ground
- Ignition SW - key in SW shorted
- CTM - key in sense short default
- Headlamp switch circuit open
Chime Inoperative With Low Oil Pressure
SYMPTOM
* CHIME INOPERATIVE WITH LOW OIL PRESSURE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Oil pressure sender ground circuit open
- Tone request circuit open
- Instrument cluster - oil press Defective
- CTM no response to oil pressure default
- CTM fails chime test
Chime Sounds With Driver Door Open
SYMPTOM
* CHIME SOUNDS WITH DRIVER DOOR OPEN
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Key in ignition switch sense circuit short to ground
- Ignition SW - key in SW shorted
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 247
- CTM - key in sense short default
- CTM not responding to key out
Open Left Door Ajar Circuit
SYMPTOM
* OPEN LEFT DOOR AJAR CIRCUIT
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Left front ajar switch sense circuit open
- Left front door ajar switch sense circuit open
- CTM defective
- Left front door ajar switch defective, shorted
Open Right Door Ajar Circuit
SYMPTOM
* OPEN RIGHT DOOR AJAR CIRCUIT
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- RF door ajar switch sense ground circuit open
- Right front ajar switch sense circuit open
- CTM defective
- Right front door ajar switch defective, shorted
Shorted Left Door Ajar Circuit
SYMPTOM
* SHORTED LEFT DOOR AJAR CIRCUIT
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Central Timer Module defective
- Left front door ajar switch defective, shorted
- LF door ajar switch sense circuit short to GND
Shorted Right Door Ajar Circuit
SYMPTOM
* SHORTED RIGHT DOOR AJAR CIRCUIT
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- RF door ajar switch sense circuit short to GND
- CTM defective
- Right front door ajar switch defective, shorted
All Gauges Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* ALL GAUGES INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Fused B (+) circuit from IOD fuse open
- No response/CCD bus
- Defective instrument cluster
Any CCD Cluster Warning Lamp Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* ANY CCD CLUSTER WARNING LAMP INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response/CCD bus
- CCD inoperative lamp/bulb defective
- CCD lamp cluster input defective
- CCD LP cluster test complete
- Defective cluster
- Instrument cluster defective
Any Hard Wired Cluster Warning Lamp
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 248
SYMPTOM
* ANY HARD WIRED CLUSTER WARNING LAMP
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective instrument cluster
- Hard wired lamp circuit open
- Inoperative lamp/bulb defective
One Gauge Not Operating Properly
SYMPTOM
* ONE GAUGE NOT OPERATING PROPERLY
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Gauge not reading 4 psi> engine warm at idle
- Oil gauge not reading 4 psi or > at idle
- Oil level low
- Sensor ground circuit open
- Instrument cluster circuit board defective
- Oil pressure sensor defective
- Charging system defective
- Charging system DTC'S
- Defective instrument cluster
- Instrument cluster defective
- Oil pressure sense circuit open
- Oil pressure sense signal CKT short to ground
- Cooling system operation faulty
- Defective JTEC module
- Fuel gauge inoperative
- Instrument cluster defective
- JTEC module defective
- Oil pressure switch defective
- Pinion factor incorrect
- Powertrain Control Module defective
Average MPH/Fuel Econ Inoperative or Wrong
SYMPTOM
* AVERAGE MPH/FUEL ECON INOPERATIVE OR WRONG
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective Compass/Mini-Trip Computer
CMTC Display Shows Failed
SYMPTOM
* CMTC DISPLAY SHOWS FAILED
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective CMTC - display failed
CMTC Fails to Respond to Instrument Panel Dimming
SYMPTOM
* CMTC FAILS TO RESPOND TO INSTRUMENT PANEL DIMMING
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * AVERAGE MPH/FUEL ECON INOPERATIVE OR
WRONG.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective Compass/Mini-Trip Computer
CMTC Segments Fail to Light Up
SYMPTOM
* CMTC SEGMENTS FAIL TO LIGHT UP
POSSIBLE CAUSES
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 249
- Defective Compass/Mini-Trip Computer - segments fail to light
Distance to Empty Inoperative or Wrong
SYMPTOM
* DISTANCE TO EMPTY INOPERATIVE OR WRONG
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * AVERAGE MPH/FUEL ECON INOPERATIVE OR
WRONG.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective Compass/Mini-Trip Computer
Elapsed Time Inoperative/Wrong
SYMPTOM
*ELAPSED TIME INOPERATIVE/WRONG
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test* AVERAGE MPH/FUEL ECON INOPERATIVE OR
WRONG.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective Compass/Mini-Trip Computer
Incorrect Reading Beyond +/- 5
SYMPTOM
* INCORRECT READING BEYOND +/- 5
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective Ambient Temperature Sensor
Repairing OC In CMTC Display
SYMPTOM
* REPAIRING "OC" IN CMTC DISPLAY
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective Ambient Temperature Sensor - SC
- Defective CMTM/OC default
- Open Ambient Temperature Sensor signal circuit
- Open sensor ground circuit
Repairing SC In CMTC Display
SYMPTOM
* REPAIRING "SC" IN CMTC DISPLAY
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Ambient temperature sensor signal CKT-short/GND
- Ambient temperature sensor signal CKT-sensor/GND
- Defective ambient temperature sensor-OC
- Defective CMTM/SC default
Switch on Compass Mini-Trip Computer Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* SWITCH ON COMPASS MINI-TRIP COMPUTER INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * AVERAGE MPH/FUEL ECON INOPERATIVE OR
WRONG.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective Compass/Mini-Trip computer
Trip Odometer Inoperative/Wrong
SYMPTOM
* TRIP ODOMETER INOPERATIVE/WRONG
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 250
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * AVERAGE MPH/FUEL ECON INOPERATIVE OR
WRONG.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective Compass/Mini-Trip computer
Automatic (Rolling) Door Locks Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* AUTOMATIC (ROLLING) DOOR LOCKS INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Link to body communication bus inoperative
- Speed sensing door locks inoperative
Doors Lock With Key In Ignition and Left Door Open
SYMPTOM
* DOORS LOCK WITH KEY IN IGNITION AND LEFT DOOR OPEN
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Link to body communication bus inoperative
- Ignition switch shorted
- Key - in ignition switch sense circuit open
- CTM input A9 short to ground
- CTM input shorted to ground
One or Both Doors Failing to Lock From One Switch
SYMPTOM
* ONE OR BOTH DOORS FAILING TO LOCK FROM ONE SWITCH
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Link to body communication bus inoperative
- Fused B (+) circuit open
- Door lock actuator assembly defective
- Door unlock actuator assembly defective
- Door lock switch assembly open
- Door unlock switch assembly open
- Door lock driver circuit open
- Door unlock driver circuit open
- Door lock driver circuit open
- Door unlock driver circuit open
- Door unlock driver circuit open
- Power door lock driver circuit open
- CTM lock driver input open
- CTM unlock driver input open
- Lock driver circuit on CTM open
- Unlock driver circuit on CTM open
One or Both Doors Failing to Unlock From One Switch.
SYMPTOM
* ONE OR BOTH DOORS FAILING TO UNLOCK FROM ONE SWITCH
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * ONE OR BOTH DOORS FAILING TO LOCK FROM
ONE SWITCH.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Link to body communication bus inoperative
- Fused B (+) circuit open
- Door lock actuator assembly defective
- Door unlock actuator assembly defective
- Door lock switch assembly open
- Door unlock switch assembly open
- Door lock driver circuit open
- Door unlock driver circuit open
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 251
- Door lock driver circuit open
- Door unlock driver circuit open
- Door unlock driver circuit open
- Power door lock driver circuit open
- CTM lock driver input open
- CTM unlock driver input open
- Lock driver circuit on CTM open
- Unlock driver circuit on CTM open
Remote Keyless Entry Problem
SYMPTOM
* REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY PROBLEM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Link to body communication bus inoperative
- Transmitter defective
- CTM Defective - RKE function
Intermittent Wipers Inoperative No DTCs - Regular Cab
SYMPTOM
* INTERMITTENT WIPERS INOPERATIVE NO DTCs
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response / CCD bus failure - CTM
- Defective Multi-Function SW / 5.0 ohms
- Open wiper park switch sense CKT
- Defective wiper motor/12 volts
- Defective Central Timer Module / stalk switch
- Central Timer Module default / 12 volts
- Open intermittent wiper mode sense CKT
Intermittent Wipers to Work - Quad Cab
SYMPTOM
* INTERMITTENT WIPERS TO WORK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response/CCD Bus Failure - CTM
- Defective Multi-Function Switch / 5.0 Ohms
- Open wiper park switch sense Circuit
- Defective wiper motor / 12 volts
- Defective Central Timer Module / Stalk switch
- Central Timer Module default / 12 volts
- Open intermittent wiper mode sense circuit
Regular Cab
SYMPTOM
* NO WIPER ACTUATION AFTER WASH BUTTON PUSHED
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- CCD bus failure - no response CTM
- Defective Central Timer Module / interval wiper times
Quad Cab
SYMPTOM
* NO WIPER ACTUATION AFTER WASH BUTTON PUSHED
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- CCD bus failure-no response CTM
- Open front washer switch sense CKT
- Defective central timer module/washer pump
Regular Cab
SYMPTOM
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 252
* WIPER SPEED SENSITIVE FEATURE INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- CCD bus failure - CTM
- CCD bus failure - PCM
- No response logic GND CKT open
- No response B (+) CKT open
- No response bus (-) CKT open
- No response CTM DEF bus (-) CKT open
- No response IGN SW RUN/ACCY CKT short - GND
- No response IGN SW RUN/START CKT short - GND
- No response power ground CKT open
- Fuse # 6 defective
- Fuse # 9 defective
Quad Cab
SYMPTOM
* WIPER SPEED SENSITIVE FEATURE INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- CCD bus failure-CTM
- CCD bus failure-PCM
- Defective central timer module/interval wipes times
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 253
Central Timer Module: Testing and Inspection
Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes
Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions
For Information regarding diagnosis of all B, C, P, U and Manufacturer Codes See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Descriptions
Diagnostic Trouble Code Tests and Associated Procedures
For Information regarding diagnosis of all B, C, P, U and Manufacturer Codes See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Tests and Associated Procedures
AM/FM Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* AM/FM SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Balance Dial Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* BALANCE DIAL INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
CASS Error
SYMPTOM
CASS ERROR
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective radio - CASS error
CD Eject Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* CD EJECT SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
CD Error
SYMPTOM
CD ERROR
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective radio - CD error
Equalizer Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* EQUALIZER INOPERATIVE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 254
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
External CD Changer (If Equipped)
SYMPTOM
* EXTERNAL CD CHANGER (IF EQUIPPED)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- CD Cable assembly Defective
- CD Changer Defective
- Defective radio
Fader Dial Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* FADER DIAL INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
FF/RW Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* FF/RW SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Hour/Minute Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* HOUR/MINUTE SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
No Sound From All Speakers
SYMPTOM
* NO SOUND FROM ALL SPEAKERS
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Open radio choke output circuit
- Open ground circuit
- Open power antenna relay output CKT - radio / radio choke
- Open radio 12v output circuit
- Power antenna relay output CKT - short to ground
- Defective radio
- Defective radio choke relay
No Sound From One Speaker
SYMPTOM
* NO SOUND FROM ONE SPEAKER
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 255
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Speaker (-) circuit open
- Rear speaker (+) circuit open
- Rear speaker (-) circuit open
- Defective front door speaker (+) INOP
- Defective front door speaker (-) INOP
- Front door speaker (+) circuit open
- Front door speaker (-) circuit open
- Front door speaker amp (+) faulty
- Front door speaker amp (-) faulty
- Front door speaker defective
- Radio (+) defective
- Radio (-) defective
No Sound From Right/Left Side Speakers
SYMPTOM
* NO SOUND FROM RIGHT/LEFT SIDE SPEAKERS
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Open ground circuit
- Open radio choke output CKT
- Radio DTC'S present
- Defective front door speaker
Pause/Play Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* PAUSE/PLAY SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Poor Sound Quality All Speakers
SYMPTOM
* POOR SOUND QUALITY ALL SPEAKERS
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Antenna connector connection Defective
- Ground circuit open
- Radio choke output circuit Defective
- Radio choke relay connection Defective
- Power antenna relay CKT Defective
- Radio connections Defective
- Radio relay output Defective
- Radio Defective
Poor Sound Quality From One Speaker
SYMPTOM
* POOR SOUND QUALITY FROM ONE SPEAKER
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Speaker (+) circuit open
- Speaker (-) circuit open
- Speaker defective
- Radio (-) circuit defective
- Door speaker defective
- Radio (+) circuit defective
PWR Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 256
* PWR SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Radio Error
SYMPTOM
RADIO ERROR
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective radio - radio error
Remote Steering Wheel Switches (If Equipped)
SYMPTOM
* REMOTE STEERING WHEEL SWITCHES (IF EQUIPPED)
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- MUX control clockspring Defective
- Radio control circuit Defective open
- Radio control MUX circuit open
- Radio control switch ground circuit open
- Radio MUX Control circuit Defective
- Remote control switch Defective
- No response CCD bus failure
- Central timer module Defective
Scan Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* SCAN SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Seek Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* SEEK SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Set Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* SET SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Shorted Front Channel
SYMPTOM
SHORTED FRONT CHANNEL
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 257
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Left front SPKR (+) circuit short to ground
- Left front SPKR (-) circuit short to ground
- Right front door speaker Defective
- Right front SPKR (-) circuit short to ground
- Left front door speaker Defective
- Right front SPKR (+) circuit short to ground
- Right rear speaker (+) CKT- short to ground
- Right rear speaker (-) CKT- short to ground
- Defective radio
Shorted Left Channel
SYMPTOM
SHORTED LEFT CHANNEL
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Left front door speaker defective
- Left front SPKR (+) circuit short to ground
- Left front SPKR (-) circuit short to ground
- Left rear speaker (+) CKT- short to ground
- Left rear speaker (-) CKT- short to ground
- Defective radio
Shorted Rear Channel
SYMPTOM
SHORTED REAR CHANNEL
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Left front door speaker defective
- Right front door speaker defective
- Left rear speaker (+) CKT-short to ground
- Left rear speaker (-) CKT-short to ground
- Right rear speaker (+) CKT-short to ground
- Right rear speaker (-) CKT-short to ground
- Defective radio
Shorted Right Channel
SYMPTOM
SHORTED RIGHT CHANNEL
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Right front door speaker defective
- Right front SPKR (+) circuit short to ground
- Right front SPKR (-) circuit short to ground
- Right rear speaker (+) CKT-short to ground
- Right rear speaker (-) CKT-short to ground
- Defective radio
Tape Eject Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* TAPE EJECT SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Tune Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* TUNE SWITCH INOPERATIVE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 258
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Volume/Time Switch Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* VOL/TIME SWITCH INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
1-5 Presets Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* 1-5 PRESETS INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Radio function controls inoperative
Chime Inoperative - Engine Temperature Critical
SYMPTOM
* CHIME INOPERATIVE - ENGINE TEMPERATURE CRITICAL
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Tone request circuit open
- Instrument cluster tone request output defective
- CTM fails chime test
- PCM DTC coolant temp check
Chime Inoperative - Key In Ignition & LF Door Open
SYMPTOM
* CHIME INOPERATIVE - KEY IN IGNITION & LF DOOR OPEN
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Key in ignition switch sense ckt open
- Ignition SW - key in switch open
- CTM no chime to key in ignition
- CTM not responding to key in switch
Chime Inoperative at All Times
SYMPTOM
* CHIME INOPERATIVE AT ALL TIMES
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- CTM fails internal chime test
Chime Inoperative With Exterior Lamps On
SYMPTOM
* CHIME INOPERATIVE WITH EXTERIOR LAMPS ON
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Key in ignition switch sense circuit short to ground
- Ignition SW - key in SW shorted
- CTM - key in sense short default
- Headlamp switch circuit open
Chime Inoperative With Low Oil Pressure
SYMPTOM
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 259
* CHIME INOPERATIVE WITH LOW OIL PRESSURE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Oil pressure sender ground circuit open
- Tone request circuit open
- Instrument cluster - oil press Defective
- CTM no response to oil pressure default
- CTM fails chime test
Chime Sounds With Driver Door Open
SYMPTOM
* CHIME SOUNDS WITH DRIVER DOOR OPEN
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Key in ignition switch sense circuit short to ground
- Ignition SW - key in SW shorted
- CTM - key in sense short default
- CTM not responding to key out
Open Left Door Ajar Circuit
SYMPTOM
* OPEN LEFT DOOR AJAR CIRCUIT
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Left front ajar switch sense circuit open
- Left front door ajar switch sense circuit open
- CTM defective
- Left front door ajar switch defective, shorted
Open Right Door Ajar Circuit
SYMPTOM
* OPEN RIGHT DOOR AJAR CIRCUIT
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- RF door ajar switch sense ground circuit open
- Right front ajar switch sense circuit open
- CTM defective
- Right front door ajar switch defective, shorted
Shorted Left Door Ajar Circuit
SYMPTOM
* SHORTED LEFT DOOR AJAR CIRCUIT
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Central Timer Module defective
- Left front door ajar switch defective, shorted
- LF door ajar switch sense circuit short to GND
Shorted Right Door Ajar Circuit
SYMPTOM
* SHORTED RIGHT DOOR AJAR CIRCUIT
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- RF door ajar switch sense circuit short to GND
- CTM defective
- Right front door ajar switch defective, shorted
All Gauges Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* ALL GAUGES INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Fused B (+) circuit from IOD fuse open
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 260
- No response/CCD bus
- Defective instrument cluster
Any CCD Cluster Warning Lamp Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* ANY CCD CLUSTER WARNING LAMP INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response/CCD bus
- CCD inoperative lamp/bulb defective
- CCD lamp cluster input defective
- CCD LP cluster test complete
- Defective cluster
- Instrument cluster defective
Any Hard Wired Cluster Warning Lamp
SYMPTOM
* ANY HARD WIRED CLUSTER WARNING LAMP
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective instrument cluster
- Hard wired lamp circuit open
- Inoperative lamp/bulb defective
One Gauge Not Operating Properly
SYMPTOM
* ONE GAUGE NOT OPERATING PROPERLY
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Gauge not reading 4 psi> engine warm at idle
- Oil gauge not reading 4 psi or > at idle
- Oil level low
- Sensor ground circuit open
- Instrument cluster circuit board defective
- Oil pressure sensor defective
- Charging system defective
- Charging system DTC'S
- Defective instrument cluster
- Instrument cluster defective
- Oil pressure sense circuit open
- Oil pressure sense signal CKT short to ground
- Cooling system operation faulty
- Defective JTEC module
- Fuel gauge inoperative
- Instrument cluster defective
- JTEC module defective
- Oil pressure switch defective
- Pinion factor incorrect
- Powertrain Control Module defective
Average MPH/Fuel Econ Inoperative or Wrong
SYMPTOM
* AVERAGE MPH/FUEL ECON INOPERATIVE OR WRONG
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective Compass/Mini-Trip Computer
CMTC Display Shows Failed
SYMPTOM
* CMTC DISPLAY SHOWS FAILED
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective CMTC - display failed
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 261
CMTC Fails to Respond to Instrument Panel Dimming
SYMPTOM
* CMTC FAILS TO RESPOND TO INSTRUMENT PANEL DIMMING
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * AVERAGE MPH/FUEL ECON INOPERATIVE OR
WRONG.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective Compass/Mini-Trip Computer
CMTC Segments Fail to Light Up
SYMPTOM
* CMTC SEGMENTS FAIL TO LIGHT UP
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective Compass/Mini-Trip Computer - segments fail to light
Distance to Empty Inoperative or Wrong
SYMPTOM
* DISTANCE TO EMPTY INOPERATIVE OR WRONG
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * AVERAGE MPH/FUEL ECON INOPERATIVE OR
WRONG.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective Compass/Mini-Trip Computer
Elapsed Time Inoperative/Wrong
SYMPTOM
*ELAPSED TIME INOPERATIVE/WRONG
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test* AVERAGE MPH/FUEL ECON INOPERATIVE OR
WRONG.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective Compass/Mini-Trip Computer
Incorrect Reading Beyond +/- 5
SYMPTOM
* INCORRECT READING BEYOND +/- 5
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective Ambient Temperature Sensor
Repairing OC In CMTC Display
SYMPTOM
* REPAIRING "OC" IN CMTC DISPLAY
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective Ambient Temperature Sensor - SC
- Defective CMTM/OC default
- Open Ambient Temperature Sensor signal circuit
- Open sensor ground circuit
Repairing SC In CMTC Display
SYMPTOM
* REPAIRING "SC" IN CMTC DISPLAY
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Ambient temperature sensor signal CKT-short/GND
- Ambient temperature sensor signal CKT-sensor/GND
- Defective ambient temperature sensor-OC
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 262
- Defective CMTM/SC default
Switch on Compass Mini-Trip Computer Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* SWITCH ON COMPASS MINI-TRIP COMPUTER INOPERATIVE
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * AVERAGE MPH/FUEL ECON INOPERATIVE OR
WRONG.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective Compass/Mini-Trip computer
Trip Odometer Inoperative/Wrong
SYMPTOM
* TRIP ODOMETER INOPERATIVE/WRONG
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * AVERAGE MPH/FUEL ECON INOPERATIVE OR
WRONG.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Defective Compass/Mini-Trip computer
Automatic (Rolling) Door Locks Inoperative
SYMPTOM
* AUTOMATIC (ROLLING) DOOR LOCKS INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Link to body communication bus inoperative
- Speed sensing door locks inoperative
Doors Lock With Key In Ignition and Left Door Open
SYMPTOM
* DOORS LOCK WITH KEY IN IGNITION AND LEFT DOOR OPEN
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Link to body communication bus inoperative
- Ignition switch shorted
- Key - in ignition switch sense circuit open
- CTM input A9 short to ground
- CTM input shorted to ground
One or Both Doors Failing to Lock From One Switch
SYMPTOM
* ONE OR BOTH DOORS FAILING TO LOCK FROM ONE SWITCH
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Link to body communication bus inoperative
- Fused B (+) circuit open
- Door lock actuator assembly defective
- Door unlock actuator assembly defective
- Door lock switch assembly open
- Door unlock switch assembly open
- Door lock driver circuit open
- Door unlock driver circuit open
- Door lock driver circuit open
- Door unlock driver circuit open
- Door unlock driver circuit open
- Power door lock driver circuit open
- CTM lock driver input open
- CTM unlock driver input open
- Lock driver circuit on CTM open
- Unlock driver circuit on CTM open
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 263
One or Both Doors Failing to Unlock From One Switch.
SYMPTOM
* ONE OR BOTH DOORS FAILING TO UNLOCK FROM ONE SWITCH
TEST NOTE
This symptom is diagnosed using the test * ONE OR BOTH DOORS FAILING TO LOCK FROM
ONE SWITCH.
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Link to body communication bus inoperative
- Fused B (+) circuit open
- Door lock actuator assembly defective
- Door unlock actuator assembly defective
- Door lock switch assembly open
- Door unlock switch assembly open
- Door lock driver circuit open
- Door unlock driver circuit open
- Door lock driver circuit open
- Door unlock driver circuit open
- Door unlock driver circuit open
- Power door lock driver circuit open
- CTM lock driver input open
- CTM unlock driver input open
- Lock driver circuit on CTM open
- Unlock driver circuit on CTM open
Remote Keyless Entry Problem
SYMPTOM
* REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY PROBLEM
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- Link to body communication bus inoperative
- Transmitter defective
- CTM Defective - RKE function
Intermittent Wipers Inoperative No DTCs - Regular Cab
SYMPTOM
* INTERMITTENT WIPERS INOPERATIVE NO DTCs
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response / CCD bus failure - CTM
- Defective Multi-Function SW / 5.0 ohms
- Open wiper park switch sense CKT
- Defective wiper motor/12 volts
- Defective Central Timer Module / stalk switch
- Central Timer Module default / 12 volts
- Open intermittent wiper mode sense CKT
Intermittent Wipers to Work - Quad Cab
SYMPTOM
* INTERMITTENT WIPERS TO WORK
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- No response/CCD Bus Failure - CTM
- Defective Multi-Function Switch / 5.0 Ohms
- Open wiper park switch sense Circuit
- Defective wiper motor / 12 volts
- Defective Central Timer Module / Stalk switch
- Central Timer Module default / 12 volts
- Open intermittent wiper mode sense circuit
Regular Cab
SYMPTOM
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 264
* NO WIPER ACTUATION AFTER WASH BUTTON PUSHED
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- CCD bus failure - no response CTM
- Defective Central Timer Module / interval wiper times
Quad Cab
SYMPTOM
* NO WIPER ACTUATION AFTER WASH BUTTON PUSHED
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- CCD bus failure-no response CTM
- Open front washer switch sense CKT
- Defective central timer module/washer pump
Regular Cab
SYMPTOM
* WIPER SPEED SENSITIVE FEATURE INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- CCD bus failure - CTM
- CCD bus failure - PCM
- No response logic GND CKT open
- No response B (+) CKT open
- No response bus (-) CKT open
- No response CTM DEF bus (-) CKT open
- No response IGN SW RUN/ACCY CKT short - GND
- No response IGN SW RUN/START CKT short - GND
- No response power ground CKT open
- Fuse # 6 defective
- Fuse # 9 defective
Quad Cab
SYMPTOM
* WIPER SPEED SENSITIVE FEATURE INOPERATIVE
POSSIBLE CAUSES
- CCD bus failure-CTM
- CCD bus failure-PCM
- Defective central timer module/interval wipes times
Component Tests and General Diagnostics
Some complaints will require a test drive as part of the repair verification procedure. The purpose
of the test drive is to try to duplicate the diagnostic code or symptom condition.
CAUTION: BEFORE ROAD TESTING A VEHICLE, BE SURE THAT ALL COMPONENTS ARE
REASSEMBLED. DURING THE TEST DRIVE, DO NOT TRY TO READ THE DRB SCREEN
WHILE IN MOTION.DO NOT HANG THE DRB FROM THE REAR VIEW MIRROR OR OPERATE
IT YOURSELF. HAVE AN ASSISTANT AVAILABLE TO OPERATE THE DRB.
Regular Cab
DRB III ERROR MESSAGES AND BLANK SCREEN
Under normal operation, the DRB will display one of only two error messages: -User-Requested
WARM Boot or User- Requested COLD Boot If the DRB should display any other error message,
record the entire display and call the MDS Hotline, or call for information and assistance at
1-800-825-8737.This is a sample of such an error message display: ver: 2.14 date: 26 Jul93 file:
key_itf.cc date: Jul 26 1993 line: 548 err: Ox1 User-Requested COLD Boot Press MORE to switch
between this display and the application screen.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 265
Press F4 when done noting information.
DRB III does not power up (blank screen) If the LED's do not light or no sound is emitted at start
up, check for loose cable connections or a bad cable. Check the vehicle battery voltage (data link
connector cavity 16). A minimum of 11 volts is required to adequately power the DRB. If all
connections are proper between the DRB and the vehicle or other devices, and the vehicle battery
is fully charged, an inoperative DRB may be the result of faulty cable or vehicle wiring.
DRB III
Display is not visible Low temperatures will affect the visibility of the display. Adjust the contrast to
compensate for this condition.
Quad Cab
Under normal operation, the DRB will display one of only two error messages:
- User-Requested WARM Boot or User-Requested COLD Boot.
If the DRB should display any other error message, record the entire display and call the MDS
Hotline, or call for information and assistance at 1-800-825-8737. This is a sample of such an error
message display:
Ver: 2.4 date: 26 Jul93 file: key_itf.cc date: Jul 26 993 line: 548 err: Ox1 User-Requested COLD
Boot
Press MORE to switch between this display and the application screen. Press F4 when done
noting information.
DRB III does not power up (Blank Screen)
If the LED's do not light or no sound is emitted at start up, check for loose cable connections or a
bad cable. Check the vehicle battery voltage (data link connector cavity 6). A minimum of volts is
required to adequately power the DRB.
If all connections are proper between the DRB and the vehicle or other devices, and the vehicle
battery is fully charged, an inoperative DRB may be the result of faulty cable or vehicle wiring.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Reading and Clearing Diagnostic Trouble Codes > Page 266
DRB III
Display is not visible
Low temperatures will affect the visibility of the display. Adjust the contrast to compensate for this
condition.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Central Timer Module <--> [Body Control Module] > Component Information > Testing
and Inspection > Page 267
Central Timer Module: Tools and Equipment
DRB III (diagnostic read-out box) Jumper Wires Ohmmeter Voltmeter
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-15-00 > Sep > 00 > ECM - Poor Driveability/Hard Engine Restart
Powertrain Control Module: Customer Interest ECM - Poor Driveability/Hard Engine Restart
NUMBER: 18-15-00
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Sept. 8, 2000
SUBJECT: Driveability Enhancements With Winter Fuel Use And For Hard Hot Engine Restarts
0VERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Cummins CM551
Engine Control Module (ECM) with new software (calibration versions: 57T11A, 5711B, 56T13).
There is no change to the JTEC PCM software.
MODELS: 1999 - 2001 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 5.9L-24V DIESEL ENGINE BUILT
ON OR BETWEEN ENGINE SERIAL NUMBERS 56478845 TO 56744082, WITH A DATE OF
MANUFACTURE OF JULY 8, 1998 TO JUNE 29, 2000. THIS INFORMATION IS AVAILABLE ON
THE ENGINE DATA PLATE, WHICH IS LOCATED ON THE LEFT SIDE OF THE ENGINE,
AFFIXED TO THE GEAR HOUSING.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may complain of poor driveability when winter fuel is used to power the engine. The
customer may complain of a no start or a hard hot engine restart condition when using any type of
good quality diesel fuel.
The poor driveability condition may occur only when either straight # 1 diesel fuel is used or when
other special cold climate winter blend fuels are in use.
The no start or long engine crank condition may occur when attempting to restart the engine while
the temperature of the engine is still close to its normal operating temperature. This hard hot restart
condition may be experienced in all ambient climates, but may be more of a concern in warmer
ambient climates.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using the Mopar Diagnostic System (MDS2) and or the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRB III(R), with the
appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify that all engine and transmission systems are
functioning as designed. If Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) are present, record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. If no DIC's are
present, and the above symptom has been experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
WHENEVER AN ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECM) IS REPLACED DUE TO FAILURE, THE
SOFTWARE OF THE REPLACEMENT CONTROLLER MUST BE VERIFIED FOR THE LATEST
REVISION LEVEL. USE THE FLASH PROCEDURE TO UPDATE REPLACED CONTROLLERS
AS NECESSARY.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
THE MDS2 AND DRB III(R) ARE REQUIRED TO PERFORM PART OF THIS REPAIR. WHEN
USING THE MDS2 AND THE DRB III(R), THE SYSTEM MUST BE OPERATING AT CIS CD 2066
OR HIGHER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-15-00 > Sep > 00 > ECM - Poor Driveability/Hard Engine Restart >
Page 276
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Log onto the MDS2 system.
2. Connect the MDS2 and DRB III(R) to the vehicle and switch the ignition key to "ON".
3. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 CONNECT TO MDS2 on the DRB III(R) MAIN MENU
SCREEN.
4. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 RUN MDS2 APPLICATION on the DRB III(R) MAIN MENU
SCREEN.
NOTE:
ONCE MDS2, DRB III(R), AND VEHICLE COMMUNICATION HAS BEEN ESTABLISHED, THE
"CANNOT READ VIN FROM DRB III(R)" MESSAGE (ON THE MDS2) WILL BE REPLACED BY
THE VEHICLE VIN. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON ON THE MDS2 TO REQUEST A MDS2
SESSION FOR THE VEHICLE VIN INDICATED. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON WHEN ASKED TO
BEGIN SESSION.
5. Select the FLASH tab on the MDS2.
6. Select READ PART NUMBERS FROM VEHICLE and click SHOW UPDATES on the MDS2.
Press the "OK" button.
NOTE:
IN ABOVE STEPS # 5 AND/OR # 6, A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO
UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT
IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST SOFTWARE LEVEL AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN.
IF THE LATEST SOFTWARE IS INSTALLED, AND NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, ANOTHER
VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS THAT WILL REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
7. Select the new software part number with the light pen and click UPDATE CONTROLLER
SOFTWARE.
8. The MDS2 and DRB III(R) will prompt for any operator action needed during the remainder of
the reprogramming process.
NOTE:
DUE TO THE ECM REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE, A DTC MAY BE SET IN OTHER
MODULES (PCM, BCM, MIC, SKIM, ETC.) WITHIN THE VEHICLE IF SO EQUIPPED. SOME
DTC'S MAY CAUSE THE MIL TO ILLUMINATE. ALL DTC'S RELATE TO A LOSS OF
COMMUNICATIONS WITH THE MODULE THAT IS BEING REPROGRAMMED. CHECK ALL
MODULES, RECORD THE FAULTS, AND ERASE THESE FAULTS PRIOR TO RETURNING THE
VEHICLE TO THE CUSTOMER. ERASE ANY FAULTS IN THE PCM ONLY AFTER ALL OTHER
MODULES HAVE HAD THEIR FAULTS ERASED.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" pin 04669020
(Figure 1). Attach the label to the CUMMINS ECM and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
Do not attach the label to the JTEC PCM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-15-00 > Sep > 00 > ECM - Poor Driveability/Hard Engine Restart >
Page 277
10. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086 and
attach the label near the VECI label (Figure 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE: FM - Flash Module
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 21-01-00 > Feb > 00 > A/T - Harsh Reverse Gear Engagement
Powertrain Control Module: Customer Interest A/T - Harsh Reverse Gear Engagement
NUMBER: 21-01-00
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: Feb 4, 2000
SUBJECT: Intermittent Harsh Engagement Into Reverse Gear On Certain RE Model
Transmissions
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves the replacement of the transmission valve body upper housing
separator plate and a valve body check ball. In addition, for 2000 M.Y. vehicles equipped with a
46RE transmission this bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the JTEC
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with new software (calibration change 00Cal13/13A).
MODELS: 2000
(AB) Ram Van
1999 - 2000 (AN) Dakota
1999 - 2000 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
2000 (DN) Durango
1999 - 2000 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO 1999 AND 2000 MODEL YEAR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH
EITHER A 42RE AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION BUILT BEFORE SEPTEMBER 1, 1999 (MDH
0901 XX) OR 2000 MODEL YEAR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 46RE AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION BUILT BEFORE DECEMBER 1,1999 (MDH I2OIXX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: The customer may experience a harsh engagement into gear when
reverse is selected. This condition may be intermittent, and may occur more frequently as the
transmission fluid warms to normal operating temperatures.
DIAGNOSIS: 1.
Verify that the transmission fluid level is correct.
2. Verify that the valve body throttle valve and transmission shift linkage is adjusted properly.
Using the Mopar Diagnostic System (MDS2) and or the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRB III) with the
appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all engine/transmission systems are functioning
as designed. If Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) are present, record them on the repair order and
repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. If no DTC's are present, and the
above symptoms have been experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
WHENEVER A POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) IS REPLACED DUE TO FAILURE,
THE SOFTWARE OF THE REPLACEMENT CONTROLLER MUST BE VERIFIED FOR THE
LATEST REVISION LEVEL. USE THE FLASH PROCEDURE TO UPDATE REPLACED
CONTROLLERS AS NECESSARY.
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED: 1
CH6OOO Scan Tool (DRB III)
1 CH7035 General Purpose Interface Bus Cable (GPIB)
1 CH700017001 J1962 Cable
1 MDS2
NOTE:
THE MDS2 AND DRB III ARE REQUIRED TO PERFORM PART OF THIS REPAIR. WHEN
USING THE MDS2 AND THE DRB III, THE SYSTEM MUST BE OPERATING AT CIS CD 2051
OR HIGHER.
PARTS REQUIRED: 1
52118261 Ball, Rear Servo Check ('Torlon" - plastic for 42RE and 46RE)
1 52118272 Plate, Valve Body Separator (42RE trans.)
1 04295875 Gasket, Transmission Pan (42RE trans.)
1 04617196AB Plate, Valve Body Separator (46RE trans.)
1 05012978AA Gasket, Transmission Pan (46RE trans.)
10 05010124AA Fluid, Transmission ATF +3
1(AR) 04669020 Label, Authorized Software Update (if a 46RE trans.)
1(AR) 04275086 Label, Authorized Modification (if a 46RE trans.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 21-01-00 > Feb > 00 > A/T - Harsh Reverse Gear Engagement > Page
282
REPAIR PROCEDURE: For both the 1999 and 2000 M.Y. 42RE and 46RE Transmission:
1. Refer to the appropriate year information on Transmission and Transfer Case removal and
installation instructions of the transmission valve body, check ball, upper housing separator plate,
and pan gasket.
2. Replace the original steel rear servo check ball with the plastic "Torlon" check ball (p/n
52118261).
3. Clean the new separator plate to remove any dirt or rust inhibitor prior to installation.
4. Install the new transmission valve body upper housing separator plate (p/n 52118272 or p/n
04617196AB).
5. Reassemble the transmission.
6. Install a new transmission pan gasket (p/n 04295875 or p/n 05012978AA).
7. Lower vehicle and install transmission fluid (p/n 05010124AA).
8. Verify fluid level after warming up the transmission and cycling the shift lever several times.
9. Verify, and if required, adjust the transmission shift linkage and the transmission throttle valve
cable per the appropriate Service Manual procedures.
For the 2000 M.Y. 46RE Transmission Only:
1. Log onto the MDS2 system.
2. Connect the MDS2 (Mopar Diagnostic System) and DRB III (Scan Tool) to the vehicle and
switch the ignition key to "ON".
3. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 CONNECT TO MDS2 on the DRB III MAIN MENU SCREEN.
4. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 RUN MDS2 APPLICATION on the DRB III MAIN MENU
SCREEN.
NOTE:
ONCE MDS2, DRB III, AND VEHICLE COMMUNICATION HAS BEEN ESTABLISHED, THE
"CANNOT READ VIN FROM DRB III "MESSAGE (ON THE MDS) WILL BE REPLACED BY THE
VEHICLE VIN. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON ON THE MDS2 TO REQUEST A MDS2 SESSION
FOR THE VEHICLE VIN INDICATED. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON WHEN ASKED TO BEGIN
SESSION.
5. Push the FLASH tab on the MDS2.
NOTE:
A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS
OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST
SOFTWARE LEVEL AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN. IF THE LATEST SOFTWARE IS
INSTALLED, AND NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, ANOTHER VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS
THAT WILL REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
6. Select READ PART NUMBERS FROM VEHICLE and click SHOW UPDATES on the MDS2.
NOTE:
A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS
OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST
SOFTWARE LEVEL AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN. IF THE LATEST SOFTWARE IS
INSTALLED, AND NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, ANOTHER VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS
THAT WILL REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
7. Select the new software part number with the light pen and click UPDATE CONTROLLER
SOFTWARE.
8. The MDS2 and DRB III will prompt for any operator action needed during the remainder of the
reprogramming process.
NOTE:
DUE TO THE PCM FLASH PROCEDURE, A DTC MAY BE SET IN OTHER MODULES (EATX,
BCM, MIC, SKIM, ABS) WITHIN THE VEHICLE IF SO EQUIPPED. SOME MAY CAUSE THE MIL
TO ILLUMINATE. ALL DTC'S RELATE TO A LOSS OF COMMUNICATIONS WITH THE MODULE
THAT IS BEING FLASHED. CHECK ALL MODULES, RECORD THE FAULTS, AND ERASE
THESE FAULTS PRIOR TO RETURNING THE VEHICLE TO THE CUSTOMER. ERASE ANY
FAULTS IN THE PCM ONLY AFTER ALL OTHER MODULES HAVE HAD THEIR FAULTS
ERASED.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 21-01-00 > Feb > 00 > A/T - Harsh Reverse Gear Engagement > Page
283
Fig. 1
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020
(Figure 1). Attach the label to the JTEC PCM and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
Fig. 2
10. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" pin 04275086 and
attach the label near the VECI label (Figure 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
21-95-01-93 Valve Body, Check Ball and Plate - Replace 1.7 Hrs.
1999-2000 (AB, AN, BR, BE, DN, WJ)
08-19-42-94 Powertrain Control Module - Reprogram (46RE only) 0.5 Hrs.
2000 (AN, AB, BR, BE, DN)
FAILURE CODE: P8- New Part
FM - Flash Module
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 18-033-04 > Aug > 04 >
Engine Controls - Generic Engine Module Programming
Powertrain Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Generic Engine
Module Programming
NUMBER: 18-033-04
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: August 20, 2004
THE DRBIII(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE ON DealerCONNECT.
FOR MARKETS OUTSIDE OF THE UNITED STATES AND CANADA, THE FLASH FILES AND
REPROGRAMMING INSTRUCTIONS WILL BE AVAILABLE ON ITIL/ISIS DVD OCTOBER, 2004.
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-030-03 REV. A DATED OCTOBER 17,
2003, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES 8 ADDITIONAL PART NUMBERS, AN
ADDITIONAL MODEL YEAR, AND AN UPDATED REPAIR PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Generic Cummins Engine Control Module (ECM) Procedure
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves programming a generic Cummins ECM with software.
MODELS
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to Ram trucks equipped with the 5.9L Cummins 24-valve diesel engine (sales
code ETC or ETH).
DISCUSSION:
Mopar(R) is phasing out pre-programmed Cummins Diesel Engine Control Modules (ECM). New
modules will no longer be pre-programmed when received from Mopar(R). Replacement of future
ECM's will require programming utilizing the DRBIII(R) and TechCONNECT. 1998 1/2 - 2002
modules will cause the "Wait to Start" light to flash, indicating the module has not been
programmed.
CAUTION:
Extreme care must be taken when programming the flash file of a generic ECM. Do not randomly
select a flash file. If in doubt, contact the STAR Center for assistance. Installing an incorrect flash
file into an ECM can cause severe engine damage. Once a flash file is selected and programmed,
the controller cannot be reprogrammed with a different flash file. The module can only be
reprogrammed to a more recent version of the same released flash file.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 18-033-04 > Aug > 04 >
Engine Controls - Generic Engine Module Programming > Page 289
PARTS REQUIRED
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 18-033-04 > Aug > 04 >
Engine Controls - Generic Engine Module Programming > Page 290
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being performed.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
Whenever a controller is programmed, the software in the DRBIII(R) must be programmed with the
latest revision level available.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash process should be restarted and then follow the
directions on the DRBIII(R).
1. Before beginning the reprogramming procedure, remove any old flash reprogramming files from
the DRBIII(R) memory. To clear the memory from the MAIN MENU power up the DRBIII(R) and
then:
a. Simultaneously press the "MORE" and "YES" keys.
b. A screen will appear requesting a "COLD BOOT".
c. Follow the on screen instructions by selecting the "F4" key.
d. When the DRBIII(R) reboots to the MAIN MENU, proceed to Step # 2.
2. With the ignition switch in the "RUN" position, determine and record the "ECM part number" of
the ECM currently in the vehicle. Using the DRBIII(R) select:
a. "DRBIII(R) Standalone"
b. "1998 - 2005 Diagnostics"
c. "All (Except Below)"
d. "Engine"
e. On 1998 1/2 - 2003 vehicles, select "Cummins". 2004 and later vehicles, proceed to next step.
f. "Module Display"
g. Record the "ECM part number" on the repair order for later reference.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 18-033-04 > Aug > 04 >
Engine Controls - Generic Engine Module Programming > Page 291
NOTE:
If the ECM is not operational, the "ECM part number" can be obtained from the label on the
controller. For 1998 1/2 - 2002 vehicles, if the label on the controller is not legible, proceed to next
step. For 2003 and later vehicles, if the label on the controller is not legible, record the "Reference
No." for use later. The "Reference No." is located in the Reference No. box at the top, center of the
Engine Data Plate (Fig. 1). Do not use the reference number shown in the figure. The Engine Data
Plate is located on the intake side of the breather cover or affixed to the APPS bracket.
3. Page back to the "Main Menu"
4. Determine if the vehicle is equipped with SKIM. Using the DRBIII(R) select:
a. "DRBIII Standalone"
b. "1998 - 2005 Diagnostics"
c. "All"
d. "System Monitor"
e. "J1850 Module Scan"
f. Look for "SKIM" in the list of modules.
5. If the vehicle is not equipped with SKIM then proceed to Step # 6. If the vehicle is equipped with
SKIM obtain the vehicle Personal Identification Number (PIN) before continuing with Step # 6. This
information is available from:
a. The original selling invoice.
b. The DealerCONNECT system under the "Sales" or "Parts" tabs - select "Key Codes".
c. By contacting the District Manager.
CAUTION:
Failure to install the SKIM pin number into the module after flashing the Cummins ECM will cause a
start and stall condition.
6. Open the hood, install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides approximately
13.5 volts.
7. If the old "ECM part number" is known, or for 2003 and later vehicles, proceed to Step # 14. On
1998 1/2 - 2002 vehicles, if the old "ECM part number" is not known, proceed to next step.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 18-033-04 > Aug > 04 >
Engine Controls - Generic Engine Module Programming > Page 292
8. On DealerCONNECT select the "Service" tab.
9. Select "Vehicle Information Plus".
10. Select "Single VIN Inquiry".
11. Manually enter the VIN and mileage and select "Enter".
12. Select the "Vehicle Option" tab.
13. Under the "Vehicle Option" window, identify and record:
a. Engine (sales code and description).
b. Emissions (Federal or California)
c. Transmission (Automatic, 5-speed manual, etc.).
NOTE:
When reprogramming a Cummins ECM be sure to do the following;
^ Download the flash file from TechCONNECT to the DRBIII(R) with the DRBIII(R) disconnected
from the vehicle.
^ Download the flash file from the DRBIII(R) to the vehicle with the DRBIII(R) disconnected from
TechCONNECT.
14. Connect the DRBIII(R) to TechCONNECT. Open TechTOOLS and verify that the "DRBIII(R)
Status: Connected" message is in the upper right corner of the TechTOOLS screen.
15. Enter the old Cummins "ECM part number" obtained from the DRBIII(R) in Step # 2 into the
"Parts Criteria" window.
16. Select "Show Updates".
17. Highlight the proper flash file from the list:
a. If the old "ECM part number" is known, highlight the flash file listed, based on the old "ECM part
number" recorded earlier Step # 2.
b. For 1998 1/2 - 2002, if the old "ECM part number" is not known, highlight the correct flash file
based on the information that was recorded from "Vehicle Options" Step # 13.
c. For 2003 and later, if the old part number is not known, highlight the proper flash file based on
the Reference No. located in the "Ref. No." box, at the top, center of the Engine Data Plate (Fig. 1).
18. Select the "DRBIII" radio button which is next to the "Download/Update" button.
19. Select the "Download/Update" button.
20. Monitor the "Flash Download/Update Progress" window on the TechCONNECT and follow the
instructions on TechCONNECT. When the flash process is complete, proceed to the next step.
21. Disconnect the DRBIII(R) from TechCONNECT.
22. Connect the DRBIII(R) to the vehicle.
23. Download the flash file from the DRBIII(R) to the vehicle. Using the DRBIII(R) select:
a. "Vehicle Flash"
b. Follow the directions on the DRBIII(R) screen. When the flash process is complete, proceed to
the next step.
24. If the vehicle is equipped with SKIM, proceed to Step # 25. If the vehicle is not equipped with
SKIM, proceed to Step # 26.
25. On vehicles equipped with SKIM, transfer the VIN and Security Key information from the SKIM
to the ECM. Using the DRBIII(R) select:
a. "DRBIII Standalone"
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 18-033-04 > Aug > 04 >
Engine Controls - Generic Engine Module Programming > Page 293
b. "1998 - 2005 Diagnostics"
c. "All"
d. "TheftAlarm"
e. "SKIM"
f. "Miscellaneous"
g. "Cummins ECM Replaced"
h. Follow the directions on the DRBIII(R) screen. When the process is complete, proceed to Step #
27.
26. On vehicles not equipped with SKIM, manually enter the VIN in the ECM. Using the DRBIII(R)
select:
a. "DRBIII Standalone"
b. "1998 - 2005 Diagnostics"
c. "All"
d. "Engine"
e. "Cummins Controller (ECM/ENGINE)"
f. "Miscellaneous"
g. "CM84X Check VIN"
h. Follow the directions on the DRBIII(R) screen. When the process is complete, proceed to next
step.
NOTE:
Due to the Cummins controller programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (PCM,
TCM, BCM, MIC, SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to
illuminate. Check all modules using "Module Scan", record the DTC's, and erase these DTC's prior
to returning the vehicle to the customer. Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all other modules
have had their DTC's erased.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law.
27. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 2).
POLICY:
Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 18-033-04 > Aug > 04 >
Engine Controls - Generic Engine Module Programming > Page 294
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Refer to Quick Labor Operations or the appropriate Labor Operation Time Schedule manual.
Disclaimer
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 18-15-00 > Sep > 00 > ECM Poor Driveability/Hard Engine Restart
Powertrain Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins ECM - Poor Driveability/Hard Engine
Restart
NUMBER: 18-15-00
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Sept. 8, 2000
SUBJECT: Driveability Enhancements With Winter Fuel Use And For Hard Hot Engine Restarts
0VERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Cummins CM551
Engine Control Module (ECM) with new software (calibration versions: 57T11A, 5711B, 56T13).
There is no change to the JTEC PCM software.
MODELS: 1999 - 2001 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 5.9L-24V DIESEL ENGINE BUILT
ON OR BETWEEN ENGINE SERIAL NUMBERS 56478845 TO 56744082, WITH A DATE OF
MANUFACTURE OF JULY 8, 1998 TO JUNE 29, 2000. THIS INFORMATION IS AVAILABLE ON
THE ENGINE DATA PLATE, WHICH IS LOCATED ON THE LEFT SIDE OF THE ENGINE,
AFFIXED TO THE GEAR HOUSING.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The customer may complain of poor driveability when winter fuel is used to power the engine. The
customer may complain of a no start or a hard hot engine restart condition when using any type of
good quality diesel fuel.
The poor driveability condition may occur only when either straight # 1 diesel fuel is used or when
other special cold climate winter blend fuels are in use.
The no start or long engine crank condition may occur when attempting to restart the engine while
the temperature of the engine is still close to its normal operating temperature. This hard hot restart
condition may be experienced in all ambient climates, but may be more of a concern in warmer
ambient climates.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using the Mopar Diagnostic System (MDS2) and or the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRB III(R), with the
appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify that all engine and transmission systems are
functioning as designed. If Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) are present, record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. If no DIC's are
present, and the above symptom has been experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
WHENEVER AN ENGINE CONTROL MODULE (ECM) IS REPLACED DUE TO FAILURE, THE
SOFTWARE OF THE REPLACEMENT CONTROLLER MUST BE VERIFIED FOR THE LATEST
REVISION LEVEL. USE THE FLASH PROCEDURE TO UPDATE REPLACED CONTROLLERS
AS NECESSARY.
PARTS REQUIRED:
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
THE MDS2 AND DRB III(R) ARE REQUIRED TO PERFORM PART OF THIS REPAIR. WHEN
USING THE MDS2 AND THE DRB III(R), THE SYSTEM MUST BE OPERATING AT CIS CD 2066
OR HIGHER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 18-15-00 > Sep > 00 > ECM Poor Driveability/Hard Engine Restart > Page 299
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Log onto the MDS2 system.
2. Connect the MDS2 and DRB III(R) to the vehicle and switch the ignition key to "ON".
3. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 CONNECT TO MDS2 on the DRB III(R) MAIN MENU
SCREEN.
4. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 RUN MDS2 APPLICATION on the DRB III(R) MAIN MENU
SCREEN.
NOTE:
ONCE MDS2, DRB III(R), AND VEHICLE COMMUNICATION HAS BEEN ESTABLISHED, THE
"CANNOT READ VIN FROM DRB III(R)" MESSAGE (ON THE MDS2) WILL BE REPLACED BY
THE VEHICLE VIN. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON ON THE MDS2 TO REQUEST A MDS2
SESSION FOR THE VEHICLE VIN INDICATED. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON WHEN ASKED TO
BEGIN SESSION.
5. Select the FLASH tab on the MDS2.
6. Select READ PART NUMBERS FROM VEHICLE and click SHOW UPDATES on the MDS2.
Press the "OK" button.
NOTE:
IN ABOVE STEPS # 5 AND/OR # 6, A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO
UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT
IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST SOFTWARE LEVEL AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN.
IF THE LATEST SOFTWARE IS INSTALLED, AND NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, ANOTHER
VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS THAT WILL REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
7. Select the new software part number with the light pen and click UPDATE CONTROLLER
SOFTWARE.
8. The MDS2 and DRB III(R) will prompt for any operator action needed during the remainder of
the reprogramming process.
NOTE:
DUE TO THE ECM REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE, A DTC MAY BE SET IN OTHER
MODULES (PCM, BCM, MIC, SKIM, ETC.) WITHIN THE VEHICLE IF SO EQUIPPED. SOME
DTC'S MAY CAUSE THE MIL TO ILLUMINATE. ALL DTC'S RELATE TO A LOSS OF
COMMUNICATIONS WITH THE MODULE THAT IS BEING REPROGRAMMED. CHECK ALL
MODULES, RECORD THE FAULTS, AND ERASE THESE FAULTS PRIOR TO RETURNING THE
VEHICLE TO THE CUSTOMER. ERASE ANY FAULTS IN THE PCM ONLY AFTER ALL OTHER
MODULES HAVE HAD THEIR FAULTS ERASED.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" pin 04669020
(Figure 1). Attach the label to the CUMMINS ECM and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
Do not attach the label to the JTEC PCM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 18-15-00 > Sep > 00 > ECM Poor Driveability/Hard Engine Restart > Page 300
10. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086 and
attach the label near the VECI label (Figure 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
FAILURE CODE: FM - Flash Module
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 21-01-00 > Feb > 00 > A/T Harsh Reverse Gear Engagement
Powertrain Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins A/T - Harsh Reverse Gear Engagement
NUMBER: 21-01-00
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: Feb 4, 2000
SUBJECT: Intermittent Harsh Engagement Into Reverse Gear On Certain RE Model
Transmissions
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves the replacement of the transmission valve body upper housing
separator plate and a valve body check ball. In addition, for 2000 M.Y. vehicles equipped with a
46RE transmission this bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the JTEC
Powertrain Control Module (PCM) with new software (calibration change 00Cal13/13A).
MODELS: 2000
(AB) Ram Van
1999 - 2000 (AN) Dakota
1999 - 2000 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
2000 (DN) Durango
1999 - 2000 (WJ) Grand Cherokee
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO 1999 AND 2000 MODEL YEAR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH
EITHER A 42RE AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION BUILT BEFORE SEPTEMBER 1, 1999 (MDH
0901 XX) OR 2000 MODEL YEAR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 46RE AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION BUILT BEFORE DECEMBER 1,1999 (MDH I2OIXX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: The customer may experience a harsh engagement into gear when
reverse is selected. This condition may be intermittent, and may occur more frequently as the
transmission fluid warms to normal operating temperatures.
DIAGNOSIS: 1.
Verify that the transmission fluid level is correct.
2. Verify that the valve body throttle valve and transmission shift linkage is adjusted properly.
Using the Mopar Diagnostic System (MDS2) and or the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRB III) with the
appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all engine/transmission systems are functioning
as designed. If Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) are present, record them on the repair order and
repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. If no DTC's are present, and the
above symptoms have been experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
WHENEVER A POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) IS REPLACED DUE TO FAILURE,
THE SOFTWARE OF THE REPLACEMENT CONTROLLER MUST BE VERIFIED FOR THE
LATEST REVISION LEVEL. USE THE FLASH PROCEDURE TO UPDATE REPLACED
CONTROLLERS AS NECESSARY.
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED: 1
CH6OOO Scan Tool (DRB III)
1 CH7035 General Purpose Interface Bus Cable (GPIB)
1 CH700017001 J1962 Cable
1 MDS2
NOTE:
THE MDS2 AND DRB III ARE REQUIRED TO PERFORM PART OF THIS REPAIR. WHEN
USING THE MDS2 AND THE DRB III, THE SYSTEM MUST BE OPERATING AT CIS CD 2051
OR HIGHER.
PARTS REQUIRED: 1
52118261 Ball, Rear Servo Check ('Torlon" - plastic for 42RE and 46RE)
1 52118272 Plate, Valve Body Separator (42RE trans.)
1 04295875 Gasket, Transmission Pan (42RE trans.)
1 04617196AB Plate, Valve Body Separator (46RE trans.)
1 05012978AA Gasket, Transmission Pan (46RE trans.)
10 05010124AA Fluid, Transmission ATF +3
1(AR) 04669020 Label, Authorized Software Update (if a 46RE trans.)
1(AR) 04275086 Label, Authorized Modification (if a 46RE trans.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 21-01-00 > Feb > 00 > A/T Harsh Reverse Gear Engagement > Page 305
REPAIR PROCEDURE: For both the 1999 and 2000 M.Y. 42RE and 46RE Transmission:
1. Refer to the appropriate year information on Transmission and Transfer Case removal and
installation instructions of the transmission valve body, check ball, upper housing separator plate,
and pan gasket.
2. Replace the original steel rear servo check ball with the plastic "Torlon" check ball (p/n
52118261).
3. Clean the new separator plate to remove any dirt or rust inhibitor prior to installation.
4. Install the new transmission valve body upper housing separator plate (p/n 52118272 or p/n
04617196AB).
5. Reassemble the transmission.
6. Install a new transmission pan gasket (p/n 04295875 or p/n 05012978AA).
7. Lower vehicle and install transmission fluid (p/n 05010124AA).
8. Verify fluid level after warming up the transmission and cycling the shift lever several times.
9. Verify, and if required, adjust the transmission shift linkage and the transmission throttle valve
cable per the appropriate Service Manual procedures.
For the 2000 M.Y. 46RE Transmission Only:
1. Log onto the MDS2 system.
2. Connect the MDS2 (Mopar Diagnostic System) and DRB III (Scan Tool) to the vehicle and
switch the ignition key to "ON".
3. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 CONNECT TO MDS2 on the DRB III MAIN MENU SCREEN.
4. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 RUN MDS2 APPLICATION on the DRB III MAIN MENU
SCREEN.
NOTE:
ONCE MDS2, DRB III, AND VEHICLE COMMUNICATION HAS BEEN ESTABLISHED, THE
"CANNOT READ VIN FROM DRB III "MESSAGE (ON THE MDS) WILL BE REPLACED BY THE
VEHICLE VIN. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON ON THE MDS2 TO REQUEST A MDS2 SESSION
FOR THE VEHICLE VIN INDICATED. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON WHEN ASKED TO BEGIN
SESSION.
5. Push the FLASH tab on the MDS2.
NOTE:
A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS
OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST
SOFTWARE LEVEL AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN. IF THE LATEST SOFTWARE IS
INSTALLED, AND NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, ANOTHER VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS
THAT WILL REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
6. Select READ PART NUMBERS FROM VEHICLE and click SHOW UPDATES on the MDS2.
NOTE:
A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS
OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST
SOFTWARE LEVEL AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN. IF THE LATEST SOFTWARE IS
INSTALLED, AND NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, ANOTHER VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS
THAT WILL REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
7. Select the new software part number with the light pen and click UPDATE CONTROLLER
SOFTWARE.
8. The MDS2 and DRB III will prompt for any operator action needed during the remainder of the
reprogramming process.
NOTE:
DUE TO THE PCM FLASH PROCEDURE, A DTC MAY BE SET IN OTHER MODULES (EATX,
BCM, MIC, SKIM, ABS) WITHIN THE VEHICLE IF SO EQUIPPED. SOME MAY CAUSE THE MIL
TO ILLUMINATE. ALL DTC'S RELATE TO A LOSS OF COMMUNICATIONS WITH THE MODULE
THAT IS BEING FLASHED. CHECK ALL MODULES, RECORD THE FAULTS, AND ERASE
THESE FAULTS PRIOR TO RETURNING THE VEHICLE TO THE CUSTOMER. ERASE ANY
FAULTS IN THE PCM ONLY AFTER ALL OTHER MODULES HAVE HAD THEIR FAULTS
ERASED.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 21-01-00 > Feb > 00 > A/T Harsh Reverse Gear Engagement > Page 306
Fig. 1
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020
(Figure 1). Attach the label to the JTEC PCM and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
Fig. 2
10. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" pin 04275086 and
attach the label near the VECI label (Figure 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE: Labor Operation No:
21-95-01-93 Valve Body, Check Ball and Plate - Replace 1.7 Hrs.
1999-2000 (AB, AN, BR, BE, DN, WJ)
08-19-42-94 Powertrain Control Module - Reprogram (46RE only) 0.5 Hrs.
2000 (AN, AB, BR, BE, DN)
FAILURE CODE: P8- New Part
FM - Flash Module
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 18-033-04 > Aug > 04 > Engine
Controls - Generic Engine Module Programming
Powertrain Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Controls - Generic Engine
Module Programming
NUMBER: 18-033-04
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: August 20, 2004
THE DRBIII(R) FLASH FILES FOR THIS BULLETIN ARE AVAILABLE ON DealerCONNECT.
FOR MARKETS OUTSIDE OF THE UNITED STATES AND CANADA, THE FLASH FILES AND
REPROGRAMMING INSTRUCTIONS WILL BE AVAILABLE ON ITIL/ISIS DVD OCTOBER, 2004.
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES SERVICE BULLETIN 18-030-03 REV. A DATED OCTOBER 17,
2003, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDES 8 ADDITIONAL PART NUMBERS, AN
ADDITIONAL MODEL YEAR, AND AN UPDATED REPAIR PROCEDURE.
SUBJECT: Generic Cummins Engine Control Module (ECM) Procedure
OVERVIEW:
This bulletin involves programming a generic Cummins ECM with software.
MODELS
NOTE:
This bulletin applies to Ram trucks equipped with the 5.9L Cummins 24-valve diesel engine (sales
code ETC or ETH).
DISCUSSION:
Mopar(R) is phasing out pre-programmed Cummins Diesel Engine Control Modules (ECM). New
modules will no longer be pre-programmed when received from Mopar(R). Replacement of future
ECM's will require programming utilizing the DRBIII(R) and TechCONNECT. 1998 1/2 - 2002
modules will cause the "Wait to Start" light to flash, indicating the module has not been
programmed.
CAUTION:
Extreme care must be taken when programming the flash file of a generic ECM. Do not randomly
select a flash file. If in doubt, contact the STAR Center for assistance. Installing an incorrect flash
file into an ECM can cause severe engine damage. Once a flash file is selected and programmed,
the controller cannot be reprogrammed with a different flash file. The module can only be
reprogrammed to a more recent version of the same released flash file.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 18-033-04 > Aug > 04 > Engine
Controls - Generic Engine Module Programming > Page 312
PARTS REQUIRED
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 18-033-04 > Aug > 04 > Engine
Controls - Generic Engine Module Programming > Page 313
SPECIAL TOOLS/EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
NOTE:
An updated J1962 cable has been released. This cable has a red colored connector at the
DRBIII(R) connection. Use this cable whenever a flash is being performed.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
NOTE:
Whenever a controller is programmed, the software in the DRBIII(R) must be programmed with the
latest revision level available.
NOTE:
If this flash process is interrupted/aborted, the flash process should be restarted and then follow the
directions on the DRBIII(R).
1. Before beginning the reprogramming procedure, remove any old flash reprogramming files from
the DRBIII(R) memory. To clear the memory from the MAIN MENU power up the DRBIII(R) and
then:
a. Simultaneously press the "MORE" and "YES" keys.
b. A screen will appear requesting a "COLD BOOT".
c. Follow the on screen instructions by selecting the "F4" key.
d. When the DRBIII(R) reboots to the MAIN MENU, proceed to Step # 2.
2. With the ignition switch in the "RUN" position, determine and record the "ECM part number" of
the ECM currently in the vehicle. Using the DRBIII(R) select:
a. "DRBIII(R) Standalone"
b. "1998 - 2005 Diagnostics"
c. "All (Except Below)"
d. "Engine"
e. On 1998 1/2 - 2003 vehicles, select "Cummins". 2004 and later vehicles, proceed to next step.
f. "Module Display"
g. Record the "ECM part number" on the repair order for later reference.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 18-033-04 > Aug > 04 > Engine
Controls - Generic Engine Module Programming > Page 314
NOTE:
If the ECM is not operational, the "ECM part number" can be obtained from the label on the
controller. For 1998 1/2 - 2002 vehicles, if the label on the controller is not legible, proceed to next
step. For 2003 and later vehicles, if the label on the controller is not legible, record the "Reference
No." for use later. The "Reference No." is located in the Reference No. box at the top, center of the
Engine Data Plate (Fig. 1). Do not use the reference number shown in the figure. The Engine Data
Plate is located on the intake side of the breather cover or affixed to the APPS bracket.
3. Page back to the "Main Menu"
4. Determine if the vehicle is equipped with SKIM. Using the DRBIII(R) select:
a. "DRBIII Standalone"
b. "1998 - 2005 Diagnostics"
c. "All"
d. "System Monitor"
e. "J1850 Module Scan"
f. Look for "SKIM" in the list of modules.
5. If the vehicle is not equipped with SKIM then proceed to Step # 6. If the vehicle is equipped with
SKIM obtain the vehicle Personal Identification Number (PIN) before continuing with Step # 6. This
information is available from:
a. The original selling invoice.
b. The DealerCONNECT system under the "Sales" or "Parts" tabs - select "Key Codes".
c. By contacting the District Manager.
CAUTION:
Failure to install the SKIM pin number into the module after flashing the Cummins ECM will cause a
start and stall condition.
6. Open the hood, install a battery charger and verify that the charging rate provides approximately
13.5 volts.
7. If the old "ECM part number" is known, or for 2003 and later vehicles, proceed to Step # 14. On
1998 1/2 - 2002 vehicles, if the old "ECM part number" is not known, proceed to next step.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 18-033-04 > Aug > 04 > Engine
Controls - Generic Engine Module Programming > Page 315
8. On DealerCONNECT select the "Service" tab.
9. Select "Vehicle Information Plus".
10. Select "Single VIN Inquiry".
11. Manually enter the VIN and mileage and select "Enter".
12. Select the "Vehicle Option" tab.
13. Under the "Vehicle Option" window, identify and record:
a. Engine (sales code and description).
b. Emissions (Federal or California)
c. Transmission (Automatic, 5-speed manual, etc.).
NOTE:
When reprogramming a Cummins ECM be sure to do the following;
^ Download the flash file from TechCONNECT to the DRBIII(R) with the DRBIII(R) disconnected
from the vehicle.
^ Download the flash file from the DRBIII(R) to the vehicle with the DRBIII(R) disconnected from
TechCONNECT.
14. Connect the DRBIII(R) to TechCONNECT. Open TechTOOLS and verify that the "DRBIII(R)
Status: Connected" message is in the upper right corner of the TechTOOLS screen.
15. Enter the old Cummins "ECM part number" obtained from the DRBIII(R) in Step # 2 into the
"Parts Criteria" window.
16. Select "Show Updates".
17. Highlight the proper flash file from the list:
a. If the old "ECM part number" is known, highlight the flash file listed, based on the old "ECM part
number" recorded earlier Step # 2.
b. For 1998 1/2 - 2002, if the old "ECM part number" is not known, highlight the correct flash file
based on the information that was recorded from "Vehicle Options" Step # 13.
c. For 2003 and later, if the old part number is not known, highlight the proper flash file based on
the Reference No. located in the "Ref. No." box, at the top, center of the Engine Data Plate (Fig. 1).
18. Select the "DRBIII" radio button which is next to the "Download/Update" button.
19. Select the "Download/Update" button.
20. Monitor the "Flash Download/Update Progress" window on the TechCONNECT and follow the
instructions on TechCONNECT. When the flash process is complete, proceed to the next step.
21. Disconnect the DRBIII(R) from TechCONNECT.
22. Connect the DRBIII(R) to the vehicle.
23. Download the flash file from the DRBIII(R) to the vehicle. Using the DRBIII(R) select:
a. "Vehicle Flash"
b. Follow the directions on the DRBIII(R) screen. When the flash process is complete, proceed to
the next step.
24. If the vehicle is equipped with SKIM, proceed to Step # 25. If the vehicle is not equipped with
SKIM, proceed to Step # 26.
25. On vehicles equipped with SKIM, transfer the VIN and Security Key information from the SKIM
to the ECM. Using the DRBIII(R) select:
a. "DRBIII Standalone"
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 18-033-04 > Aug > 04 > Engine
Controls - Generic Engine Module Programming > Page 316
b. "1998 - 2005 Diagnostics"
c. "All"
d. "TheftAlarm"
e. "SKIM"
f. "Miscellaneous"
g. "Cummins ECM Replaced"
h. Follow the directions on the DRBIII(R) screen. When the process is complete, proceed to Step #
27.
26. On vehicles not equipped with SKIM, manually enter the VIN in the ECM. Using the DRBIII(R)
select:
a. "DRBIII Standalone"
b. "1998 - 2005 Diagnostics"
c. "All"
d. "Engine"
e. "Cummins Controller (ECM/ENGINE)"
f. "Miscellaneous"
g. "CM84X Check VIN"
h. Follow the directions on the DRBIII(R) screen. When the process is complete, proceed to next
step.
NOTE:
Due to the Cummins controller programming procedure, a DTC may be set in other modules (PCM,
TCM, BCM, MIC, SKIM, etc.) within the vehicle, if so equipped. Some DTC's may cause the MIL to
illuminate. Check all modules using "Module Scan", record the DTC's, and erase these DTC's prior
to returning the vehicle to the customer. Erase any DTC's in the PCM only after all other modules
have had their DTC's erased.
NOTE:
The following step is required by law.
27. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086AB and
attach near the VECI label (Fig. 2).
POLICY:
Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Powertrain Control Module: > 18-033-04 > Aug > 04 > Engine
Controls - Generic Engine Module Programming > Page 317
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Refer to Quick Labor Operations or the appropriate Labor Operation Time Schedule manual.
Disclaimer
This bulletin is supplied as technical information only and is not an authorization for repair.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Technical Service Bulletins > Page 318
Powertrain Control Module: Specifications
ECM Mounting Bolts 24 Nm
PCM Mounting Bolts 4 Nm
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations
Powertrain Control Module: Component Locations
Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
PCM Location And Mounting
The PCM is bolted to the firewall in the right-rear side of the engine compartment.
Engine Control Module (ECM)
Engine Control Module (ECM) Location
The Engine Control Module (ECM) is bolted to the left side of the engine behind the fuel filter.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Locations > Component Locations > Page 321
Engine Control Module (ECM), Hex Headed Bolt, 50-way Connector, Fuel Transfer Pump,
Mounting Bolts (3)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Powertrain Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 324
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 325
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 326
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 327
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 328
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 329
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 330
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 331
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 332
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 333
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 334
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 335
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 336
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 337
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 338
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 339
Powertrain Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 340
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 341
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 342
Powertrain Control Module: Connector Views
Diesel
Engine Control Module - Diesel
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 343
Powertrain Control Module C1
Powertrain Control Module C2
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 344
Powertrain Control Module C3
Gasoline Engine
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 345
Powertrain Control Module C1
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 346
Powertrain Control Module C2
Powertrain Control Module C3
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > System Operation
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation System Operation
The speed control electronic control circuitry is integrated into the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM). The PCM is located in the engine compartment. The PCM speed control functions are
monitored by the On-Board Diagnostics (OBD). All OBD sensed systems are monitored by the
PCM. Each monitored circuit is assigned a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC). The PCM will store a
DTC in electronic memory for certain failures it detects. See On-Board Diagnostic Test For Speed
Control System for more information. The PCM cannot be repaired and must be replaced if faulty.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Description and Operation > System Operation > Page 349
Powertrain Control Module: Description and Operation 46/47RE Transmission
The PCM controls operation of the converter clutch, overdrive clutch, and governor pressure
solenoid. The control module determines transmission shift points based on input signals from the
transmission thermistor, transmission output shaft speed sensor, crankshaft position sensor,
vehicle speed sensor, throttle position sensor, and battery temperature sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Testing and Inspection > Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions
Powertrain Control Module: Diagnostic Trouble Code Descriptions
Trouble Codes
Trouble Code Descriptions
For Information regarding diagnosis of all B, C, P, U and Manufacturer Codes See: Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection/Diagnostic Trouble Code
Descriptions
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair Powertrain Control Module (PCM)
PCM Location And Mounting
The PCM is bolted to the firewall in the right-rear side of the engine compartment.
REMOVAL
To avoid possible voltage spike damage to the PCM, ignition key must be off, and negative battery
cable must be disconnected before unplugging PCM connectors. 1. Disconnect negative battery
cable(s) at battery's). 2. Remove cover over electrical connectors. Cover snaps onto PCM. 3.
Carefully unplug the three 32-way connectors from PCM. 4. Remove three PCM mounting bolts
and remove PCM from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
1. Install PCM and mounting bolts to vehicle. 2. Tighten bolts to 4 Nm (35 in. lbs.). 3. Check pin
connectors in the PCM and the three 32-way connectors for corrosion or damage. Repair as
necessary. 4. Install three 32-way connectors. 5. Install cover over electrical connectors. Cover
snaps onto PCM. 6. Install battery cable(s)). 7. Use the DRB scan tool to reprogram new PCM with
vehicles original Identification Number (VIN) and original vehicle mileage. If this step is not
done, a Diagnostic 'Trouble Code (DTC) may be set.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Powertrain Control Module <--> [Engine Control Module] > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Powertrain Control Module (PCM) > Page 354
Powertrain Control Module: Service and Repair Engine Control Module (ECM) - Diesel
Engine Control Module (ECM) Location And Mounting
The ECM is bolted to the engine block behind the fuel filter.
REMOVAL 1. Record any Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) found in the PCM or ECM.
To avoid possible voltage spike damage to either the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) or ECM,
ignition key must be off, and negative battery cables must be disconnected before unplugging ECM
connectors.
2. Disconnect both negative battery cables at both batteries. 3. Remove 50-way electrical
connector bolt at ECM. Note: Connector bolt is female 4mm hex head. To remove bolt, use a
ball-hex bit or ball- hex
screwdriver such as Snap-On(R) 4 mm SDABM4 (5/32" may also be used). As bolt is being
removed, very carefully remove connector from ECM.
4. Remove three ECM mounting bolts and remove ECM from vehicle.
INSTALLATION Do not apply paint to back of ECM. Poor ground will result. 1. Clean ECM
mounting points at engine block. 2. Position ECM to engine block and install 3 mounting bolts.
Tighten bolts to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 3. Check pin connectors in ECM and 50-way connector for
corrosion or damage. Repair as necessary. 4. Clean pins in 50-way electrical connector with a
quick-dry electrical contact cleaner. 5. Very carefully install 50-way connector to ECM. tighten
connector hex bolt. 6. Install battery cables. 7. Turn key to ON position. Without starting engine,
slowly press throttle pedal to floor and then slowly release. This step must be done (one time) to
ensure accelerator pedal position sensor calibration has been learned by ECM. If not done,
possible DTC's may be set.
8. Use DRB scan tool to erase any stored companion DTC's from PCM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Locations
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Locations
Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 358
8w-10-2
The ASD relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), in the engine compartment.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 359
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Computers and Control Systems > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 360
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations
Fuel Pump Relay: Locations
Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 365
8w-10-2
The fuel pump relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 366
Fuel Pump Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 367
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Pump Relay > Component Information > Locations > Page 368
Fuel Pump Relay: Description and Operation
FUEL INJECTION PUMP RELAY-ECM OUTPUT The Engine Control Module (ECM) energizes the
electric fuel injection pump through the fuel injection pump relay. Battery voltage is applied to the
fuel injection pump relay at all times. When the key is turned ON, the relay is energized when a
12-volt signal is provided by the ECM. When energized, 12-volts is supplied to the Fuel Pump
Control Module. The Fuel Pump Control Module is located on the top of the fuel injection pump and
is non-serviceable.
The fuel injection pump relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). Refer to label
under PDC cover for relay location.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Intake Air Heater Relay: Component Locations
Intake Manifold Air Heater Relays
The relays are located in engine compartment, bolted to left inner fender below left battery.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations >
Page 373
Relay Output To Heater, Heater Relay #1, Heater Relay #2
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air Heater Relay
No.1
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Intake Air Heater Relay
No.1 > Page 376
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Intake Air Heater Relay > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 377
Intake Air Heater Relay: Service and Repair
Intake Manifold Air Heater Relays
The relays are located in engine compartment, bolted to left inner fender below left battery.
REMOVAL The mounting bracket and both relays are replaced as an assembly.
1. Disconnect both negative battery cables at both batteries. 2. Disconnect four relay trigger wires
at both relays. Note position of wiring before removing. 3. Lift four rubber shields from all 4 cables .
4. Remove four nuts at cable connectors. Note position of wiring before removing. 5. Remove three
relay mounting bracket bolts and remove relay assembly.
INSTALLATION 1. Install relay assembly to inner fender. tighten mounting bolts to 4.5 Nm (40 in.
lbs.) torque. 2. Connect eight electrical connectors to relays. 3. Connect battery cables to both
batteries.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Locations
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Locations
Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 381
8w-10-2
The ASD relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), in the engine compartment.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 382
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Powertrain Management > Relays and Modules Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay <--> [Main Relay (Computer/Fuel System)] >
Component Information > Locations > Page 383
Automatic Shut Down (ASD) Relay
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-32-99 > Oct > 99 > Two Way Radio Intermittent Poor Reception
Air Bag Control Module: Customer Interest Two Way Radio - Intermittent Poor Reception
NUMBER: 08-32-99
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Oct. 1, 1999
SUBJECT: Radio Interference To/From Two-Way Radio Receivers
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves installing a revised Airbag Control Module (ACM).
MODELS: 1998 - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customers may complain of intermittent poor reception on their two-way radios.
NOTE:
THIS CONDITION DOES NOT AFFECT THE OPERATION OF ANY AM OR FM BAND RADIO.
DISCUSSION:
Radio receivers from approximately 30 MHZ to 50 MHZ may be susceptible to Radio
Frequency Interference (RFI) from the Airbag Control Module (ACM).
The following services are within this band range of 30 MHZ to 50 MHZ:
^ Public Service Low Band VHF (30 - 50 MHZ)
^ Six Meter Amateur Radio Band (50 - 54 MHZ)
DIAGNOSIS:
NOTE:
TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 08-06-99, DATED MARCH 5, 1999, ADDRESSES TWO-WAY
RADIO INTERFERENCE FROM THE FUEL PUMP MODULE AND SHOULD BE PERFORMED
PRIOR TO PERFORMING THIS TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN.
Turn the ignition key to the RUN position. Operate the two-way radio and monitor for
RFI/static/poor reception. If RFI is present with the ignition key in the RUN position, perform the
following Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
THE INTERFERENCE MAY BE INTERMITTENT. IF THE CONDITION IS NOT PRESENT
DURING THE DIAGNOSIS, REPEAT THE DIAGNOSIS SEVERAL TIMES TO ATTEMPT TO
RE-CREATE THE CONDITION.
NOTE:
IT IS IMPORTANT TO IDENTIFY WHICH COMPONENTS ARE EMITTING RFI. AFTER A
REPAIR HAS BEEN MADE, PERFORM THE DIAGNOSIS AGAIN TO IDENTIFY IF ANY OTHER
COMPONENT IS PRODUCING RFI. SOME VEHICLES MAY REQUIRE ADDITIONAL
DIAGNOSIS.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 56043128AE Module, Airbag Control
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
THIS REPAIR IS COMPATIBLE WITH DAIMLERCHRYSLER'S MOBILE SERVICE PROGRAM
AND DOES NOT REQUIRE HOISTS OR OTHER FULL SERVICE FACILITY SPECIAL
EQUIPMENT.
1. Replace the ACM with p/n 56043128AE. Refer to the appropriate Ram Truck Service Manual,
Group 8M, for information regarding Airbag Control Module Removal And Installation procedures.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 08-32-99 > Oct > 99 > Two Way Radio Intermittent Poor Reception > Page 393
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-45-09-92 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 08-32-99 > Oct > 99 > Two Way
Radio - Intermittent Poor Reception
Air Bag Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Two Way Radio - Intermittent Poor
Reception
NUMBER: 08-32-99
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Oct. 1, 1999
SUBJECT: Radio Interference To/From Two-Way Radio Receivers
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves installing a revised Airbag Control Module (ACM).
MODELS: 1998 - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customers may complain of intermittent poor reception on their two-way radios.
NOTE:
THIS CONDITION DOES NOT AFFECT THE OPERATION OF ANY AM OR FM BAND RADIO.
DISCUSSION:
Radio receivers from approximately 30 MHZ to 50 MHZ may be susceptible to Radio
Frequency Interference (RFI) from the Airbag Control Module (ACM).
The following services are within this band range of 30 MHZ to 50 MHZ:
^ Public Service Low Band VHF (30 - 50 MHZ)
^ Six Meter Amateur Radio Band (50 - 54 MHZ)
DIAGNOSIS:
NOTE:
TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 08-06-99, DATED MARCH 5, 1999, ADDRESSES TWO-WAY
RADIO INTERFERENCE FROM THE FUEL PUMP MODULE AND SHOULD BE PERFORMED
PRIOR TO PERFORMING THIS TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN.
Turn the ignition key to the RUN position. Operate the two-way radio and monitor for
RFI/static/poor reception. If RFI is present with the ignition key in the RUN position, perform the
following Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
THE INTERFERENCE MAY BE INTERMITTENT. IF THE CONDITION IS NOT PRESENT
DURING THE DIAGNOSIS, REPEAT THE DIAGNOSIS SEVERAL TIMES TO ATTEMPT TO
RE-CREATE THE CONDITION.
NOTE:
IT IS IMPORTANT TO IDENTIFY WHICH COMPONENTS ARE EMITTING RFI. AFTER A
REPAIR HAS BEEN MADE, PERFORM THE DIAGNOSIS AGAIN TO IDENTIFY IF ANY OTHER
COMPONENT IS PRODUCING RFI. SOME VEHICLES MAY REQUIRE ADDITIONAL
DIAGNOSIS.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 56043128AE Module, Airbag Control
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
THIS REPAIR IS COMPATIBLE WITH DAIMLERCHRYSLER'S MOBILE SERVICE PROGRAM
AND DOES NOT REQUIRE HOISTS OR OTHER FULL SERVICE FACILITY SPECIAL
EQUIPMENT.
1. Replace the ACM with p/n 56043128AE. Refer to the appropriate Ram Truck Service Manual,
Group 8M, for information regarding Airbag Control Module Removal And Installation procedures.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 08-32-99 > Oct > 99 > Two Way
Radio - Intermittent Poor Reception > Page 399
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-45-09-92 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Air Bag Control Module: > 09-006-01
> Aug > 01 > Engine - Oil Pan Gasket Leak
Oil Pan Gasket: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Oil Pan Gasket Leak
NUMBER: 09-006-01
GROUP: Engine
DATE: August 24, 2001
SUBJECT: Engine Oil Pan Gasket Sealing
MODELS: 1998 - 2002 BE/BR Ram Truck
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO RAM TRUCKS EQUIPPED WITH THE 24-VALVE DIESEL
ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
Repeat oil pan gasket leaks can occur on 24 Valve Diesels it the gasket is applied without the use
of Mopar Silicon Rubber Adhesive (RTV) Sealant (PN 04883971). This bulletin provides specific
routing of the sealant when replacing the engine oil pan gasket. When replacing an oil pan gasket,
apply a 1/8" bead of RTV to the oil pan side of the gasket, around the back of the engine,
extending up to the fourth bolt hole from the rear on each side, as per (Fig. 1).
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 410
Air Bag Control Module: Specifications
Tighten the four screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor panel transmission
tunnel to 14 Nm (125 in lbs).
Tighten the nuts that secure the instrument panel center support bracket to the studs on the lower
instrument panel structural support to 14 Nm (125 in lbs).
Tighten the screws that secure each side of the instrument panel center support bracket to the
ACM mounting bracket to 14 Nm (125 in lbs).
Tighten the two screws that secure the trim cover to the ACM mounting bracket on the floor panel
transmission tunnel to 2.2 Nm (20 in lbs).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 411
Air Bag Control Module: Locations
Airbag Control Module
Airbag Control Module (ACM)
Module Locations
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 412
Airbag Control Module Remove/Install
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 413
Air Bag Control Module: Diagrams
Airbag Control Module (ACM) Connector
Airbag Control Module - 23 Way
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 414
Air Bag Control Module: Service Precautions
WARNING:
- THE AIR BAG CONTROL MODULE CONTAINS THE IMPACT SENSOR, WHICH ENABLES
THE SYSTEM TO DEPLOY THE AIRBAG. BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE
ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU MUST FIRST DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE
BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE. THEN WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM
CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE FURTHER SYSTEM SERVICE. THIS IS THE ONLY
SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO DO THIS COULD RESULT IN
ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
- NEVER STRIKE OR KICK THE AIR BAG CONTROL MODULE, AS IT CAN DAMAGE THE
IMPACT SENSOR OR AFFECT ITS CALIBRATION. IF AN AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE IS
ACCIDENTALLY DROPPED DURING SERVICE, THE MODULE MUST BE SCRAPPED AND
REPLACED WITH A NEW UNIT FAILURE TO OBSERVE THIS WARNING COULD RESULT IN
ACCIDENTAL, INCOMPLETE, OR IMPROPER AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE
OCCUPANT INJURIES
.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 415
Air Bag Control Module: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The Airbag Control Module (ACM) is secured with screws to a mounting bracket located under the
instrument panel center support bracket on the floor panel transmission tunnel in the passenger
compartment of the vehicle. A plastic trim cover on the floor panel transmission tunnel conceals the
ACM and the instrument panel center support bracket. The ACM contains an electronic
microprocessor, an electronic impact sensor, an electromechanical safing sensor, and an energy
storage capacitor.
Club cab and quad cab versions of this vehicle are equipped with a structural seat system. The
structural seat system uses an electronic seat belt control system, which includes a Seatbelt
Control Timer Module (SCTM). The SCTM has a hard wired fault circuit input to the ACM, which
the SCTM uses to signal the status of the electronic seat belt control system to the ACM. If the
ACM detects a fault input or no input from the SCTM, it sends messages to the instrument cluster
over the CCD data bus to turn on the seat belt reminder lamp. Refer to Seat Belt Control Systems
for more information on the electronic seat belt control system and the SCTM.
The ACM cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if damaged or faulty, it must be replaced.
OPERATION
The microprocessor in the ACM contains the airbag system logic. The airbag system logic includes
On-Board Diagnostics (OBD), and the ability to communicate with the instrument cluster circuitry
over the Chrysler Collision Detection (CCD) data bus to control the airbag indicator lamp. The
microprocessor continuously monitors all of the airbag system electrical circuits to determine the
system readiness. If the ACM detects a monitored system fault, it sends messages to the
instrument cluster over the CCD data bus to turn on the airbag indicator lamp. Refer to Instrument
Cluster in Instrument Panel Systems for more information on the airbag indicator lamp.
One electronic impact sensor is used in this airbag system. The impact sensor is an accelerometer
that senses the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides verification of the direction and severity
of an impact. The impact sensor is calibrated for the specific vehicle, and is only serviced as a unit
with the ACM. A pre-programmed decision algorithm in the ACM microprocessor determines when
the deceleration rate as signaled by the impact sensor indicates an impact that is severe enough to
require airbag system protection. When the programmed conditions are met, the ACM sends an
electrical signal to deploy the airbags.
In addition to the electronic impact sensor, there is an electromechanical sensor within the ACM
called a safing sensor. The safing sensor is a normally open series switch located in the airbag
deployment circuit of the ACM. This sensor detects impact energy of a lesser magnitude than the
electronic impact sensor, and must be closed in order for the airbags to deploy.
The ACM also contains an energy-storage capacitor. This capacitor stores enough electrical
energy to deploy the airbags for up to one second following a battery disconnect or failure during
an impact. The purpose of the capacitor is to provide airbag system protection in a severe
secondary impact, if the initial impact has damaged or disconnected the battery, but was not
severe enough to deploy the airbags.
A unique feature of the ACM used in this model is that it reads and learns the Vehicle Identification
Number (VIN) through messages received from the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) over the
CCD data bus. This was done so that the ACM could learn whether the vehicle was equipped with
a conventional seat system or the structural seat system. It takes approximately 20 engine start
cycles before the complete VIN number is learned and stored in the ACM memory. Once the ACM
has stored the VIN information in memory, it cannot be installed in any other vehicle without setting
a VIN mismatch fault.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 416
Air Bag Control Module: Service and Repair
WARNING:
- THE AIR BAG CONTROL MODULE CONTAINS THE IMPACT SENSOR, WHICH ENABLES
THE SYSTEM TO DEPLOY THE AIRBAG. BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE
ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU MUST FIRST DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE
BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE. THEN WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM
CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE FURTHER SYSTEM SERVICE. THIS IS THE ONLY
SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. FAILURE TO DO THIS COULD RESULT IN
ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
- NEVER STRIKE OR KICK THE AIR BAG CONTROL MODULE, AS IT CAN DAMAGE THE
IMPACT SENSOR OR AFFECT ITS CALIBRATION. IF AN AIRBAG CONTROL MODULE IS
ACCIDENTALLY DROPPED DURING SERVICE, THE MODULE MUST BE SCRAPPED AND
REPLACED WITH A NEW UNIT FAILURE TO OBSERVE THIS WARNING COULD RESULT IN
ACCIDENTAL, INCOMPLETE, OR IMPROPER AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND POSSIBLE
OCCUPANT INJURIES.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. If either of the airbags has not been deployed,
wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service.
2. If the vehicle is equipped with a manual transmission, remove the center console from the floor
panel transmission tunnel.
Airbag Control Module Trim Cover Remove/Install
3. If the vehicle is equipped with an automatic transmission, remove the two screws that secure the
trim cover to the Airbag Control Module (ACM)
mounting bracket on the floor panel transmission tunnel and remove the trim cover.
Airbag Control Module Remove/Install
4. Loosen the screw that secures each side of the instrument panel center support bracket to the
ACM mounting bracket. Do not remove these screws. 5. Remove the two nuts that secure the
instrument panel center support bracket to the studs on the lower instrument panel structural
support. 6. Disengage the retainer on the instrument panel wire harness to the ACM from the
mounting hole in the left side of the instrument panel center
support bracket.
7. Pull the top of the instrument panel center support bracket rearward and down from the
instrument panel studs. Fold it down over the top of the
ACM until it is laying flat on the floor panel transmission tunnel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Control Module >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 417
8. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the ACM. To disconnect the
instrument panel wire harness connector from the
ACM: a. Slide the red Connector Position Assurance (CPA) lock on the top of the connector toward
the side of the vehicle. b. Depress the connector latch tab and pull the connector straight away
from the ACM connector receptacle.
NOTE: Always remove and replace the airbag control module and its mounting bracket as a unit.
Replacement modules include a replacement mounting bracket. Do not transfer the module to
another mounting bracket.
9. Remove the four screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor panel transmission
tunnel.
10. Remove the ACM, the mounting bracket and the instrument panel center support bracket from
the floor panel transmission tunnel as a unit.
INSTALLATION 1. Carefully position the ACM, the mounting bracket and the instrument panel
center support bracket onto the floor panel transmission tunnel. When
the ACM is correctly positioned the arrow on the ACM label will be pointed forward in the vehicle.
2. Install and tighten the four screws that secure the ACM mounting bracket to the floor panel
transmission tunnel. Tighten the screws to 14 Nm (125
in lbs).
3. With the instrument panel center support bracket still folded down flat on the floor panel
transmission tunnel, reconnect the instrument panel wire
harness connector to the ACM connector receptacle. Be certain that the connector latch and the
red CPA lock are fully engaged.
4. Fold the top of the instrument panel center support bracket up and forward over the studs on the
lower instrument panel structural support. 5. Install and tighten the nuts that secure the instrument
panel center support bracket to the studs on the lower instrument panel structural support.
Tighten the nuts to 14 Nm (125 in lbs).
6. Engage the retainer on the instrument panel wire harness with the mounting hole in the left side
of the instrument panel center support bracket. 7. Tighten the screws that secure each side of the
instrument panel center support bracket to the ACM mounting bracket. Tighten the screws 14 Nm
(125 in lbs).
8. If the vehicle is equipped with a manual transmission, install the center console onto the floor
panel transmission tunnel. 9. If the vehicle is equipped with an automatic transmission, position the
trim cover over the ACM on the floor panel transmission tunnel.
10. If the vehicle is equipped with an automatic transmission, install and tighten the two screws that
secure the trim cover to the ACM mounting
bracket on the floor panel transmission tunnel. Tighten the screws to 2.2 Nm (20 in lbs).
11. Do not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. Refer to Airbag System in the
Diagnosis and Testing for the proper procedures.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications
Seat Belt Control Module: Specifications
Tighten the two screws that secure the SCTM to the mounting bracket to 2.2 Nm (20 in lbs).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 421
Seat Belt Control Module: Locations
Seatbelt Timer Control Module Remove/Install
The Seatbelt Control Timer Module (SCTM) is secured to a bracket underneath the front edge of
the front seat center cushion.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Seat Belt Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 424
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 425
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 426
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 427
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 428
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 429
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 430
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 431
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 432
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 433
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 434
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 435
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 436
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 437
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 438
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 439
Seat Belt Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 440
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 441
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 442
Seat Belt Control Module: Connector Views
Seatbelt Control Timer Module
Seatbelt Control Timer Module - 13 Way
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 443
Seat Belt Control Module: Description and Operation
SEAT BELT CONTROL TIMER MODULE
DESCRIPTION
The Seat Belt Control Timer Module (SCTM) is secured to a bracket underneath the front edge of
the front seat center cushion. The SCTM mounting bracket also serves as the support for the
slide-out seat cup holder unit. The SCTM controls the supply of battery current to both of the front
seat belt retractor latch solenoids. The SCTM contains an electromechanical Gravity (G)-sensor
and an electronic timer circuit. The SCTM monitors the ignition switch state and both door jamb
switches through hard-wired inputs. In response to those inputs, the SCTM controls hard-wired
outputs to both seat belt retractor latch solenoids. The SCTM also sends diagnostic outputs to the
Airbag Control Module (ACM) over a hard-wired fault circuit.
For diagnosis of the CCD data bus, the ACM or the fault circuit input to the ACM from the SCTM,
the use of a DRB scan tool and the proper Diagnostic Procedures are recommended. The SCTM
cannot be repaired. If faulty or damaged, it must be replaced.
OPERATION
The SCTM provides battery current to energize the seat belt retractor latch solenoids whenever the
ignition switch is in the ON or ACCESSORY position, unless the G-sensor input indicates a vehicle
condition that requires the set belt retractor to be latched. When the seat belt retractor latch
solenoids are energized the retractor spools are unlatched, and the seat belt webbing can be
extracted from the retractor. When the solenoids are deenergized the retractor spools latch,
preventing the seat belt webbing from being extracted further from the retractor. This logic ensures
that the seat belts will latch and/or remain latched if battery power is lost during a vehicle collision.
The electromechanical G-sensor within the SCTM monitors the rate of vehicle acceleration and
de-acceleration in any horizontal direction. The G-sensor also responds to the horizontal attitude of
the vehicle, If the G-sensor monitors a gravity force of greater than about 0.7G in any horizontal
direction, or the vehicle is tilted in any direction at an angle of greater than about 45 degrees, the
SCTM will de-energize (lock) the seat belt retractor latch solenoids.
The SCTM electronic timer circuit provides the vehicle occupants with the ability to extract the seat
belt webbing from the retractor spool for a time period of about 30 minutes after the ignition switch
is turned to the Off position. The electronic timer circuit also monitors the state of the door jamb
switches, and unlatches the seat belt retractors after either door jamb switch cycles from open to
closed or from closed to open. Each time the SCTM receives and input indicating a change in the
state of a monitored switch, the 30 minute unlatch timer starts again. The timer also is used to
de-energize the retractor latch solenoids after about 30 minutes, and prevent the battery from being
drained while the vehicle is not being driven.
The hard wired SCTM output to the ACM is used to indicate whether a fault condition is present in
the structural seat belt control system. The ACM monitors the input from the SCTM and sends the
proper messages to the instrument cluster on the Chrysler Collision Detection (CCD) data bus to
turn the seat belt reminder lamp ON or OFF. If the ACM receives a fault input or does not detect
any input from the SCTM, it sets a fault code and sends messages to the instrument cluster to turn
the lamp on.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Control Module >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 444
Seat Belt Control Module: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the fasteners that secure the front
seat adjusters to the floor panel.
Seatbelt Timer Control Module Remove/Install
3. Tilt the structural seat assembly rearward far enough to reach under the forward edge of the
front seat center cushion and access the Seatbelt
Control Timer Module (SCTM).
4. Remove the two screws that secure the SCTM to the mounting bracket under the forward edge
of the front seat center cushion. 5. Lower the SCTM from the mounting bracket far enough to
access and disconnect the front seat wire harness connector from the SCTM connector
receptacle.
6. Remove the SCTM from under the front seat.
INSTALLATION
1. Tilt the structural seat assembly rearward far enough to reach under the forward edge of the
front seat center cushion and install the SCTM. 2. Reconnect the front seat wire harness connector
to the SCTM connector receptacle. 3. Position the SCTM to the mounting bracket under the
forward edge of the front seat center cushion. 4. Install and tighten the two screws that secure the
SCTM to the mounting bracket. Tighten the screws to 2.2 Nm (20 in lbs). 5. Install the fasteners
that secure the front seat adjusters to the floor panel. 6. Do not connect the battery negative cable
at this time. Refer to Seatbelt Control System Test Mode in the Diagnosis and Testing for the
proper
procedures.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Starter Relay: Locations
8w-10-2
The starter relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), in the engine compartment.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 449
Starter Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 450
Engine Starter Motor Relay
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 451
Starter Relay: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
The starter relay is an electromechanical device that switches battery current to the pull-in coil of
the starter solenoid when the ignition switch is turned to the Start position. The starter relay is
located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), in the engine compartment. See the fuse and relay
layout label affixed to the inside surface of the PDC cover for starter relay identification and
location.
The starter relay is a International Standards Organization (ISO) relay. Relays conforming to the
ISO specifications have common physical dimensions, current capacities, terminal patterns, and
terminal functions.
The starter relay cannot be repaired or adjusted and, if faulty or damaged, it must be replaced.
OPERATION
The ISO relay consists of an electromagnetic coil, a resistor or diode, and three (two fixed and one
movable) electrical contacts. The movable (common feed) relay contact is held against one of the
fixed contacts (normally closed) by spring pressure. When the electromagnetic coil is energized, it
draws the movable contact away from the normally closed fixed contact, and holds it against the
other (normally open) fixed contact.
When the electromagnetic coil is de-energized, spring pressure returns the movable contact to the
normally closed position. The resistor or diode is connected in parallel with the electromagnetic coil
in the relay, and helps to dissipate voltage spikes that are produced when the coil is de-energized.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 452
Starter Relay: Testing and Inspection
Starter Relay
The starter relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), in the engine compartment.
Refer to the fuse and relay layout label affixed to the underside of the PDC cover for starter relay
identification and location.
1. Remove the starter relay from the PDC. Refer to Starter Relay in the Replacement for the
procedures. 2. A relay in the de-energized position should have continuity between terminals 87A
and 30, and no continuity between terminals 87 and 30. If OK,
go to Step 3. If not OK, replace the faulty relay
3. Resistance between terminals 85 and 86 (electromagnet) should be 75 ± 5 ohms. If OK, go to
Step 4. If not OK, replace the faulty relay 4. Connect a battery to terminals 85 and 86. There should
now be continuity between terminals 30 and 87, and no continuity between terminals 87A
and 30. If OK, perform the Relay Circuit Test that follows. If not OK, replace the faulty relay
Relay Circuit Test 1. The relay common feed terminal cavity (30) is connected to battery voltage
and should be hot at all times. If OK, go to Step 2. If not OK, repair
the open circuit to the fuse in the PDC as required.
2. The relay normally closed terminal (87A) is connected to terminal 30 in the de-energized
position, but is not used for this application. Go to Step
3.
3. The relay normally open terminal (87) is connected to the common feed terminal (30) in the
energized position. This terminal supplies battery
voltage to the starter solenoid field coils. There should be continuity between the cavity for relay
terminal 87 and the starter solenoid terminal at all times. If OK, go to Step 4. If not OK, repair the
open circuit to the starter solenoid as required.
4. The coil battery terminal (86) is connected to the electromagnet in the relay It is energized when
the ignition switch is held in the Start position.
On vehicles with a manual transmission, the clutch pedal must be fully depressed for this test.
Check for battery voltage at the cavity for relay terminal 86 with the ignition switch in the Start
position, and no voltage when the ignition switch is released to the On position. If OK, go to Step 5.
If not OK with an automatic transmission, check for an open or short circuit to the ignition switch
and repair, if required. If the circuit to the ignition switch is OK, refer to Ignition Switch and Key
Lock Cylinder in the Diagnosis and Testing of Ignition System for testing of the ignition switch. If not
OK with a manual transmission, check the circuit between the relay and the clutch pedal position
switch for an open or a short.
5. The coil ground terminal (85) is connected to the electromagnet in the relay On vehicles with a
manual transmission, it is grounded at all times. On
vehicles with an automatic transmission, it is grounded through the park/neutral position switch only
when the gearshift selector lever is in the Park or Neutral positions. Check for continuity to ground
at the cavity for relay terminal 85. If not OK with a manual transmission, repair the circuit to ground
as required. If not OK with an automatic transmission, check for an open or short circuit to the
park/neutral position switch and repair, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Starting and Charging > Starter Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 453
Starter Relay: Service and Repair
Power Distribution Center
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the cover from the Power
Distribution Center (PDC). 3. See the fuse and relay layout label affixed to the underside of the
PDC cover for starter relay identification and location. 4. Remove the starter relay from the PDC.
INSTALLATION
1. See the fuse and relay layout label affixed to the underside of the PDC cover for the proper
starter relay location. 2. Position the starter relay in the proper receptacle in the PDC. 3. Align the
starter relay terminals with the terminal cavities in the PDC receptacle. 4. Push down firmly on the
starter relay until the terminals are fully seated in the terminal cavities in the PDC receptacle. 5.
Install the cover onto the PDC. 6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 21-04-00 > Jun > 00 > TCM - MIL ON/DTC P1763 Set
Control Module: Customer Interest TCM - MIL ON/DTC P1763 Set
NUMBER: 21-04-00
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: June 3O, 2000
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-07-99, DATED APRIL 30,
1999, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE REVISED MODEL YEARS.
SUBJECT: Erroneous MIL Illumination For P1763 - Trans. Governor Pressure Sensor Volts Too
High
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the JTEC Powertrain
Control Module (PCM) with new software (calibration change 96Cal18, 97Cal18, 98Cal12, and
99Cal14).
MODELS:
**1996** - 1999 (AB) Ram Van
**1996** - 1999 (AN) Dakota
**1996** - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
1998 - 1999 (DN) Durango
**1997** - 1999 (TJ) Wrangler
**1996** 1999 (XJ) Cherokee
**1996** - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AN RE SERIES AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION BUILT BEFORE DECEMBER 18, 1998 (MDH 1218XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some vehicles may exhibit a MIL illumination with a Diagnostic Trouble
Code (DTC) of P1763 - Transmission Governor Pressure Sensor Volts Too High. The vehicle
operator may experience slower than normal vehicle accelerations because the transmission may
have temporarily entered its third gear "Limp-In" mode as a result of the DTC. The "Limp-In" mode
may last until the vehicle owner cycles the ignition key. The technician may not detect a problem
with the automatic transmission during a diagnostic test or test drive.
The MIL is caused by an increase in hydraulic pressure. The increased hydraulic pressure is the
result of a new valve body machining process, which entered into production January 1, 1998. This
condition will occur most often with vehicles that were built between January 1, 1998 and
December 18, 1998.
Vehicles built prior to January 1,1998 may also experience this condition if the valve body or the
transmission assembly is replaced with components built after January 1, 1998.
DIAGNOSIS: Using the Mopar Diagnostic System (MDS2) and or the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRB
III(R)), with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify that all engine and transmission
systems are functioning as designed. If Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) are present, record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. If no
DTC's are present, and the above symptom has been experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
WHENEVER A POWERTRAIN (PCM) IS REPLACED DUE TO FAILURE, THE SOFTWARE OF
THE REPLACEMENT CONTROLLER MUST BE VERIFIED FOR THE LATEST REVISION
LEVEL. USE THE FLASH PROCEDURE TO UPDATE REPLACED CONTROLLERS AS
NECESSARY.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04669020 Label, Authorized Software Update
1 04275086 Label, Authorized Modification
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
1 CH6000 Scan Tool (DRB III(R))
1 CH7035 General Purpose Interface Bus Cable (GPIB)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 21-04-00 > Jun > 00 > TCM - MIL ON/DTC P1763 Set > Page 464
1 CH7000/7001 J1962 Cable
1 MDS2
NOTE:
THE MDS2 AND DRB III(R) ARE REQUIRED TO PERFORM PART OF THIS REPAIR. WHEN
USING THE MDS2 AND THE DRB III(R), THE SYSTEM MUST BE OPERATING AT CIS CD 2061
OR HIGHER.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Log onto the MDS2 system.
2. Connect the MDS2 and DRB III(R) to the vehicle and switch the ignition key to "ON".
3. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 CONNECT TO MDS2 on the DRB III(R) MAIN MENU
SCREEN.
4. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 RUN MDS2 APPLICATION on the DRB III(R) MAIN MENU
SCREEN.
NOTE:
ONCE MDS2, DRB III(R), AND VEHICLE COMMUNICATION HAS BEEN ESTABLISHED, THE
"CANNOT READ VIN FROM DRB III(R)" MESSAGE (ON THE MDS2) WILL BE REPLACED BY
THE VEHICLE VIN. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON ON THE MDS2 TO REQUEST A MDS2
SESSION FOR THE VEHICLE VIN INDICATED. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON WHEN ASKED TO
BEGIN SESSION.
5. Select the FLASH tab on the MDS2.
6. Select READ PART NUMBERS FROM VEHICLE and click SHOW UPDATES on the MDS2.
Press the "OK" button.
NOTE:
IN ABOVE STEPS # 5 AND/OR # 6, A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO
UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT
IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST SOFTWARE LEVEL AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN.
IF THE LATEST SOFTWARE IS INSTALLED, AND NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, ANOTHER
VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS THAT WILL REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
7. Select the new software part number with the light pen and click UPDATE CONTROLLER
SOFTWARE.
8. The MDS2 and DRB III(R) will prompt for any operator action needed during the remainder of
the reprogramming process.
NOTE:
DUE TO THE PCM REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE, A DTC MAY BE SET IN OTHER
MODULES (EATX, BCM, MIC, SKIM) WITHIN THE VEHICLE, IF SO EQUIPPED. SOME DTC'S
MAY CAUSE THE MIL TO ILLUMINATE. ALL DTC'S RELATE TO A LOSS OF
COMMUNICATIONS WITH THE MODULE THAT IS BEING REPROGRAMMED. CHECK ALL
MODULES, RECORD THE FAULTS, AND ERASE THESE FAULTS PRIOR TO RETURNING THE
VEHICLE TO THE CUSTOMER. ERASE ANY FAULTS IN THE PCM ONLY AFTER ALL OTHER
MODULES HAVE HAD THEIR FAULTS ERASED.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020
(Figure 1). Attach the label to the JTEC PCM and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for
Control Module: > 21-04-00 > Jun > 00 > TCM - MIL ON/DTC P1763 Set > Page 465
10. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086 and
attach the label near the VECI label (Figure 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-19-42-99 0.5 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: FM - Flash Module
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-04-00 > Jun > 00 > TCM - MIL ON/DTC P1763 Set
Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins TCM - MIL ON/DTC P1763 Set
NUMBER: 21-04-00
GROUP: Transmission
DATE: June 3O, 2000
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 18-07-99, DATED APRIL 30,
1999, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ALL REVISIONS ARE
HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE REVISED MODEL YEARS.
SUBJECT: Erroneous MIL Illumination For P1763 - Trans. Governor Pressure Sensor Volts Too
High
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the JTEC Powertrain
Control Module (PCM) with new software (calibration change 96Cal18, 97Cal18, 98Cal12, and
99Cal14).
MODELS:
**1996** - 1999 (AB) Ram Van
**1996** - 1999 (AN) Dakota
**1996** - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
1998 - 1999 (DN) Durango
**1997** - 1999 (TJ) Wrangler
**1996** 1999 (XJ) Cherokee
**1996** - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AN RE SERIES AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION BUILT BEFORE DECEMBER 18, 1998 (MDH 1218XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: Some vehicles may exhibit a MIL illumination with a Diagnostic Trouble
Code (DTC) of P1763 - Transmission Governor Pressure Sensor Volts Too High. The vehicle
operator may experience slower than normal vehicle accelerations because the transmission may
have temporarily entered its third gear "Limp-In" mode as a result of the DTC. The "Limp-In" mode
may last until the vehicle owner cycles the ignition key. The technician may not detect a problem
with the automatic transmission during a diagnostic test or test drive.
The MIL is caused by an increase in hydraulic pressure. The increased hydraulic pressure is the
result of a new valve body machining process, which entered into production January 1, 1998. This
condition will occur most often with vehicles that were built between January 1, 1998 and
December 18, 1998.
Vehicles built prior to January 1,1998 may also experience this condition if the valve body or the
transmission assembly is replaced with components built after January 1, 1998.
DIAGNOSIS: Using the Mopar Diagnostic System (MDS2) and or the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRB
III(R)), with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify that all engine and transmission
systems are functioning as designed. If Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) are present, record
them on the repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin. If no
DTC's are present, and the above symptom has been experienced, perform the Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
WHENEVER A POWERTRAIN (PCM) IS REPLACED DUE TO FAILURE, THE SOFTWARE OF
THE REPLACEMENT CONTROLLER MUST BE VERIFIED FOR THE LATEST REVISION
LEVEL. USE THE FLASH PROCEDURE TO UPDATE REPLACED CONTROLLERS AS
NECESSARY.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04669020 Label, Authorized Software Update
1 04275086 Label, Authorized Modification
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
1 CH6000 Scan Tool (DRB III(R))
1 CH7035 General Purpose Interface Bus Cable (GPIB)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-04-00 > Jun > 00 > TCM - MIL ON/DTC P1763 Set > Page 471
1 CH7000/7001 J1962 Cable
1 MDS2
NOTE:
THE MDS2 AND DRB III(R) ARE REQUIRED TO PERFORM PART OF THIS REPAIR. WHEN
USING THE MDS2 AND THE DRB III(R), THE SYSTEM MUST BE OPERATING AT CIS CD 2061
OR HIGHER.
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Log onto the MDS2 system.
2. Connect the MDS2 and DRB III(R) to the vehicle and switch the ignition key to "ON".
3. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 CONNECT TO MDS2 on the DRB III(R) MAIN MENU
SCREEN.
4. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 RUN MDS2 APPLICATION on the DRB III(R) MAIN MENU
SCREEN.
NOTE:
ONCE MDS2, DRB III(R), AND VEHICLE COMMUNICATION HAS BEEN ESTABLISHED, THE
"CANNOT READ VIN FROM DRB III(R)" MESSAGE (ON THE MDS2) WILL BE REPLACED BY
THE VEHICLE VIN. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON ON THE MDS2 TO REQUEST A MDS2
SESSION FOR THE VEHICLE VIN INDICATED. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON WHEN ASKED TO
BEGIN SESSION.
5. Select the FLASH tab on the MDS2.
6. Select READ PART NUMBERS FROM VEHICLE and click SHOW UPDATES on the MDS2.
Press the "OK" button.
NOTE:
IN ABOVE STEPS # 5 AND/OR # 6, A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO
UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT
IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST SOFTWARE LEVEL AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN.
IF THE LATEST SOFTWARE IS INSTALLED, AND NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, ANOTHER
VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS THAT WILL REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
7. Select the new software part number with the light pen and click UPDATE CONTROLLER
SOFTWARE.
8. The MDS2 and DRB III(R) will prompt for any operator action needed during the remainder of
the reprogramming process.
NOTE:
DUE TO THE PCM REPROGRAMMING PROCEDURE, A DTC MAY BE SET IN OTHER
MODULES (EATX, BCM, MIC, SKIM) WITHIN THE VEHICLE, IF SO EQUIPPED. SOME DTC'S
MAY CAUSE THE MIL TO ILLUMINATE. ALL DTC'S RELATE TO A LOSS OF
COMMUNICATIONS WITH THE MODULE THAT IS BEING REPROGRAMMED. CHECK ALL
MODULES, RECORD THE FAULTS, AND ERASE THESE FAULTS PRIOR TO RETURNING THE
VEHICLE TO THE CUSTOMER. ERASE ANY FAULTS IN THE PCM ONLY AFTER ALL OTHER
MODULES HAVE HAD THEIR FAULTS ERASED.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020
(Figure 1). Attach the label to the JTEC PCM and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service
Bulletins for Control Module: > 21-04-00 > Jun > 00 > TCM - MIL ON/DTC P1763 Set > Page 472
10. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086 and
attach the label near the VECI label (Figure 2).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-19-42-99 0.5 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: FM - Flash Module
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Control Module, A/T > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 473
Control Module: Description and Operation
This vehicle does not have a Transmission Control Module. Transmission control is accomplished
through the Engine Control Module or Powertrain Control Module.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Locations
8w-10-2
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 477
Transmission Control System Relay: Diagrams
Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Transmission and Drivetrain > Relays and
Modules - A/T > Transmission Control System Relay, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 478
Transmission Control Relay
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Windshield Washer Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 484
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 485
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 486
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 487
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 488
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 489
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 490
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 491
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 492
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 493
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 494
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 495
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 496
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 497
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 498
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 499
Windshield Washer Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 500
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Control Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 501
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Wiper Module - CTM Mandatory PROM Update
Technical Service Bulletin # 08-43-99 Date: 991217
Wiper Module - CTM Mandatory PROM Update
NUMBER: 08-43-99
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Dec. 17, 1999
SUBJECT: Central Timer Module Software Update When A Wiper Module Is Replaced
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Central Timer
Module (CTM) with new software (EEPROM changes).
MODELS: 1998 - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Trucks
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH REMOTE KEYLESS ENTRY.
DISCUSSION: Due to a design change in MOPAR replacement wiper modules, the CTM must be
updated with new software in order to allow the wiper module to function properly. This following
Repair Procedure must be performed any time the wiper module is replaced.
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
1 CH6OOO Scan Tool (DRB III)
1 CH7035 General Purpose Interface Bus Cable (GPIB)
1 CH7OOO/7001 J1962 Cable
1 CH7025 DIN Power Cable
1 MDS2
NOTE:
THE MDS2 AND DRB III ARE REQUIRED TO PERFORM PART OF THIS REPAIR. THE MDS2
SYSTEM MUST BE OPERATING AT CIS CD2046 OR HIGHER. THE DRB III MUST BE
OPERATING AT VERSION LEVEL 30.9 OR HIGHER.
POLICY: Reimbursabie within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-19-22-90 0.2 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: FM - Flash Module
CTM Flash With Vehicle Connected to DRBIII and MDS2
1. Log onto the MDS2 system.
2. Connect the MDS2 (Mopar Diagnostic System) to the DRB III (Scan Tool) with the GPIB cable.
Connect the DRB III to the vehicle with the J1962 cable and switch the ignition key to "ON".
3. Use the arrow keys and select option # 2, "CONNECT TO MDS1 OR MDS2," on the DRB III
MAIN MENU SCREEN.
4. Use the arrow keys and select option # 2, "RUN MDS2 APPLICATION," on the DRB III.
NOTE:
ONCE MDS2, DRB III, AND VEHICLE COMMUNICATION HAS BEEN ESTABLISHED, THE
"CANNOT READ VIN FROM DRB III" MESSAGE (ON THE MDS2) WILL BE REPLACED BY THE
VEHICLE VIN. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON ON THE MDS2 TO REQUEST A MDS2 SESSION
FOR THE VEHICLE VIN INDICATED. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON WHEN ASKED TO BEGIN
SESSION.
5. Push the FLASH tab on the MDS2.
NOTE:
A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS
OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST
SOFTWARE LEVELS AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Wiper Module - CTM Mandatory PROM Update > Page
506
6. Select "READ PART NUMBERS FROM VEHICLE" and click "SHOW UPDATES" on the MDS2.
NOTE:
A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS
OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST
SOFTWARE LEVELS AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN.
7. Select the new CTM software part number with the light pen and click UPDATE CONTROLLER
SOFTWARE.
8. The MDS2 and DRB III will download software files to the DRB Ill® and program CTM in
approximately 30 seconds.
9. When MDS2 status box reads "Check DRB Screen For Important Instructions," proceed with the
instructions identified on the DRB III screen.
CTM Flash With DRBIII In Disconnected Mode
1. Log onto the MDS2 system.
2. A MDS2 session can be started by either entering the VIN or by selecting the appropriate Year,
Model, and Engine.
CAUTION:
MDS2 SYSTEM SOFTWARE OPERATING AT CIS CD2046 WILL NOT DISPLAY ANY
AVAILABLE CTM FLASHES WHEN A SESSION IS STARTED BY SELECTING YEAR, MODEL,
AND ENGINE FOR 1998 5.9L CUMMINS 16 (12 VALVE ENGINE). SELECT THE 1998 5.9L 24
VALVE CUMMINS ENGINE IF IT BECOMES NECESSARY TO FLASH A CTM ON A 1998 5.9L
CUMMINS 16 (12 VALVE ENGINE). ALL SUBSEQUENT (CIS CD2047 OR HIGHER) MDS2
RELEASES WILL FUNCTION PROPERLY.
3. Connect the DRB III to the MDS2 (Mopar Diagnostic System) with the GPIB cable and the DIN
cable.
4. Use the arrow keys and select option # 2, "CONNECT TO MDS1 OR MDS2," on the DRB III
MAIN MENU SCREEN
5. Use the arrow keys and select option # 2, "RUN MDS2 APPLICATION," on the DRB III.
6. Once the vehicle information has been entered, push the FLASH tab on the MDS2.
NOTE:
A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS
OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST
SOFTWARE LEVELS AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN.
7. Using the light pen, scroll to the bottom of the list of available flashes and select all available
CTM software part numbers, then click DOWNLOAD SOFTWARE TO DRB III. It will take less than
one minute to download the software into the DRB III.
NOTE:
PART NUMBERS LISTED ARE SOFTWARE PART NUMBERS ONLY AND MAY NOT MATCH
THE ACTUAL CTM PART NUMBER IDENTIFIED ON THE CTM. IN ADDITION, THE SOFTWARE
PART NUMBER WILL NOT MATCH THE SOFTWARE VERSION NUMBER THAT WILL BE
IDENTIFIED WHEN USING DRB III "STAND ALONE" MODE TO COMMUNICATE TO THE CTM.
8. Once the software has been downloaded, a dialog box will appear identifying that the download
was successful. Select OK.
9. Disconnect the DRB III from the MDS2 and connect the DRB III to the vehicle.
10. Connect the DRB III to the vehicle and switch the ignition key to the RUN position.
11. Use the arrow keys and select option # 2, "CONNECT TO MDS1 OR MDS2," on the DRB III
MAIN MENU SCREEN.
12. Use the arrow keys and select option # 2, "RUN MDS2 APPLICATION," on the DRB III.
13. Wait for the "MDS2 diagnostic mode" menu to appear on the DRB III.
14. Use the arrow keys and select option # 2, "PROGRAM VEHICLE CONTROLLERS," from the
DRB III menu screen.
15. If the vehicle is equipped with a CTM, the CTM software part number will be displayed on the
DRB III. Select the CTM flash software part number.
16. Use the Page FWD key on the DRB III to download the software into the CTM. A status screen
will display "UPDATE IN PROGRESS" as the software is downloaded into the CTM.
17. To have the DRB III properly verify the CTM software part number, turn the ignition key to OFF
when prompted by DRB III.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Wiper Module - CTM Mandatory PROM Update > Page
507
18. Turn the ignition key to back to RUN when the prompted by DRB III. The DRB III will then
confirm that the download was successful by displaying the message CTM REPROGRAMMING
WAS SUCCESSFUL.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Central Timer Module (Base)
Central Time Module (Base) Remove/Install
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Locations > Central Timer Module (Base) > Page 510
Central Time Module (High-Line) Remove/Install
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Wiper Control Module: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 513
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 514
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 515
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 516
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 517
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 518
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 519
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 520
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 521
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 522
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 523
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 524
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 525
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 526
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 527
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 528
Wiper Control Module: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 529
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Control
Module > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 530
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Locations
Wiper Relay: Locations
8w-10-2
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Locations > Page 534
Power Distribution Center
The intermittent wipe relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) in the engine
compartment.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Wiper Relay: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 537
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 538
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 539
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 540
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 541
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 542
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 543
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 544
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 545
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 546
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 547
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 548
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 549
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 550
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 551
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 552
Wiper Relay: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 553
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 554
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 555
Wiper Relay: Connector Views
Power Distribution Center (PDC)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 556
Wiper Motor Relay
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 557
Wiper Relay: Service Precautions
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO RESTRAINT SYSTEMS /
AIRBAG SYSTEMS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY
.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 558
Wiper Relay: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The intermittent wipe relay is a International Standards Organization (ISO) micro-relay. The
terminal designations and functions are the same as a conventional ISO relay. However, the
micro-relay terminal orientation (or footprint) is different, current capacity is lower, and the relay
case dimensions are smaller than those of the conventional ISO relay.
The intermittent wipe relay is a electromechanical device that switches battery current to the
windshield wiper motor or wiper motor park switch when the relay coil is grounded by the Central
Timer Module (CTM) in response to inputs from the windshield wiper (multi-function) switch. See
Intermittent Wipe Relay in the Diagnosis and Testing for more information.
The intermittent wipe relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC), in the engine
compartment. Refer to the PDC label for relay identification and location.
The intermittent wipe relay cannot be repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 559
Wiper Relay: Testing and Inspection
Intermittent Wipe Relay
For additional testing and inspection information please refer to Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/ See: Relays and Modules - Powertrain
Management/Relays and Modules - Computers and Control Systems/Central Timer Module
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
Relay Test
The intermittent wipe relay is located in the Power Distribution Center (PDC) in the engine
compartment. Refer to the PDC label for intermittent wipe relay identification and location.
Remove the intermittent wipe relay from the PDC as described in the Replacement to perform the
following tests: 1. A relay in the de-energized position should have continuity between terminals
87A and 30, and no continuity between terminals 87 and 30. If OK,
go to Step 2.If not OK, replace the faulty relay.
2. Resistance between terminals 85 and 86 (electromagnet) should be 75 ± 5 ohms. If OK, go to
Step 3. If not OK, replace the faulty relay. 3. Connect a battery to terminals 85 and 86. There
should now be continuity between terminals 30 and 87, and no continuity between terminals 87A
and 30. If OK, see Relay Circuit Test in the Diagnosis and Testing. If not OK, a replace the faulty
relay.
Relay Circuit Test
1. The relay common feed terminal cavity (30) is connected to the wiper (multi-function) switch.
There should be continuity between the cavity for
relay terminal 30 and the two fused ignition switch output circuit cavities of the multi-function switch
wire harness connector at all times. If OK, go to Step 2. If not OK, repair the open circuit(s) to the
multifunction switch as required.
2. The relay normally closed terminal (87A) is connected to terminal 30 in the de-energized
position. There should be continuity between the cavity
for relay terminal 87A and the wiper park switch sense circuit cavities of the wiper motor wire
harness connector and the 14-way Central Timer Module (CTM) wire harness connector at all
times. If OK, go to Step 3. If not OK, repair the open circuit(s) to the wiper motor and CTM as
required.
3. The relay normally open terminal (87) is connected to the common feed terminal (30) in the
energized position. There should be battery voltage at
the cavity for relay terminal 87 with the ignition switch in the On or Accessory positions. If OK, go to
Step 4. If not OK, repair the open circuit to the ignition switch as required.
4. The coil battery terminal (86) is connected to the electromagnet in the relay. There should be
battery voltage at the cavity for relay terminal 86
with the ignition switch in the On or Accessory positions. If OK, go to Step 5. If not OK, repair the
open circuit to the ignition switch as required.
5. The coil ground terminal (85) is connected to the electromagnet in the relay. It is grounded by
the CTM to energize the relay and cycle the wiper
motor. Check for continuity between the cavity for relay terminal 85 and the intermittent wiper relay
control circuit cavity of the 14-way CTM wire harness connector There should be continuity. If OK,
replace the faulty base version CTM; or, use a DRB scan tool and the proper Diagnostic
Procedures for diagnosis of the high-line version CTM. If not OK, repair the open circuit to the CTM
as required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Relays and Modules > Relays and Modules - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Relay >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 560
Wiper Relay: Service and Repair
Power Distribution Center
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the cover from the Power
Distribution Center (PDC). 3. Refer to the label on the PDC cover for intermittent wipe relay
identification and location. 4. Unplug the intermittent wipe relay from the PDC. 5. Install the
intermittent wipe relay by aligning the relay terminals with the cavities in the PDC and pushing the
relay firmly into place. 6. Install the PDC cover. 7. Connect the battery negative cable. 8. Test the
relay operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Arm/Disarm Switch, Antitheft > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Arm/Disarm Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Arm/Disarm Switch, Antitheft > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 567
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Arm/Disarm Switch, Antitheft > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 568
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Arm/Disarm Switch, Antitheft > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 569
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Arm/Disarm Switch, Antitheft > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 570
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Arm/Disarm Switch, Antitheft > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 571
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Arm/Disarm Switch, Antitheft > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 572
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Arm/Disarm Switch, Antitheft > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 573
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Arm/Disarm Switch, Antitheft > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 574
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Arm/Disarm Switch, Antitheft > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 575
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Arm/Disarm Switch, Antitheft > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 576
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Arm/Disarm Switch, Antitheft > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 577
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Arm/Disarm Switch, Antitheft > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 578
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Arm/Disarm Switch, Antitheft > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 579
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Arm/Disarm Switch, Antitheft > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 580
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Arm/Disarm Switch, Antitheft > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 581
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Arm/Disarm Switch, Antitheft > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 582
Arm/Disarm Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Arm/Disarm Switch, Antitheft > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 583
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Arm/Disarm Switch, Antitheft > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 584
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Arm/Disarm Switch, Antitheft > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 585
Arm/Disarm Switch: Connector Views
Driver Door Arm/Disarm Switch - Black 2 Way
Passenger Door Arm/Disarm Switch - Black 2 Way
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Locations
Door Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Locations
Door Jamb Switch Remove/Install
The door jamb switches are mounted to the door hinge pillars.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Door Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 591
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 592
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 593
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 594
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 595
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 596
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 597
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 598
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 599
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 600
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 601
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 602
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 603
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 604
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 605
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 606
Door Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 607
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 608
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 609
Door Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The door jamb switches are mounted to the door hinge pillars. The switches close a path to ground
for the Central Timer Module (CTM) when a door is opened, and open the ground path when a
door is closed.
The door jamb switches cannot be repaired and, if faulty or damaged, they must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Door
Sensor/Switch (For Alarm) > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 610
Door Sensor/Switch (For Alarm): Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Grasp the body of the door jamb switch
with a pair of pliers and move the switch gently back-and-forth while pulling it out of the door hinge
pillar
mounting hole.
Door Jamb Switch Remove/Install
3. Pull the door jamb switch out from the pillar far enough to access the wire harness connector. 4.
Unplug the door jamb switch from the wire harness connector. 5. Reverse the removal procedures
to install.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Lock
Cylinder Switch > Component Information > Locations
Lock Cylinder Switch: Locations
Door Lock Cylinder Switch Remove/Install - Typical
The door lock cylinder switches are mounted to the back of the key lock cylinder inside each door.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Lock
Cylinder Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 614
Lock Cylinder Switch: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The door lock cylinder switches are mounted to the back of the key lock cylinder inside each door.
They are normally-open momentary switches that close to ground only when the lock cylinder is
rotated to the unlock position.
The door lock cylinder switches cannot be repaired and, if faulty or damaged, they must be
replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment > Lock
Cylinder Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 615
Lock Cylinder Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the door outside latch handle
mounting hardware and linkage from the inside of the door.
Door Lock Cylinder Switch Remove/Install - Typical
3. From the outside of the door, pull the door outside latch handle out far enough to access the
door lock cylinder switch. 4. Disengage the door lock cylinder switch from the back of the lock
cylinder. 5. Unplug the door lock cylinder switch wire harness connector. 6. Disengage the
retainers that secure the door lock cylinder switch wire harness to the inner door panel. 7. Remove
the door lock cylinder switch from the door. 8. Reverse the removal procedures to install.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations
Remote Radio Switches Remove/Install
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations > Page 619
Remote Switch: Diagrams
Left Remote Radio Switch
Right Remote Radio Switch - 2 Way
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations > Page 620
Remote Switch: Service Precautions
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY
.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations > Page 621
Remote Switch: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
A remote radio switch option is available on models equipped with the AM/FM/CD/cassette/3-band
graphic equalizer (RAZ sales code) radio receiver and the high-line Central Timer Module (CTM).
Refer to Central Timer Module in the Description and Operation of Instrument Panel Systems for
more information on this component.
Remote Radio Switches
Two rocker-type switches are mounted in the sides of the rear (instrument panel side) steering
wheel trim cover. The switch on the left side is the seek switch and has seek up, seek down, and
preset station advance functions. The switch on the right side is the volume control switch and has
volume up, and volume down functions. The two switches are retained in mounting holes located
on each side of the rear steering wheel trim cover by four latches that are integral to the switches.
The remote radio switches share a common steering wheel wire harness with the vehicle speed
control switches. The steering wheel wire harness is connected to the instrument panel wire
harness through the clockspring. Refer to Clockspring in the Description and Operation of Passive
Restraint Systems for more information on this component.
OPERATION
The remote radio switches are resistor multiplexed units that are hard wired to the high-line CTM
through the clockspring. The CTM monitors the status of the remote radio switches and sends the
proper switch status messages on the Chrysler Collision Detection (CCD) data bus network to the
radio receiver. The electronic circuitry within the radio is programmed to respond to these remote
radio switch status messages by adjusting the radio settings as requested.
For diagnosis of the CTM or the CCD data bus, the use of a DRB scan tool and the proper
Diagnostic Procedures are recommended. For more information on the features and control
functions for each of the remote radio switches, see the owner's manual in the vehicle glove box.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations > Page 622
Remote Switch: Testing and Inspection
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
Remote Radio Switches
1. Remove the remote radio switch(es) from the steering wheel.
Remote Radio Switch Test Table
2. Use an ohmmeter to check the switch resistances as shown in the Remote Radio Switch Test
chart. If the remote radio switch resistances check
OK, go to Step 3. If not OK, replace the faulty switch.
3. Check for continuity between the ground circuit cavity of the remote radio switch wire harness
connector and a good ground. There should be
continuity If OK, go to Step 4. If not OK, repair the open ground circuit to ground as required.
4. Disconnect the 18-way wire harness connector from the Central Timer Module (CTM). Check for
continuity between the radio control mux circuit
cavity of the remote radio switch wire harness connector and a good ground. There should be no
continuity If OK, go to Step 5. If not OK, repair the shorted radio control mux circuit as required.
5. Check for continuity between the radio control mux circuit cavities of the remote radio switch wire
harness connector and the 18-way CTM wire
harness connector. There should be continuity. If OK, refer to the proper Diagnostic Procedures to
test the CTM and the Chrysler Collision Detection (CCD) data bus. If not OK, repair the open radio
control mux circuit as required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Accessories and Optional Equipment >
Remote Switch, Audio - Stereo > Component Information > Locations > Page 623
Remote Switch: Service and Repair
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
REMOVAL 1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the driver side airbag
module from the steering wheel. Refer to Driver Side Airbag Module in the Replacement of Passive
Restraint
Systems for the procedures.
3. Remove the speed control switch located on the same side of the steering wheel as the remote
radio switch that is being serviced. Refer to Speed
Control Switches in the Replacement of Speed Control System for the procedures.
Remote Radio Switches Remove/Install
4. Disconnect the steering wheel wire harness connector from the connector receptacle of the
remote radio switch. 5. Disengage the four remote radio switch latches that secure the switch to the
inside of the mounting hole in the steering wheel rear trim cover. 6. From the outside of the steering
wheel rear trim cover, remove the remote radio switch from the trim cover mounting hole.
INSTALLATION 1. Position the remote radio switch to the mounting hole on the outside of the
steering wheel rear trim cover. Be certain that the connector receptacle
is oriented toward the bottom of the switch and pointed toward the center of the steering wheel.
2. Press firmly and evenly on the remote radio switch until each of the switch latches is fully
engaged in the mounting hole of the steering wheel rear
trim cover.
3. Reconnect the steering wheel wire harness connector to the connector receptacle of the remote
radio switch. 4. Install the speed control switch onto the steering wheel. Refer to Speed Control
Switches in the Replacement of Speed Control System for the
procedures.
5. Install the driver side airbag module onto the steering wheel. Refer to Driver Side Airbag Module
in the Replacement of Passive Restraint Systems
for the procedures.
6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 629
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 630
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 631
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 632
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 633
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 634
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 635
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 636
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 637
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 638
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 639
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 640
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 641
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 642
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 643
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 644
Power Door Lock Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 645
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 646
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 647
Power Door Lock Switch: Connector Views
Driver Door Window/Lock Switch - 16 Way
Passenger Door Window/Lock Switch
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 648
Power Door Lock Switch: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The power locks can be controlled by a two-way switch integral to the power window and lock
switch and bezel unit on the trim panel of each front door. A Light-Emitting Diode (LED) in the
paddle of each switch is illuminated whenever the ignition switch is in the On position.
On models with a base version of the Central Timer Module (CTM), the power lock switches are
hard-wired to the power lock motors. On models with a high-line version of the CTM, the power
lock switch controls the battery feeds to the lock and unlock sense inputs of the high-line CTM. The
CTM then relays the correct battery and ground feeds to the power lock motors.
The power window and lock switch and bezel unit cannot be repaired and, if faulty or damaged, the
entire switch and bezel unit must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 649
Power Door Lock Switch: Testing and Inspection
For additional testing and inspection information please refer to Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/ See: Body and Frame/Body Control
Systems/Central Timer Module
The Light-Emitting Diode (LED) illumination lamps for all of the power window and lock switch and
bezel unit switch paddles receive battery current through the power window circuit breaker in the
junction block. If all of the LEDs are inoperative in either or both power window and lock switch and
bezel units, refer to Power Window Systems for diagnosis. If only one LED in a power window and
lock switch and bezel unit is inoperative, replace the faulty switch and bezel unit.
1. Check the fuse in the junction block. If OK, go to Step 2. If not OK, repair the shorted circuit or
component as required and replace the faulty fuse. 2. Check for battery voltage at the fuse in the
junction block. If OK, go to Step 3. If not OK, repair the open circuit to the Power Distribution
Center
(PDC) as required.
3. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Remove the power window and lock switch
and bezel unit from the door trim panel. Unplug the
wire harness connector from the switch and bezel unit.
4. Connect the battery negative cable. Check for battery voltage at the fused B(+) circuit cavity of
the body half of the power window and lock switch
and bezel unit wire harness connector. If OK, go to Step 5. If not OK, repair the open circuit to the
junction block as required.
Power Lock Switch Continuity - Driver Side
Power Lock Switch Continuity - Passenger Side
5. Test the power lock switch continuity See the Power Lock Switch Continuity charts to determine
if the continuity is correct in the Neutral, Lock
and Unlock switch positions. If OK, repair the door lock switch output (lock and/or unlock) circuit(s)
from the body half of the power window and
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 650
lock switch and bezel unit wire harness connector to the power lock motors or the high-line version
of the Central Timer Module (CTM) as required. If not OK, replace the faulty switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Door Lock Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 651
Power Door Lock Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
Power Window And Lock Switch And Bezel Unit Remove/Install
2. Using a wide flat-bladed tool such as a trim stick, gently pry the upper edge of the switch bezel
to release the retainer that secures the switch bezel
to the door trim panel opening.
3. Pull the switch and bezel unit away from the door trim panel opening far enough to access and
unplug the wire harness connector. 4. Remove the power window and lock switch and bezel unit
from the door trim panel. 5. Reverse the removal procedures to install. When installing the switch
and bezel unit to the door trim panel opening, insert the rear of the bezel into
the opening, then push down on the front of the bezel until the retaining tab snaps into place.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations
Power Mirror Switch: Locations
Power Mirror Switch Remove/Install - Typical
Both the right and left power outside mirrors are controlled by a single multi-function switch unit
located on and mounted to the upper flag area of the driver side door trim panel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 655
Power Mirror Switch: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Both the right and left power outside mirrors are controlled by a single multi-function switch unit
located on and mounted to the upper flag area of the driver side door trim panel. The switch knob is
rotated clockwise (right mirror control), or counterclockwise (left mirror control) to select the mirror
to be adjusted. The switch knob is then moved in a joystick fashion to control movement of the
selected mirror up, down, right, or left.
The power mirror switch cannot be repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must be replaced. The
power mirror switch knob is available for service replacement.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Mirror Switch >
Component Information > Locations > Page 656
Power Mirror Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
Power Mirror Switch Remove/Install - Typical
2. Pull the control knob rearward to remove it from the power mirror switch stem. 3. Remove the
nut that secures the power mirror switch to the driver side front door trim panel. 4. Remove the trim
panel from the inside of the driver side front door. 5. Pull the trim panel away from the inner door
far enough to access the power mirror switch wire harness connector. 6. Unplug the power mirror
switch wire harness connector. 7. Remove the power mirror switch from the back of the door trim
panel. 8. Reverse the removal procedures to install.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Specifications
Power Seat Switch: Specifications
Tighten the switch mounting screws to 2.2 Nm (20 in lbs).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 660
Power Seat Switch: Locations
Power Seat Switch Remove/Install - Typical
The Power Seat switch is located on the lower outboard side of the driver side seat cushion on the
seat cushion side shield on all models.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 661
Power Seat Switch: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The power seat in standard cab models can be adjusted in six different ways using the power seat
switch. The power seat switch for extended cab models (club cab and quad cab) has an additional
switch knob for adjusting the power lumbar support. The switch is located on the lower outboard
side of the driver side seat cushion on the seat cushion side shield on all models. Refer to the
owner's manual in the vehicle glove box for more information on the power seat switch functions
and the seat adjusting procedures.
The individual switches in the power seat switch module cannot be repaired. If one switch is
damaged or faulty, the entire power seat switch module must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 662
Power Seat Switch: Testing and Inspection
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the power seat switch from the
power seat.
Power Seat Switch Continuity
3. Use an ohmmeter to test the continuity of the power seat switches in each position. See the
Power Seat Switch Continuity chart. If OK, see Power
Seat Adjuster and Motors or Power Lumbar Adjuster and Motor in the Diagnosis and Testing. If not
OK, replace the faulty power seat switch module.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 663
Power Seat Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Standard Cab 1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
Seat Switch and Bezel Remove/Install
2. Remove the two screws that secure the power seat switch and bezel unit to the seat cushion
frame.
Power Seat Switch Connector Remove
3. Pull the switch and bezel unit out from the seat far enough to access the switch wire harness
connector. Gently pry the locking tabs of the switch
away from the wire harness connector and carefully unplug the connector from the power seat
switch module.
4. Remove the two screws that secure the power seat switch module to the bezel and remove the
bezel. 5. Reverse the removal procedures to install. Tighten the switch mounting screws to 2.2 Nm
(20 in lbs).
Extended Cab 1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the screw that
secures the recliner lever to the recliner mechanism release shaft on the outboard side of the driver
side front seat. 3. Pull the recliner lever off of the recliner mechanism release shaft. 4. Remove the
three screws that secure the driver side seat cushion side shield to the outboard seat cushion
frame. 5. Pull the driver side seat cushion side shield away from the seat cushion frame far enough
to access the power seat switch module wire harness
connector.
6. Gently pry the locking tabs of the switch away from the wire harness connector and carefully
unplug the connector from the power seat switch
module.
7. Remove the seat cushion side shield and power seat switch module from the seat as a unit.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Body and Frame > Power Seat Switch >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 664
Power Seat Switch Remove/Install - Typical
8. Remove the two screws that secure the power seat switch to the inside of the seat cushion side
shield. 9. Remove the power seat switch from the seat cushion side shield.
10. Reverse the removal procedures to install. Tighten the switch mounting screws to 2.2 Nm (20 in
lbs).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > With Quad Cab
Connector Pin Identification
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > With Quad Cab > Page 670
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Brake Fluid
Pressure Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 671
Brake Fluid Pressure Sensor/Switch: Testing and Inspection
PRESSURE DIFFERENTIAL SWITCH
1. Have helper sit in drivers seat to apply brake pedal and observe red brake warning light. 2.
Raise vehicle on hoist. 3. Connect bleed hose to a rear wheel cylinder and immerse hose end in
container partially filled with brake fluid. 4. Have helper press and hold brake pedal to floor and
observe warning light.
a. If warning light illuminates, switch is operating correctly. b. If light fails to illuminate, check circuit
fuse, bulb, and wiring. The parking brake switch can be used to aid in identifying whether or not the
brake light bulb and fuse is functional. Repair or replace parts as necessary and test differential
pressure switch operation again.
5. If warning light still does not illuminate, switch is faulty. Replace combination valve assembly,
bleed brake system and verify proper switch and
valve operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Locations
Brake Switch
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > With Quad Cab
Connector Pin Identification
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Braking
Sensor/Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > With Quad Cab > Page 677
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > With Four Wheel Antilock Brakes
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications
Front Bolts 11 ft.lb
Rear Bolts 18 ft.lb
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > With Four Wheel Antilock Brakes > Page 682
Wheel Speed Sensor: Specifications
Mounting Bolt 18 ft.lb
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations
Wheel Speed Sensor: Component Locations
Tone Wheel - 4x2
Wheel Speed Sensor Tone Wheel (2WD Quad Cab Typical)
Wheel Speed Sensor Tone Wheel
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 685
Front Speed Sensor Mounting - 4x2
Wheel Speed Sensor - 4x4
Rear Speed Sensor Mounting
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Component Locations > Page 686
Wheel Speed Sensor: Connector Locations
Left Front Wheel Speed Sensor Connector
Right Front Wheel Speed Sensor Connector
Rear Wheel Speed Sensor Connector
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Front
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams Front
Connector Pin Identification
Connector Pin Identification
Connector Pin Identification
Connector Pin Identification
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Front > Page 689
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Front > Page 690
Wheel Speed Sensor: Diagrams Rear
Connector Pin Identification
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Four Wheel Antilock Brakes
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Four Wheel Antilock Brakes
The ABS brake system uses 3 wheel speed sensors. A sensor is mounted to each front steering
knuckles. The third sensor is mounted on top of the rear axle differential housing. The sensor is a
magnet coil that is mounted over a tone wheel front/exciter ring rear with an air gap between them.
The sensors measure the wheel speed by monitoring the rotation of the tone wheels front/exciter
ring rear. As the teeth of the tone wheels front/exciter ring rear move through the magnetic field of
the sensor an AC voltage is generated. This signal frequency increases or decreases proportionally
to the speed of the wheel. The CAB monitors these signals for changes in wheel deceleration. If
the CAB detects a sudden wheel or wheels deceleration within a predetermined amount the CAB
will activate the ABS system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Four Wheel Antilock Brakes > Page 693
Wheel Speed Sensor: Description and Operation Rear Wheel Antilock Brakes
Rear Wheel Speed Sensor And Exciter Ring
Rear Wheel Speed Sensor Location
The rear wheel Speed Sensor (WSS) is mounted in the rear differential housing. The WSS consists
of a magnet surrounded by windings from a single strand of wire. The sensor sends a small AC
signal to the Controller Antilock Brake (CAB). This signal is generated by magnetic induction. The
magnetic induction is created when a toothed sensor ring (exciter ring or tone wheel) passes the
stationary magnetic WSS.
Exciter Ring Location
The exciter ring is press fitted onto the differential carrier next to the final drive ring gear. For
replacement procedure of the exciter ring, refer to Differential Assembly. See: Transmission and
Drivetrain/Differential Assembly
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Description and Operation > Four Wheel Antilock Brakes > Page 694
Operation Of The Wheel Speed Sensor
When the ring gear is rotated, the exciter ring passes the tip of the WSS. As the exciter ring passes
the tip of the WSS, the magnetic lines of force of the sensor are cut, causing the magnetic field to
be moved across the sensor's windings. This, in turn causes current to flow through the WSS
circuit. Every time a tooth of the exciter ring passes the tip of the WSS, an AC signal is generated.
Each AC signal (positive to negative signal or sinewave) is interpreted by the CAB. It then
compares the frequency of the sinewave to a time value to calculate vehicle speed. The CAB
continues to monitor the frequency to determine a deceleration rate that would indicate a possible
wheel-locking tendency.
The signal strength of any magnetic induction sensor is directly affected by:
- Magnetic field strength; the stronger the magnetic field, the stronger the signal.
- Number of windings in the sensor; more windings provide a stronger signal.
- Exciter ring speed; the faster the exciter ring rotates, the stronger the signal will be.
- Distance between the exciter ring teeth and WSS; the closer the WSS is to the exciter ring, the
stronger the signal will be.
The rear WSS is not adjustable. A clearance specification has been established for manufacturing
tolerances. If the clearance is not within these specifications, then either the WSS or other
components may be damaged. The clearance between the WSS and the exciter ring is 0.005 0.050 in.
Data Link Connector - Typical
The assembly plant performs a "Rolls Test" on every vehicle that leaves the assembly plant. One
of the test performed is a test of the WSS. To properly test the sensor, the assembly plant connects
test equipment to the Data Link Connector (DLC). This connector is located to the right of the
steering column and attached to the lower portion of the instrument panel. The rolls test terminal is
spliced to the WSS circuit. The vehicle is then driven on a set of rollers and the WSS output is
monitored for proper operation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor Replacement
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Wheel Speed Sensor Replacement
Front
REMOVAL
1. Raise and support vehicle. 2. Remove wheel and tire assembly. 3. Disconnect the ABS wheel
speed sensor wire from under the hood. Remove sensor wire from the frame and steering knuckle.
4. Remove brake caliper. 5. Remove rotor on models with 5 wheel studs. On models with 8 studs
remove rotor hub bearing assembly and separate the rotor from the hub
bearing.
Wheel Speed Sensor - 4x4
6. Remove bolt attaching sensor to the hub bearing. 7. Remove sensor and wire.
INSTALLATION
1. Install the sensor in the hub bearing and tighten the bolt to 14 Nm (11 ft. lbs.). Use original or
replacement sensor bolts only. The bolts are special
and must not be substituted.
2. Install the rotor on models with 5 wheel studs. On models with 8 studs install the rotor on the hub
bearing and install the assembly on the knuckle.
3. Install sensor wire to the steering knuckle and frame. Connect the wheel speed sensor wire
under the hood. 4. Check sensor wire routing. Be sure wire is clear of all chassis components and
is not twisted or kinked at any spot. 5. Install brake caliper. 6. Install wheel and tire assemblies. 7.
Remove support and lower the vehicle. 8. Apply brakes several times to seat brake shoes and
caliper piston. Do not move vehicle until firm brake pedal is obtained. 9. Verify sensor operation
with scan tool.
With Rear Wheel Antilock Brakes
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Remove brake line mounting nut and remove the brake line from the
sensor stud.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor Replacement > Page 697
Rear Speed Sensor Mounting
3. Remove mounting stud from the sensor and shield. 4. Remove sensor and shield from
differential housing. 5. Disconnect sensor wire harness and remove sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect harness to sensor. Be sure seal is securely in place between sensor and wiring
connector. 2. Install O-ring on sensor (if removed). 3. Insert sensor in differential housing. 4. Install
sensor shield. 5. Install the sensor mounting stud and tighten to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 6. Install the
brake line on the sensor stud and install the nut. 7. Lower vehicle.
With Four Wheel Antilock Brakes
REMOVAL
1. Raise vehicle on hoist. 2. Remove brake line mounting nut and remove the brake line from the
sensor stud.
Rear Speed Sensor Mounting
3. Remove mounting stud from the sensor and shield. 4. Remove sensor and shield from
differential housing. 5. Disconnect sensor wire harness and remove sensor.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect harness to sensor. Be sure seal is securely in place between sensor and wiring
connector.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor Replacement > Page 698
2. Install O-ring on sensor (if removed). 3. Insert sensor in differential housing. 4. Install sensor
shield. 5. Install the sensor mounting stud and tighten to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.). 6. Install the brake line
on the sensor stud and install the nut. 7. Lower vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Brakes and Traction Control > Wheel Speed
Sensor > Component Information > Service and Repair > Wheel Speed Sensor Replacement > Page 699
Wheel Speed Sensor: Service and Repair Tone Wheel Replacement
Front Tone Wheel
Tone Wheel - 4x2
The tone wheel for the front speed sensor is located in the rotor hub on 4x2 models. On 4x4
models, the tone wheel is located in the hub/bearing housing.
The tone wheel is not a serviceable component. On 4x2 models, the complete rotor and hub
assembly will have to be replaced if the tone wheel is damaged. On 4x4 models, the hub/bearing
must be replaced, if the tone wheel is damaged.
Rear Tone Wheel
The toothed exciter ring is press-fitted onto the differential carrier next to the final drive ring gear in
the differential case. If the ring is damaged, refer to Differential Assembly for service procedures.
See: Transmission and Drivetrain/Differential Assembly
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature(ECT) Sensor 14 Nm
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 705
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
The engine coolant temperature sensor is installed into the front of the cylinder head near to the
thermostat housing and protrudes into a water jacket.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 706
Connector View
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 707
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR-ECM INPUT
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
The engine coolant temperature sensor is installed into the front of the cylinder head near to the
thermostat housing and protrudes into a water jacket. The sensor provides an input voltage to the
Engine Control Module (ECM) to monitor coolant temperature. The ECM uses this input along with
inputs from other sensors for engine protection, fuel timing and fuel control. As coolant temperature
varies, the coolant temperature sensor resistance will change. This change in resistance results in
a different input voltage to the ECM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cooling System > Engine - Coolant
Temperature Sensor/Switch > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component Information >
Specifications > Page 708
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair
ECT Sensor Location
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor is located at the front of the cylinder head near the
thermostat.
REMOVAL
WARNING: THE COOLING SYSTEM MAY BE UNDER PRESSURE. HOT COOLANT CAN
CAUSE BURNS.
1. Partially drain cooling system until coolant level is below cylinder head. 2. Disconnect ECT
sensor electrical connector from sensor.
ECT Sensor Removal/Installation
3. Remove ECT sensor from cylinder head. 4. Discard sensor O-ring.
INSTALLATION 1. Clean sensor mounting hole of rust or contaminants. 2. Install new O-ring to
sensor. Apply clean engine oil to sensor O-ring and sensor threads. 3. Install ECT sensor into
cylinder head. Tighten to 14 Nm (10 ft. lbs.) torque. 4. Connect sensor electrical connector. 5. fill
cooling system and check for coolant leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Specifications
Cruise Control Switch: Specifications
Tighten mounting screws to 3 N.m (26 in lbs +/- 2 in lbs) torque.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 713
Speed Control Switches (2), Mounting Screws (2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Speed Control Switch - 2 Way
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Left Speed Control Switch - 2 Way > Page 716
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 717
Cruise Control Switch: Service Precautions
WARNING: BEFORE BEGINNING ANY AIR BAG SYSTEM COMPONENT REMOVAL OR
INSTALLATION, REMOVE AND ISOLATE THE NEGATIVE (-) CABLE(S) FROM THE BATTERY.
THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. THEN WAIT TWO
MINUTES FOR SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE FURTHER SYSTEM
SERVICE. FAILURE TO DO THIS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT
AND POSSIBLE INJURY
.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 718
Cruise Control Switch: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
Two separate speed control switch modules are mounted on the steering wheel to the left and right
side of the driver's airbag module. Within the two switch modules, five momentary contact
switches, supporting seven different speed control functions are used. The outputs from these
switches are filtered into one input. The Powertrain Control Module (PCM) determines which output
has been applied through resistive multiplexing. The input circuit voltage is measured by the PCM
to determine which switch function has been selected.
A speed control indicator lamp, located on the instrument panel cluster is energized by the PCM via
the CCD Bus. This occurs when speed control system power has been turned ON, and the engine
is running.
The two switch modules are labeled: ON/OFF, SET, RESUME/ACCEL, CANCEL and COAST.
Refer to the owner's manual for more information on speed control switch functions and setting
procedures. The individual switches cannot be repaired. If one individual switch fails, the switch
module must be replaced.
SPEED CONTROL SWITCHES-PCM INPUT
Six different speed control functions, using three momentary contact switches, are monitored
through this multiplexed input. The resistance monitored at this input, in combination with the
length of time the PCM measures the resistance, determines which switch feature has been
selected. The three switches are: On/Off; Set/Coast, Cancel and Resume/Accelerate.
Refer to Vehicle Speed Control System for further speed control information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Cruise Control Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 719
Cruise Control Switch: Service and Repair
Speed Control Switches
WARNING: BEFORE BEGINNING ANY AIR BAG SYSTEM COMPONENT REMOVAL OR
INSTALLATION, REMOVE AND ISOLATE THE NEGATIVE (-) CABLE(S) FROM THE BATTERY.
THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG SYSTEM. THEN WAIT TWO
MINUTES FOR SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE FURTHER SYSTEM
SERVICE. FAILURE TO DO THIS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT
AND POSSIBLE INJURY.
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate negative battery cable(s). 2. Remove airbag module. Refer to Passive
Restraint Systems for procedures. 3. Remove switch-to-steering wheel mounting screws. 4.
Remove switch. 5. Remove electrical connector at switch.
INSTALLATION
1. Install electrical connector to switch. 2. Install switch and mounting screws. 3. Tighten screws to
3 N.m (26 in lbs +/- 2 in lbs) torque. 4. Install airbag module. Refer to Passive Restraint Systems
for procedures. 5. Connect negative battery cable(s).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Cruise Control > Vehicle Speed
Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control > Component Information > Description and Operation
Vehicle Speed Sensor/Transducer - Cruise Control: Description and Operation
The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) is no longer used for any Dodge Truck.
Vehicle speed and distance covered are measured by the Rear Wheel Speed Sensor. The sensor
is mounted to the rear axle. A signal is sent from this sensor to the Controller Antilock Brake (CAB)
computer. A signal is then sent from the CAB to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to determine
vehicle speed and distance covered. The PCM will then determine strategies for speed control
system operation.
Testing for the Rear Wheel Speed Sensor can be found at Antilock Brakes / Traction Control
Systems. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection
All other testing for the Vehicle Speed Signal can be found at Computers and Control Systems.
See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations
Engine Oil Pressure Sensor, Electrical Connector
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 727
Connector View
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sender > Component
Information > Locations > Page 728
Oil Pressure Sender: Testing and Inspection
For Oil Pressure Testing, refer to Powertrain Management/Computers and Controls/Testing and
Inspection/Procedures/Driveability (DR) Tests.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications
Oil Pressure Sensor: Specifications
Oil Pressure Sender/Switch 12 ft.lb
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 732
Oil Pressure Sensor: Locations
Oil Pressure Sensor (Engine) Location
The oil pressure sensor is installed into the oil pressure galley on the engine block. It is located
below and to the rear of the ECM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 733
Oil Pressure Sensor: Diagrams
Engine Oil Pressure Sensor - 3 Way
Engine Oil Pressure Sensor (Diesel) - 3 Way
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 734
Oil Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
A signal is sent from the engine oil pressure sensor (sending unit) to the Engine Control Module
(ECM) relating to engine oil pressure. The ECM monitors this signal and converts it to a pressure
value. This value is used by the ECM for the engine protection system.
The pressure signal from the ECM is bussed to the instrument panel oil gauge/lamp via the CCD
circuits.
Oil Pressure Sensor (Engine) Location
The oil pressure sensor is installed into the oil pressure galley on the engine block. It is located
below and to the rear of the ECM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Engine > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 735
Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the battery negative cables.
Oil Pressure Sensor Location
2. Disconnect the oil pressure sensor connector. 3. Using a suitable socket, remove the oil
pressure sensor from the block (counter-clockwise).
INSTALLATION
Oil Pressure Sensor And O-Ring
1. If the sensor is not being replaced, inspect the O-ring and replace if necessary. 2. Install the oil
pressure sensor and tighten to 16 Nm (144 inch lbs.) torque. 3. Connect the battery negative
cables. 4. Start engine and check for oil leaks at the sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Specifications
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Specifications
Tighten the one screw that secures the ambient temperature sensor bracket to the inner hood
reinforcement to 5.6 Nm (50 in lbs).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Specifications > Page 740
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Locations
Ambient Temperature Sensor Remove/Install
The ambient temperature sensor is a variable resistor mounted to a bracket that is secured with a
screw to the underside of the hood panel near the hood latch striker in the engine compartment.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Specifications > Page 741
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Diagrams
Ambient Temperature Sensor
Ambient Temperature Sensor - 2 Way
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Specifications > Page 742
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
Ambient air temperature is monitored by the compass mini-trip computer module through the
ambient temperature sensor. The ambient temperature sensor is a variable resistor mounted to a
bracket that is secured with a screw to the underside of the hood panel near the hood latch striker
in the engine compartment.
The ambient temperature sensor cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must
be replaced.
OPERATION
The ambient temperature sensor is a variable resistor that operates on a five volt reference signal
sent to it by the compass mini-trip computer module. The resistance in the sensor changes as
temperature changes, changing the return circuit voltage to the compass mini-trip computer
module. Based upon the resistance in the sensor, the compass mini-trip computer module senses
a specific voltage on the return circuit, which it is programmed to correspond to a specific
temperature.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Specifications > Page 743
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Testing and Inspection
The thermometer function is supported by the ambient temperature sensor, a wiring circuit, and a
portion of the compass mini-trip computer module. If any portion of the ambient temperature sensor
circuit fails, the compass/thermometer display function will self-diagnose the circuit. An "SC" (short
circuit) will appear in the display in place of the temperature, when the sensor is exposed to
temperatures above 55° C (131° F), or if the sensor circuit is shorted. An "OC" (open circuit) will
appear in the display in place of the temperature, when the sensor is exposed to temperatures
below -40° C (-40° F), or if the sensor circuit is open.
The ambient temperature sensor circuit can also be diagnosed using the following Sensor Test,
and Sensor Circuit Test. If the temperature sensor and circuit are confirmed to be OK, but the
temperature display is inoperative or incorrect, refer to Compass Mini-Trip Computer in the
Diagnosis and Testing.
Sensor Test 1. Turn the ignition switch to the Off position. Disconnect and isolate the battery
negative cable. Disconnect the ambient temperature sensor wire
harness connector.
2. Measure the resistance of the ambient temperature sensor. At -40° C (-40° F), the sensor
resistance is 336 K Ohms. At 55° C (131° F), the sensor
resistance is 2.488 K Ohms. The sensor resistance should read between these two values. If OK,
refer to Sensor Circuit Test in the Diagnosis and Testing. If not OK, replace the faulty ambient
temperature sensor.
Sensor Circuit Test 1. Turn the ignition switch to the Off position. Disconnect and isolate the battery
negative cable. Disconnect the ambient temperature sensor wire
harness connector and the overhead console wire harness connector.
2. Connect a jumper wire between the two terminals in the body half of the ambient temperature
sensor wire harness connector. 3. Check for continuity between the sensor return circuit and the
ambient temperature sensor signal circuit cavities of the roof wire harness overhead
console connector. There should be continuity. If OK, go to Step 4. If not OK, repair the open
sensor return circuit or ambient temperature sensor signal circuit to the ambient temperature
sensor as required.
4. Remove the jumper wire from the body half of the ambient temperature sensor wire harness
connector. Check for continuity between the sensor
return circuit cavity of the roof wire harness overhead console connector and a good ground. There
should be no continuity. If OK, go to Step 5. If not OK, repair the shorted sensor return circuit as
required.
5. Check for continuity between the ambient temperature sensor signal circuit cavity of the roof wire
harness overhead console connector and a good
ground. There should be no continuity. If OK, refer to Compass Mini-Trip Computer in the
Diagnosis and Testing. If not OK, repair the shorted ambient temperature sensor signal circuit as
required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Ambient Temperature Sensor /
Switch HVAC > Component Information > Specifications > Page 744
Ambient Temperature Sensor / Switch HVAC: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
Ambient Temperature Sensor Remove/Install
2. Locate the ambient temperature sensor, on the underside of the hood near the hood latch
striker. 3. Disconnect the wire harness connector from the ambient temperature sensor connector
receptacle. 4. Remove the one screw that secures the ambient temperature sensor bracket to the
inner hood reinforcement. 5. Remove the ambient temperature sensor from the inner hood
reinforcement.
INSTALLATION
1. Position the ambient temperature sensor onto the inner hood reinforcement. 2. Install and tighten
the one screw that secures the ambient temperature sensor bracket to the inner hood
reinforcement. Tighten the screw to 5.6 Nm
(50 in lbs).
3. Reconnect the wire harness connector to the ambient temperature sensor connector receptacle.
4. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Locations
Blower Motor Switch: Locations
The blower motor switch is mounted in the heater-A/C control panel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 748
Blower Motor Switch: Service Precautions
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO RESTRAINT SYSTEMS /
AIR BAG SYSTEMS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN,
OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY
.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 749
Blower Motor Switch: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The heater-only or heater-A/C blower motor is controlled by a four position rotary-type blower
motor switch, mounted in the heater-A/C control panel. The switch allows the selection of one of
four blower motor speeds, but can only be turned off by selecting the Off position with the
heater-A/C mode control switch knob.
The blower motor switch directs the blower motor ground path through the mode control switch to
the blower motor resistor, or directly to ground, as required to achieve the selected blower motor
speed.
The blower motor switch cannot be repaired and, if faulty or damaged, the entire heater-only or
heater-A/C control unit must be replaced. The blower motor switch knob is serviced separately.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Blower Motor Switch > Component
Information > Locations > Page 750
Blower Motor Switch: Testing and Inspection
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
1. Check for battery voltage at the fuse in the Power Distribution Center (PDC). If OK, go to Step 2.
If not OK, repair the shorted circuit or
component as required and replace the faulty fuse.
2. Turn the ignition switch to the Off position. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable.
Remove the heater-A/C control from the instrument
panel. Check for continuity between the ground circuit cavity of the heater-A/C control wire harness
connector and a good ground. There should be continuity. If OK, go to Step 3. If not OK, repair the
open circuit to ground as required.
3. With the heater-A/C control wire harness connector unplugged, place the heater-A/C mode
control switch knob in any position except the Off
position. Check for continuity between the ground circuit terminal and each of the blower motor
driver circuit terminals of the heater-A/C control as you move the blower motor switch knob to each
of the four speed positions. There should be continuity at each driver circuit terminal in only one
blower motor switch speed position. If OK, test and repair the blower driver circuits between the
heater-A/C control connector and the blower motor resistor as required. If not OK, replace the
faulty heater-A/C control unit.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Locations
Suction And Discharge Line Remove/Install
The high pressure cut-off switch is located on the discharge line near the compressor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 755
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
High Pressure Cut-off Switch The high pressure cut-off switch is located on the discharge line near
the compressor. The switch is screwed onto a fitting that contains a Schrader-type valve, which
allows the switch to be serviced without discharging the refrigerant system. The discharge line
fitting is equipped with an O-ring to seal the switch connection.
The high pressure cut-off switch is connected in series electrically with the low pressure cycling
clutch switch between ground and the Powertrain Control Module (PCM). The switch contacts open
and close causing the PCM to turn the compressor clutch on and off. This prevents compressor
operation when the discharge line pressure approaches high levels.
The high pressure cut-off switch contacts are open when the discharge line pressure rises above
about 3100 to 3375 kPa (450 to 490 psi). The switch contacts will close when the discharge line
pressure drops to about 1860 to 2275 kPa (270 to 330 psi). When checking refrigerant system
pressures with a manifold gauge set, keep in mind that the indicated pressures will be about 172
kPa (25 psi) below the actual switch pressure values due to the pressure drop that occurs in the
refrigerant system between the switch and the high pressure service port.
The high pressure cut-off switch is a factory-calibrated unit. The switch cannot be adjusted or
repaired and, if faulty or damaged, it must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 756
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
Before performing diagnosis of the high pressure cut-off switch, verify that the refrigerant system
has the correct refrigerant charge. See Refrigerant System Charge in the Service Procedures for
more information.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Unplug the high pressure cut-off switch
wire harness connector from the switch on the refrigerant system fitting. 3. Check for continuity
between the two terminals of the high pressure cut-off switch. There should be continuity If OK, test
and repair the A/C
switch sense circuit as required. If not OK, replace the faulty switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > High Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 757
High Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
High Pressure Cut-Off Switch Remove/Install
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Unplug the wire harness connector from
the high pressure cut-off switch, which is mounted to a fitting on the discharge line between the
compressor and the condenser inlet.
3. Unscrew the high pressure cut-off switch from the discharge line fitting. 4. Remove the high
pressure cut-off switch from the vehicle. 5. Remove the O-ring seal from the discharge line fitting
and discard.
INSTALLATION
1. Lubricate a new O-ring seal with clean refrigerant oil and install it on the discharge line fitting.
Use only the specified O-rings as they are made of
a special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the
compressor in the vehicle.
2. Install and tighten the high pressure cut-off switch on the discharge line fitting. 3. Plug the wire
harness connector into the high pressure cut-off switch. 4. Connect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Specifications
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Specifications
Switch contacts are open when the suction pressure is about 172 kPa (25 psi) or lower
Switch contacts close when the suction pressure rises to about 296 kPa (43 psi) or above.
Lower ambient temperatures, below about -1° C (30° F), will also cause the switch contacts to
open. This is due to the pressure/temperature relationship of the refrigerant in the system.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Specifications > Page 761
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Locations
Accumulator And Low Pressure Cycling Clutch Switch
The low pressure cycling clutch switch is located on the top of the accumulator.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Specifications > Page 762
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Description and Operation
Accumulator And Low Pressure Cycling Clutch Switch
SYSTEM OPERATION
Low Pressure Cycling Clutch Switch The low pressure cycling clutch switch is located on the top of
the accumulator. The switch is screwed onto an accumulator fitting that contains a Schrader type
valve, which allows the switch to be serviced without discharging the refrigerant system. The
accumulator fitting is equipped with an O-ring to seal the switch connection.
The low pressure cycling clutch switch is connected in series electrically with the high pressure
cut-off switch and the heater-A/C controls, between ground and the Powertrain Control Module
(PCM). The switch contacts open and close causing the PCM to turn the compressor clutch on and
off. This regulates the refrigerant system pressure and controls evaporator temperature. Controlling
evaporator temperature prevents condensate water on the evaporator fins from freezing and
obstructing air conditioning system air flow.
The low pressure cycling clutch switch contacts are open when the suction pressure is about 172
kPa (25 psi) or lower. The switch contacts will close when the suction pressure rises to about 296
kPa (43 psi) or above. Lower ambient temperatures, below about -1° C (30° F), will also cause the
switch contacts to open. This is due to the pressure/temperature relationship of the refrigerant in
the system.
The low pressure cycling clutch switch is a factory calibrated unit. It cannot be adjusted or repaired
and, if faulty or damaged, it must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Specifications > Page 763
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Testing and Inspection
Accumulator And Low Pressure Cycling Clutch Switch
Low Pressure Cycling Clutch Switch
Before performing diagnosis of the low pressure cycling clutch switch, be certain that the switch is
properly installed on the accumulator fitting. If the switch is too loose it may not open the
Schrader-type valve in the accumulator fitting, which will prevent the switch from correctly
monitoring the refrigerant system pressure. Also verify that the refrigerant system has the correct
refrigerant charge. See Refrigerant System Charge in the Service Procedures for more information.
Remember that lower ambient temperatures, below about -1° C (30° F), during cold weather will
open the switch contacts and prevent compressor operation due to the pressure/temperature
relationship of the refrigerant.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Unplug the low pressure cycling clutch
switch wire harness connector from the switch on the accumulator fitting. 3. Install a jumper wire
between the two cavities of the low pressure cycling clutch switch wire harness connector. 4.
Connect a manifold gauge set to the refrigerant system service ports. See Refrigerant System
Service Equipment and Refrigerant System Service
Ports in the Description and Operation for more information.
5. Connect the battery negative cable. 6. Place the heater-A/C mode control switch knob in any
A/C position and start the engine. 7. Check for continuity between the two terminals of the low
pressure cycling clutch switch. There should be continuity with a suction pressure
reading of 296 kPa (43 psi) or above, and no continuity with a suction pressure reading of 172 kPa
(25 psi) or below. If OK, test and repair the A/C switch sense circuit as required. If not OK, replace
the faulty switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - HVAC > Refrigerant Pressure Sensor /
Switch, HVAC > Low Pressure Sensor / Switch, HVAC > Component Information > Specifications > Page 764
Low Pressure Sensor / Switch: Service and Repair
Accumulator And Low Pressure Cycling Clutch Switch
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Unplug the wire harness connector from
the low pressure cycling clutch switch on the top of the accumulator. 3. Unscrew the low pressure
cycling clutch switch from the fitting on the top of the accumulator. 4. Remove the O-ring seal from
the accumulator fitting and discard.
INSTALLATION
1. Lubricate a new O-ring seal with clean refrigerant oil and install it on the accumulator fitting. Use
only the specified O-rings as they are made of a
special material for the R-134a system. Use only refrigerant oil of the type recommended for the
compressor in the vehicle.
2. Install and tighten the low pressure cycling clutch switch on the accumulator fitting. The switch
should be hand-tightened onto the accumulator
fitting.
3. Plug the wire harness connector into the low pressure cycling clutch switch. 4. Connect the
battery negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Dimmer Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 770
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 771
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 772
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 773
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 774
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 775
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 776
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 777
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 778
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 779
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 780
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 781
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 782
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 783
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 784
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 785
Dimmer Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 786
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 787
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Dimmer Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 788
Multi-Function Switch - 24 Way
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Door Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 793
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 794
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 795
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 796
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 797
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 798
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 799
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 800
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 801
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 802
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 803
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 804
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 805
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 806
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 807
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 808
Door Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 809
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 810
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 811
Door Switch: Connector Views
Driver Door Jamb Switch (CTM) - Natural 2 Way
Passenger Door Jamb Switch - Natural 3 Way
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-42-99 > Dec > 99 >
Fuel Gauge - Reads Full for an Excessive Time
Fuel Gauge Sender: Customer Interest Fuel Gauge - Reads Full for an Excessive Time
NUMBER: 08-42-99
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Dec. 17, 1999
SUBJECT: The Fuel Gauge Reads Full For An Excessive Period Of Time
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves installing a new fuel pump module.
MODELS: 1998 - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH THE 5.9L CUMMINS DIESEL
ENGINE.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: After driving over 200 miles, the fuel gauge may read full until the vehicle
travels over a bump in the road and then the gauge operates normally.
DIAGNOSIS: This condition may be caused by the float in the fuel pump module sticking and may
be difficult to diagnose. Perform the repair procedure if the customer's concern matches the
description identified in the Symptom/Condition.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04897668AE Module, Fuel Pump
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Using the procedure identified in the 1999 Ram Truck Service Manual (Publication No.
81-370-9108), page 14-92, replace the fuel pump module with p/n 04897668AE.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 14-50-05-90 1.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Fuel Gauge Sender: > 08-42-99 >
Dec > 99 > Fuel Gauge - Reads Full for an Excessive Time
Fuel Gauge Sender: All Technical Service Bulletins Fuel Gauge - Reads Full for an Excessive Time
NUMBER: 08-42-99
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Dec. 17, 1999
SUBJECT: The Fuel Gauge Reads Full For An Excessive Period Of Time
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves installing a new fuel pump module.
MODELS: 1998 - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLE EQUIPPED WITH THE 5.9L CUMMINS DIESEL
ENGINE.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: After driving over 200 miles, the fuel gauge may read full until the vehicle
travels over a bump in the road and then the gauge operates normally.
DIAGNOSIS: This condition may be caused by the float in the fuel pump module sticking and may
be difficult to diagnose. Perform the repair procedure if the customer's concern matches the
description identified in the Symptom/Condition.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04897668AE Module, Fuel Pump
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Using the procedure identified in the 1999 Ram Truck Service Manual (Publication No.
81-370-9108), page 14-92, replace the fuel pump module with p/n 04897668AE.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 14-50-05-90 1.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 825
Fuel Gauge Sender: Specifications
Fuel Pump Module Locknut 24-44 Nm
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 826
Fuel Tank Module, Rollover Valve
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 827
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 828
Fuel Gauge Sender: Description and Operation
FUEL GAUGE SENDING UNIT
The fuel gauge sending unit (fuel level sensor) is attached to the side of the fuel tank module. The
sending unit consists of a float, an arm, and a variable resistor (track). The resistor track is used to
send electrical signals to the powertrain Control Module (PCM) for fuel gauge operation. After this
signal is sent to the PCM, the PCM will transmit the data across the CCD bus circuits to the
instrument panel. Here it is translated into the appropriate fuel gauge level reading.
As fuel level increases, the float and arm move up. This decreases the sending unit resistance,
causing the fuel gauge to read full. As fuel level decreases, the float and arm move down. This
increases the sending unit resistance causing the fuel gauge to read empty.
FUEL TANK MODULE
An electric fuel pump is not used in the fuel tank module for diesel powered engines. Fuel is
supplied by the engine mounted fuel transfer pump and the fuel injection pump.
Top View Of Fuel Tank Module
The fuel tank module is installed in the top of the fuel tank. The fuel tank module contains the
following components: Fuel reservoir
- A separate in-tank fuel filter
- Rollover valve
- Fuel gauge sending unit (fuel level sensor)
- Fuel supply line connection
- Fuel return line connection
- Auxiliary non-pressurized fuel supply fitting
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Fuel Gauge Sender >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 829
Fuel Gauge Sender: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Drain and remove fuel tank. Refer to Fuel Tank Removal/Installation. 2. Thoroughly clean area
around tank module at top of tank.
Locknut Removal/Installation - Typical Module
3. The plastic fuel tank module locknut is threaded onto fuel tank. Install Special Tool 6856 to
locknut and remove locknut. The fuel tank module
will spring up when locknut is removed.
4. Remove module from fuel tank.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel tank module is serviced, the rubber gasket must be replaced.
1. Thoroughly clean locknut and locknut threads at top of tank. 2. Using new gasket, carefully
position fuel tank module into opening in fuel tank. 3. Position locknut over top of fuel tank module.
Install locknut finger tight. 4. When looking down at tank from drivers side of tank, the arrow at top
of module should be aligned between two marks stamped into tank
(approximately 2 o'clock position). The fuel line connectors, roll over valve and fuel gauge electrical
connector should all be pointed to drivers side of vehicle. Rotate and align module/tank marks if
necessary before tightening locknut. This step must be performed to prevent the module's float
from contacting side of fuel tank.
5. Tighten locknut to 24-44 Nm (18-32 ft. lbs.) torque. 6. Install fuel tank. Refer to Fuel Tank
Removal/ Installation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Water In Fuel Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Water In Fuel Sensor Probe - Maintenance
Water In Fuel Sensor: Technical Service Bulletins Water In Fuel Sensor Probe - Maintenance
NUMBER: 14-03-00
GROUP: Fuel
DATE: April 14, 2000
SUBJECT: Maintenance To The Water-In-Fuel Sensor Probes Due To Possible Fuel
Contamination
MODELS: 1998 - 2001 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
NOTE: THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 5.9L - 24V DIESEL
ENGINE.
DISCUSSION:
The probes on the end of the Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor may become less effective at sensing the
presence of water in the fuel if they are exposed to contaminated fuel. Contaminant from the fuel
may insulate the WIF sensor probes and inhibit the WIF lamp from illuminating when water is
present.
Figure 1
Any time service is performed on the fuel filter or fuel filter housing, the probes on the end of the
Water-In-Fuel sensor should be cleaned. Use a clean cloth to wipe the WIF probes of any
contaminant (Figure 1).
Two designs of the fuel filter housing have been placed in service. Though the designs are
different, cleaning the WIF sensor probes remain basically the same.
POLICY:
Information Only
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Water In Fuel Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 834
Water In Fuel Sensor: Locations
Water-In-Fuel Sensor Location
The Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor is located at the side of fuel filter/water separator canister.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Water In Fuel Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 835
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Water In Fuel Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 836
Water In Fuel Sensor: Description and Operation
WATER-IN-FUEL (WIF) SENSOR-ECM INPUT
The sensor sends an input to the Engine Control Module (ECM) when it senses water in the fuel
filter water separator. As the water level in the filter/separator increases, the resistance across the
WIF sensor decreases. This decrease in resistance is sent as a signal to the ECM and compared
to a high water standard value. Once the value reaches 30 to 40 kilohms, the ECM will activate the
water-in-fuel warning lamp through CCD bus circuits. This all takes place when the ignition key is
initially put in the ON position. The ECM continues to monitor the input at the end of the intake
manifold air heater post-heat cycle.
Water-In-Fuel Sensor Location
The WIF sensor is located at the bottom of the fuel filter/water separator canister.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Instrument Panel > Water In Fuel Sensor >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 837
Water In Fuel Sensor: Service and Repair
The Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor is located at the side of fuel filter/water separator canister. Refer to
Fuel Filter-Water Separator Removal/Installation for WIF sensor removal/installation procedures.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Specifications
Backup Lamp Switch: Specifications
Back-up Lamp Switch 20 ft.lb
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 842
Transmission Connectors
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Backup Lamp Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 845
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 846
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 847
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 848
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 849
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 850
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 851
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 852
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 853
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 854
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 855
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 856
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 857
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 858
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 859
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 860
Backup Lamp Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 861
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 862
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 863
8w-51-2
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Backup Lamp Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 864
Backup Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
Removal
1. Disengage wiring connector from the backup lamp switch.
Backup Lamp Switch
2. Remove the backup lamp switch from the extension/adapter housing. Be sure to remove the
switch gasket from the housing.
Installation
1. Remove any remaining gasket material from the extension/adapter housing. 2. Install switch and
gasket into the extension/ adapter housing. 3. 1brque the backup lamp switch to 20 - 35 Nm (20 28 ft. lbs.).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine/Lighting - Stoplamp Switch/Vacuum Pump Rev.
Brake Light Switch: Technical Service Bulletins Engine/Lighting - Stoplamp Switch/Vacuum Pump
Rev.
NUMBER: 26-12-98B
GROUP: Miscellaneous
DATE: December, 1998
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH BLACK BARS IN THE MARGIN
Models: 1999 Ram Truck Service Manual - Publication Number 81-370-9108
DESCRIPTION OF CHANGES
Revision to the stop lamp switch service procedures
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine/Lighting - Stoplamp Switch/Vacuum Pump Rev. > Page 869
5-2
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine/Lighting - Stoplamp Switch/Vacuum Pump Rev. > Page 870
5-10
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine/Lighting - Stoplamp Switch/Vacuum Pump Rev. > Page 871
5-17
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine/Lighting - Stoplamp Switch/Vacuum Pump Rev. > Page 872
5-18
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine/Lighting - Stoplamp Switch/Vacuum Pump Rev. > Page 873
5-40
Revision to the vacuum pump service procedures
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine/Lighting - Stoplamp Switch/Vacuum Pump Rev. > Page 874
9-238
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine/Lighting - Stoplamp Switch/Vacuum Pump Rev. > Page 875
9-239
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine/Lighting - Stoplamp Switch/Vacuum Pump Rev. > Page 876
9-240
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 877
Brake Light Switch: Locations
The switch is mounted on the brake pedal mounting bracket under the instrument panel.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 878
Brake Lamp Switch Connector
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > General Information
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation General Information
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-12-98.
The plunger type stop lamp switch is mounted on a bracket attached to the brake pedal support.
The switch can be adjusted when necessary.
CAUTION: The switch can only be adjusted during initial installation. If the switch is not adjusted
properly, a new switch must be installed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > General Information > Page 881
Brake Light Switch: Description and Operation Switch With RWAL System
SYSTEM OPERATION
Vehicles equipped with the speed control option use a dual function stop lamp switch. The switch is
mounted on the brake pedal mounting bracket under the instrument panel. The PCM monitors the
state of the dual function stop lamp switch.
BRAKE SWITCH-PCM INPUT
When the brake light switch is activated, the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) receives an input
indicating that the brakes are being applied. After receiving this input, the PCM maintains idle
speed to a scheduled rpm through control of the Idle Air Control (IAC) motor. The brake switch
input is also used to supply/deny power to the speed control servo solenoids.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 882
Brake Light Switch: Testing and Inspection
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-12-98.
Stop Lamp Switch Terminal Identification
The stop lamp switch can be tested with an ohmmeter. The ohmmeter is used to check continuity
between the pin terminals.
SWITCH CIRCUIT IDENTIFICATION
- Terminals 1 and 2: stop lamp circuit
- Terminals 3 and 4: RWAL/ABS module and Powertrain Control Module (PCM) circuit
- Terminals 5 and 6: speed control circuit.
NOTE: Disconnect switch harness before testing switch continuity.
SWITCH CONTINUITY TEST
With switch plunger extended, attach test leads to pins 1 and 2. Replace switch if meter indicates
no continuity.
With switch plunger retracted, attach test leads to pins 3 and 4. Replace switch if meter indicates
no continuity.
With switch plunger retracted, attach test leads to pins 5 and 6. Replace switch if meter indicates
no continuity.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 883
Brake Light Switch: Adjustments
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-12-98.
To adjust a new switch after installation, release the brake pedal. Then move the release lever on
the switch to engage the switch plunger.
CAUTION: The switch can only be adjusted during initial installation. If the switch is not adjusted
properly, a new switch must be installed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Brake Light Switch >
Component Information > Description and Operation > Page 884
Brake Light Switch: Service and Repair
The content of this article reflects changes called for in TSB 26-12-98.
REMOVAL
1. Remove knee bolster for access to stop lamp switch and pedal.
Stop Lamp Switch & Harness Connector
2. Disconnect switch harness. 3. Press and hold brake pedal in applied position. 4. Rotate switch
counterclockwise about 30° to align switch lock tab with notch in bracket. 5. Pull switch rearward
out of mounting bracket and release brake pedal.
INSTALLATION
1. Connect harness wires to new switch. 2. Press and hold brake pedal down.
Stop Lamp Switch
3. Install switch. Align tabs on switch with notch in switch bracket. Then insert switch in bracket and
turn it clockwise about 30° to lock it in place. 4. Release brake pedal. Then move the release lever
on the switch to engage the switch plunger. The switch is now adjusted and cannot be adjusted
again.
5. Install the knee bolster.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Door Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 889
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 890
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 891
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 892
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 893
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 894
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 895
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 896
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 897
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 898
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 899
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 900
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 901
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 902
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 903
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 904
Door Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 905
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 906
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Door Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 907
Door Switch: Connector Views
Driver Door Jamb Switch (CTM) - Natural 2 Way
Passenger Door Jamb Switch - Natural 3 Way
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Glove Box Lamp Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Glove Box Lamp And Switch Remove/Install
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Glove Box Lamp Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 911
Glove Box Lamp Switch: Service Precautions
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO RESTRAINT SYSTEMS /
AIRBAG SYSTEMS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY
.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Glove Box Lamp Switch
> Component Information > Locations > Page 912
Glove Box Lamp Switch: Service and Repair
Glove Box Lamp And Switch Remove/Install
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
REMOVAL 1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the glove box from the
instrument panel. Refer to Glove Box in the Replacement for the procedures. 3. Reach through the
glove box opening and behind the glove box lamp and switch mounting bracket to access the
instrument panel wire harness
connector on the glove box lamp and switch.
4. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the connector receptacle on the
back of the glove box lamp and switch unit. 5. Reach through the glove box opening and behind
the glove box lamp and switch mounting bracket to depress the retaining tabs on the top and
bottom of the glove box lamp and switch housing.
6. While holding the retaining tabs depressed, push the glove box lamp and switch unit out through
the hole in the mounting bracket on the
instrument panel glove box opening upper reinforcement.
7. Remove the glove box lamp and switch unit from the instrument panel.
INSTALLATION 1. Reach through the glove box opening and behind the glove box lamp and
switch mounting bracket to feed the instrument panel wire harness
connectors out through the hole in the glove box lamp and switch housing mounting bracket.
2. Position the glove box lamp and switch unit to the instrument panel. 3. Reconnect the instrument
panel wire harness connector to the connector receptacle on the back of the glove box lamp and
switch unit. 4. Push the glove box lamp and switch unit into the hole in the mounting bracket on the
instrument panel glove box opening upper reinforcement. 5. Install the glove box onto the
instrument panel. Refer to Glove Box in the Replacement for the procedures. 6. Close the glove
box. 7. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Specifications
Hazard Warning Switch: Specifications
Tighten the screw that secures the instrument panel wire harness connector to the multi-function
switch connector receptacle to 2 Nm (17 in lbs).
Tighten the two screws that secure the multi-function switch to the steering column to 2 Nm (17 in
lbs).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 916
Hazard Warning Switch: Locations
Multi-Function Switch
The turn signal and hazard warning switches are integral to the multi-function switch unit, which is
secured to the left side of the steering column.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 917
Multi-Function Switch - 24 Way
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 918
Hazard Warning Switch: Service Precautions
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO RESTRAINT SYSTEMS /
AIRBAG SYSTEMS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY
.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 919
Hazard Warning Switch: Description and Operation
DESCRIPTION
Multi-Function Switch
The turn signal and hazard warning switches are integral to the multi-function switch unit, which is
secured to the left side of the steering column. The only visible parts of the multi-function switch are
the control stalk that extends from the left side of the steering column, and the hazard warning
switch push button that protrudes from the top of the steering column. The multi-function switch
control stalk has both nomenclature and international control symbols on it, which identify its many
functions. The hazard warning switch push button is identified with a double triangle, which is the
international control symbol for hazard warning. The remainder of the mufti-function switch is
concealed beneath the steering column shrouds.
The multi-function switch also contains circuitry for the following functions: Headlamp beam selection
- Headlamp optical horn
- Windshield wipers
- Windshield washers.
However, the turn signal and hazard warning switches cannot be repaired. If these switches or any
other circuit or component of the multi-function switch unit is faulty or damaged, the entire
multifunction switch unit must be replaced.
OPERATION
The hazard warning switch is controlled by the hazard warning switch push button. Push the switch
button in to unlatch the switch and activate the hazard warning system, and push in on the button
again to latch the switch and turn the system off. When the hazard warning switch is latched
(hazard warning off), the push button will be in a lowered position on the top of the steering column
shroud; and, when the hazard warning switch is unlatched (hazard warning on), the push button
will be in a raised position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 920
Hazard Warning Switch: Testing and Inspection
The turn signal switch and the hazard warning switch are integral to the multi-function switch. Refer
to Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Systems in the Diagnosis and Testing before testing the
multi-function switch.
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness
connector from the multi-function switch
connector receptacle.
Multi-Function Switch Continuity
2. Using an ohmmeter, perform the switch continuity checks at the connector receptacle terminals
as shown in the Multi-Function Switch Continuity
chart.
3. If the turn signal switch or hazard warning switch fails any of the continuity checks, replace the
faulty multi-function switch assembly as required.
If the switch circuits are OK, repair the lighting circuits as required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 921
Hazard Warning Switch: Service and Repair
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
REMOVAL 1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. If the vehicle is so equipped,
remove the tilt lever from the left side of the steering column.
Steering Column Shrouds Remove/Install
3. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds from the steering column. 4. Remove the lower fixed
column shroud from the steering column.
Multi-Function Switch Connector - Typical
5. Move the upper fixed column shroud far enough to access the back of the multi-function switch.
6. Remove the tamper proof mounting screws (a Snap On tamper proof Torx bit TTXR20B2 or
equivalent is required) that secure the multi-function
switch to the steering column.
7. Gently pull the multi-function switch away from the steering column far enough to access and
remove the screw that secures the instrument panel
wire harness connector to the multi-function switch connector receptacle.
8. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the multi-function switch connector
receptacle. 9. Remove the multi-function switch from the steering column.
INSTALLATION 1. Position the multi-function switch onto the steering column. 2. Reconnect the
instrument panel wire harness connector to the multi-function switch connector receptacle. 3. Install
and tighten the screw that secures the instrument panel wire harness connector to the
multi-function switch connector receptacle. Tighten
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Hazard Warning Switch
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 922
the screw to 2 Nm (17 in lbs).
4. Install and tighten the two screws that secure the multi-function switch to the steering column.
Tighten the screws to 2 Nm (17 in lbs). 5. Install the lower fixed column shroud onto the steering
column. 6. Install both the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. 7. If the vehicle is so
equipped install the tilt lever onto the left side of the steering column. 8. Reconnect the battery
negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Specifications
Headlamp Switch: Specifications
Tighten the three screws that secure the headlamp switch to the instrument panel to 2.2 Nm (20 in
lbs).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 926
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 927
Headlamp Switch: Service Precautions
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO RESTRAINT SYSTEMS /
AIRBAG SYSTEMS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY
.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 928
Headlamp Switch: Application and ID
CAUTION: Do not use bulbs that have a higher candle power than the bulb listed. Damage to lamp
can result.
Some components have lamps that can only be serviced by a Authorized Service Center (ASC)
after the component is removed from the vehicle. When illumination goes out in the Electronic
Instrument Cluster (EIC) the complete button module must be replaced. The Mechanical
Instrument Cluster (MIC) uses PC 194 bulbs for illumination.
When changing lamp bulbs check the socket for corrosion. If corrosion is present, clean it with a
wire brush and coat the inside of the socket lightly with Mopar Multi-Purpose Grease or equivalent.
Headlamp Switch = Bulb Number 158
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Headlamp Switch >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 929
Headlamp Switch: Service and Repair
Headlamp Switch Remove/Install
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
REMOVAL 1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Remove the cluster bezel from
the instrument panel. Refer to Cluster Bezel in the Replacement for the procedures. 3. Remove the
three screws that secure the headlamp switch bezel to the instrument panel. 4. Pull the headlamp
switch away from the instrument panel far enough to access the instrument panel wire harness
connectors. 5. Disconnect the two instrument panel wire harness connectors from the headlamp
switch connector receptacles. 6. Remove the headlamp switch from the instrument panel.
INSTALLATION 1. Position the headlamp switch to the instrument panel. 2. Reconnect the two
instrument panel wire harness connectors to the headlamp switch connector receptacles. 3. Install
the headlamp switch into the instrument panel. 4. Install and tighten the three screws that secure
the headlamp switch to the instrument panel. Tighten the screws to 2.2 Nm (20 in lbs). 5. Install the
cluster bezel onto the instrument panel. Refer to Cluster Bezel in the Replacement for the
procedures. 6. Reconnect the battery negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Horn Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 934
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 935
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 936
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 937
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 938
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 939
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 940
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 941
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 942
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 943
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 944
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 945
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 946
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 947
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 948
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 949
Horn Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 950
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 951
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 952
Horn Switch: Service Precautions
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY
.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 953
Horn Switch: Description and Operation
Driver Side Airbag Module Trim Cover And Horn Switch
DESCRIPTION
A center-blow, normally open, resistive membrane-type horn switch is secured with heat stakes to
the back side of the driver side airbag module trim cover in the center of the steering wheel. The
switch consists of two plastic membranes, one that is flat and one that is slightly convex. These two
membranes are secured to each other around the perimeter. Inside the switch, the centers of the
facing surfaces of these membranes each has a grid made with an electrically conductive material
applied to it. One of the grids is connected to a circuit that provides it with continuity to ground at all
times. The grid of the other membrane is connected to the horn relay control circuit.
The steering wheel and steering column must be properly grounded in order for the horn switch to
function properly. The horn switch is only serviced as a part of the driver side airbag module trim
cover. If the horn switch is damaged or faulty, or if the driver side airbag is deployed, the driver side
airbag module trim cover and horn switch must be replaced as a unit.
OPERATION
When the center area of the driver side airbag trim cover is depressed, the electrically conductive
grids on the facing surfaces of the horn switch membranes A contact each other, closing the switch
circuit. The completed horn switch circuit provides a ground for the control coil side of the horn
relay, which activates the relay. When the horn switch is released, the resistive tension of the
convex membrane separates the two electrically conductive grids and opens the switch circuit.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Horn Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Page 954
Horn Switch: Testing and Inspection
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
For additional testing and inspection information please refer to Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/ See: Body and Frame/Body Control
Systems/Central Timer Module
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Remove the steering column opening cover
from the instrument panel. 2. Check for continuity between the metal steering column jacket and a
good ground. There should be continuity. If OK, go to Step 3. 3. Remove the driver side airbag
module from the steering wheel. Disconnect the horn switch wire harness connectors from the
driver side airbag
module.
4. Remove the horn relay from the Power Distribution Center (PDC). Check for continuity between
the steering column half of the horn switch feed
wire harness connector and a good ground. There should be no continuity. If OK, go to Step 5. If
not OK repair the shorted horn relay control circuit to the horn relay in the PDC as required.
5. Check for continuity between the steering column half of the horn switch feed wire harness
connector and the horn relay control circuit cavity for
the horn relay in the PDC. There should be continuity If OK, go to Step 6. If not OK, repair the open
horn relay control circuit to the horn relay in the PDC as required.
6. Check for continuity between the horn switch feed wire and the horn switch ground wire on the
driver side airbag module. There should be no
continuity. If OK, go to Step 7. If not OK, replace the faulty horn switch.
7. Depress the center of the driver side airbag module trim cover and check for continuity between
the horn switch feed wire and the horn switch
ground wire on the driver side airbag module. There should now be continuity. If not OK, replace
the faulty horn switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Interior Light Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 959
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 960
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 961
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 962
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 963
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 964
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 965
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 966
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 967
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 968
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 969
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 970
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 971
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 972
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 973
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 974
Interior Light Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 975
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Interior Light Switch >
Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 976
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Specifications
Turn Signal Switch: Specifications
Tighten the screw that secures the instrument panel wire harness connector to the multi-function
switch connector receptacle to 2 Nm (17 in lbs).
Tighten the two screws that secure the multi-function switch to the steering column to 2 Nm (17 in
lbs).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 980
Turn Signal Switch: Locations
Multi-Function Switch
The turn signal and hazard warning switches are integral to the multi-function switch unit, which is
secured to the left side of the steering column.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 981
Multi-Function Switch - 24 Way
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 982
Turn Signal Switch: Service Precautions
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO RESTRAINT SYSTEMS /
AIRBAG SYSTEMS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY
.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 983
Turn Signal Switch: Description and Operation
Multi-Function Switch
DESCRIPTION
The turn signal and hazard warning switches are integral to the multi-function switch unit, which is
secured to the left side of the steering column. The only visible parts of the multi-function switch are
the control stalk that extends from the left side of the steering column, and the hazard warning
switch push button that protrudes from the top of the steering column. The multi-function switch
control stalk has both nomenclature and international control symbols on it, which identify its many
functions. The hazard warning switch push button is identified with a double triangle, which is the
international control symbol for hazard warning. The remainder of the mufti-function switch is
concealed beneath the steering column shrouds.
The multi-function switch also contains circuitry for the following functions: Headlamp beam selection
- Headlamp optical horn
- Windshield wipers
- Windshield washers.
However, the turn signal and hazard warning switches cannot be repaired. If these switches or any
other circuit or component of the multi-function switch unit is faulty or damaged, the entire
multifunction switch unit must be replaced.
OPERATION
The multi-function switch control stalk that extends from the left side of the steering column just
below the steering wheel is moved up or down to activate the turn signal switch. When the control
stalk is moved in the upward direction, the right turn signal switch circuitry is activated; and, when
the control stalk is moved in the downward direction, the left turn signal switch circuitry is activated.
The turn signal switch has a detent position in each direction that provides turn signals with
automatic cancellation, and an intermediate momentary position in each direction that provides turn
signals only until the multi-function switch control stalk is released.
When the turn signal switch is in a detent position, it is turned off by one of two turn signal
cancelling cam lobes that are integral to the rotor of the clockspring mechanism. Turning the
steering wheel causes the turn signal cancelling cam lobes to contact a cancel actuator in the
multi-function switch, and the turn signal switch automatically returns to the off position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 984
Turn Signal Switch: Testing and Inspection
Multi-Function Switch Continuity
The turn signal switch and the hazard warning switch are integral to the multi-function switch. Refer
to Turn Signal and Hazard Warning Systems in the Diagnosis and Testing before testing the
multi-function switch.
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness
connector from the multi-function switch
connector receptacle.
2. Using an ohmmeter, perform the switch continuity checks at the connector receptacle terminals
as shown in the Multi-Function Switch Continuity
chart.
3. If the turn signal switch or hazard warning switch fails any of the continuity checks, replace the
faulty multi-function switch assembly as required.
If the switch circuits are OK, repair the lighting circuits as required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 985
Turn Signal Switch: Service and Repair
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
REMOVAL 1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. If the vehicle is so equipped,
remove the tilt lever from the left side of the steering column.
Steering Column Shrouds Remove/Install
3. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds from the steering column. 4. Remove the lower fixed
column shroud from the steering column.
Multi-Function Switch Connector - Typical
5. Move the upper fixed column shroud far enough to access the back of the multi-function switch.
6. Remove the tamper proof mounting screws (a Snap On tamper proof Torx bit TTXR20B2 or
equivalent is required) that secure the multi-function
switch to the steering column.
7. Gently pull the multi-function switch away from the steering column far enough to access and
remove the screw that secures the instrument panel
wire harness connector to the multi-function switch connector receptacle.
8. Disconnect the instrument panel wire harness connector from the multi-function switch connector
receptacle. 9. Remove the multi-function switch from the steering column.
INSTALLATION 1. Position the multi-function switch onto the steering column. 2. Reconnect the
instrument panel wire harness connector to the multi-function switch connector receptacle. 3. Install
and tighten the screw that secures the instrument panel wire harness connector to the
multi-function switch connector receptacle. Tighten
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Lighting and Horns > Turn Signal Switch >
Component Information > Specifications > Page 986
the screw to 2 Nm (17 in lbs).
4. Install and tighten the two screws that secure the multi-function switch to the steering column.
Tighten the screws to 2 Nm (17 in lbs). 5. Install the lower fixed column shroud onto the steering
column. 6. Install both the upper and lower shrouds onto the steering column. 7. If the vehicle is so
equipped install the tilt lever onto the left side of the steering column. 8. Reconnect the battery
negative cable.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Specifications
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor Bracket Bolts 12 Nm
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 992
APPS Assembly, Lever, Mounting Bolts(6), Wire Harness Clip, Calibration Screws (No Adjustment)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 993
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR (APPS)-ECM INPUT
The Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) is a linear potentiometer. It provides the Engine
Control Module (ECM) with a DC voltage signal proportional to the angle, or position of the
accelerator pedal. In previous model years, this part was known as the Throttle Position Sensor
(TPS).
Diesel engines used in previous model years used a mechanical cable between the accelerator
pedal and the TPS lever. Linkage and bellcranks between the TPS cable lever and the fuel
injection pump were also used. Although the cable has been retained with the APPS, the linkage
and bellcranks between the cable lever and the fuel injection pump are no longer used.
APPS Assembly Location
APPS Sensor Location (Rear View)
The APPS assembly is located at the top-left-front of the engine. A plastic cover is used to cover
the assembly. The actual sensor is located behind its mounting bracket.
The APPS is serviced (replaced) as one assembly including the lever, brackets and sensor. The
APPS is calibrated and permanently positioned to its mounting bracket.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to remove sensor from its mounting bracket as electronic calibration will
be destroyed (sensor-to-bracket mounting screws are permanently attached). Two accelerator
lever set screws are used to position lever. Do not attempt to alter positions of these set screws as
electronic calibration will be destroyed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 994
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Cable/Lever/Linkage/Cover
The APPS is serviced (replaced) as one assembly including the lever, brackets and sensor. The
APPS is calibrated to its mounting bracket. The APPS assembly is located at left-front of engine
below plastic cable/lever/linkage cover.
APPS Assembly
CAUTION: Do not attempt to remove sensor from its mounting bracket as electronic calibration will
be destroyed (sensor-to-bracket mounting screws are permanently attached). Two accelerator
lever set screws are used to position lever. Do not attempt to alter positions of these set screws as
electronic calibration will be destroyed.
REMOVAL 1. Disconnect both negative battery cables at both batteries. 2. Remove cable cover.
Cable cover is attached with 2 Phillips screws, 2 plastic retention clips and 2 push tabs. Remove 2
Phillips screws and
carefully pry out 2 retention clips. After clip removal, push rearward on front tab, and upward on
lower tab for cover removal.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 995
Cables At Throttle Lever
3. Using finger pressure only, disconnect end of speed control servo cable from throttle lever pin by
pulling forward on connector while holding lever
rearward.DO NOT try to pull connector off perpendicular to lever pin. Connector will be broken.
4. Using two small screwdrivers, pry throttle cable connector socket from throttle lever ball. Be very
careful not to bend throttle lever arm. 5. Disconnect transmission control cable at lever arm (if
equipped). 6. Squeeze pinch tabs on speed control cable and pull cable rearward to remove from
cable mounting bracket. 7. Squeeze pinch tabs on throttle cable and pull cable rearward to remove
from cable mounting bracket. 8. If equipped with an automatic transmission, refer to Transmission
for transmission control cable removal procedures. 9. Disconnect wiring harness clip at bottom of
bracket.
Electrical Connector At Bottom Of APPS
10. Remove 6 mounting bolts and partially remove APPS assembly from engine. After assembly is
partially removed, disconnect electrical connector
from bottom of sensor by pushing on connector tab.
11. Remove APPS assembly from engine.
INSTALLATION 1. Snap electrical connector into bottom of sensor. 2. Position APPS assembly to
engine and install 6 bolts. Tighten bolts to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.) torque. 3. Connect wiring harness
clip at bottom of bracket. 4. If equipped with an automatic transmission, refer to Transmission for
transmission control cable installation procedures. 5. Install speed control cable into mounting
bracket. Be sure pinch tabs have secured cable. 6. Install throttle cable into mounting bracket. Be
sure pinch tabs have secured cable. 7. Connect throttle cable at lever (snaps on). 8. Connect
speed control cable to lever by pushing cable connector rearward onto lever pin while holding lever
forward. 9. Install cable cover.
10. Connect both negative battery cables to both batteries. 11. ECM Calibration: Turn key to ON
position. Without starting engine, slowly press throttle pedal to floor and then slowly release. This
step must be
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 996
done (one time) to ensure accelerator pedal position sensor calibration has been learned by ECM.
If not done, possible DTC's may be set.
12. Use DRB scan tool to erase any DTC's from ECM/PCM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Battery Temperature Sensor: Locations
Battery Temperature Sensor Location
The sensor is located under the battery and is attached (snapped into) the battery tray.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1000
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1001
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service Precautions
WARNING: TO PROTECT THE HANDS FROM BATTERY ACID, A SUITABLE PAIR OF HEAVY
DUTY RUBBER GLOVES, NOT THE HOUSEHOLD TYPE, SHOULD BE WORN WHEN
REMOVING OR SERVICING A BATTERY. SAFETY GLASSES ALSO SHOULD BE WORN
.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page
1002
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The battery temperature sensor is used to determine the battery temperature and control battery
charging rate. This temperature data, along with data from monitored line voltage, is used by the
PCM to vary the battery charging rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures and is
gradually reduced at warmer temperatures.
BATTERY TEMPERATURE SENSOR-PCM INPUT
Provides a signal to the PCM corresponding to the battery temperature.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Testing
Battery Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection Testing
To perform a complete test of this sensor and its circuitry, refer to the appropriate Powertrain
Diagnostic Procedures. To test the sensor only, refer to the following:
Battery Temperature Sensor Location
1. The sensor is located on the driver's side of the vehicle under the battery and is attached to
(snapped into) the battery tray. Only one sensor is used,
including vehicles with dual batteries (diesel engines). A two-wire pigtail harness is attached
directly to the sensor. The opposite end of this harness connects the sensor to the engine wiring
harness.
2. Disconnect the two-wire pigtail harness from the engine harness. 3. Attach ohmmeter leads to
the wire terminals of the pigtail harness. 4. At room temperature of 25° C (75-80° F), an ohmmeter
reading of 9,000 (9K) to 11,000 (11K) ohms should be observed. 5. If reading is above or below the
specification, replace the sensor. 6. Refer to the Replacement for procedures.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Battery Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Testing and
Inspection > Page 1005
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
Battery Temperature Sensor Location
The battery temperature sensor is located under the vehicle battery and is attached (snapped into)
a mounting hole on battery tray. Only one sensor is used (dual batteries). The sensor is located
under the battery on drivers side of vehicle.
REMOVAL
1. Remove battery. Refer to Battery for procedures 2. Disconnect sensor pigtail harness from
engine wire harness. 3. Pry sensor straight up from battery tray mounting hole.
INSTALLATION
1. Feed pigtail harness through mounting hole in top of battery tray and press sensor into top of
tray (snaps in). 2. Connect pigtail harness. 3. Install battery. Refer to Battery for procedures.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor: Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) Bolt 20 Nm
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1009
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) Location
The camshaft position sensor (CMP) is located below the fuel injection pump. It is attached to the
back of the timing gear cover housing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1010
Connector View
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1011
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (CMP)-ECM INPUT
Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP)
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) contains a hall effect device called a sync signal generator to
generate a sync signal.
The sync signal generator detects a machined hole on the rear face of the camshaft drive gear.
The signal is used to verify the position of the #1 cylinder during engine operation.
When the leading edge of the machined hole enters the tip of the CMP the interruption of magnetic
field causes the voltage to switch high resulting in a signal of approximately 5 volts.
When the trailing edge of the machined hole leaves the tip of the CMP the change of the magnetic
field causes the voltage to switch low to 0 volts.
Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) Location
The CMP is located below the fuel injection pump. It is attached to the back of the timing gear
cover housing.
The CMP is not used for any control of fuel system. It is used only for diagnostic purposes.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1012
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) Location
The camshaft position sensor (CMP) is located below the fuel injection pump. It is attached to the
back of the timing gear cover housing.
REMOVAL 1. Disconnect both negative cables from both batteries. 2. Clean area around CMP. 3.
Disconnect electrical at CMP.
Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) Removal/Installation
4. Remove CMP mounting bolt. Bolt head is female-hex. 5. Remove CMP from engine by twisting
and pulling straight back. 6. Discard CMP O-ring.
INSTALLATION 1. Install new O-ring to CMP. Apply clean engine oil to O-ring. 2. Clean area
around CMP mounting hole. 3. To prevent tearing O-ring, install CMP into gear housing using a
twisting action. 4. Install mounting bolt and tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.) torque. 5. Install electrical
connector to CMP. 6. Connect both negative cables to both batteries.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Specifications
Engine Coolant Temperature(ECT) Sensor 14 Nm
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1016
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Locations
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
The engine coolant temperature sensor is installed into the front of the cylinder head near to the
thermostat housing and protrudes into a water jacket.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1017
Connector View
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1018
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Description and Operation
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE (ECT) SENSOR-ECM INPUT
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
The engine coolant temperature sensor is installed into the front of the cylinder head near to the
thermostat housing and protrudes into a water jacket. The sensor provides an input voltage to the
Engine Control Module (ECM) to monitor coolant temperature. The ECM uses this input along with
inputs from other sensors for engine protection, fuel timing and fuel control. As coolant temperature
varies, the coolant temperature sensor resistance will change. This change in resistance results in
a different input voltage to the ECM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer) > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1019
Coolant Temperature Sensor/Switch (For Computer): Service and Repair
ECT Sensor Location
The Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) sensor is located at the front of the cylinder head near the
thermostat.
REMOVAL
WARNING: THE COOLING SYSTEM MAY BE UNDER PRESSURE. HOT COOLANT CAN
CAUSE BURNS.
1. Partially drain cooling system until coolant level is below cylinder head. 2. Disconnect ECT
sensor electrical connector from sensor.
ECT Sensor Removal/Installation
3. Remove ECT sensor from cylinder head. 4. Discard sensor O-ring.
INSTALLATION 1. Clean sensor mounting hole of rust or contaminants. 2. Install new O-ring to
sensor. Apply clean engine oil to sensor O-ring and sensor threads. 3. Install ECT sensor into
cylinder head. Tighten to 14 Nm (10 ft. lbs.) torque. 4. Connect sensor electrical connector. 5. fill
cooling system and check for coolant leaks.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Speed Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Engine Speed Sensor: Specifications
Sensor To Vibration Damper Air Gap
Minimum ..............................................................................................................................................
................................................ 1.25 mm (.049 in) Maximum ...............................................................
.............................................................................................................................. 1.30 mm (.051 in)
Torque
Engine Speed Sensor Nuts/Bolts
......................................................................................................................................................... 24
N.m (18 ft. lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Speed Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1023
Engine Speed Sensor: Locations
Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP) Location
The CKP sensor is located on the left rear side of engine block near the starter motor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Speed Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1024
Connector View
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Speed Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1025
Engine Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (CKP)-ECM INPUT
Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP) Location
The Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP) is located on the lower left-rear side of the engine behind
the starter motor.
Engine speed and crankshaft position are provided through the CKP. The sensor generates pulses
that are the input sent to the Engine Control Module (ECM). The ECM interprets the sensor input to
determine the crankshaft position. The ECM then uses this position, along with other inputs, to
determine injector firing sequence and fuel timing. The sensor must be powered up by 5 volts to
operate.
The sensor is a hall effect device combined with an internal magnet. It is also sensitive to steel
within a certain distance from it.
Crankshaft Tone Wheel
The engine crankshaft is equipped with a bolt-on tone wheel. The tone wheel is equipped with 35
teeth and a gap where the 36th tooth should be placed. This missing tooth indicates to the ECM
the relative position of cylinder #1 to the Top Dead Center (TDC) position. This does not mean that
cylinder #1 is at TDC. When the CKP is aligned with the missing tooth, the missing tooth is 60
degrees away from cylinder #1 TDC position. The teeth cause pulses to be generated when they
pass under the sensor. The pulses are the input to the ECM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Speed Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1026
Engine Speed Sensor: Testing and Inspection
The perform a complete test of this sensor and its circuitry. Refer to the DRB scan tool. Also refer
to the appropriate powertrain Diagnostics Procedures.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Engine Speed Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1027
Engine Speed Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
Crankshaft Position Sensor (CKP) Location
The CKP is located on the left/rear side of engine block near the starter motor.
1. Disconnect both negative battery cables at both batteries. 2. Remove starter motor. Refer to
Starter. 3. Disconnect electrical connector at CKP. 4. Remove CKP mounting bolt and hold down
bracket. 5. Pull CKP from engine block with a slight twisting action.
CKP Removal/Installation
6. Discard old CKP O-ring.
INSTALLATION
1. Install new O-ring to CKP Apply clean engine oil to O-ring. 2. Clean area around CKP mounting
hole. 3. To prevent tearing O-ring, install CKP into engine block using a twisting action. 4. Position
hold down bracket and install mounting bolt. 5. tighten bolt to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.) torque. 6. Install
starter motor. Refer to Starter. 7. Connect both negative battery cables at both batteries.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Specifications
Intake Manifold Air Temperature(IAT) Sensor 14 Nm
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 1031
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Locations
Intake Manifold Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Location
The intake manifold air temperature sensor is installed into the rear of the intake manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 1032
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 1033
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
INTAKE MANIFOLD AIR TEMPERATURE (IAT) SENSOR-ECM INPUT
The IAT provides an input voltage to the Engine Control Module (ECM) indicating intake manifold
air temperature. The input is used along with inputs from other sensors for engine protection, fuel
timing and fuel control. As the temperature of the air-fuel stream in the manifold varies, the sensor
resistance changes. This results in a different input voltage to the ECM.
Intake Manifold Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Location
The intake manifold air temperature sensor is installed into the rear of the intake manifold with the
sensor element extending into the air stream.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Intake Air Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 1034
Intake Air Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
IAT Sensor Location
The IAT sensor is located in the left/rear side of the intake manifold.
REMOVAL 1. Disconnect electrical connector from IAT sensor.
IAT Sensor Removal/Installation
2. Remove IAT sensor from intake manifold. 3. Discard sensor O-ring.
INSTALLATION 1. Clean sensor mounting hole of rust or contaminants. 2. Install new O-ring to
sensor. Apply clean engine oil to sensor O-ring and sensor threads. 3. Install IAT sensor into intake
manifold. tighten to 14 Nm (10 ft. lbs.) torque. 4. Connect sensor electrical connector.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Specifications
Manifold Air Pressure Sensor 14 Nm
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 1038
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Locations
MAP Sensor Location
The MAP sensor is installed into the rear of the intake manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 1039
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 1040
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Description and Operation
The MAP sensor reacts to air pressure changes in the intake manifold. It provides an input voltage
to the Engine Control Module (ECM). As pressure changes, MAP sensor voltage will change. The
change in MAP sensor voltage results in a different input voltage to the ECM. The ECM uses this
input, along with inputs from other sensors to provide fuel timing, fuel control and engine protection.
Engine protection is used to derate (drop power off) the engine if turbocharger pressure becomes
to high.
Intake Manifold Air Temperature (IAT) Sensor Location
The MAP sensor is installed into the rear of the intake manifold.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
> Page 1041
Manifold Pressure/Vacuum Sensor: Service and Repair
MAP Sensor Location
The MAP sensor is located in the left/rear side of the intake manifold.
REMOVAL 1. Disconnect electrical connector from MAP sensor.
MAP Sensor Removal/Installation
2. Remove MAP sensor from intake manifold. 3. Discard sensor O-ring.
INSTALLATION 1. Clean sensor mounting hole of rust or contaminants. 2. Install new O-ring to
sensor. Apply clean engine oil to sensor O-ring and sensor threads. 3. Install MAP sensor into
intake manifold. Tighten to 14 Nm (10 ft. lbs.) torque. 4. Connect sensor electrical connector.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Oil Pressure Sensor: Specifications
Oil Pressure Sender/Switch 12 ft.lb
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1045
Oil Pressure Sensor: Locations
Oil Pressure Sensor (Engine) Location
The oil pressure sensor is installed into the oil pressure galley on the engine block. It is located
below and to the rear of the ECM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1046
Oil Pressure Sensor: Diagrams
Engine Oil Pressure Sensor - 3 Way
Engine Oil Pressure Sensor (Diesel) - 3 Way
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1047
Oil Pressure Sensor: Description and Operation
A signal is sent from the engine oil pressure sensor (sending unit) to the Engine Control Module
(ECM) relating to engine oil pressure. The ECM monitors this signal and converts it to a pressure
value. This value is used by the ECM for the engine protection system.
The pressure signal from the ECM is bussed to the instrument panel oil gauge/lamp via the CCD
circuits.
Oil Pressure Sensor (Engine) Location
The oil pressure sensor is installed into the oil pressure galley on the engine block. It is located
below and to the rear of the ECM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Oil Pressure Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1048
Oil Pressure Sensor: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect the battery negative cables.
Oil Pressure Sensor Location
2. Disconnect the oil pressure sensor connector. 3. Using a suitable socket, remove the oil
pressure sensor from the block (counter-clockwise).
INSTALLATION
Oil Pressure Sensor And O-Ring
1. If the sensor is not being replaced, inspect the O-ring and replace if necessary. 2. Install the oil
pressure sensor and tighten to 16 Nm (144 inch lbs.) torque. 3. Connect the battery negative
cables. 4. Start engine and check for oil leaks at the sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Throttle Position Sensor: > 18-02-99 > Feb > 99 > Torque Converter Clutch - Erratic
Operation
Technical Service Bulletin # 18-02-99 Date: 990219
Torque Converter Clutch - Erratic Operation
NUMBER: 18-02-99
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Feb. 19, 1999
SUBJECT: Erratic Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Operation (5.9L Diesel Applications)
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software (calibration changes 98cal12 & 99cal14).
MODELS: 1998 - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 5.9L 24 VALVE DIESEL
ENGINE AND AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION BUILT BETWEEN JAN. 1, 1998 AND DEC. 18, 1998
(MDH 0101XX & 1218XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some vehicles may experience a surge like condition while in 4th gear. This may be caused by the
Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) unlocking and locking when it should be consistently locked. The
cause of this erratic operation has been identified as electrical noise from the Throttle Position
Sensor (TPS) or Alternator.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using the Mopar Diagnostic System (MDS/MDS2) and or the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRB III(R))
with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all engine/transmission systems are
functioning as designed. If Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) are present, record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
Verify the condition by creating a custom display in the DRB III(R) and include the following:
SENSORS (Output Shaft Speed, TPS Volts, Trans Temp Degree) & INPUTS/OUTPUTS (Brake
Switch, Park/Neutral, ASD Relay Sense, Desired TC Clutch).
Drive the vehicle with a helper monitoring the DRB III(R). Warm the engine and verify the
transmission fluid temperature is greater than 32°F and consistent. Operate the vehicle with an
output shaft speed greater than 2200 rpm. Verify that the brake switch shows a released status that
is consistent and verify the park/neutral status reads D/R and is consistent. While keeping the
output shaft speed above 2200 rpm, hold the throttle so the TPS reads 1 volt. Monitor the TC clutch
status, it should be consistently locked. If the TC clutch status shows unlocking/locking, look to see
if the TPS volts are fluctuating by 0.2 volts or more. It the conditions are met, perform the Repair
Procedure. If a surge like condition is felt but the above test does not confirm the TCC
unlocking/locking occurrence, further diagnosis and testing will be required.
NOTE:
WHENEVER A POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) IS REPLACED DUE TO FAILURE,
THE SOFTWARE OF THE REPLACEMENT CONTROLLER MUST BE VERIFIED FOR THE
LATEST REVISION LEVEL. USE THE FLASH PROCEDURE TO UPDATE REPLACED
CONTROLLERS AS NECESSARY.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04669020 Label, Authorized Software Update
1 04275086 Label, Authorized Modification
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
1 CH6000 Scan Tool (DRB III(R))
1 CH7035 General Purpose Interface Bus Cable (GPIB)
1 CH7000/7001 J1962 Cable
1 MDS1 or MDS2
NOTE:
THE MDS1/MDS2 AND DRB III(R) ARE REQUIRED TO PERFORM PART OF THIS REPAIR. IF
USING THE MDS1 AND DRB III(R) THE MDS MUST BE OPERATING AT RELEASE 21 OR
HIGHER AND TIL CD RELEASE 1179 OR HIGHER MUST BE INSTALLED. IF USING THE MDS2
AND DRB III(R) THE SYSTEM MUST BE OPERATING AT CIS CD2030 OR HIGHER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Throttle Position Sensor: > 18-02-99 > Feb > 99 > Torque Converter Clutch - Erratic
Operation > Page 1057
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-19-42-95 0.5 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: FM - Flash Module
MDS1 Procedure
1. Connect the MDS1 (Mopar Diagnostic System) and DRB III(R) (Scan Tool) to the vehicle and
power them up.
2. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 CONNECT TO MDS1 OR MDS2 on the DRB III(R) MAIN
MENU SCREEN.
3. Use the arrow keys and select MDS DIAGNOSTICS OR DRB III(R) UPDATE on the DRB III(R)
MAIN MENU SCREEN.
4. Use the arrow keys and select DIAGNOSTIC MENU on the MDS1, then press NEXT MENU.
5. Use the arrow keys and select VEHICLE CONTROLLER PROGRAMMING on the MDS1, then
press NEXT MENU.
6. Use the arrow keys and select PROGRAMMING OF ALL OTHER CONTROLLERS USING THE
MDS1 & DRB III(R) on the MDS, then press NEXT MENU.
7. Follow the steps presented on the MDS1 and DRB III(R) that will allow the DRB III(R) to obtain
the current part number of the PCM.
8. The MDS1 will display the vehicle's PCM part number and the replacement part number(s).
Press NEXT MENU to begin programming.
NOTE:
A NO UPDATES AVAILABLE MESSAGE MAY BE DISPLAYED. CHECK THE PCM PART
NUMBER ON THE VEHICLE AND COMPARE IT TO THE PART NUMBER DISPLAYED ON THE
MDS. IF NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, FIRST CHECK YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT
FOR THE LATEST SOFTWARE LEVELS AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN. IF THE
LATEST SOFTWARE IS INSTALLED, ANOTHER VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS THAT WILL
REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
9. The MDS1 and DRB III(R) will prompt for any operator action needed during the remainder of
the reprogramming process.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
10. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020
(Figure 1). Attach the label to the PCM and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Throttle Position Sensor: > 18-02-99 > Feb > 99 > Torque Converter Clutch - Erratic
Operation > Page 1058
11. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086 and
attach the label near the VECI label (Figure 2).
MDS2 Procedures
1. Log onto the MDS2 system.
2. Connect the MDS2 (Mopar Diagnostic System) and DRB III(R) (Scan Tool) to the vehicle and
switch the ignition key to "ON".
3. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 CONNECT TO MDS1 OR MDS2 on the DRB III(R) MAIN
MENU SCREEN.
4. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 RUN MDS2 APPLICATION on the DRB III(R) MAIN MENU
SCREEN.
NOTE:
ONCE MDS2, DRB III(R), AND VEHICLE COMMUNICATION HAS BEEN ESTABLISHED, THE
CANNOT READ VIN FROM DRB III(R) MESSAGE (ON THE MDS2) WILL BE REPLACED BY
THE VEHICLE VIN. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON ON THE MDS2 TO REQUEST A MDS2
SESSION FOR THE VEHICLE VIN INDICATED. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON WHEN ASKED TO
BEGIN SESSION.
5. Push the FLASH tab on the MDS2.
NOTE:
A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS
OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST
SOFTWARE LEVEL AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN. IF THE LATEST SOFTWARE IS
INSTALLED, AND NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, ANOTHER VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS
THAT WILL REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
6. Select READ PART NUMBERS FROM VEHICLE and click SHOW UPDATES on the MDS2.
NOTE:
A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS
OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST
SOFTWARE LEVEL AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN. IF THE LATEST SOFTWARE IS
INSTALLED, AND NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, ANOTHER VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS
THAT WILL REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
7. Select the new software part number with the light pen and click UPDATE CONTROLLER
SOFTWARE.
8. The MDS2 and DRB III(R) will prompt for any operator action needed during the remainder of
the reprogramming process.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020
(Figure 1). Attach the label to the PCM and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
10. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086 and
attach the label near the VECI label (Figure 2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Throttle Position Sensor: > 18-02-99 > Feb > 99 > Torque Converter Clutch Erratic Operation
Technical Service Bulletin # 18-02-99 Date: 990219
Torque Converter Clutch - Erratic Operation
NUMBER: 18-02-99
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Feb. 19, 1999
SUBJECT: Erratic Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Operation (5.9L Diesel Applications)
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software (calibration changes 98cal12 & 99cal14).
MODELS: 1998 - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 5.9L 24 VALVE DIESEL
ENGINE AND AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION BUILT BETWEEN JAN. 1, 1998 AND DEC. 18, 1998
(MDH 0101XX & 1218XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some vehicles may experience a surge like condition while in 4th gear. This may be caused by the
Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) unlocking and locking when it should be consistently locked. The
cause of this erratic operation has been identified as electrical noise from the Throttle Position
Sensor (TPS) or Alternator.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using the Mopar Diagnostic System (MDS/MDS2) and or the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRB III(R))
with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all engine/transmission systems are
functioning as designed. If Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) are present, record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
Verify the condition by creating a custom display in the DRB III(R) and include the following:
SENSORS (Output Shaft Speed, TPS Volts, Trans Temp Degree) & INPUTS/OUTPUTS (Brake
Switch, Park/Neutral, ASD Relay Sense, Desired TC Clutch).
Drive the vehicle with a helper monitoring the DRB III(R). Warm the engine and verify the
transmission fluid temperature is greater than 32°F and consistent. Operate the vehicle with an
output shaft speed greater than 2200 rpm. Verify that the brake switch shows a released status that
is consistent and verify the park/neutral status reads D/R and is consistent. While keeping the
output shaft speed above 2200 rpm, hold the throttle so the TPS reads 1 volt. Monitor the TC clutch
status, it should be consistently locked. If the TC clutch status shows unlocking/locking, look to see
if the TPS volts are fluctuating by 0.2 volts or more. It the conditions are met, perform the Repair
Procedure. If a surge like condition is felt but the above test does not confirm the TCC
unlocking/locking occurrence, further diagnosis and testing will be required.
NOTE:
WHENEVER A POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) IS REPLACED DUE TO FAILURE,
THE SOFTWARE OF THE REPLACEMENT CONTROLLER MUST BE VERIFIED FOR THE
LATEST REVISION LEVEL. USE THE FLASH PROCEDURE TO UPDATE REPLACED
CONTROLLERS AS NECESSARY.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04669020 Label, Authorized Software Update
1 04275086 Label, Authorized Modification
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
1 CH6000 Scan Tool (DRB III(R))
1 CH7035 General Purpose Interface Bus Cable (GPIB)
1 CH7000/7001 J1962 Cable
1 MDS1 or MDS2
NOTE:
THE MDS1/MDS2 AND DRB III(R) ARE REQUIRED TO PERFORM PART OF THIS REPAIR. IF
USING THE MDS1 AND DRB III(R) THE MDS MUST BE OPERATING AT RELEASE 21 OR
HIGHER AND TIL CD RELEASE 1179 OR HIGHER MUST BE INSTALLED. IF USING THE MDS2
AND DRB III(R) THE SYSTEM MUST BE OPERATING AT CIS CD2030 OR HIGHER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Throttle Position Sensor: > 18-02-99 > Feb > 99 > Torque Converter Clutch Erratic Operation > Page 1064
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-19-42-95 0.5 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: FM - Flash Module
MDS1 Procedure
1. Connect the MDS1 (Mopar Diagnostic System) and DRB III(R) (Scan Tool) to the vehicle and
power them up.
2. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 CONNECT TO MDS1 OR MDS2 on the DRB III(R) MAIN
MENU SCREEN.
3. Use the arrow keys and select MDS DIAGNOSTICS OR DRB III(R) UPDATE on the DRB III(R)
MAIN MENU SCREEN.
4. Use the arrow keys and select DIAGNOSTIC MENU on the MDS1, then press NEXT MENU.
5. Use the arrow keys and select VEHICLE CONTROLLER PROGRAMMING on the MDS1, then
press NEXT MENU.
6. Use the arrow keys and select PROGRAMMING OF ALL OTHER CONTROLLERS USING THE
MDS1 & DRB III(R) on the MDS, then press NEXT MENU.
7. Follow the steps presented on the MDS1 and DRB III(R) that will allow the DRB III(R) to obtain
the current part number of the PCM.
8. The MDS1 will display the vehicle's PCM part number and the replacement part number(s).
Press NEXT MENU to begin programming.
NOTE:
A NO UPDATES AVAILABLE MESSAGE MAY BE DISPLAYED. CHECK THE PCM PART
NUMBER ON THE VEHICLE AND COMPARE IT TO THE PART NUMBER DISPLAYED ON THE
MDS. IF NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, FIRST CHECK YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT
FOR THE LATEST SOFTWARE LEVELS AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN. IF THE
LATEST SOFTWARE IS INSTALLED, ANOTHER VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS THAT WILL
REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
9. The MDS1 and DRB III(R) will prompt for any operator action needed during the remainder of
the reprogramming process.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
10. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020
(Figure 1). Attach the label to the PCM and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Throttle Position Sensor: > 18-02-99 > Feb > 99 > Torque Converter Clutch Erratic Operation > Page 1065
11. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086 and
attach the label near the VECI label (Figure 2).
MDS2 Procedures
1. Log onto the MDS2 system.
2. Connect the MDS2 (Mopar Diagnostic System) and DRB III(R) (Scan Tool) to the vehicle and
switch the ignition key to "ON".
3. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 CONNECT TO MDS1 OR MDS2 on the DRB III(R) MAIN
MENU SCREEN.
4. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 RUN MDS2 APPLICATION on the DRB III(R) MAIN MENU
SCREEN.
NOTE:
ONCE MDS2, DRB III(R), AND VEHICLE COMMUNICATION HAS BEEN ESTABLISHED, THE
CANNOT READ VIN FROM DRB III(R) MESSAGE (ON THE MDS2) WILL BE REPLACED BY
THE VEHICLE VIN. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON ON THE MDS2 TO REQUEST A MDS2
SESSION FOR THE VEHICLE VIN INDICATED. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON WHEN ASKED TO
BEGIN SESSION.
5. Push the FLASH tab on the MDS2.
NOTE:
A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS
OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST
SOFTWARE LEVEL AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN. IF THE LATEST SOFTWARE IS
INSTALLED, AND NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, ANOTHER VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS
THAT WILL REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
6. Select READ PART NUMBERS FROM VEHICLE and click SHOW UPDATES on the MDS2.
NOTE:
A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS
OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST
SOFTWARE LEVEL AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN. IF THE LATEST SOFTWARE IS
INSTALLED, AND NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, ANOTHER VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS
THAT WILL REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
7. Select the new software part number with the light pen and click UPDATE CONTROLLER
SOFTWARE.
8. The MDS2 and DRB III(R) will prompt for any operator action needed during the remainder of
the reprogramming process.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020
(Figure 1). Attach the label to the PCM and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
10. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086 and
attach the label near the VECI label (Figure 2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1066
Throttle Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Refer to Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information >
Locations > Page 1070
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Park/Neutral Position Switch
1. Raise vehicle and position drain pan under switch.
2. Disconnect switch wires.
3. Remove switch from case.
4. Move shift lever to Park and Neutral positions. Verify that switch operating lever fingers are
centered in switch opening in case.
5. Install new seal on switch and install switch in case. Tighten switch to 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.) torque.
6. Test continuity of new switch with 12V test lamp.
7. Connect switch wires and lower vehicle.
8. Top off transmission fluid level.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1075
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1076
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1077
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1078
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1079
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1080
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1081
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1082
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1083
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1084
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1085
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1086
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1087
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1088
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1089
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1090
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1091
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram
Information and Instructions > Page 1092
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Computers and Control Systems > Vehicle Speed Sensor > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1093
Vehicle Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
The Vehicle Speed Sensor (VSS) is no longer used for any Dodge Truck.
Vehicle speed and distance covered are measured by the Rear Wheel Speed Sensor. The sensor
is mounted to the rear axle. A signal is sent from this sensor to the Controller Antilock Brake (CAB)
computer. A signal is then sent from the CAB to the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) to determine
vehicle speed and distance covered. The PCM will then determine strategies for speed control
system operation.
Testing for the Rear Wheel Speed Sensor can be found at Antilock Brakes / Traction Control
Systems. See: Brakes and Traction Control/Antilock Brakes / Traction Control Systems/Testing and
Inspection
All other testing for the Vehicle Speed Signal can be found at Computers and Control Systems.
See: Powertrain Management/Computers and Control Systems/Testing and Inspection
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Specifications
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor Bracket Bolts 12 Nm
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 1098
APPS Assembly, Lever, Mounting Bolts(6), Wire Harness Clip, Calibration Screws (No Adjustment)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 1099
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Description and Operation
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR (APPS)-ECM INPUT
The Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor (APPS) is a linear potentiometer. It provides the Engine
Control Module (ECM) with a DC voltage signal proportional to the angle, or position of the
accelerator pedal. In previous model years, this part was known as the Throttle Position Sensor
(TPS).
Diesel engines used in previous model years used a mechanical cable between the accelerator
pedal and the TPS lever. Linkage and bellcranks between the TPS cable lever and the fuel
injection pump were also used. Although the cable has been retained with the APPS, the linkage
and bellcranks between the cable lever and the fuel injection pump are no longer used.
APPS Assembly Location
APPS Sensor Location (Rear View)
The APPS assembly is located at the top-left-front of the engine. A plastic cover is used to cover
the assembly. The actual sensor is located behind its mounting bracket.
The APPS is serviced (replaced) as one assembly including the lever, brackets and sensor. The
APPS is calibrated and permanently positioned to its mounting bracket.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to remove sensor from its mounting bracket as electronic calibration will
be destroyed (sensor-to-bracket mounting screws are permanently attached). Two accelerator
lever set screws are used to position lever. Do not attempt to alter positions of these set screws as
electronic calibration will be destroyed.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 1100
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Cable/Lever/Linkage/Cover
The APPS is serviced (replaced) as one assembly including the lever, brackets and sensor. The
APPS is calibrated to its mounting bracket. The APPS assembly is located at left-front of engine
below plastic cable/lever/linkage cover.
APPS Assembly
CAUTION: Do not attempt to remove sensor from its mounting bracket as electronic calibration will
be destroyed (sensor-to-bracket mounting screws are permanently attached). Two accelerator
lever set screws are used to position lever. Do not attempt to alter positions of these set screws as
electronic calibration will be destroyed.
REMOVAL 1. Disconnect both negative battery cables at both batteries. 2. Remove cable cover.
Cable cover is attached with 2 Phillips screws, 2 plastic retention clips and 2 push tabs. Remove 2
Phillips screws and
carefully pry out 2 retention clips. After clip removal, push rearward on front tab, and upward on
lower tab for cover removal.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 1101
Cables At Throttle Lever
3. Using finger pressure only, disconnect end of speed control servo cable from throttle lever pin by
pulling forward on connector while holding lever
rearward.DO NOT try to pull connector off perpendicular to lever pin. Connector will be broken.
4. Using two small screwdrivers, pry throttle cable connector socket from throttle lever ball. Be very
careful not to bend throttle lever arm. 5. Disconnect transmission control cable at lever arm (if
equipped). 6. Squeeze pinch tabs on speed control cable and pull cable rearward to remove from
cable mounting bracket. 7. Squeeze pinch tabs on throttle cable and pull cable rearward to remove
from cable mounting bracket. 8. If equipped with an automatic transmission, refer to Transmission
for transmission control cable removal procedures. 9. Disconnect wiring harness clip at bottom of
bracket.
Electrical Connector At Bottom Of APPS
10. Remove 6 mounting bolts and partially remove APPS assembly from engine. After assembly is
partially removed, disconnect electrical connector
from bottom of sensor by pushing on connector tab.
11. Remove APPS assembly from engine.
INSTALLATION 1. Snap electrical connector into bottom of sensor. 2. Position APPS assembly to
engine and install 6 bolts. Tighten bolts to 12 Nm (105 in. lbs.) torque. 3. Connect wiring harness
clip at bottom of bracket. 4. If equipped with an automatic transmission, refer to Transmission for
transmission control cable installation procedures. 5. Install speed control cable into mounting
bracket. Be sure pinch tabs have secured cable. 6. Install throttle cable into mounting bracket. Be
sure pinch tabs have secured cable. 7. Connect throttle cable at lever (snaps on). 8. Connect
speed control cable to lever by pushing cable connector rearward onto lever pin while holding lever
forward. 9. Install cable cover.
10. Connect both negative battery cables to both batteries. 11. ECM Calibration: Turn key to ON
position. Without starting engine, slowly press throttle pedal to floor and then slowly release. This
step must be
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications >
Page 1102
done (one time) to ensure accelerator pedal position sensor calibration has been learned by ECM.
If not done, possible DTC's may be set.
12. Use DRB scan tool to erase any DTC's from ECM/PCM.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Locations
One of the sensors is located inside of the Bosch VP44 fuel injection pump. The other fuel
temperature sensor is located in the top of the fuel filter housing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Fuel Temperature Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1106
Fuel Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
Two different fuel temperature sensors are used. One of the sensors is located inside of the Bosch
VP44 fuel injection pump and is a non-serviceable part. It is used to check fuel temperature within
the injection pump and to set a Diagnostic Trouble Code (DTC) if a specific high fuel temperature
has been reached. If high temperature has been reached, engine power will be de-rated by the
Engine Control Module (ECM).
The other fuel temperature sensor is located in the top of the fuel filter housing and is serviceable
(serviceable if replacing the fuel heater). It is used to control the fuel heater element. Refer to Fuel
Heater Description and Operation for additional information.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-02-99 > Feb > 99 > Torque Converter Clutch - Erratic Operation
Technical Service Bulletin # 18-02-99 Date: 990219
Torque Converter Clutch - Erratic Operation
NUMBER: 18-02-99
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Feb. 19, 1999
SUBJECT: Erratic Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Operation (5.9L Diesel Applications)
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software (calibration changes 98cal12 & 99cal14).
MODELS: 1998 - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 5.9L 24 VALVE DIESEL
ENGINE AND AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION BUILT BETWEEN JAN. 1, 1998 AND DEC. 18, 1998
(MDH 0101XX & 1218XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some vehicles may experience a surge like condition while in 4th gear. This may be caused by the
Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) unlocking and locking when it should be consistently locked. The
cause of this erratic operation has been identified as electrical noise from the Throttle Position
Sensor (TPS) or Alternator.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using the Mopar Diagnostic System (MDS/MDS2) and or the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRB III(R))
with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all engine/transmission systems are
functioning as designed. If Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) are present, record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
Verify the condition by creating a custom display in the DRB III(R) and include the following:
SENSORS (Output Shaft Speed, TPS Volts, Trans Temp Degree) & INPUTS/OUTPUTS (Brake
Switch, Park/Neutral, ASD Relay Sense, Desired TC Clutch).
Drive the vehicle with a helper monitoring the DRB III(R). Warm the engine and verify the
transmission fluid temperature is greater than 32°F and consistent. Operate the vehicle with an
output shaft speed greater than 2200 rpm. Verify that the brake switch shows a released status that
is consistent and verify the park/neutral status reads D/R and is consistent. While keeping the
output shaft speed above 2200 rpm, hold the throttle so the TPS reads 1 volt. Monitor the TC clutch
status, it should be consistently locked. If the TC clutch status shows unlocking/locking, look to see
if the TPS volts are fluctuating by 0.2 volts or more. It the conditions are met, perform the Repair
Procedure. If a surge like condition is felt but the above test does not confirm the TCC
unlocking/locking occurrence, further diagnosis and testing will be required.
NOTE:
WHENEVER A POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) IS REPLACED DUE TO FAILURE,
THE SOFTWARE OF THE REPLACEMENT CONTROLLER MUST BE VERIFIED FOR THE
LATEST REVISION LEVEL. USE THE FLASH PROCEDURE TO UPDATE REPLACED
CONTROLLERS AS NECESSARY.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04669020 Label, Authorized Software Update
1 04275086 Label, Authorized Modification
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
1 CH6000 Scan Tool (DRB III(R))
1 CH7035 General Purpose Interface Bus Cable (GPIB)
1 CH7000/7001 J1962 Cable
1 MDS1 or MDS2
NOTE:
THE MDS1/MDS2 AND DRB III(R) ARE REQUIRED TO PERFORM PART OF THIS REPAIR. IF
USING THE MDS1 AND DRB III(R) THE MDS MUST BE OPERATING AT RELEASE 21 OR
HIGHER AND TIL CD RELEASE 1179 OR HIGHER MUST BE INSTALLED. IF USING THE MDS2
AND DRB III(R) THE SYSTEM MUST BE OPERATING AT CIS CD2030 OR HIGHER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-02-99 > Feb > 99 > Torque Converter Clutch - Erratic Operation > Page 1115
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-19-42-95 0.5 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: FM - Flash Module
MDS1 Procedure
1. Connect the MDS1 (Mopar Diagnostic System) and DRB III(R) (Scan Tool) to the vehicle and
power them up.
2. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 CONNECT TO MDS1 OR MDS2 on the DRB III(R) MAIN
MENU SCREEN.
3. Use the arrow keys and select MDS DIAGNOSTICS OR DRB III(R) UPDATE on the DRB III(R)
MAIN MENU SCREEN.
4. Use the arrow keys and select DIAGNOSTIC MENU on the MDS1, then press NEXT MENU.
5. Use the arrow keys and select VEHICLE CONTROLLER PROGRAMMING on the MDS1, then
press NEXT MENU.
6. Use the arrow keys and select PROGRAMMING OF ALL OTHER CONTROLLERS USING THE
MDS1 & DRB III(R) on the MDS, then press NEXT MENU.
7. Follow the steps presented on the MDS1 and DRB III(R) that will allow the DRB III(R) to obtain
the current part number of the PCM.
8. The MDS1 will display the vehicle's PCM part number and the replacement part number(s).
Press NEXT MENU to begin programming.
NOTE:
A NO UPDATES AVAILABLE MESSAGE MAY BE DISPLAYED. CHECK THE PCM PART
NUMBER ON THE VEHICLE AND COMPARE IT TO THE PART NUMBER DISPLAYED ON THE
MDS. IF NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, FIRST CHECK YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT
FOR THE LATEST SOFTWARE LEVELS AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN. IF THE
LATEST SOFTWARE IS INSTALLED, ANOTHER VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS THAT WILL
REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
9. The MDS1 and DRB III(R) will prompt for any operator action needed during the remainder of
the reprogramming process.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
10. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020
(Figure 1). Attach the label to the PCM and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest: > 18-02-99 > Feb > 99 > Torque Converter Clutch - Erratic Operation > Page 1116
11. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086 and
attach the label near the VECI label (Figure 2).
MDS2 Procedures
1. Log onto the MDS2 system.
2. Connect the MDS2 (Mopar Diagnostic System) and DRB III(R) (Scan Tool) to the vehicle and
switch the ignition key to "ON".
3. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 CONNECT TO MDS1 OR MDS2 on the DRB III(R) MAIN
MENU SCREEN.
4. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 RUN MDS2 APPLICATION on the DRB III(R) MAIN MENU
SCREEN.
NOTE:
ONCE MDS2, DRB III(R), AND VEHICLE COMMUNICATION HAS BEEN ESTABLISHED, THE
CANNOT READ VIN FROM DRB III(R) MESSAGE (ON THE MDS2) WILL BE REPLACED BY
THE VEHICLE VIN. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON ON THE MDS2 TO REQUEST A MDS2
SESSION FOR THE VEHICLE VIN INDICATED. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON WHEN ASKED TO
BEGIN SESSION.
5. Push the FLASH tab on the MDS2.
NOTE:
A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS
OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST
SOFTWARE LEVEL AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN. IF THE LATEST SOFTWARE IS
INSTALLED, AND NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, ANOTHER VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS
THAT WILL REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
6. Select READ PART NUMBERS FROM VEHICLE and click SHOW UPDATES on the MDS2.
NOTE:
A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS
OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST
SOFTWARE LEVEL AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN. IF THE LATEST SOFTWARE IS
INSTALLED, AND NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, ANOTHER VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS
THAT WILL REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
7. Select the new software part number with the light pen and click UPDATE CONTROLLER
SOFTWARE.
8. The MDS2 and DRB III(R) will prompt for any operator action needed during the remainder of
the reprogramming process.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020
(Figure 1). Attach the label to the PCM and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
10. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086 and
attach the label near the VECI label (Figure 2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-04-98 > Sep > 98 > Accessory Drive Belt - Noisy/Damaged
Drive Belt: All Technical Service Bulletins Accessory Drive Belt - Noisy/Damaged
NO: 09-04-98
GROUP: Engine
DATE: Sep. 25, 1998
SUBJECT: Accessory Drive Belt Noise Or Damage/Crank Pulley Bolt Loose
MODELS: 1994 - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AN 8.0L ENGINE.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some vehicles may exhibit a condition where the accessory drive belt becomes damaged on the
inboard edge. Customers may explain the problem as belt noise. This may be caused by the crank
pulley loosening on the crank and causing a misalignment.
DIAGNOSIS:
Inspect the accessory drive belt for fraying or unusual wear on the inboard edge. If wear is noted,
inspect the crank pulley bolt for looseness and the crank pulley for misalignment. Sight the crank
pulley with other accessory drives or use a straight edge to detect misalignment. If the crank pulley
is misaligned or bolt is loose, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 53041067 Belt, Accessory Drive 1994 - 1996 Models W/AC Federal
1 53041163 Belt, Accessory Drive 1994 - 1996 Models W/AC California
1 53041068 Belt, Accessory Drive 1994 - 1996 Models WO/AC Federal
1 53041164 Belt, Accessory Drive 1994 - 1996 Models WO/AC California
1 53041116 Belt, Accessory Drive 1997 - 1999 Models WO/AC Federal
1 53041117 Belt, Accessory Drive 1997 - 1999 Models WO/AC California
1 53041115 Belt, Accessory Drive 1997 - 1999 Models W/AC All
1 04318032 Adhesive, Stud and Bearing Mount
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves removing the crank pulley bolt, checking the press fit of the pulley, reinstalling
the bolt using thread locker, and replacing the accessory drive belt.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the accessory drive belt following service manual procedures.
3. Drain and remove the radiator following all service manual warnings/cautions and procedures.
NOTE:
DRAIN THE COOLANT INTO A CLEAN DRAIN PAN.
4. Remove the bolt attaching the crankshaft pulley damper to the crankshaft.
5. Using your hands, pull on the crankshaft pulley damper to test the press fit to the crank shaft.
The pulley should be tight and not come off the crank with hand pressure.
NOTE:
IF THE CRANK PULLEY DAMPER IS LOOSE (NO PRESS FIT) REPLACE THE CRANK PULLEY
DAMPER WITH P/N 53020776.
6. Use Miller Tool C-3688 and fully press the crankshaft pulley damper onto the crankshaft.
7. Add thread locker p/n 04318032 to the end 3 or 4 threads of the crank pulley bolt.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-04-98 > Sep > 98 > Accessory Drive Belt - Noisy/Damaged > Page 1122
8. Install the bolt and torque it to 312 Nm (230 ft. lbs.).
NOTE:
USE A BAR TO LOCK THE PULLEY IN PLACE WHILE TIGHTENING.
9. Install a new accessory drive belt following service manual procedures.
10. Reinstall the radiator following service manual procedures.
11. Reinstall the negative battery cable.
12. Fill the cooling system with the saved coolant and operate the vehicle to purge air from the
system. Top off the automatic transmission fluid (if required).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 09-25-25-90 1.5 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Throttle Position Sensor: > 08-32-99 > Oct > 99 > Customer Interest for Throttle
Position Sensor: > 18-02-99 > Feb > 99 > Torque Converter Clutch - Erratic Operation
Technical Service Bulletin # 18-02-99 Date: 990219
Torque Converter Clutch - Erratic Operation
NUMBER: 18-02-99
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Feb. 19, 1999
SUBJECT: Erratic Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Operation (5.9L Diesel Applications)
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software (calibration changes 98cal12 & 99cal14).
MODELS: 1998 - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 5.9L 24 VALVE DIESEL
ENGINE AND AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION BUILT BETWEEN JAN. 1, 1998 AND DEC. 18, 1998
(MDH 0101XX & 1218XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some vehicles may experience a surge like condition while in 4th gear. This may be caused by the
Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) unlocking and locking when it should be consistently locked. The
cause of this erratic operation has been identified as electrical noise from the Throttle Position
Sensor (TPS) or Alternator.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using the Mopar Diagnostic System (MDS/MDS2) and or the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRB III(R))
with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all engine/transmission systems are
functioning as designed. If Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) are present, record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
Verify the condition by creating a custom display in the DRB III(R) and include the following:
SENSORS (Output Shaft Speed, TPS Volts, Trans Temp Degree) & INPUTS/OUTPUTS (Brake
Switch, Park/Neutral, ASD Relay Sense, Desired TC Clutch).
Drive the vehicle with a helper monitoring the DRB III(R). Warm the engine and verify the
transmission fluid temperature is greater than 32°F and consistent. Operate the vehicle with an
output shaft speed greater than 2200 rpm. Verify that the brake switch shows a released status that
is consistent and verify the park/neutral status reads D/R and is consistent. While keeping the
output shaft speed above 2200 rpm, hold the throttle so the TPS reads 1 volt. Monitor the TC clutch
status, it should be consistently locked. If the TC clutch status shows unlocking/locking, look to see
if the TPS volts are fluctuating by 0.2 volts or more. It the conditions are met, perform the Repair
Procedure. If a surge like condition is felt but the above test does not confirm the TCC
unlocking/locking occurrence, further diagnosis and testing will be required.
NOTE:
WHENEVER A POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) IS REPLACED DUE TO FAILURE,
THE SOFTWARE OF THE REPLACEMENT CONTROLLER MUST BE VERIFIED FOR THE
LATEST REVISION LEVEL. USE THE FLASH PROCEDURE TO UPDATE REPLACED
CONTROLLERS AS NECESSARY.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04669020 Label, Authorized Software Update
1 04275086 Label, Authorized Modification
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
1 CH6000 Scan Tool (DRB III(R))
1 CH7035 General Purpose Interface Bus Cable (GPIB)
1 CH7000/7001 J1962 Cable
1 MDS1 or MDS2
NOTE:
THE MDS1/MDS2 AND DRB III(R) ARE REQUIRED TO PERFORM PART OF THIS REPAIR. IF
USING THE MDS1 AND DRB III(R) THE MDS MUST BE OPERATING AT RELEASE 21 OR
HIGHER AND TIL CD RELEASE 1179 OR HIGHER MUST BE INSTALLED. IF USING THE MDS2
AND DRB III(R) THE SYSTEM MUST BE OPERATING AT CIS CD2030 OR HIGHER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Throttle Position Sensor: > 08-32-99 > Oct > 99 > Customer Interest for Throttle
Position Sensor: > 18-02-99 > Feb > 99 > Torque Converter Clutch - Erratic Operation > Page 1132
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-19-42-95 0.5 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: FM - Flash Module
MDS1 Procedure
1. Connect the MDS1 (Mopar Diagnostic System) and DRB III(R) (Scan Tool) to the vehicle and
power them up.
2. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 CONNECT TO MDS1 OR MDS2 on the DRB III(R) MAIN
MENU SCREEN.
3. Use the arrow keys and select MDS DIAGNOSTICS OR DRB III(R) UPDATE on the DRB III(R)
MAIN MENU SCREEN.
4. Use the arrow keys and select DIAGNOSTIC MENU on the MDS1, then press NEXT MENU.
5. Use the arrow keys and select VEHICLE CONTROLLER PROGRAMMING on the MDS1, then
press NEXT MENU.
6. Use the arrow keys and select PROGRAMMING OF ALL OTHER CONTROLLERS USING THE
MDS1 & DRB III(R) on the MDS, then press NEXT MENU.
7. Follow the steps presented on the MDS1 and DRB III(R) that will allow the DRB III(R) to obtain
the current part number of the PCM.
8. The MDS1 will display the vehicle's PCM part number and the replacement part number(s).
Press NEXT MENU to begin programming.
NOTE:
A NO UPDATES AVAILABLE MESSAGE MAY BE DISPLAYED. CHECK THE PCM PART
NUMBER ON THE VEHICLE AND COMPARE IT TO THE PART NUMBER DISPLAYED ON THE
MDS. IF NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, FIRST CHECK YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT
FOR THE LATEST SOFTWARE LEVELS AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN. IF THE
LATEST SOFTWARE IS INSTALLED, ANOTHER VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS THAT WILL
REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
9. The MDS1 and DRB III(R) will prompt for any operator action needed during the remainder of
the reprogramming process.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
10. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020
(Figure 1). Attach the label to the PCM and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Throttle Position Sensor: > 08-32-99 > Oct > 99 > Customer Interest for Throttle
Position Sensor: > 18-02-99 > Feb > 99 > Torque Converter Clutch - Erratic Operation > Page 1133
11. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086 and
attach the label near the VECI label (Figure 2).
MDS2 Procedures
1. Log onto the MDS2 system.
2. Connect the MDS2 (Mopar Diagnostic System) and DRB III(R) (Scan Tool) to the vehicle and
switch the ignition key to "ON".
3. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 CONNECT TO MDS1 OR MDS2 on the DRB III(R) MAIN
MENU SCREEN.
4. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 RUN MDS2 APPLICATION on the DRB III(R) MAIN MENU
SCREEN.
NOTE:
ONCE MDS2, DRB III(R), AND VEHICLE COMMUNICATION HAS BEEN ESTABLISHED, THE
CANNOT READ VIN FROM DRB III(R) MESSAGE (ON THE MDS2) WILL BE REPLACED BY
THE VEHICLE VIN. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON ON THE MDS2 TO REQUEST A MDS2
SESSION FOR THE VEHICLE VIN INDICATED. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON WHEN ASKED TO
BEGIN SESSION.
5. Push the FLASH tab on the MDS2.
NOTE:
A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS
OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST
SOFTWARE LEVEL AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN. IF THE LATEST SOFTWARE IS
INSTALLED, AND NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, ANOTHER VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS
THAT WILL REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
6. Select READ PART NUMBERS FROM VEHICLE and click SHOW UPDATES on the MDS2.
NOTE:
A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS
OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST
SOFTWARE LEVEL AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN. IF THE LATEST SOFTWARE IS
INSTALLED, AND NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, ANOTHER VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS
THAT WILL REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
7. Select the new software part number with the light pen and click UPDATE CONTROLLER
SOFTWARE.
8. The MDS2 and DRB III(R) will prompt for any operator action needed during the remainder of
the reprogramming process.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020
(Figure 1). Attach the label to the PCM and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
10. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086 and
attach the label near the VECI label (Figure 2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Drive Belt: > 18-02-99 > Feb > 99 > Torque Converter Clutch - Erratic Operation
Technical Service Bulletin # 18-02-99 Date: 990219
Torque Converter Clutch - Erratic Operation
NUMBER: 18-02-99
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Feb. 19, 1999
SUBJECT: Erratic Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) Operation (5.9L Diesel Applications)
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves selectively erasing and reprogramming the Powertrain Control
Module (PCM) with new software (calibration changes 98cal12 & 99cal14).
MODELS: 1998 - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A 5.9L 24 VALVE DIESEL
ENGINE AND AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION BUILT BETWEEN JAN. 1, 1998 AND DEC. 18, 1998
(MDH 0101XX & 1218XX).
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some vehicles may experience a surge like condition while in 4th gear. This may be caused by the
Torque Converter Clutch (TCC) unlocking and locking when it should be consistently locked. The
cause of this erratic operation has been identified as electrical noise from the Throttle Position
Sensor (TPS) or Alternator.
DIAGNOSIS:
Using the Mopar Diagnostic System (MDS/MDS2) and or the Diagnostic Scan Tool (DRB III(R))
with the appropriate Diagnostic Procedures Manual, verify all engine/transmission systems are
functioning as designed. If Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTC's) are present, record them on the
repair order and repair as necessary before proceeding further with this bulletin.
Verify the condition by creating a custom display in the DRB III(R) and include the following:
SENSORS (Output Shaft Speed, TPS Volts, Trans Temp Degree) & INPUTS/OUTPUTS (Brake
Switch, Park/Neutral, ASD Relay Sense, Desired TC Clutch).
Drive the vehicle with a helper monitoring the DRB III(R). Warm the engine and verify the
transmission fluid temperature is greater than 32°F and consistent. Operate the vehicle with an
output shaft speed greater than 2200 rpm. Verify that the brake switch shows a released status that
is consistent and verify the park/neutral status reads D/R and is consistent. While keeping the
output shaft speed above 2200 rpm, hold the throttle so the TPS reads 1 volt. Monitor the TC clutch
status, it should be consistently locked. If the TC clutch status shows unlocking/locking, look to see
if the TPS volts are fluctuating by 0.2 volts or more. It the conditions are met, perform the Repair
Procedure. If a surge like condition is felt but the above test does not confirm the TCC
unlocking/locking occurrence, further diagnosis and testing will be required.
NOTE:
WHENEVER A POWERTRAIN CONTROL MODULE (PCM) IS REPLACED DUE TO FAILURE,
THE SOFTWARE OF THE REPLACEMENT CONTROLLER MUST BE VERIFIED FOR THE
LATEST REVISION LEVEL. USE THE FLASH PROCEDURE TO UPDATE REPLACED
CONTROLLERS AS NECESSARY.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 04669020 Label, Authorized Software Update
1 04275086 Label, Authorized Modification
EQUIPMENT REQUIRED:
1 CH6000 Scan Tool (DRB III(R))
1 CH7035 General Purpose Interface Bus Cable (GPIB)
1 CH7000/7001 J1962 Cable
1 MDS1 or MDS2
NOTE:
THE MDS1/MDS2 AND DRB III(R) ARE REQUIRED TO PERFORM PART OF THIS REPAIR. IF
USING THE MDS1 AND DRB III(R) THE MDS MUST BE OPERATING AT RELEASE 21 OR
HIGHER AND TIL CD RELEASE 1179 OR HIGHER MUST BE INSTALLED. IF USING THE MDS2
AND DRB III(R) THE SYSTEM MUST BE OPERATING AT CIS CD2030 OR HIGHER.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Drive Belt: > 18-02-99 > Feb > 99 > Torque Converter Clutch - Erratic Operation >
Page 1139
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-19-42-95 0.5 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: FM - Flash Module
MDS1 Procedure
1. Connect the MDS1 (Mopar Diagnostic System) and DRB III(R) (Scan Tool) to the vehicle and
power them up.
2. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 CONNECT TO MDS1 OR MDS2 on the DRB III(R) MAIN
MENU SCREEN.
3. Use the arrow keys and select MDS DIAGNOSTICS OR DRB III(R) UPDATE on the DRB III(R)
MAIN MENU SCREEN.
4. Use the arrow keys and select DIAGNOSTIC MENU on the MDS1, then press NEXT MENU.
5. Use the arrow keys and select VEHICLE CONTROLLER PROGRAMMING on the MDS1, then
press NEXT MENU.
6. Use the arrow keys and select PROGRAMMING OF ALL OTHER CONTROLLERS USING THE
MDS1 & DRB III(R) on the MDS, then press NEXT MENU.
7. Follow the steps presented on the MDS1 and DRB III(R) that will allow the DRB III(R) to obtain
the current part number of the PCM.
8. The MDS1 will display the vehicle's PCM part number and the replacement part number(s).
Press NEXT MENU to begin programming.
NOTE:
A NO UPDATES AVAILABLE MESSAGE MAY BE DISPLAYED. CHECK THE PCM PART
NUMBER ON THE VEHICLE AND COMPARE IT TO THE PART NUMBER DISPLAYED ON THE
MDS. IF NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, FIRST CHECK YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT
FOR THE LATEST SOFTWARE LEVELS AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN. IF THE
LATEST SOFTWARE IS INSTALLED, ANOTHER VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS THAT WILL
REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
9. The MDS1 and DRB III(R) will prompt for any operator action needed during the remainder of
the reprogramming process.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
10. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020
(Figure 1). Attach the label to the PCM and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Other Service Bulletins for Drive Belt: > 18-02-99 > Feb > 99 > Torque Converter Clutch - Erratic Operation >
Page 1140
11. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086 and
attach the label near the VECI label (Figure 2).
MDS2 Procedures
1. Log onto the MDS2 system.
2. Connect the MDS2 (Mopar Diagnostic System) and DRB III(R) (Scan Tool) to the vehicle and
switch the ignition key to "ON".
3. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 CONNECT TO MDS1 OR MDS2 on the DRB III(R) MAIN
MENU SCREEN.
4. Use the arrow keys and select # 2 RUN MDS2 APPLICATION on the DRB III(R) MAIN MENU
SCREEN.
NOTE:
ONCE MDS2, DRB III(R), AND VEHICLE COMMUNICATION HAS BEEN ESTABLISHED, THE
CANNOT READ VIN FROM DRB III(R) MESSAGE (ON THE MDS2) WILL BE REPLACED BY
THE VEHICLE VIN. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON ON THE MDS2 TO REQUEST A MDS2
SESSION FOR THE VEHICLE VIN INDICATED. PRESS THE "OK" BUTTON WHEN ASKED TO
BEGIN SESSION.
5. Push the FLASH tab on the MDS2.
NOTE:
A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS
OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST
SOFTWARE LEVEL AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN. IF THE LATEST SOFTWARE IS
INSTALLED, AND NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, ANOTHER VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS
THAT WILL REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
6. Select READ PART NUMBERS FROM VEHICLE and click SHOW UPDATES on the MDS2.
NOTE:
A MESSAGE MAY APPEAR THAT INDICATES NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE. IF THIS
OCCURS, MAKE SURE YOUR DIAGNOSTIC EQUIPMENT IS OPERATING AT THE LATEST
SOFTWARE LEVEL AS LISTED EARLIER IN THIS BULLETIN. IF THE LATEST SOFTWARE IS
INSTALLED, AND NO UPDATES ARE AVAILABLE, ANOTHER VEHICLE CONDITION EXISTS
THAT WILL REQUIRE FURTHER INVESTIGATION.
7. Select the new software part number with the light pen and click UPDATE CONTROLLER
SOFTWARE.
8. The MDS2 and DRB III(R) will prompt for any operator action needed during the remainder of
the reprogramming process.
NOTE:
THE FOLLOWING STEPS ARE REQUIRED BY LAW.
9. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Software Update Label" p/n 04669020
(Figure 1). Attach the label to the PCM and cover the label with the clear plastic overlay.
10. Type the necessary information on the "Authorized Modification Label" p/n 04275086 and
attach the label near the VECI label (Figure 2).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Fuel Delivery and Air Induction > Throttle Position Sensor > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1141
Drive Belt: Description and Operation
All vehicles are available with either a 3.9L V-6, a 5.2L V-8, two different 5.9L V-8 engines, an 8.0L
V-10 or a 5.9L in-line 6 cylinder diesel engine. The accessory drive components are operated by a
single, crankshaft driven, serpentine drive belt on all engines. An automatic belt tensioner is also
used to maintain correct belt tension at all times. This is used on all engines. Refer to Drive Belt
Tensioner.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor: Specifications
Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) Bolt 20 Nm
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1146
Camshaft Position Sensor: Locations
Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) Location
The camshaft position sensor (CMP) is located below the fuel injection pump. It is attached to the
back of the timing gear cover housing.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1147
Connector View
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1148
Camshaft Position Sensor: Description and Operation
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (CMP)-ECM INPUT
Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP)
The Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) contains a hall effect device called a sync signal generator to
generate a sync signal.
The sync signal generator detects a machined hole on the rear face of the camshaft drive gear.
The signal is used to verify the position of the #1 cylinder during engine operation.
When the leading edge of the machined hole enters the tip of the CMP the interruption of magnetic
field causes the voltage to switch high resulting in a signal of approximately 5 volts.
When the trailing edge of the machined hole leaves the tip of the CMP the change of the magnetic
field causes the voltage to switch low to 0 volts.
Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) Location
The CMP is located below the fuel injection pump. It is attached to the back of the timing gear
cover housing.
The CMP is not used for any control of fuel system. It is used only for diagnostic purposes.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Camshaft Position Sensor > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1149
Camshaft Position Sensor: Service and Repair
Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) Location
The camshaft position sensor (CMP) is located below the fuel injection pump. It is attached to the
back of the timing gear cover housing.
REMOVAL 1. Disconnect both negative cables from both batteries. 2. Clean area around CMP. 3.
Disconnect electrical at CMP.
Camshaft Position Sensor (CMP) Removal/Installation
4. Remove CMP mounting bolt. Bolt head is female-hex. 5. Remove CMP from engine by twisting
and pulling straight back. 6. Discard CMP O-ring.
INSTALLATION 1. Install new O-ring to CMP. Apply clean engine oil to O-ring. 2. Clean area
around CMP mounting hole. 3. To prevent tearing O-ring, install CMP into gear housing using a
twisting action. 4. Install mounting bolt and tighten to 20 Nm (15 ft. lbs.) torque. 5. Install electrical
connector to CMP. 6. Connect both negative cables to both batteries.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Locations
The Key-In-Switch is located in the ignition switch module.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Locations > Page
1154
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Description and Operation
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY LOCK CYLINDER
The ignition switch is located on the steering column. The Key-In-Switch is located in the ignition
switch module. For removal/installation of either the key lock cylinder or ignition switch, refer to
Ignition Switch and Key Cylinder Removal/Installation.
On vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission and a steering column mounted shifter an
interlock device is located within the steering column. This interlock device is used to lock the
transmission shifter in the PARK position when the key is in the LOCKED or ACCESSORY
position. The interlock device within the steering column is not serviceable. If repair is necessary,
the steering column assembly must be replaced.
On vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission and a floor mounted shifter, a cable connects
the interlock device within the steering column assembly, to the transmission floor shift lever. This
interlock device is used to lock the transmission shifter in the PARK position when the key is in the
LOCKED or ACCESSORY position. The interlock device within the steering column is not
serviceable. If repair is necessary, the steering column assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Locations > Page
1155
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
The ignition key must be in the key cylinder for cylinder removal.
REMOVAL 1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. If equipped with tilt column, remove tilt
lever by turning it counterclockwise.
Shroud Removal/Installation - Typical
3. Remove upper and lower covers (shrouds) from steering column. 4. If equipped with automatic
transmission, place shifter in PARK position.
Retaining Pin
5. A retaining pin is located at side of key cylinder assembly.
a. Rotate key to RUN position. b. Press in on retaining pin while pulling key cylinder from ignition
switch.
INSTALLATION If installing ignition key lock cylinder only, proceed to following steps 2, 3 and 4.
Also refer to following steps 12 through 18. If installing both switch and key cylinder, refer to steps
1 through 18.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Locations > Page
1156
Flag In RUN Position
Key Cylinder Rear View
1. Rotate flag on rear of ignition switch until in RUN position. This step must be done to allow tang
on key cylinder to fit into slots within ignition
switch.
Installing Key Cylinder Into Switch
2. With key into ignition key cylinder, rotate key clockwise until retaining pin can be depressed .
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Locations > Page
1157
3. Install key cylinder into ignition switch by aligning retaining pin into retaining pin slot. Push key
cylinder into switch until retaining pin engages.
After pin engages, rotate key to OFF or LOCK position.
4. Check for proper retention of key cylinder by attempting to pull cylinder from switch.
Ignition Switch View From Column
Park Lock Linkage - Automatic Transmission - Typical
5. Automatic Transmission Only: Before attaching ignition switch to steering column, the
transmission shifter must be in PARK position. The park
lock dowel pin on rear of ignition switch must also be properly indexed into the park lock linkage
before installing switch.
Steering Wheel Lock Lever
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Powertrain Management > Sensors and
Switches - Ignition System > Ignition Switch > Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Locations > Page
1158
6. The flag at rear of ignition switch must be properly indexed into steering column before installing
switch. This flag is used to operate the steering
wheel lock lever in steering column. This lever allows steering wheel position to be locked when
key switch is in LOCK position.
7. Place ignition switch in LOCK position. The switch is in the LOCK position when column lock flag
is parallel to ignition switch terminals. 8. Automatic Transmission Only: Apply a light coating of
grease to park lock dowel pin and park lock slider linkage. Before installing switch, push
the park lock slider linkage forward until it bottoms. Do a final positioning by pulling it rearward
about one-quarter inch.
9. Apply a light coating of grease to both column lock flag and shaft at end of flag.
10. Place ignition switch into openings on steering column.
a. Automatic Transmission Only: Be sure park lock dowel pin on rear of ignition switch enters slot in
park lock slider linkage. b. Be sure flag on rear of switch is positioned above steering wheel lock
lever. c. Align dowel pins on rear of switch into holes on side of steering column. d. Install 3 ignition
switch mounting screws. Tighten screws to 3 Nm ± 0.5 Nm (26 in. lbs. ± 4 in. lbs.) torque.
11. Connect electrical connectors to ignition switch and halo lamp. Make sure that switch locking
tabs are fully seated in wiring connectors. 12. Install steering column covers (shrouds). tighten
screws to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.) torque. 13. Install tilt column lever (if equipped). 14. Connect negative
cable to battery. 15. Check for proper operation of halo light. 16. Automatic Transmission Only:
Shifter should lock in PARK position when key is in LOCK position (if equipped with shift lock
device). Shifter
should unlock when key rotated to ON position.
17. Check for proper operation of ignition switch in ACCESSORY, LOCK, OFF; ON, RUN, and
START positions. 18. Steering wheel should lock when key is in LOCK position. Rotate steering
wheel to verify. Steering wheel should unlock when key is rotated to
ON position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches
Air Bag Deactivation Switch: Technical Service Bulletins Air Bag - On/Off Switches
NUMBER: 08-025-01
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Nov. 23, 2001
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 08-037-99, DATED
NOVEMBER 12, 1999, WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES AND NOTED IN
THE 1999 TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN MANUAL (PUBLICATION NO. 81-699-00004). ALL
REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS** AND INCLUDE ADDITIONAL MODELS,
PARTS, AND 2001 MODEL YEAR PROCEDURES.
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN DOES NOT APPLY TO DIAMLERCHRYSLER CANADA DEALERS.
SUBJECT: Airbag On-Off Switches
MODELS:
1990 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan
1995 - **2001** (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
1990 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon
1990 - 1993 (AG) Daytona
1990 - 1995 (AJ) Lebaron Coupe/Convertible
1994 - **2001** (AN) Dakota
1990 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Shadow Convertible/Sundance
1991 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan Voyager
1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue
1994 - **2001** (BR/BE) Ram Pickup
1995 - 1996 (B7) Stealth
1998 - **2001** (DN) Durango
1995 - 2000 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon
1995 - 2000 (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
**2001** (JR) Sebring Sedan/Stratus Sedan/Sebring Convertible
1996 - 2000 (JX) Sebring Convertible
1993 - **2001** (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - 2000 (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
1995 - **2001** (PL) Neon
1997 (PR) Prowler
**2001 (PT) PT Cruiser**
**2001** (RS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 1164
1996 - 1997 (SR) Viper
**2001 - 2002 (ST) Sebring Coupe/Stratus Coupe**
1997 - 2001** (TJ) Wrangler
1999 - **2001** (WJ) Grand Cherokee
1997 - **2001** (XJ) Cherokee
1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN IS PROVIDED TO IDENTIFY THE PARTS AND PROCEDURES NECESSARY
TO DEACTIVATE AIRBAGS AUTHORIZED BY NHTSA. AIRBAG DEACTIVATION IS A
CUSTOMER PAY PROCEDURE, NOT COVERED UNDER THE PROVISIONS OF THE
WARRANTY. THE COMPONENT PARTS ARE COVERED UNDER THE APPROPRIATE MOPAR
PART WARRANTY.
NOTE:
**SOME 2001 MODEL YEAR PACKAGES (AN/AN84/DN/JR/LH/PL/PT/RS/TJ) REQUIRE
OCCUPANT RESTRAINT CONTROLLER (ORC) CONFIGURATION USING THE DRB III(R) AS
DETAILED IN EACH VEHICLE SPECIFIC PACKAGE.**
DISCUSSION:
DaimlerChrysler Corporation is now offering airbag on-off switches for the selected vehicles listed
above. The switches are packaged in a kit containing all necessary parts (except as indicated) and
a detailed instruction sheet. Under the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration's rule,
consumers will be authorized for on-off switches by claiming they meet any of several criteria.
Airbag on-off switches must not be installed without the vehicle owner presenting the NHTSA
authorization letter. For more information concerning the authorization process and/or the
authorization letter call NHTSA's Auto Safety Hotline at 1-800-424-9393. We encourage you
(dealer) to install these switches when the customer is interested in doing so and has the
necessary NHTSA authorization.
NOTE:
FOR SOME 2000 MODEL YEAR APPLICATIONS (AB/AN/AN84/DN/JA/NS) **AND SOME 2001
CARRYOVER APPLICATIONS (AB/BR/WJ/XJ)**, A NEW OWNER'S MANUAL INSERT IS
REQUIRED, P/N 05013528AA, AND MUST BE ORDERED IN ADDITION TO THE AIRBAG
SWITCH KIT. THE NEW INSERT IS ORANGE, AND MUST BE PRESENTED TO THE
CUSTOMER IN PLACE OF THE YELLOW ONE, P/N 05013517AA, THAT WILL COME IN THE
AIRBAG KIT.
**FOR SOME 2001 MODEL YEAR APPLICATIONS (WITH J1850 BUS,
AN/AN84/DN/JR/LH/PL(PT/RS/TJ) A NEW OWNER'S MANUAL INSERT IS REQUIRED, P/N
05016025AA, AND MUST BE ORDERED IN ADDITION TO THE AIRBAG SWITCH KIT. THE
NEW INSERT MUST BE PRESENTED TO THE CUSTOMER AFTER INSTALLATION.**
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 1165
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 1166
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 1167
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 1168
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 1169
PARTS REQUIRED:
NOTE:
SOME INSTRUCTION SHEETS FOR THE 1999 MODELS LIST ONLY 1998 MODELS ON THE
COVER PAGE. THE 1998 KITS CAN BE USED ON ALL 1999 CARRY-OVER VEHICLES.
DEACTIVATION/DOCUMENTATION PROCEDURE:
1. Before you install any airbag on-off switch for owners of air bag equipped vehicles, the owner
must present to you an "Authorization Form" from the U.S. Department of Transportation National
Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA), certifying the specific vehicle by its vehicle
identification number. The authorization applies only to the vehicle identified and not to other
vehicles that the owner may have~
2. The owner must complete the "Authorization to Install Air Bag On-Off Switch Release
Agreement Form" available in the "Forms Folder" under "TSB/Recall" tab of MDS2 and printed on
your dealership letterhead. keep a copy for your records and make a copy for the vehicle owner.
3. Complete the NHTSA authorization form, and return it to NHTSA within seven days, making
copies for the owner's and your records.
NOTE:
ALL DEALER OWNED USED VEHICLES SHOULD BE INSPECTED FOR PROPER AIRBAG
OPERATION, i.e. NOT DEACTIVATED, PRIOR TO RESALE.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 1170
Air Bag Deactivation Switch: Technical Service Bulletins Air Bag System - ON-OFF Switch
Availibility
NO: 08-17-98 Rev. C
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Dec. 30, 1998
SUBJECT: Airbag On-Off Switches
THIS REPAIR IS COMPATIBLE WITH DAIMLERCHRYSLER'S MOBILE SERVICE PROGRAM
AND DOES NOT REQUIRE HOISTS OR OTHER FULL SERVICE FACILITY SPECIAL
EQUIPMENT.
THIS BULLETIN SUPERSEDES TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 08-17-98 Rev. B DATED
SEPTEMBER 18, 1998 WHICH SHOULD BE REMOVED FROM YOUR FILES. ADDITIONAL
MODELS HAVE BEEN ADDED. ALL REVISIONS ARE HIGHLIGHTED WITH **ASTERISKS**.
MODELS:
**1990 - 1995 (AA) Spirit/Acclaim/Lebaron Sedan**
1995 - **1999** (AB) Ram Van/Wagon
**1990 - 1993 (AC) Dynasty/New Yorker/New Yorker Salon**
1990 - 1993 (AG) Daytona
1990 - 1995 (AJ) LeBaron Coupe/Convertible
1994 -**1999** (AN) Dakota
1990 - 1994 (AP) Shadow/Shadow Convertible/Sundance
1991 - 1995 (AS) Town & Country/Caravan/Voyager
**1990 - 1993 (AY) Imperial/New Yorker Fifth Avenue**
1994 - **1999** (BR) Ram Pickup
**1995 - 1996 (B7) Stealth**
1998 - **1999** (DN) Durango
**1995 - 1999 (FJ) Avenger/Sebring/Talon**
1995 - **1999** (JA) Breeze/Cirrus/Stratus
1996 - **1999** (JX) Sebring Convertible
1993 -**1999** (LH) Concorde/Intrepid/Vision/LHS/New Yorker/300M
1996 - **1999** (NS) Town & Country/Caravan/ Voyager
1995 - **1999** (PL) Neon
1996 - 1997 (SR) Viper
1997 - **1999** (TJ) Wrangler
1997 - **1999** (XJ) Cherokee
1993 - 1998 (ZJ) Grand Cherokee/Grand Wagoneer
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN IS PROVIDED TO IDENTIFY THE PARTS AND PROCEDURES NECESSARY
TO DEACTIVATE AIRBAGS AUTHORIZED BY NHTSA. AIRBAG DEACTIVATION IS A
CUSTOMER PAY PROCEDURE, NOT COVERED UNDER THE PROVISIONS OF THE
WARRANTY. THE COMPONENT PARTS ARE COVERED UNDER THE APPROPRIATE MOPAR
PART WARRANTY.
DISCUSSION:
DaimlerChrysler Corporation is now offering airbag on-off switches for the selected vehicles listed
above. Other applicable passenger vehicles will be announced as soon as the switches are
available. The switches are packaged in a kit containing all necessary parts (except as indicated)
and a detailed instruction sheet.
Under the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration's rule, consumers will be authorized for
on-off switches by claiming they meet any of several criteria. Airbag on-off switches must not be
installed without the vehicle owner presenting the NHTSA authorization letter. For more information
concerning the authorization process and/or the authorization letter call NHTSA's Auto Safety
Hotline at 1-800-424-9393.
We encourage you (dealer) to install these switches when the customer is interested in doing so
and has the necessary NHTSA authorization.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 1171
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 1172
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 1173
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 1174
PARTS REQUIRED:
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 1175
NOTE:
SOME INSTRUCTION SHEETS FOR THE 1999 MODELS LIST ONLY 1998 MODELS ON THE
COVER PAGE. THE 1998 KITS CAN BE USED ON ALL 1999 CARRY-OVER VEHICLES.
DEACTIVATION/DOCUMENTATION PROCEDURE:
1. Before you install any airbag on-off switch for owners of air bag equipped vehicles, the owner
must present to you an "Authorization Form" from the U.S. Department of Transportation National
Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA), certifying the specific vehicle by its vehicle
identification number. The authorization applies only to the vehicle identified and not to other
vehicles that the owner may have.
2. The owner must complete the "Authorization to Install Air Bag On-Off Switch Release
Agreement Form" available on T.I.L. and printed on your dealership letterhead. Keep a copy for
your records and make a copy for the vehicle owner.
3. Complete the NHTSA authorization form, and return it to NHTSA within seven days, making
copies for the owner's and your records.
NOTE:
ALL DEALER OWNED USED VEHICLES SHOULD BE INSPECTED FOR PROPER AIRBAG
OPERATION, i.e. NOT DEACTIVATED, PRIOR TO RESALE.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Air Bag - On/Off Switches > Page 1176
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1177
Air Bag Deactivation Switch: Specifications
Tighten the three screws that secure the passenger side airbag on/off switch to the switch bezel to
2.2 Nm (20 in lbs).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1178
Passenger Side Airbag On/Off Switch Remove/Install
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1179
Air Bag Deactivation Switch: Diagrams
Passenger Airbag On/Off Switch C1 - 2 Way
Passenger Airbag On/Off Switch C2 - 4 Way
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1180
Air Bag Deactivation Switch: Service Precautions
WARNING: THE KEY MUST ALWAYS BE REMOVED FROM THE PASSENGER SIDE AIRBAG
ON/OFF SWITCH KEY ACTUATOR AFTER THE SWITCH HAS BEEN USED. NEVER LEAVE A
KEY IN THE SWITCH KEY ACTUATOR. FAILURE TO OBSERVE THIS WARNING COULD
RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL, INCOMPLETE OR IMPROPER AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE OCCUPANT INJURIES
.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1181
Air Bag Deactivation Switch: Description and Operation
PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF SWITCH
A Passenger Airbag On/Off Switch located on the instrument panel allows the passenger airbag
module to be turned OFF when certain child restraint devices are being used in the right front
seating position. The switch is equipped with a key cylinder so that the switch position can only be
changed using an ignition key. When the ignition switch is in the On position and the passenger
side airbag is OFF, a Light-Emitting Diode (LED) illuminates an "OFF" indicator lamp on the
faceplate of the switch.
The passenger side airbag ON/OFF switch is located on the instrument panel. To turn OFF the
passenger side airbag, turn the key actuator switch from the vertical position to a slanted position
(pointing to the "OFF" light indicator), approximately 45 degrees clockwise, remove the key
completely from the switch and verify that the switch actuator hole stays in the new position (45
degrees clockwise from vertical). The switch is spring loaded to the "ON" position. It will return to
the "ON" position unless you remove the key. When the IGNITION is ON, this procedure will
illuminate the "OFF" light indicator on the passenger airbag ON/OFF switch.
To re-enable the passenger side airbag, reverse the procedure above so that the key switch
actuator is returned to a vertical position.
NOTE:
Do not turn ignition ON with key in Switch. Do not turn switch with ignition ON. Do not leave key in
switch. Do not leave the key in the key actuator under any condition.
WARNING: THE KEY MUST ALWAYS BE REMOVED FROM THE PASSENGER SIDE AIRBAG
ON/OFF SWITCH KEY ACTUATOR AFTER THE SWITCH HAS BEEN USED. NEVER LEAVE A
KEY IN THE SWITCH KEY ACTUATOR. FAILURE TO OBSERVE THIS WARNING COULD
RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL, INCOMPLETE OR IMPROPER AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE OCCUPANT INJURIES.
The Passenger Airbag On/Off Switch cannot be adjusted or repaired and, if faulty or damaged, the
switch must be replaced
THE AIRBAG MODULE INFLATOR ASSEMBLY CONTAINS SODIUM AZIDE AND POTASSIUM
NITRATE. THESE MATERIALS ARE POISONOUS AND EXTREMELY FLAMMABLE. CONTACT
WITH ACID, WATER, OR HEAVY METALS MAY PRODUCE HARMFUL AND IRRITATING
GASES (SODIUM HYDROXIDE IS FORMED IN THE PRESENCE OF MOISTURE) OR
COMBUSTIBLE COMPOUNDS. IN ADDITION, THE PASSENGER AIRBAG MODULE CONTAINS
ARGON GAS PRESSURIZED TO OVER 2500 PSI. DO NOT ATTEMPT TO DISMANTLE AN
AIRBAG MODULE OR TAMPER WITH ITS INFLATOR. DO NOT PUNCTURE, INCINERATE, OR
BRING INTO CONTACT WITH ELECTRICITY DO NOT STORE AT TEMPERATURE
EXCEEDING 93°C (200°F). REPLACE AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS ONLY WITH PARTS
SPECIFIED IN THE CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS CATALOG. SUBSTITUTE PARTS MAY
APPEAR INTERCHANGEABLE, BUT INTERNAL DIFFERENCES MAY RESULT IN INFERIOR
OCCUPANT PROTECTION. THE FASTENERS, SCREWS, AND BOLTS ORIGINALLY USED
FOR THE AIRBAG SYSTEM COMPONENTS HAVE SPECIAL COATINGS AND ARE
SPECIFICALLY DESIGNED FOR THE AIRBAG BAG SYSTEM. THEY MUST NEVER BE
REPLACED WITH ANY SUBSTITUTES. ANY TIME A NEW FASTENER IS NEEDED, REPLACE
IT WITH THE CORRECT FASTENERS PROVIDED IN HE SERVICE PACKAGE OR SPECIFIED
IN THE CHRYSLER MOPAR PARTS CATALOG.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1182
Air Bag Deactivation Switch: Service and Repair
WARNING: THE AIRBAG SYSTEM IS A SENSITIVE, COMPLEX ELECTROMECHANICAL UNIT.
BEFORE ATTEMPTING TO DIAGNOSE OR SERVICE ANY AIRBAG SYSTEM OR RELATED
STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENTS YOU
MUST FIRST DISCONNECT AND ISOLATE THE BATTERY NEGATIVE (GROUND) CABLE.
THEN WAIT TWO MINUTES FOR THE SYSTEM CAPACITOR TO DISCHARGE BEFORE
FURTHER SYSTEM SERVICE. THIS IS THE ONLY SURE WAY TO DISABLE THE AIRBAG
SYSTEM. FAILURE TO DO THIS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT
AND POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
REMOVAL 1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. If either of the airbags has not
been deployed, wait two minutes for the system capacitor to
discharge before further service.
2. Remove the cluster bezel from the instrument panel. Refer to Cluster Bezel in the Replacement
of Instrument Panel Systems for the procedures. 3. Remove the glove box from the instrument
panel. Refer to Glove Box in the Replacement of Instrument Panel Systems for the procedures.
Passenger Side Airbag On/Off Switch Wire Harness Connectors
4. Reach through the glove box opening to access and disconnect the two passenger side airbag
on/off switch wire harness connectors from the
instrument panel wire harness. These connectors are retained on a bracket located on the inboard
glove box opening reinforcement.
Passenger Side Airbag On/Off Switch Bezel Remove/Install
5. Remove the three screws that secure the passenger side airbag on/off switch bezel to the
instrument panel. 6. Remove the passenger side airbag on/off switch and switch bezel from the
instrument panel as a unit.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Air Bag Deactivation
Switch > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1183
Passenger Side Airbag On/Off Switch Remove/Install
7. Remove the three screws that secure the passenger side airbag on/off switch to the back of the
switch bezel. 8. Remove the passenger side airbag on/off switch from the switch bezel.
INSTALLATION 1. Position the passenger side airbag on/off switch to the back of the switch bezel.
2. Install and tighten the three screws that secure the passenger side airbag on/off switch to the
switch bezel. Tighten the screws to 2.2 Nm (20 in lbs)
.
3. Route the passenger side airbag on/off switch wire harness through the switch bezel opening of
the instrument panel. 4. Reach through the glove box opening to access and reconnect the two
passenger side airbag on/off switch wire harness connectors to the
instrument panel wire harness. These connectors are retained on a bracket located on the inboard
glove box opening reinforcement. Be certain that both connectors are fully engaged and latched.
5. Position the passenger side airbag on/off switch bezel to the opening in the instrument panel. 6.
Install and tighten the three screws that secure the passenger side airbag on/off switch bezel to the
instrument panel. Tighten the screws to 2.2 Nm
(20 in lbs).
7. Install the glove box onto the instrument panel. Refer to Glove Box in the Replacement of
Instrument Panel Systems for the procedures. 8. Install the cluster bezel onto the instrument panel.
Refer to Cluster Bezel in the Replacement of Instrument Panel Systems for the procedures. 9. Do
not reconnect the battery negative cable at this time. Refer to Airbag System in the Diagnosis and
Testing for the proper procedures.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations
Impact Sensor: Locations
Airbag Control Module
The airbag impact and safing sensors are located inside the airbag control module. The airbag
control module is located under the center of the instrument panel and is attached to the center
instrument panel support bracket. The airbag impact and safing sensors are integral to the airbag
control module and are not separately serviceable. If found to be defective, the airbag control
module must be replaced as a whole unit.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1187
Impact Sensor: Description and Operation
Impact and Safing Sensors
One electronic impact sensor is used in this airbag system. The impact sensor is an accelerometer
that senses the rate of vehicle deceleration, which provides verification of the direction and severity
of an impact. The impact sensor is calibrated for the specific vehicle, and is only serviced as a unit
with the ACM. A pre-programmed decision algorithm in the ACM microprocessor determines when
the deceleration rate as signaled by the impact sensor indicates an impact that is severe enough to
require airbag system protection. When the programmed conditions are met, the ACM sends an
electrical signal to deploy the airbags.
In addition to the electronic impact sensor, there is an electromechanical sensor within the ACM
called a safing sensor. The safing sensor is a normally open series switch located in the airbag
deployment circuit of the ACM. This sensor detects impact energy of a lesser magnitude than the
electronic impact sensor, and must be closed in order for the airbags to deploy.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Impact Sensor >
Component Information > Locations > Page 1188
Impact Sensor: Service and Repair
The impact and safing sensors are integral to the airbag control module and are not separately
serviceable. If the sensors or airbag control module is found to be defective, the airbag control
module must be replaced as a complete unit.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Restraint Systems > Seat Belt Buckle Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams
Seat Belt Buckle Switch: Diagrams
Seatbelt Switch (Club Cab) - Green 2 Way
Seatbelt Switch (Standard Cab) - Black 2 Way
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations
Battery Temperature Sensor: Locations
Battery Temperature Sensor Location
The sensor is located under the battery and is attached (snapped into) the battery tray.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1196
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1197
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service Precautions
WARNING: TO PROTECT THE HANDS FROM BATTERY ACID, A SUITABLE PAIR OF HEAVY
DUTY RUBBER GLOVES, NOT THE HOUSEHOLD TYPE, SHOULD BE WORN WHEN
REMOVING OR SERVICING A BATTERY. SAFETY GLASSES ALSO SHOULD BE WORN
.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Locations > Page 1198
Battery Temperature Sensor: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The battery temperature sensor is used to determine the battery temperature and control battery
charging rate. This temperature data, along with data from monitored line voltage, is used by the
PCM to vary the battery charging rate. System voltage will be higher at colder temperatures and is
gradually reduced at warmer temperatures.
BATTERY TEMPERATURE SENSOR-PCM INPUT
Provides a signal to the PCM corresponding to the battery temperature.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Testing
Battery Temperature Sensor: Testing and Inspection Testing
To perform a complete test of this sensor and its circuitry, refer to the appropriate Powertrain
Diagnostic Procedures. To test the sensor only, refer to the following:
Battery Temperature Sensor Location
1. The sensor is located on the driver's side of the vehicle under the battery and is attached to
(snapped into) the battery tray. Only one sensor is used,
including vehicles with dual batteries (diesel engines). A two-wire pigtail harness is attached
directly to the sensor. The opposite end of this harness connects the sensor to the engine wiring
harness.
2. Disconnect the two-wire pigtail harness from the engine harness. 3. Attach ohmmeter leads to
the wire terminals of the pigtail harness. 4. At room temperature of 25° C (75-80° F), an ohmmeter
reading of 9,000 (9K) to 11,000 (11K) ohms should be observed. 5. If reading is above or below the
specification, replace the sensor. 6. Refer to the Replacement for procedures.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Battery Temperature
Sensor > Component Information > Testing and Inspection > Page 1201
Battery Temperature Sensor: Service and Repair
Battery Temperature Sensor Location
The battery temperature sensor is located under the vehicle battery and is attached (snapped into)
a mounting hole on battery tray. Only one sensor is used (dual batteries). The sensor is located
under the battery on drivers side of vehicle.
REMOVAL
1. Remove battery. Refer to Battery for procedures 2. Disconnect sensor pigtail harness from
engine wire harness. 3. Pry sensor straight up from battery tray mounting hole.
INSTALLATION
1. Feed pigtail harness through mounting hole in top of battery tray and press sensor into top of
tray (snaps in). 2. Connect pigtail harness. 3. Install battery. Refer to Battery for procedures.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Locations
The Key-In-Switch is located in the ignition switch module.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Locations > Page 1206
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Description and Operation
IGNITION SWITCH AND KEY LOCK CYLINDER
The ignition switch is located on the steering column. The Key-In-Switch is located in the ignition
switch module. For removal/installation of either the key lock cylinder or ignition switch, refer to
Ignition Switch and Key Cylinder Removal/Installation.
On vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission and a steering column mounted shifter an
interlock device is located within the steering column. This interlock device is used to lock the
transmission shifter in the PARK position when the key is in the LOCKED or ACCESSORY
position. The interlock device within the steering column is not serviceable. If repair is necessary,
the steering column assembly must be replaced.
On vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission and a floor mounted shifter, a cable connects
the interlock device within the steering column assembly, to the transmission floor shift lever. This
interlock device is used to lock the transmission shifter in the PARK position when the key is in the
LOCKED or ACCESSORY position. The interlock device within the steering column is not
serviceable. If repair is necessary, the steering column assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Locations > Page 1207
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder: Service and Repair
The ignition key must be in the key cylinder for cylinder removal.
REMOVAL 1. Disconnect negative cable from battery. 2. If equipped with tilt column, remove tilt
lever by turning it counterclockwise.
Shroud Removal/Installation - Typical
3. Remove upper and lower covers (shrouds) from steering column. 4. If equipped with automatic
transmission, place shifter in PARK position.
Retaining Pin
5. A retaining pin is located at side of key cylinder assembly.
a. Rotate key to RUN position. b. Press in on retaining pin while pulling key cylinder from ignition
switch.
INSTALLATION If installing ignition key lock cylinder only, proceed to following steps 2, 3 and 4.
Also refer to following steps 12 through 18. If installing both switch and key cylinder, refer to steps
1 through 18.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Locations > Page 1208
Flag In RUN Position
Key Cylinder Rear View
1. Rotate flag on rear of ignition switch until in RUN position. This step must be done to allow tang
on key cylinder to fit into slots within ignition
switch.
Installing Key Cylinder Into Switch
2. With key into ignition key cylinder, rotate key clockwise until retaining pin can be depressed .
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Locations > Page 1209
3. Install key cylinder into ignition switch by aligning retaining pin into retaining pin slot. Push key
cylinder into switch until retaining pin engages.
After pin engages, rotate key to OFF or LOCK position.
4. Check for proper retention of key cylinder by attempting to pull cylinder from switch.
Ignition Switch View From Column
Park Lock Linkage - Automatic Transmission - Typical
5. Automatic Transmission Only: Before attaching ignition switch to steering column, the
transmission shifter must be in PARK position. The park
lock dowel pin on rear of ignition switch must also be properly indexed into the park lock linkage
before installing switch.
Steering Wheel Lock Lever
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Ignition Switch >
Ignition Switch Lock Cylinder > Component Information > Locations > Page 1210
6. The flag at rear of ignition switch must be properly indexed into steering column before installing
switch. This flag is used to operate the steering
wheel lock lever in steering column. This lever allows steering wheel position to be locked when
key switch is in LOCK position.
7. Place ignition switch in LOCK position. The switch is in the LOCK position when column lock flag
is parallel to ignition switch terminals. 8. Automatic Transmission Only: Apply a light coating of
grease to park lock dowel pin and park lock slider linkage. Before installing switch, push
the park lock slider linkage forward until it bottoms. Do a final positioning by pulling it rearward
about one-quarter inch.
9. Apply a light coating of grease to both column lock flag and shaft at end of flag.
10. Place ignition switch into openings on steering column.
a. Automatic Transmission Only: Be sure park lock dowel pin on rear of ignition switch enters slot in
park lock slider linkage. b. Be sure flag on rear of switch is positioned above steering wheel lock
lever. c. Align dowel pins on rear of switch into holes on side of steering column. d. Install 3 ignition
switch mounting screws. Tighten screws to 3 Nm ± 0.5 Nm (26 in. lbs. ± 4 in. lbs.) torque.
11. Connect electrical connectors to ignition switch and halo lamp. Make sure that switch locking
tabs are fully seated in wiring connectors. 12. Install steering column covers (shrouds). tighten
screws to 2 Nm (17 in. lbs.) torque. 13. Install tilt column lever (if equipped). 14. Connect negative
cable to battery. 15. Check for proper operation of halo light. 16. Automatic Transmission Only:
Shifter should lock in PARK position when key is in LOCK position (if equipped with shift lock
device). Shifter
should unlock when key rotated to ON position.
17. Check for proper operation of ignition switch in ACCESSORY, LOCK, OFF; ON, RUN, and
START positions. 18. Steering wheel should lock when key is in LOCK position. Rotate steering
wheel to verify. Steering wheel should unlock when key is rotated to
ON position.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Specifications
Neutral Safety Switch: Specifications
Switch, Park/Neutral 25 ft.lb
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1214
Solenoid Case Connector, Park/Neutral Position Switch Connector
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1215
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Starting and Charging > Neutral Safety
Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1216
Neutral Safety Switch: Service and Repair
Removal
1. Raise vehicle and position drain pan under switch. 2. Disconnect switch wires. 3. Remove switch
from case.
Installation
Fig. 21
1. Move shift lever to Park and Neutral positions. Verify that switch operating lever fingers are
centered in switch opening in case. 2. Install new seal on switch and install switch in case. Tighten
switch to 34 Nm (26 ft. lbs.) torque. 3. Test continuity of new switch with 12V test lamp. 4. Connect
switch wires and lower vehicle. 5. Top off transmission fluid level.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Overdrive Switch, A/T > Component Information > Description and Operation
Overdrive Switch: Description and Operation
The overdrive OFF (control) switch is located in the shift lever arm. The switch is a momentary
contact device that signals the PCM to toggle current status of the overdrive function. At key-on,
overdrive operation is allowed. Pressing the switch once causes the overdrive OFF mode to be
entered and the overdrive OFF switch lamp to be illuminated. Pressing the switch a second time
causes normal overdrive operation to be restored and the overdrive lamp to be turned off. The
overdrive OFF mode defaults to ON after the ignition switch is cycled OFF and ON. The normal
position for the control switch is the ON position. The switch must be in this position to energize the
solenoid and allow a 3-4 upshift. The control switch indicator light illuminates only when the
overdrive switch is turned to the OFF position, or when illuminated by the transmission control
module.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Position Switch/Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 1225
Transmission Position Switch/Sensor: Service and Repair
Park/Neutral Position Switch
1. Raise vehicle and position drain pan under switch.
2. Disconnect switch wires.
3. Remove switch from case.
4. Move shift lever to Park and Neutral positions. Verify that switch operating lever fingers are
centered in switch opening in case.
5. Install new seal on switch and install switch in case. Tighten switch to 34 Nm (25 ft. lbs.) torque.
6. Test continuity of new switch with 12V test lamp.
7. Connect switch wires and lower vehicle.
8. Top off transmission fluid level.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Output Shaft Speed Sensor, Transmission Solenoid 8-way Connector, Park/Neutral Switch
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 1229
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Speed Sensor, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 1230
Transmission Speed Sensor: Description and Operation
Fig. 5
The speed sensor (Fig. 5) is located in the overdrive gear case. The sensor is positioned over the
park gear and monitors transmission output shaft rotating speed. Speed sensor signals are
triggered by the park gear lugs as they rotate past the sensor pickup face. Input signals from the
sensor are sent to the transmission control module for processing. The vehicle speed sensor also
serves as a backup for the transmission speed sensor. Signals from this sensor are shared with the
powertrain control module.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Locations
Governor Pressure Sensor, Transmission Temperature Sensor, Governor Pressure Solenoid,
Governor
The transmission temperature sensor is located in the transmission solenoid assembly in the valve
body. The governor pressure sender and the transmission fluid temperature thermistor are
separate sensors in the same component. This component is attached to the governor body in the
solenoid assembly of the valve body.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - A/T > Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch, A/T > Component Information > Locations > Page 1234
Transmission Temperature Sensor/Switch: Description and Operation
Transmission fluid temperature readings are supplied to the transmission control module by the
thermistor. The temperature readings are used to control engagement of the fourth gear overdrive
clutch, the converter clutch, and governor pressure. Normal resistance value for the thermistor at
room temperature is approximately 1000 ohms.
The PCM prevents engagement of the converter clutch and overdrive clutch, when fluid
temperature is below approximately 10 °C (50 °F).
If fluid temperature exceeds 126 °C (260 °F), the PCM causes a 4-3 downshift and engage the
converter clutch. Engagement is according to the third gear converter clutch engagement schedule.
The overdrive OFF lamp in the instrument panel illuminates when the shift back to third occurs. The
transmission will not allow fourth gear operation until fluid temperature decreases to approximately
110 °C (230 °F).
The thermistor is part of the governor pressure sensor assembly and is immersed in transmission
fluid at all times.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) Switch <--> [Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch] > Component
Information > Locations
4WD Drive Switch
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) Switch <--> [Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > With Quad Cab
Connector Pin Identification
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Transmission and Drivetrain > Sensors and
Switches - Transfer Case > Four-Wheel Drive (4WD) Switch <--> [Four Wheel Drive Selector Switch] > Component
Information > Diagrams > With Quad Cab > Page 1241
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Lockout Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Power Window Lockout Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Lockout Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1247
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Lockout Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1248
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Lockout Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1249
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Lockout Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1250
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Lockout Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1251
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Lockout Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1252
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Lockout Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1253
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Lockout Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1254
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Lockout Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1255
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Lockout Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1256
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Lockout Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1257
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Lockout Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1258
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Lockout Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1259
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Lockout Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1260
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Lockout Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1261
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Lockout Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1262
Power Window Lockout Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Lockout Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1263
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window
Lockout Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1264
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Locations
Power Window And Lock Switch And Bezel Unit Remove/Install
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Power Window Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1270
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1271
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1272
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1273
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1274
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1275
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1276
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1277
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1278
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1279
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1280
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1281
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1282
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1283
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1284
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1285
Power Window Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1286
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1287
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1288
Power Window Switch: Connector Views
Driver Door Window/Lock Switch - 16 Way
Passenger Door Window/Lock Switch
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1289
Power Window Switch: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The power windows are controlled by two-way switches integral to the power window and lock
switch and bezel unit on the trim panel of each front door. A second power window switch in the
driver side switch and bezel unit allows the driver to control the passenger side window. A
Light-Emitting Diode (LED) in the paddle of each switch is illuminated whenever the ignition switch
is in the On position.
The power window switch for the driver side front door has an Auto label on it. This switch has a
second detent position beyond the normal Down position that provides an automatic one-touch
window down feature. This feature is controlled by an electronic circuit and a relay that are integral
to the driver side front door power window and lock switch unit.
The power window switches control the battery and ground feeds to the power window motors. The
passenger side power window switch receives a ground feed through the driver side power window
switch for operating the passenger side power window motor.
The power window and lock switch and bezel unit cannot be repaired and, if faulty or damaged, the
entire switch and bezel unit must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1290
Power Window Switch: Testing and Inspection
Power Window And Lock Switch And Bezel Unit Remove/Install
The auto down feature of the driver side power window switch is controlled by an electronic circuit
within the switch unit. The auto down circuitry is activated when the driver side power window
switch is moved to the second detent in the Down direction. The outputs from the auto down
circuitry are carried through the same switch pins that provide the normal down function. The auto
down circuit cannot be tested. If the driver side power window switch continuity tests are passed,
but the auto down feature is inoperative, replace the faulty driver side power window switch unit.
The Light-Emitting Diode (LED) illumination lamps for all of the power window and lock switch and
bezel unit switch paddles receive battery current through the power window circuit breaker in the
junction block. If all of the LEDs are inoperative in either or both power window and lock switch and
bezel units and the power windows are inoperative, perform the diagnosis for Power Window
System. If the power windows operate, but any or all of the LEDs are inoperative, the power
window and lock switch and bezel unit with the inoperative LED(s) is faulty and must be replaced.
1. Check the circuit breaker in the junction block. If OK, go to Step 2.If not OK, replace the faulty
circuit breaker. 2. Turn the ignition switch to the On position. Check for battery voltage at the circuit
breaker in the junction block. If OK, turn the ignition switch to
the Off position and go to Step 3. If not OK, repair the circuit to the ignition switch as required.
3. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. Remove the power window and lock switch
and bezel unit from the door trim panel. Unplug the
wire harness connector from the switch and bezel unit.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1291
Power Window Switch Continuity - Driver Side
Power Window Switch Continuity - Passenger Side
4. Test the power window switch continuity. See the Power Window Switch Continuity charts to
determine if the continuity is correct in the Neutral,
Up and Down switch positions. If OK, see Power Window Motor in the Diagnosis and Testing. If not
OK, replace the faulty switch.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Windows and Glass > Power Window Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1292
Power Window Switch: Service and Repair
Power Window And Lock Switch And Bezel Unit Remove/Install
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Using a wide flat-bladed tool such as a trim
stick, gently pry the upper edge of the switch bezel to release the retainer that secures the switch
bezel
to the door trim panel opening.
3. Pull the switch and bezel unit away from the door trim panel opening far enough to access and
unplug the wire harness connector. 4. Remove the power window and lock switch and bezel unit
from the door trim panel. 5. Reverse the removal procedures to install. When installing the switch
and bezel unit to the door trim panel opening, insert the rear of the bezel into
the opening, then push down on the front of the bezel until the retaining tab snaps into place.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Locations
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Locations
Washer Reservoir And Pump Remove/Install
The washer fluid level sensor is mounted on the inboard side of the reservoir above the washer
pump.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1297
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Description and Operation
SYSTEM OPERATION
The washer fluid level sensor is mounted on the inboard side of the reservoir above the washer
pump. A barbed nipple on the sensor is press-fit into a rubber grommet seal installed in a hole in
the side of the reservoir.
When the fluid level in the reservoir falls below the pivoting float on the sensor, the float changes
position and closes the internal switch contacts of the sensor. Refer to Low Washer Fluid Warning
Lamp in the Diagnosis and Testing for diagnosis of the low washer fluid warning lamp and circuit,
including the sensor.
The washer fluid level sensor cannot be repaired. If faulty or damaged, the sensor unit must be
replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Washer Fluid
Level Switch > Component Information > Locations > Page 1298
Washer Fluid Level Switch: Service and Repair
Washer Reservoir And Pump Remove/Install
REMOVAL
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Unplug the wire harness connector from
the washer pump. 3. Remove the washer supply hose from the washer pump and drain the washer
fluid from the reservoir into a clean container for reuse.
NOTE: The pivoting float of the washer fluid sensor must be in a horizontal position within the
reservoir in order to be removed. With the reservoir empty and held in an upright position, the
pivoting float will orient itself to the horizontal position when the sensor connector is pointed straight
downwards.
4. Using a trim stick or another suitable wide flat-bladed tool, gently pry the washer fluid level
sensor out of the rubber grommet seal. Care must be
taken not to damage the reservoir.
5. Remove the rubber grommet seal from the reservoir and discard. 6. Reverse the removal
procedures to install. Always use a new rubber grommet seal on the reservoir.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Specifications
Windshield Washer Switch: Specifications
Tighten the fasteners as follows:
- Multi-function switch wire harness connector screw - 2 Nm (17 in lbs).
- Multi-function switch mounting screws - 2 Nm (17 in lbs).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1302
Windshield Washer Switch: Locations
Multi-Function Switch
The windshield wiper and washer switches are contained in the multi-function switch assembly.
The multi-function switch assembly is secured to the left side of the steering column.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Windshield Washer Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1305
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1306
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1307
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1308
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1309
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1310
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1311
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1312
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1313
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1314
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1315
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1316
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1317
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1318
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1319
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1320
Windshield Washer Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1321
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1322
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1323
Multi-Function Switch - 24 Way
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1324
Windshield Washer Switch: Service Precautions
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AN AIRBAG, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY
.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1325
Windshield Washer Switch: Description and Operation
Multi-Function Switch
SYSTEM OPERATION
The windshield wiper and washer switches are contained in the multi-function switch assembly.
The multi-function switch assembly is secured to the left side of the steering column. A knob on the
end of the multi-function switch stalk is rotated to select the desired wiper speed or intermittent
wipe delay, or depressed toward the steering column to activate the washer system.
The multi-function switch contains circuitry for the following functions: Turn signals
- Hazard warning
- Headlamp beam selection A
- Headlamp optical horn
- Windshield wipers
- Windshield washers.
However, the multi-function switch cannot be repaired. If any function of the multi-function switch is
faulty, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1326
Windshield Washer Switch: Testing and Inspection
Multi-Function Switch Continuity
See System Diagnosis before testing the multi-function switch.
For additional testing and inspection information please refer to Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/ See: Body and Frame/Body Control
Systems/Central Timer Module
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AN AIRBAG, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Unplug the multi-function switch wire
harness connector from the multi-function switch. 3. Using an ohmmeter, perform the switch
continuity checks at the switch terminals as shown in the Multi-Function Switch Continuity chart. 4.
If the switch fails any of the continuity checks, replace the faulty switch. If the switch is OK, repair
the wiper system and/or washer system wire
harness circuits as required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1327
Windshield Washer Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. If the vehicle is so equipped remove the tilt
steering column lever.
3. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds from the steering column. 4. Remove the lower fixed
column shroud.
Multifunction Switch
5. Move the upper fixed column shroud far enough to access the rear of the multi-function switch.
6. Remove the tamper proof mounting screws (a Snap On tamper proof Torx bit TTXR20B2 or
equivalent is required) that secure the multi-function
switch to the steering column.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Windshield
Washer Switch > Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1328
7. Gently pull the switch away from the steering column far enough to access and remove the
multi-function switch wire harness connector screw. 8. Unplug the wire harness connector from the
multi-function switch. 9. Reverse the removal procedures to install. Tighten the fasteners as
follows:
- Multi-function switch wire harness connector screw - 2 Nm (17 in lbs).
- Multi-function switch mounting screws - 2 Nm (17 in lbs).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Specifications
Wiper Switch: Specifications
Tighten the fasteners as follows:
- Multi-function switch wire harness connector screw - 2 Nm (17 in lbs).
- Multi-function switch mounting screws - 2 Nm (17 in lbs).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Specifications > Page 1332
Wiper Switch: Locations
Multi-Function Switch
The windshield wiper and washer switches are contained in the multi-function switch assembly.
The multi-function switch assembly is secured to the left side of the steering column.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions
Wiper Switch: Diagram Information and Instructions
Introduction
General Information (Part 1 Of 2)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1335
General Information (Part 2 Of 2)
Chrysler wiring diagrams are designed to provide information regarding the vehicles wiring content.
In order to effectively use Chrysler wiring diagrams to diagnose and repair a Chrysler vehicle, it is
important to understand all of their features and characteristics.
Diagrams are arranged such that the power (B+) side of the circuit is placed near the top of the
page, and the ground (B-) side of the circuit is placed near the bottom of the page.
All switches, components, and modules are shown in the at rest position with the doors closed and
the key removed from the ignition.
Components are shown two ways. A solid line around a component indicates that the component is
complete. A dashed line around a component indicates that the component being shown is not
complete. Incomplete components have a reference number to indicate the page where the
component is shown complete.
It is important to realize that no attempt is made on the diagrams to represent components and
wiring as they appear on the vehicle. For example, a short piece of wire is treated the same as a
long one. In addition, switches and other components are shown as simply as possible, with regard
to function only.
Circuit Function
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1336
Circuit Identification Code Chart
All circuits in the diagrams use an alpha/numeric code to identify the wire and its function. To
identify which circuit code applies to a system, refer to the Circuit Identification Code Chart. This
chart shows the main circuits only and does not show the secondary codes that may apply to some
models.
Circuit Information
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1337
Wire Code Identification
Wire Color Code Chart
Each wire shown in the diagrams contains a code which identifies the main circuit, part of the main
circuit, gauge of wire, and color.
Connector Information
CAUTION: Not all connectors are serviced. Some connectors are serviced only with a harness. A
typical example might be the Supplemental Restraint System connectors. Always check parts
availability before attempting a repair.
IDENTIFICATION
In-line connectors are identified by a number, as follows: In-line connectors located on the engine compartment harness are C100 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the instrument panel harness are C200 series numbers.
- Connectors located on the body harness are C300 series numbers.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1338
- Jumper harness connectors are C400 series numbers.
- Grounds and ground connectors are identified with a "G" and follow the same series numbering
as the in-line connector.
Component Identification
Component connectors are identified by the component name instead of a number.
Connector Identification
Multiple connectors on a component use a C1, C2, etc. identifier.
Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) Sensitive Devices
Electrostatic Discharge Symbol
All Electrostatic Discharge (ESD) sensitive components are solid state and a symbol is used to
indicate this. When handling any component with this symbol, comply with the following procedures
to reduce the possibility of electrostatic charge build-up on the body and inadvertent discharge into
the component. If it is not known whether the part is ESD sensitive, assume that it is.
1. Always touch a known good ground before handling the part. This should be repeated while
handling the part, especially after sliding across a seat,
sitting down from a standing position, or walking a distance.
2. Avoid touching electrical terminals of the part, unless instructed to do so by a written procedure.
3. When using a voltmeter, be sure to connect the ground lead first. 4. Do not remove the part from
its protective packing until it is time to install the part. 5. Before removing the part from its package,
ground the package to a known good ground on the vehicle.
Fasteners
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1339
Shock Tower To Spring Minimum Clearance Area
CAUTION: At no time when servicing a vehicle, can a sheet metal screw, bolt, or other metal
fastener be installed in the strut tower to take the place of an original plastic clip. Also, NO holes
can be drilled into the front strut tower in the area shown in for the installation of any metal
fasteners into the strut tower.
Because of the minimum clearance in this area , installation of metal fasteners could damage the
coil spring coating and lead to a corrosion failure of the spring. If a plastic clip is missing, or is lost
or broken during servicing of a vehicle, replace it only with the equivalent part listed in the parts
catalog.
Fuses
CAUTION: When replacing a blown fuse, it is important to replace it with a fuse having the correct
amperage rating. The use of a fuse with a rating other than that indicated may result in an electrical
overload. If a properly rated fuse continues to blow, it indicates a problem that should be corrected.
Notes, Cautions and Warnings
Additional important information is presented in three ways: Notes, Cautions, and Warnings.
NOTES are used to help describe how switches or components operate to complete a particular
circuit. They are also used to indicate different conditions that may appear on the vehicle. For
example, an up-to and after condition.
CAUTIONS are used to indicate information that could prevent making an error that may damage
the vehicle.
WARNINGS provide information to prevent personal injury and vehicle damage. Below is a list of
general warnings that should be followed any time a vehicle is being serviced.
WARNING:
- ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY GLASSES FOR EYE PROTECTION.
- USE SAFETY STANDS ANYTIME A PROCEDURE REQUIRES BEING UNDER A VEHICLE.
- BE SURE THAT THE IGNITION SWITCH ALWAYS IS IN THE OFF POSITION, UNLESS THE
PROCEDURE REQUIRES IT TO BE ON.
- SET THE PARKING BRAKE WHEN WORKING ON ANY VEHICLE. AN AUTOMATIC
TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN PARK. A MANUAL TRANSMISSION SHOULD BE IN
NEUTRAL.
- OPERATE THE ENGINE ONLY IN A WELL-VENTILATED AREA.
- KEEP AWAY FROM MOVING PARTS WHEN THE ENGINE IS RUNNING, ESPECIALLY THE
FAN AND BELTS.
- TO PREVENT SERIOUS BURNS, AVOID CONTACT WITH HOT PARTS SUCH AS THE
RADIATOR, EXHAUST MANIFOLD(S), TAIL PIPE, CATALYTIC CONVERTER, AND MUFFLER.
- DO NOT ALLOW FLAME OR SPARKS NEAR THE BATTERY. GASES ARE ALWAYS
PRESENT IN AND AROUND THE BATTERY.
- ALWAYS REMOVE RINGS, WATCHES, LOOSE HANGING JEWELRY, AND LOOSE
CLOTHING.
Positive Temperature Coefficient
Positive Temperature Coefficient (PTC) devices are being used for circuit protection. These PTC's
act like a solid state fuse. They are located in the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1340
junction block, and are used to protect such items as: power door lock motors, power windows, and
various engine solenoids.
Positive Temperature Coefficient Symbol
A special symbol is used to identify these in the wiring diagrams.
Section Identification
Wiring Diagram Section Identification
The wiring diagrams are grouped into individual sections. If a component is most likely found in a
particular group, it will be shown complete (all wires, connectors, and pins) within that group. For
example, the Auto Shut Down Relay is most likely to be found in Group 30, so it is shown there
complete. It can, however, be shown partially in another group if it contains some associated
wiring.
Symbols
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1341
Symbols
International symbols are used throughout the wiring diagrams. These symbols are consistent with
those being used around the world.
Take-Outs
The abbreviation T/O is used in the component location to indicate a point at which the wiring
harness branches out to a component.
How to Find System & Component Diagrams
When trying to find the diagram for a specific component or system, use the Group Index
information or the Alphabetic Index to Wiring Diagrams under Electrical
Whenever a reference exists to another sheet or figure, find the corresponding diagram using the
Group Index, Diagrams By Sheet Number, or Diagrams By Figure Number. The reference number
for the subsequent diagram will match a listed group shown.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1342
Connector and Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component. 3. Cut off the existing wire connector directly behind the insulator. Remove six
inches of tape from the harness. 4. Stagger cut all wires on the harness side at 1/2 inch intervals.
5. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire on the harness side.
Stagger Cutting Wires (Typical)
6. Stagger cut the matching wires on the repair connector assembly in the opposite order as was
done on the harness side of the repair. Allow extra
length for soldered connections. Check that the overall length is the same as the original.
7. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each wire. 8. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side
of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
9. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
10. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2). 11. Twist the wires together (Example 3). 12. Solder the connection together using rosin core
solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 13. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat
using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
14. Repeat steps 8 through 13 for each wire. 15. Re-tape the wire harness starting 1-1/2 inches
behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 16. Re-connect the repaired connector. 17.
Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Connector Replacement
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1343
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector (that is to be repaired) from its mating
half/component.
Connector Locking Wedge
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Reset the terminal locking tang, if it has one. 6. Insert the removed wire in the same cavity on
the repair connector. 7. Repeat steps 4 through 6 for each wire in the connector, being sure that all
wires are inserted into the proper cavities. 8. Insert the connector locking wedge into the repaired
connector, if required. 9. Connect the connector to its mating half/component.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1344
Diode Replacement
Diode Identification
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Locate the diode in the harness and remove the protective covering.
3. Remove the diode from the harness, pay attention to the current flow direction. 4. Remove the
insulation from the wires in the harness. Only remove enough insulation to solder in the new diode.
5. Install the new diode in the harness, making sure current flow is correct. 6. Solder the connection
together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder. 7. Tape the diode to the harness
using electrical tape, making sure the diode is completely sealed from the elements. 8. Re-connect
the battery and test affected systems.
Terminal Replacement
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector being repaired from its mating
half/component.
Connnector Locking Wedge Tab (Typical)
3. Remove the connector locking wedge, if required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1345
Terminal Removal
Terminal Removal Using Special Tool
4. Position the connector locking finger away from the terminal using the proper pick from Special
Tool Kit 6680. Pull on the wire to remove the
terminal from the connector.
5. Cut the wire 6 inches from the back of the connector. 6. Remove 1 inch of insulation from the
wire on the harness side. 7. Select a wire from the terminal repair assembly that best matches the
color of the wire being repaired. 8. Cut the repair wire to the proper length and remove 1 inch of
insulation. 9. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will
be long enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
Wire Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1346
10. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1). 11. Push
the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire re close to the insulation (Example 2). 12.
Twist the wires together (Example 3). 13. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder
only. Do not use acid core solder. 14. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a
heat gun. Heat the joint until the tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
15. Insert the repaired wire into the connector. 16. Install the connector locking wedge, if required
and re-connect the connector to its mating half/component. 17. Re-tape the wire harness starting
1-1/2 inches behind the connector and 2 inches past the repair. 18. Connect the battery and test all
affected systems.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Molex Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Molex Connector Repair
3. Insert the terminal releasing special tool 6742 into the terminal end of the connector.
Using Special Tool 6742
4. Using special tool 6742, release the locking fingers on the terminal. 5. Pull on the wire to remove
it from the connector. 6. Repair or replace the connector or terminal, as necessary.
Terminal/Connector Repair-Thomas and Betts Connectors
1. Disconnect the battery. 2. Disconnect the connector from its mating half/component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1347
Thomas And Betts Connector Lock Release Tabs
3. Push in the two lock tabs on the side of the connector.
Removing Wire Terminal
4. Insert the probe end of Special Tool 6934 into the back of the connector cavity. 5. Grasp the wire
and Special Tool 6934 and slowly remove the wire and terminal from the connector. 6. Repair or
replace the terminal. 7. Install the wire and terminal in the connector. Fully seat the terminal in the
connector.
Single Lock Tab
8. Push in the single lock tab on the side of the connector.
Wiring Repair
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1348
Wire Repair
When replacing or repairing a wire, it is important that the correct gauge be used as shown in the
wiring diagrams. The wires must also be held securely in place to prevent damage to the insulation.
1. Disconnect the battery negative cable.
2. Remove 1 inch of insulation from each end of the wire.
3. Place a piece of heat-shrink tubing over one side of the wire. Be sure the tubing will be long
enough to cover and seal the entire repair area.
4. Spread the strands of the wire apart on each part of the exposed wires (Example 1).
5. Push the two ends of wire together until the strands of wire are close to the insulation (Example
2).
6. Twist the wires together (Example 3).
7. Solder the connection together using rosin core solder only. Do not use acid core solder.
8. Center the heat-shrink tubing over the joint and heat using a heat gun. Heat the joint until the
tubing is tightly sealed and sealant comes out of both
ends of the tubing.
9. Secure the wire to the existing ones to prevent chafing or damage to the insulation.
10. Connect the battery and test all affected systems.
Special Tools
Probing Tool Package 6807
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1349
Terminal Pick 6680
Terminal Removing Tool 6932
Terminal Removing Tool 6934
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1350
Wiper Switch: Diagnostic Aids
Intermittent and Poor Connections
Most intermittent electrical problems are caused by faulty electrical connections or wiring. It is also
possible for a sticking component or relay to cause a problem. Before condemning a component or
wiring assembly check the following items.
- Connectors are fully seated
- Spread terminals, or terminal push out
- Terminals in the wiring assembly are fully seated into the connector/component and locked in
position
- Dirt or corrosion on the terminals. Any amount of corrosion or dirt could cause an intermittent
problem
- Damaged connector/component casing exposing the item to dirt and moisture
- Wire insulation that has rubbed through causing a short to ground
- Some or all of the wiring strands broken inside of the insulation covering.
- Wiring broken inside of the insulation
Troubleshooting Tests
Before beginning any tests on a vehicle's electrical system, use the wiring diagrams to study the
circuit. Also refer to Troubleshooting Wiring Problems section.
Testing For Voltage
Testing For Voltage
1. Connect the ground lead of a voltmeter to a known good ground. 2. Connect the other lead of
the voltmeter to the selected test point. The vehicle ignition may need to be turned ON to check
voltage. Refer to the
appropriate test procedure.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1351
Testing For Continuity
Testing For Continuity
1. Remove the fuse for the circuit being checked or disconnect the battery. 2. Connect one lead of
the ohmmeter to one side of the circuit being tested. 3. Connect the other lead to the other end of
the circuit being tested. Low or no resistance means good continuity.
Testing For A Short To Ground
1. Remove the fuse and disconnect all items involved with the fuse. 2. Connect a test light or a
voltmeter across the terminals of the fuse. 3. Starting at the fuse block, wiggle the wiring harness
every 6 to 8 Inches and watch the voltmeter/test light. 4. If the voltmeter registers voltage or the
test light glows, there is a short-to-ground in that general area of the wiring harness.
Testing For A Short-to-ground On Fuses Powering Several Loads
1. Refer to the wiring diagrams and disconnect or isolate all items on the fuse circuit. 2. Replace
the blown fuse. 3. Supply power to the fuse by turning ON the ignition switch or re-connecting the
battery. 4. Start connecting the items in the fuse circuit, one at a time. When the fuse blows, the
circuit with the short-to-ground has been isolated.
Testing For Voltage Drop
Testing For Voltage Drop
1. Connect the positive lead of the voltmeter to the side of the circuit closest to the battery. 2.
Connect the other lead of the voltmeter to the other side of the switch or component.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1352
3. Operate the item. 4. The voltmeter will show the difference in voltage between the two points.
Troubleshooting Tools
TROUBLESHOOTING TOOLS
When diagnosing a problem in an electrical circuit, there are several common tools necessary.
These tools are listed and explained below.
- Jumper Wire - This is a test wire used to connect two points of a circuit. It can be used to bypass
an open in a circuit.
WARNING: NEVER USE A JUMPER WIRE ACROSS A LOAD, SUCH AS A MOTOR,
CONNECTED BETWEEN A BATTERY FEED AND GROUND.
- Voltmeter - This instrument is used to check for voltage on a circuit. Always connect the black
lead to a known good ground and the red lead to the positive side of the circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking voltages in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance.
- Ohmmeter - This instrument is used to check the resistance between two points of a circuit. Low
or no resistance in a circuit can mean good continuity or a shorted circuit.
CAUTION: Most of the electrical components used in today's vehicle are solid state. When
checking resistance in these circuits, use a meter with a 10 megohm or greater impedance. In
addition, be sure the power is disconnected from the circuit. Circuits that are powered-up by the
vehicle electrical system can cause damage to the equipment and provide false readings.
Probing Tool
- Probing Tools - These tools are used for probing terminals in connectors. Select the proper size
tool from Special Tool Package 6807 and insert it into the terminal being tested. Use the other end
of the tool to insert the meter probe.
Troubleshooting Wiring Problems
When troubleshooting wiring problems there are six steps which can aid in the procedure. The
steps are listed and explained below. Always check for non-factory items added to the vehicle
before doing any diagnosis. If the vehicle is equipped with these items, disconnect them to verify
these add-on items are not the cause of the problem.
1. Verify the problem.
2. Verify any related symptoms. Do this by performing operational checks on components that are
in the same circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
3. Analyze the symptoms. Use the wiring diagrams to determine what the circuit is doing, where the
problem most likely is occurring and where the
diagnosis will continue.
4. Isolate the problem area.
5. Repair the problem.
6. Verify proper operation. For this step check for proper operation of all items on the repaired
circuit. Refer to the wiring diagrams.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Diagram Information and Instructions > Page 1353
Multi-Function Switch - 24 Way
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1354
Wiper Switch: Service Precautions
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AN AIRBAG, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY
.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1355
Wiper Switch: Description and Operation
Multi-Function Switch
SYSTEM OPERATION
The windshield wiper and washer switches are contained in the multi-function switch assembly.
The multi-function switch assembly is secured to the left side of the steering column. A knob on the
end of the multi-function switch stalk is rotated to select the desired wiper speed or intermittent
wipe delay, or depressed toward the steering column to activate the washer system.
The multi-function switch contains circuitry for the following functions: Turn signals
- Hazard warning
- Headlamp beam selection A
- Headlamp optical horn
- Windshield wipers
- Windshield washers.
However, the multi-function switch cannot be repaired. If any function of the multi-function switch is
faulty, or if the switch is damaged, the entire switch assembly must be replaced.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1356
Wiper Switch: Testing and Inspection
For additional testing and inspection information please refer to Powertrain
Management/Computers and Control Systems/ See: Body and Frame/Body Control
Systems/Central Timer Module
See Wiper System and/or Washer System Testing and Inspection before testing the multi-function
switch. See: Wiper and Washer Systems/Testing and Inspection
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AN AIRBAG, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Unplug the multi-function switch wire
harness connector from the multi-function switch.
Multi-Function Switch Continuity
3. Using an ohmmeter, perform the switch continuity checks at the switch terminals as shown in the
Multi-Function Switch Continuity chart. 4. If the switch fails any of the continuity checks, replace the
faulty switch. If the switch is OK, repair the wiper system and/or washer system wire
harness circuits as required.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1357
Wiper Switch: Service and Repair
REMOVAL
WARNING: ON VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AIRBAGS, REFER TO AIR BAGS AND SEAT
BELTS/AIR BAGS BEFORE ATTEMPTING ANY STEERING WHEEL, STEERING COLUMN, OR
INSTRUMENT PANEL COMPONENT DIAGNOSIS OR SERVICE. FAILURE TO TAKE THE
PROPER PRECAUTIONS COULD RESULT IN ACCIDENTAL AIRBAG DEPLOYMENT AND
POSSIBLE PERSONAL INJURY.
1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. If the vehicle is so equipped remove the tilt
steering column lever.
3. Remove both the upper and lower shrouds from the steering column. 4. Remove the lower fixed
column shroud.
Multifunction Switch
5. Move the upper fixed column shroud far enough to access the rear of the multi-function switch.
6. Remove the tamper proof mounting screws (a Snap On tamper proof torx bit TTXR20B2 or
equivalent is required) that secure the multi-function
switch to the steering column.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Sensors and Switches > Sensors and Switches - Wiper and Washer Systems > Wiper Switch
> Component Information > Diagrams > Page 1358
7. Gently pull the switch away from the steering column far enough to access and remove the
multi-function switch wire harness connector screw. 8. Unplug the wire harness connector from the
multi-function switch. 9. Reverse the removal procedures to install. Tighten the fasteners as
follows:
- Multi-function switch wire harness connector screw - 2 Nm (17 in lbs).
- Multi-function switch mounting screws - 2 Nm (17 in lbs).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Pick-Up
Alignment: Specifications Pick-Up
CASTER:
With a GVW of 8,800 lbs. and a Wheel Base of 134.7 inches: Preferred ...........................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
......... +3.10° Range ............................................................................................................................
.......................................................................................... ± 1.00°
With a GVW of 8,800 lbs. and a Wheel Base of 138.7 inches: Preferred ...........................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
......... +3.15° Range ............................................................................................................................
.......................................................................................... ± 1.00°
With a GVW of 8,800 lbs. and a Wheel Base of 154.7 inches: Preferred ...........................................
..............................................................................................................................................................
......... +3.25° Range ............................................................................................................................
.......................................................................................... ± 1.00°
CAMBER:
Not Set
TOTAL TOE-IN:
Preferred ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................................... +0.10° Range .................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................... ±
0.10°
CROSS CASTER:
Preferred ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... 0° Range .................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................... ±
0.5°
CROSS CAMBER:
Not Set
THRUST ANGLE:
Preferred ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... 0° Range .................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................... ±
0.4°
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Pick-Up > Page 1364
Alignment: Specifications Cab-Chassis
NOTE: To determine correct caster alignment angle for Cab-Chassis vehicles the following
procedure must be performed.
CASTER:
Chassis Measurement
1. Take a height measurement to the center of the front gauge hole in the frame. Take another
measurement to the center of the rear spring hanger
bolt. Take these measurements on both sides of the vehicle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Pick-Up > Page 1365
Corrected Caster Chart Cab-Chassis
2. Subtract the front measurement from the rear measurement and use the average between the
right and left side. Use this number (caster correlation
value) with the corrected caster chart to obtain the preferred caster angle.
CAMBER:
Not Set
TOTAL TOE-IN:
Preferred ..............................................................................................................................................
.................................................................... +0.10° Range .................................................................
..................................................................................................................................................... ±
0.10°
CROSS CASTER:
Preferred ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... 0° Range .................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................... ±
0.5°
CROSS CAMBER:
Not Set
THRUST ANGLE:
Preferred ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................................... 0° Range .................................................................
....................................................................................................................................................... ±
0.4°
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1366
Alignment: Description and Operation
Alignment Angles - Independent Front Suspension
Alignment Angels - Link/Coil
Wheel alignment is the positioning of the wheels in relation to the vehicle. This is accomplished
through suspension and steering linkage adjustments. An alignment is essential for efficient
steering, good directional stability and to minimize tire wear. The most important measurements of
an alignment are caster, camber and toe position. CASTER is the forward or rearward tilt of the steering knuckle from vertical. Tilting the top of the
knuckle rearward provides positive caster. Tilting the top of the knuckle forward provides negative
caster. Caster is a directional stability angle which enables the front wheels to return to a straight
ahead position after turns.
- CAMBER is the inward or outward tilt of the wheel relative to the center of the vehicle. Tilting the
top of the wheel inward provides negative camber. Tilting the top of the wheel outward provides
positive camber. Incorrect camber will cause wear on the inside or outside edge of the tire.
- WHEEL TOE POSITION is the difference between the leading inside edges and trailing inside
edges of the front tires. Incorrect wheel toe position is the most common cause of unstable steering
and uneven tire wear. The wheel toe position is the final front wheel alignment adjustment.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1367
CAUTION: Do not attempt to modify any suspension or steering components by heating and
bending.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Specifications > Page 1368
Alignment: Testing and Inspection
PRE-ALIGNMENT
Before starting wheel alignment, the following inspection and necessary corrections must be
completed. 1. Inspect tires for size and tread wear. 2. Set tire air pressure. 3. Inspect front wheel
bearings for wear. 4. Inspect front wheels for excessive radial or lateral runout and balance. 5.
Inspect ball studs, linkage pivot points and steering gear for looseness, roughness or binding 6.
Inspect suspension components for wear and noise.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Cab and Chassis
Caster Correction Measurement
Alignment: Service and Repair Cab and Chassis Caster Correction Measurement
NOTE: To determine the correct caster alignment angle for Cab-Chassis vehicles the following procedure
must be performed.
- 4x2 11000 GVW has a solid front axle and uses a 4x4 frame.
Corrected Caster Chart - Cab Chassis
1. Take a height measurement to the center of the front gauge hole in the frame. Take another
measurement to the center of the rear spring hanger
bolt. Take these measurements on both sides of the vehicle.
2. Subtract the front measurement from the rear measurement and use the average between the
right and left side. Use this number (caster correlation
valve) with the Corrected Caster Chart to obtain the preferred caster angle.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Cab and Chassis
Caster Correction Measurement > Page 1371
Chassis Measurement
Corrected Caster Chart-Cab Chassis
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Cab and Chassis
Caster Correction Measurement > Page 1372
Alignment: Service and Repair Independent Front Suspension
Before each alignment reading the vehicle should be jounced (rear first, then front). Grasp each
bumper at the center and jounce the vehicle up and down several times. Always release the
bumper in the down position. Set the front end alignment to specifications while the vehicle is in its
NORMALLY LOADED CONDITION.
Caster Camber Adjustment Location
Camber and caster angle adjustments involve changing the position of the upper suspension arm
pivot bar. CASTER: Move the rear position of the pivot bar in or out. This will change the caster
angle significantly and camber angle only slightly. To retain camber move the forward pivot very
slightly in the opposite direction.
NOTE: For example, to increase a positive caster angle, move the rear position of the pivot bar
inward (toward the engine). Move the front of pivot bar outward (away from the engine) slightly until
the original camber angle is obtained.
CAMBER: Move the forward position of the pivot bar in or out. This will change the camber angle
significantly and caster angle only slightly. The camber angle should be adjusted as close as
possible to the preferred service specification. After adjustment is made tighten pivot bar nuts to
specifications. TOE POSITION: The wheel toe position adjustment should be the final adjustment.
1. Start the engine and turn wheels both ways before straightening the wheels. Center and secure
the steering wheel and turn off engine. 2. Loosen the tie rod adjustment sleeve clamp bolts/nuts.
NOTE: Each front wheel should be adjusted for one-half of the total toe position specification. This
will ensure the steering wheel will be centered when the wheels are positioned straight-ahead.
3. Adjust the wheel toe position by turning the tie rod adjustment sleeves as necessary.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Cab and Chassis
Caster Correction Measurement > Page 1373
Alignment: Service and Repair Link/Coil Suspension
Before each alignment reading the vehicle should be jounced (rear first, then front). Grasp each
bumper at the center and jounce the vehicle up and down several times. Always release the
bumper in the down position. Set the front end alignment to specifications while the vehicle is in its
NORMALLY LOADED CONDITION. CAMBER: The wheel camber angle is preset and is not
adjustable. CASTER: Check the caster of the front axle for correct angle. Be sure the axle is not
bent or twisted. Road test the vehicle and make left and right turn. Observe the steering wheel
return-to-center position. Low caster will cause poor steering wheel returnability.
Cam Adjuster
Caster can be adjusted by rotating the cams on the lower suspension arm. TOE POSITION: The
wheel toe position adjustment should be the final adjustment. 1. Start the engine and turn wheels
both ways before straightening the wheels. Center and Secure the steering wheel and turn off
engine. 2. Loosen the adjustment sleeve clamp bolts.
Alignment Bar/Drag Link Adjustment
CAUTION: Do not loosen/move alignment bar or alignment bar clamp. The bar is used as a locator
for the adjuster clamps.
3. Adjust the right wheel toe position with the drag link. Turn the sleeve until the right wheel is at
the correct TOE-IN position. Position clamp bolts
to their original position and tighten to specifications. Make sure the toe setting does not change
during clamp tightening.
4. Adjust left wheel toe position with tie rod at left knuckle. Turn the sleeve until the left wheel is at
the correct TOE-IN position. Position clamp
bolts to their original position and tighten to specifications. Make sure the toe setting does not
change during clamp tightening.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Alignment > System Information > Service and Repair > Cab and Chassis
Caster Correction Measurement > Page 1374
5. Verify the right toe setting.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Low Power/Poor Performance Diagnosis
Fuel Pressure: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Low Power/Poor Performance Diagnosis
NUMBER: 18-21-99
GROUP: Vehicle Performance
DATE: Sep. 3, 1999
SUBJECT: 5.9L - 24V Cummins Diesel Low Power Or Poor Performance Diagnostic
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves diagnostic procedure that may be used to assist the technician
in the diagnosis of a low power or poor performance complaint.
MODELS: 1998 - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
The vehicle operator may complain of slow acceleration or a lack of power when towing or hauling
moderate to heavy loads. The condition may be worse at higher altitude.
DIAGNOSIS:
NOTE:
DO NOT PROCEED WITH THIS TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN (TSB) UNTIL TSB 18-11-99
HAS BEEN PERFORMED, ALL SCHEDULED MAINTENANCE OF THE AIR FILTER AND FUEL
FILTER IS CURRENT, AND ANY ACTIVE OR INACTIVE DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODES (DTC)
HAVE BEEN REPAIRED.
Interview the vehicle operator to understand under what driving conditions the above symptom
occurs.
1). While inside the vehicle cab and using the Diagnostic Readout Box (DRB III(R)), verify that the
throttle is opening fully.
2). Refer to the 1999 Ram Truck Service Manual 81-370-9108 pages 14-78 to 14-80. Perform the
complete FUEL TRANSFER PUMP PRESSURE TEST procedure.
3). Inspect the fuel tank rollover valve for restrictions or that the shipping cap has not been left on
the end of the valve.
4). Inspect the Charge Air Cooler hoses and clamps for proper installation. Inspect all connections
and clamps for looseness. Verify that no leaks are present when the engine is under boost
conditions. Pay close attention to the exhaust connections.
5). While performing the following road test, verify that the turbo boost pressure is 16 psi (33 in. of
Hg.) during wide open throttle (WOT) acceleration. If boost pressure is found to be less than 16 psi
(33 in. of Hg.), refer to TSB 11-08-98.
6). While road testing the vehicle in a safe area and manner, conduct an acceleration test. For
vehicles equipped with an automatic transmission conduct a 0-60 mph acceleration test. For
vehicles equipped with a manual transmission, conduct a 40-60 mph acceleration test in 4th gear.
It may take the technician performing several acceleration tests to obtain consistent acceleration
times.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Engine - Low Power/Poor Performance Diagnosis > Page 1380
5.9L - 24V DIESEL 0-60 MPH WIDE OPEN THROTTLE ACCELERATION TEST
5.9L - 24V DIESEL 40-60 MPH WIDE OPEN THROTTLE ACCELERATION TEST IN 4th GEAR
7). Refer the to the acceleration reference charts. If the acceleration times, of the vehicle in
question, are equal to or less than the stated times listed in the following acceleration charts, then
the vehicle performance is normal and the vehicle can be returned to the vehicle owner. If the
acceleration times are greater than the stated times listed in the acceleration charts, then further
diagnostic testing is required.
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Pressure > System
Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1381
Fuel Pressure: Specifications
Fuel Transfer (Lift) Pump Pressure
Engine running ....................................................................................................................................
.................................... 69 kPa (10 psi) Minimum Engine cranking .....................................................
.............................................................................................................. 48 kPa (5 - 7 psi) Minimum
Fuel Injector "Pop Off" Pressure
Using injector tester
.............................................................................................................................................................
31,026 kPa (4500 ± 250 psi)
Fuel Injector Leak-Down Pressure ........................................................................................
Approximately 20 bars (291 psi) lower than pop pressure.
Fuel Pressure Drop
Across fuel filter test ports (at 2500
rpm)................................................................................................................................... 35 kPa (5
psi) maximum
Overflow Valve Release Pressure
At 2500 rpm .........................................................................................................................................
..................................................... 97 kPa (14 psi)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information
> Specifications > Diesel Idle Plate
Idle Speed: Specifications Diesel Idle Plate
ENGINE DATA PLATE
The engine data plate contains: Advertised horsepower
- Cubic inch/liter of engine
- Engine model number
- Fuel rate at advertised horsepower
- Idle speed specification
- Injection pump CPL number
- Injection pump timing (in degrees)
- Injector firing order
- Valve lash specification
Engine Data Plate Location
If anything differs between the specifications found on the engine data plate and the specifications
used in any service procedure, use specifications on data plate. The engine data plate is
permanently riveted to the side of the engine timing gear cover located on the drivers side of
engine.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Idle Speed > System Information
> Specifications > Diesel Idle Plate > Page 1386
Idle Speed: Specifications Idle Speed Information Not Available
Information not supplied by the manufacturer
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Cleaner
Fresh Air Duct/Hose > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Cleaner Fresh Air Duct/Hose: Service and Repair
AIR INTAKE / BOOST SYSTEM
The air intake system consists of the air cleaner/ housing assembly, turbocharger, charge air cooler
piping, charge air cooler, intake air grid heater, and the intake manifold.
Intake Air Circulation
Intake air is drawn through the air cleaner and into the turbocharger compressor housing.
Pressurized air from the turbocharger then flows forward through the charge air cooler located in
front of the radiator. From the charge air cooler the air flows back into the intake manifold. The
charge air cooler is a heat exchanger that uses air flow from vehicle motion to dissipate heat from
the intake air. As the turbocharger increases air pressure, the air temperature increases. Lowering
the intake air temperature increases engine efficiency and power.
CAUTION: The charge air cooler must be cleaned following turbocharger failure involving an oil
leak. Oil leaking from the turbocharger can cause engine runaway, possibly leading to engine
failure. Refer to Charge Air Cooler Removal and Installation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
Testing Air Cleaner Element
Do not attempt to unnecessarily remove the top of the air cleaner housing for air cleaner element
inspection on diesel engines.
Filter Minder - Location
The air cleaner (filter) housing is equipped with an air Filter Minder(R) gauge. This air flow
restriction gauge will determine when the air cleaner element is restricted and should be replaced.
Filter Minder
The Filter Minded consists of a diaphragm and calibrated spring sealed inside of a plastic housing.
A yellow colored disc attached to the diaphragm moves along a graduated scale on the side of the
Filter Minder. After the engine has been shut off, a ratcheting device located within the Filter Minder
will hold the yellow disc at the highest restriction that the air cleaner element has experienced. A
drop in air pressure due to an air cleaner element restriction moves the diaphragm and the yellow
disc will indicate the size of the air drop.
CAUTION: Certain engine degreasers or cleaners may discolor or damage the plastic housing of
the Filter Minder. Cover and tape the Filter Minder if any engine degreasers or cleaners are to be
used.
To test, turn the engine off. If the yellow disc has reached the red colored zone on the graduated
scale, the air cleaner element should be replaced. Refer to the proceeding removal/installation
paragraphs.
Resetting the Filter Minder: After the air cleaner (filter) element has been replaced, press the
rubber button on the top of the Filter Minder. This will allow the yellow colored disc to reset. After
the button has been pressed, the yellow disc should spring back to the UP position.
If the Filter Minder gauge has reached the red colored zone, and after an examination of the air
cleaner (filter) element, the element appears to be clean, the high reading may be due to a
temporary condition such as snow build-up at the air intake. Temporary high restrictions may also
occur if the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter
Element > Component Information > Service and Repair > Page 1394
air cleaner (filter) element has gotten wet such as during a heavy rain or snow. If this occurs, allow
the element to dry out during normal engine operation. Reset the rubber button on the top of the
Filter Minder and retest after the element has dried.
REMOVAL
1. Loosen air inlet tube clamp at air cleaner housing inlet. Remove this tube at air cleaner housing
cover. 2. The housing cover is equipped with four (4) spring clips and is hinged at front with plastic
tabs. Unlatch clips from top of air cleaner housing and
tilt housing cover up and forward for cover removal.
3. Remove air cleaner element from air cleaner housing.
INSTALLATION
1. Before installing a new air cleaner element, clean inside of air cleaner housing. 2. Position air
cleaner cover to tabs on front of air cleaner housing. Latch four spring clips to seal cover to
housing. 3. Install air inlet tube at air cleaner housing inlet. Note hose alignment notches at both
inlet hose and air cleaner cover. 4. Position tube clamp to inlet tube and tighten to 3 Nm (25 in.
lbs.) torque.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Specifications
Fuel Filter: Specifications
Fuel Drain Manifold "T" Fitting 12 Nm
Fuel Filter Canister Mounting Nut 14 Nm
Fuel Filter Drain Valve Mounting Screws 3-5 Nm
Fuel Filter Canister Bracket Bolts 24 Nm
Banjo Fittings at top of Filter/Separator 24 Nm
Fuel Pump Module Locknut 24-44 Nm
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1398
Fuel Filter: Locations
Fuel Filter/Water Separator Location
The fuel filter/water separator assembly is located on left side of engine above starter motor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1399
Fuel Filter: Description and Operation
FUEL FILTER/WATER SEPARATOR
The fuel filter/water separator protects the fuel injection pump by removing water and contaminants
from the fuel. The construction of the filter/separator allows fuel to pass through it, but helps
prevent moisture (water) from doing so. Moisture collects at the bottom of the canister.
Fuel Filter/Water Separator Location
The fuel filter/water separator assembly is located on left side of engine above starter motor. The
assembly also includes the fuel heater and Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor.
For draining of water from canister, refer to Fuel Filter/Water Separator Removal/Installation.
A Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor is attached to side of canister. Refer to Water-In-Fuel Sensor
Description/Operation.
The fuel heater is installed into the top of the filter/separator housing. Refer to Fuel Heater
Description/Operation.
FUEL TANK MODULE
An electric fuel pump is not used in the fuel tank module for diesel powered engines. Fuel is
supplied by the engine mounted fuel transfer pump and the fuel injection pump.
Top View Of Fuel Tank Module
The fuel tank module is installed in the top of the fuel tank. The fuel tank module contains the
following components: Fuel reservoir
- A separate in-tank fuel filter
- Rollover valve
- Fuel gauge sending unit (fuel level sensor)
- Fuel supply line connection
- Fuel return line connection
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Specifications > Page 1400
- Auxiliary non-pressurized fuel supply fitting
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Filter/Water Separator Replacement
Fuel Filter: Service and Repair Fuel Filter/Water Separator Replacement
Fuel Filter/Water Separator/Drain Hose Location
The fuel filter/water separator assembly is located on left/rear side of engine above starter motor.
The assembly contains the fuel filter cartridge, Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor, and fuel heater.
REMOVAL
Drain Valve At Fuel Filter/water Separator
Draining water from filter canister: The canister drain valve serves two purposes. One is to partially
drain filter canister of excess water. The other is to completely drain canister for filter, heater or
water-in-fuel sensor replacement. The filter should be drained whenever water-in- fuel warning
lamp remains illuminated. (Note that lamp will be illuminated for approximately two seconds when
ignition key is initially placed in ON position for a bulb check).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Filter/Water Separator Replacement > Page 1403
Fuel Filter/water Separator Components
1. A drain hose is located at bottom of drain valve. Place drain pan under drain hose. 2. With
engine not running, rotate drain valve handle forward to OPEN (DRAIN) position. Hold drain valve
open until all water and contaminants
have been removed and clean fuel exits drain hose.
3. If fuel filter, fuel heater or Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor is being replaced, drain canister
completely. Dispose of mixture in drain pan according to
applicable regulations.
4. After draining operation, rotate valve handle rearward to CLOSE position. If fuel filter, fuel heater
or WIF sensor is being replaced, proceed to
next step.
5. Remove drain hose at drain valve. 6. Disconnect Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor electrical
connector at sensor. The WIF sensor is located at side of filter canister. 7. Loosen filter canister nut
at top of header while lowering canister assembly from header. 8. Remove and discard seals and
center O-rings . 9. Remove filter element (cartridge) from canister.
10. Remove WIF sensor and its O-ring seal from canister . 11. Inspect WIF sensor probes.
Carefully clean contaminants from sensor probes with a cloth if necessary. Replace sensor if
probes are covered with
contaminants and will not clean up.
Fuel Heater Mounting Screws (Bottom View)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Filter/Water Separator Replacement > Page 1404
12. Fuel Heater: The fuel heater is located inside fuel filter housing (header). The heater mounting
plate, heating element, temperature sensor and
wiring harness are serviced as one assembly. a. Disconnect heater pigtail harness electrical
connector from main engine wiring harness near upper/rear of filter. b. The plastic electrical
connector at end of 2-wire pigtail harness will have to be removed from wiring harness before
attempting to pass harness
through filter header.
c. Note locations (colors) of wires in connector before removing connector. d. Remove clip retaining
wires to connector. e. Remove wires from connector. f.
Remove 3 fuel heater mounting screws.
g. Press down on heater sealing grommet to remove heater from filter canister header. h. Pass
wire harness through hole in filter header while removing heater from header.
INSTALLATION
1. Clean inside of canister and canister header. 2. Fuel Heater:
a. Lift fuel heater assembly into filter header while passing wire harness upward through hole in
header. Heater sealing grommet should protrude
at top of filter header.
b. Instal 3 fuel heater mounting screws and tighten to 2-3 Nm (15-20 in. lbs.) torque. c. Install 2
wires into electrical connector and install connector clip. d. Connect heater pigtail harness electrical
connector to main engine wiring harness.
3. Install new O-ring seal to WIF sensor. 4. Install WIF sensor to canister. tighten to 2-3 Nm (15-20
in. lbs.) torque. 5. If drain valve assembly is being replaced, tighten mounting screws to 3-5 Nm
(30-40 in. lbs.) torque. 6. Install new O-rings. 7. Install new seal between canister and canister
header.
If filter canister is not filled with clean diesel fuel before installation, manual air bleeding of fuel
system may be necessary (temporary rough engine running may occur). If necessary, refer to Air
Bleed Procedures.
8. Load filter into canister. 9. Fill filter canister with clean diesel fuel.
10. Apply a light film of clean diesel oil to all seals. 11. Position canister assembly to canister
header. Note locating tabs on canister should align into notch on canister header. 12. Install
canister nut and tighten to 14 Nm (10 ft. lbs.) torque. 13. Connect electrical connector to WIF
sensor. 14. Connect drain hose to bottom of drain valve. 15. Start engine and check for leaks.
Air Bleed Procedure
A certain amount of air becomes trapped in the fuel system when fuel system components on the
supply and/or high-pressure side are serviced or replaced. Primary air bleeding is accomplished
using the electric fuel transfer (lift) pump. If the vehicle has been allowed to run completely out of
fuel, the fuel injectors must also be bled as the fuel injection pump is not self-bleeding (priming).
Servicing or replacing components on the fuel return side will not require air bleeding.
WARNING: DO NOT BLEED AIR FROM THE FUEL SYSTEM OF A HOT ENGINE.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Filter/Water Separator Replacement > Page 1405
Fuel Supply Line Banjo Bolt
1. Loosen, but do not remove, banjo bolt holding low-pressure fuel supply line to side of fuel
injection pump. Place a shop towel around banjo fitting
to catch excess fuel.
The fuel transfer (lift) pump is self-priming: When the key is first turned on (without cranking
engine), the pump operates for approximately 2 seconds and then shuts off. The pump will also
operate for up to 25 seconds after the starter is engaged, and then disengaged and the engine is
not running. The pump shuts off immediately if the key is on and the engine stops running.
2. Turn key to CRANK position and quickly release key to ON position before engine starts. This
will operate fuel transfer pump for approximately
25 seconds.
3. If fuel is not present at fuel supply line after 25 seconds, turn key OFF. Repeat previous step
until fuel is exiting at fuel supply line. 4. tighten banjo bolt at fuel supply line to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
torque. Primary air bleeding is now completed. 5. Attempt to start engine. If engine will not start,
proceed to following steps. If engine does start, it may run erratically and be very noisy for a few
minutes. This is a normal condition.
6. Continue to next step if:
- The vehicle fuel tank has been allowed to run empty
- The fuel injection pump has been replaced
- High-pressure fuel lines have been replaced
- Vehicle has not been operated after an extended period
CAUTION: Do not engage the starter motor for more than 30 seconds at a time. Allow two minutes
between cranking intervals.
7. Perform previous air bleeding procedure steps using fuel transfer pump. Be sure fuel is present
at fuel supply line before proceeding. 8. Crank the engine for 30 seconds at a time to allow air
trapped in the injection pump to vent out the drain manifold.
WARNING: THE FUEL INJECTION PUMP SUPPLIES EXTREMELY HIGH FUEL PRESSURE TO
EACH INDIVIDUAL INJECTOR THROUGH THE HIGH-PRESSURE LINES. FUEL UNDER THIS
AMOUNT OF PRESSURE CAN PENETRATE THE SKIN AND CAUSE PERSONAL INJURY.
WEAR SAFETY GOGGLES AND ADEQUATE PROTECTIVE CLOTHING AND AVOID CONTACT
WITH FUEL SPRAY WHEN BLEEDING HIGH-PRESSURE FUEL LINES. ENGINE MAY START
WHILE CRANKING STARTER MOTOR.
9. Engine may start, may run erratically and be very noisy for a few minutes. This is a normal
condition.
10. Thoroughly clean area around injector fittings where they join injector connector tubes.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Filter/Water Separator Replacement > Page 1406
Bleeding High-Pressure Fuel Lines At Injectors
11. Bleed air by loosening high-pressure fuel line fittings at cylinders number 3, 4 and 5. 12.
Continue bleeding injectors until engine runs smoothly. It may take a few minutes for engine to run
smooth. 13. Tighten fuel line(s) at injector(s) to 38 Nm (28 ft. lbs.) torque.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Fuel Filter > Component
Information > Service and Repair > Fuel Filter/Water Separator Replacement > Page 1407
Fuel Filter: Service and Repair Fuel Tank Module Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Drain and remove fuel tank. Refer to Fuel Tank Removal/Installation. 2. Thoroughly clean area
around tank module at top of tank.
Locknut Removal/Installation - Typical Module
3. The plastic fuel tank module locknut is threaded onto fuel tank. Install Special Tool 6856 to
locknut and remove locknut. The fuel tank module
will spring up when locknut is removed.
4. Remove module from fuel tank.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel tank module is serviced, the rubber gasket must be replaced.
1. Thoroughly clean locknut and locknut threads at top of tank. 2. Using new gasket, carefully
position fuel tank module into opening in fuel tank. 3. Position locknut over top of fuel tank module.
Install locknut finger tight. 4. When looking down at tank from drivers side of tank, the arrow at top
of module should be aligned between two marks stamped into tank
(approximately 2 o'clock position). The fuel line connectors, roll over valve and fuel gauge electrical
connector should all be pointed to drivers side of vehicle. Rotate and align module/tank marks if
necessary before tightening locknut. This step must be performed to prevent the module's float
from contacting side of fuel tank.
5. Tighten locknut to 24-44 Nm (18-32 ft. lbs.) torque. 6. Install fuel tank. Refer to Fuel Tank
Removal/ Installation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Firing Order > Component
Information > Specifications
Firing Order: Specifications
Firing Order
The cylinders are numbered front to rear; 1 to 6. The firing order is 1-5-3-6-2-4.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Ignition Timing > Number One
Cylinder > Component Information > Locations
Number One Cylinder: Locations
Firing Order
The cylinders are numbered front to rear; 1 to 6. The firing order is 1-5-3-6-2-4.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications
Valve Clearance: Specifications
Intake ...................................................................................................................................................
............................................ 0.254 mm (0.010 inch)
Exhaust ................................................................................................................................................
............................................. 0.508 mm (0.020 inch)
Note: Adjust valves when the engine is cold, below 60°C (140 °F).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1418
Valve Clearance: Adjustments
VALVE LASH VERIFICATION & ADJUSTMENT
NOTE: To obtain accurate readings, valve lash measurements AND adjustments should only be
performed when the engine coolant temperature is less than 60° C (140° F).
NOTE: The 24 valve overhead system is a "low-maintenance" design. Routine adjustments are no
longer necessary, however, measurement should still take place when trouble-shooting
performance problems, or upon completion of a repair that includes removal and installation of the
valve train components.
1. Disconnect battery negative cables.
Cylinder Head Cover And Gasket
2. Remove cylinder head cover.
Fuel Pump Gear Access Cover
3. Remove the fuel pump gear access cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1419
Fuel Pump Gear Timing Mark Orientation
4. Using the crankshaft barring tool # 7471B, rotate the engine and align the pump gear mark with
the top dead center (TDC) mark on the gear
housing cover.
Measuring Valve Lash
5. With the engine in this position (pump gear mark at 12 o'clock), valve lash can be measured at
the following rocker arms: INTAKE 1-2-4 /
EXHAUST 1-3-5 Measure the valve lash by inserting a feeler gauge between the rocker arm socket
and crosshead. Refer to the Valve Lash Limit Chart for the correct specifications. If the
measurement falls within the limits, adjustment/resetting is not necessary. If measurement finds the
lash outside of the limits, adjustment/resetting is required.
VALVE LASH LIMIT CHART
INTAKE
MIN. .....................................................................................................................................................
..................................... 0.152 mm (0.006 in.) MAX. ............................................................................
............................................................................................................. 0.381 mm (0.015 in.)
EXHAUST
MIN. .....................................................................................................................................................
..................................... 0.381 mm (0.015 in.) MAX. ............................................................................
............................................................................................................. 0.762 mm (0.030 in.)
NOTE: If measured valve lash falls within these specifications, no adjustment/reset is necessary.
Engine operation within these ranges has no adverse affect on performance, emissions, fuel
economy or level of engine noise.
6. If adjustment/resetting is required, loosen the lock nut on rocker arms and turn the adjusting
screw until the desired lash is obtained:
Adjust valves when the engine is cold, below 60°C (140°F)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1420
^ INTAKE 0.254 mm (0.010 in.)
^ EXHAUST 0.508 mm (0.020 in.)
7. Tighten the lock nut and re-check the valve lash.
Fuel Pump Gear Timing Mark Orientation
8. Using the crankshaft barring tool, rotate the crankshaft one revolution (360°) to align the pump
gear mark to the 6 o'clock position in relation to
the TDC mark on the gear housing cover
9. With the engine in this position (pump gear mark at 6 o'clock), valve lash can be measured at
the remaining rocker arms: INTAKE 3-5-6 /
EXHAUST 2-4-6. Use the same method as above for determining whether adjustment is
necessary, and adjust those that are found to be outside of the limits.
Cylinder Head Cover And Gasket
10. Install the cylinder head cover.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Tune-up and Engine Performance Checks > Valve Clearance > System
Information > Specifications > Page 1421
Fuel Pump Gear Access Cover
11. Install the fuel pump gear access cover.
12. Connect the battery negative cables.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 09-04-98 > Sep > 98 > Accessory Drive Belt - Noisy/Damaged
Drive Belt: Customer Interest Accessory Drive Belt - Noisy/Damaged
NO: 09-04-98
GROUP: Engine
DATE: Sep. 25, 1998
SUBJECT: Accessory Drive Belt Noise Or Damage/Crank Pulley Bolt Loose
MODELS: 1994 - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AN 8.0L ENGINE.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some vehicles may exhibit a condition where the accessory drive belt becomes damaged on the
inboard edge. Customers may explain the problem as belt noise. This may be caused by the crank
pulley loosening on the crank and causing a misalignment.
DIAGNOSIS:
Inspect the accessory drive belt for fraying or unusual wear on the inboard edge. If wear is noted,
inspect the crank pulley bolt for looseness and the crank pulley for misalignment. Sight the crank
pulley with other accessory drives or use a straight edge to detect misalignment. If the crank pulley
is misaligned or bolt is loose, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 53041067 Belt, Accessory Drive 1994 - 1996 Models W/AC Federal
1 53041163 Belt, Accessory Drive 1994 - 1996 Models W/AC California
1 53041068 Belt, Accessory Drive 1994 - 1996 Models WO/AC Federal
1 53041164 Belt, Accessory Drive 1994 - 1996 Models WO/AC California
1 53041116 Belt, Accessory Drive 1997 - 1999 Models WO/AC Federal
1 53041117 Belt, Accessory Drive 1997 - 1999 Models WO/AC California
1 53041115 Belt, Accessory Drive 1997 - 1999 Models W/AC All
1 04318032 Adhesive, Stud and Bearing Mount
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves removing the crank pulley bolt, checking the press fit of the pulley, reinstalling
the bolt using thread locker, and replacing the accessory drive belt.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the accessory drive belt following service manual procedures.
3. Drain and remove the radiator following all service manual warnings/cautions and procedures.
NOTE:
DRAIN THE COOLANT INTO A CLEAN DRAIN PAN.
4. Remove the bolt attaching the crankshaft pulley damper to the crankshaft.
5. Using your hands, pull on the crankshaft pulley damper to test the press fit to the crank shaft.
The pulley should be tight and not come off the crank with hand pressure.
NOTE:
IF THE CRANK PULLEY DAMPER IS LOOSE (NO PRESS FIT) REPLACE THE CRANK PULLEY
DAMPER WITH P/N 53020776.
6. Use Miller Tool C-3688 and fully press the crankshaft pulley damper onto the crankshaft.
7. Add thread locker p/n 04318032 to the end 3 or 4 threads of the crank pulley bolt.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Customer
Interest: > 09-04-98 > Sep > 98 > Accessory Drive Belt - Noisy/Damaged > Page 1430
8. Install the bolt and torque it to 312 Nm (230 ft. lbs.).
NOTE:
USE A BAR TO LOCK THE PULLEY IN PLACE WHILE TIGHTENING.
9. Install a new accessory drive belt following service manual procedures.
10. Reinstall the radiator following service manual procedures.
11. Reinstall the negative battery cable.
12. Fill the cooling system with the saved coolant and operate the vehicle to purge air from the
system. Top off the automatic transmission fluid (if required).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 09-25-25-90 1.5 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-04-98 > Sep > 98 > Accessory Drive Belt - Noisy/Damaged
Drive Belt: All Technical Service Bulletins Accessory Drive Belt - Noisy/Damaged
NO: 09-04-98
GROUP: Engine
DATE: Sep. 25, 1998
SUBJECT: Accessory Drive Belt Noise Or Damage/Crank Pulley Bolt Loose
MODELS: 1994 - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
NOTE:
THIS INFORMATION APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH AN 8.0L ENGINE.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Some vehicles may exhibit a condition where the accessory drive belt becomes damaged on the
inboard edge. Customers may explain the problem as belt noise. This may be caused by the crank
pulley loosening on the crank and causing a misalignment.
DIAGNOSIS:
Inspect the accessory drive belt for fraying or unusual wear on the inboard edge. If wear is noted,
inspect the crank pulley bolt for looseness and the crank pulley for misalignment. Sight the crank
pulley with other accessory drives or use a straight edge to detect misalignment. If the crank pulley
is misaligned or bolt is loose, perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 53041067 Belt, Accessory Drive 1994 - 1996 Models W/AC Federal
1 53041163 Belt, Accessory Drive 1994 - 1996 Models W/AC California
1 53041068 Belt, Accessory Drive 1994 - 1996 Models WO/AC Federal
1 53041164 Belt, Accessory Drive 1994 - 1996 Models WO/AC California
1 53041116 Belt, Accessory Drive 1997 - 1999 Models WO/AC Federal
1 53041117 Belt, Accessory Drive 1997 - 1999 Models WO/AC California
1 53041115 Belt, Accessory Drive 1997 - 1999 Models W/AC All
1 04318032 Adhesive, Stud and Bearing Mount
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
This bulletin involves removing the crank pulley bolt, checking the press fit of the pulley, reinstalling
the bolt using thread locker, and replacing the accessory drive belt.
1. Disconnect the negative battery cable.
2. Remove the accessory drive belt following service manual procedures.
3. Drain and remove the radiator following all service manual warnings/cautions and procedures.
NOTE:
DRAIN THE COOLANT INTO A CLEAN DRAIN PAN.
4. Remove the bolt attaching the crankshaft pulley damper to the crankshaft.
5. Using your hands, pull on the crankshaft pulley damper to test the press fit to the crank shaft.
The pulley should be tight and not come off the crank with hand pressure.
NOTE:
IF THE CRANK PULLEY DAMPER IS LOOSE (NO PRESS FIT) REPLACE THE CRANK PULLEY
DAMPER WITH P/N 53020776.
6. Use Miller Tool C-3688 and fully press the crankshaft pulley damper onto the crankshaft.
7. Add thread locker p/n 04318032 to the end 3 or 4 threads of the crank pulley bolt.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All
Technical Service Bulletins: > 09-04-98 > Sep > 98 > Accessory Drive Belt - Noisy/Damaged > Page 1436
8. Install the bolt and torque it to 312 Nm (230 ft. lbs.).
NOTE:
USE A BAR TO LOCK THE PULLEY IN PLACE WHILE TIGHTENING.
9. Install a new accessory drive belt following service manual procedures.
10. Reinstall the radiator following service manual procedures.
11. Reinstall the negative battery cable.
12. Fill the cooling system with the saved coolant and operate the vehicle to purge air from the
system. Top off the automatic transmission fluid (if required).
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 09-25-25-90 1.5 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Drive Belt: > 08-32-99 > Oct > 99 > Two Way Radio - Intermittent Poor Reception
Air Bag Control Module: All Technical Service Bulletins Two Way Radio - Intermittent Poor
Reception
NUMBER: 08-32-99
GROUP: Electrical
DATE: Oct. 1, 1999
SUBJECT: Radio Interference To/From Two-Way Radio Receivers
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves installing a revised Airbag Control Module (ACM).
MODELS: 1998 - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
SYMPTOM/CONDITION:
Customers may complain of intermittent poor reception on their two-way radios.
NOTE:
THIS CONDITION DOES NOT AFFECT THE OPERATION OF ANY AM OR FM BAND RADIO.
DISCUSSION:
Radio receivers from approximately 30 MHZ to 50 MHZ may be susceptible to Radio
Frequency Interference (RFI) from the Airbag Control Module (ACM).
The following services are within this band range of 30 MHZ to 50 MHZ:
^ Public Service Low Band VHF (30 - 50 MHZ)
^ Six Meter Amateur Radio Band (50 - 54 MHZ)
DIAGNOSIS:
NOTE:
TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN 08-06-99, DATED MARCH 5, 1999, ADDRESSES TWO-WAY
RADIO INTERFERENCE FROM THE FUEL PUMP MODULE AND SHOULD BE PERFORMED
PRIOR TO PERFORMING THIS TECHNICAL SERVICE BULLETIN.
Turn the ignition key to the RUN position. Operate the two-way radio and monitor for
RFI/static/poor reception. If RFI is present with the ignition key in the RUN position, perform the
following Repair Procedure.
NOTE:
THE INTERFERENCE MAY BE INTERMITTENT. IF THE CONDITION IS NOT PRESENT
DURING THE DIAGNOSIS, REPEAT THE DIAGNOSIS SEVERAL TIMES TO ATTEMPT TO
RE-CREATE THE CONDITION.
NOTE:
IT IS IMPORTANT TO IDENTIFY WHICH COMPONENTS ARE EMITTING RFI. AFTER A
REPAIR HAS BEEN MADE, PERFORM THE DIAGNOSIS AGAIN TO IDENTIFY IF ANY OTHER
COMPONENT IS PRODUCING RFI. SOME VEHICLES MAY REQUIRE ADDITIONAL
DIAGNOSIS.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 56043128AE Module, Airbag Control
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
THIS REPAIR IS COMPATIBLE WITH DAIMLERCHRYSLER'S MOBILE SERVICE PROGRAM
AND DOES NOT REQUIRE HOISTS OR OTHER FULL SERVICE FACILITY SPECIAL
EQUIPMENT.
1. Replace the ACM with p/n 56043128AE. Refer to the appropriate Ram Truck Service Manual,
Group 8M, for information regarding Airbag Control Module Removal And Installation procedures.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Drive Belt: > 08-32-99 > Oct > 99 > Two Way Radio - Intermittent Poor Reception > Page 1442
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-45-09-92 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > All Other
Service Bulletins for Drive Belt: > 08-32-99 > Oct > 99 > Two Way Radio - Intermittent Poor Reception > Page 1448
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 08-45-09-92 0.3 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8 - New Part
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1449
Drive Belt: Description and Operation
All vehicles are available with either a 3.9L V-6, a 5.2L V-8, two different 5.9L V-8 engines, an 8.0L
V-10 or a 5.9L in-line 6 cylinder diesel engine. The accessory drive components are operated by a
single, crankshaft driven, serpentine drive belt on all engines. An automatic belt tensioner is also
used to maintain correct belt tension at all times. This is used on all engines. Refer to Drive Belt
Tensioner.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1450
Drive Belt: Testing and Inspection
VISUAL DIAGNOSIS
Belt Wear Patterns
When diagnosing serpentine accessory drive belts, small cracks that run across the ribbed surface
of the belt from rib to rib, are considered normal. These are not a reason to replace the belt.
However, cracks running along a rib (not across) are not normal. Any belt with cracks running
along a rib must be replaced. Also replace the belt if it has excessive wear, frayed cords or severe
glazing. Refer to the Accessory Drive Belt Diagnosis charts for further belt diagnosis.
NOISE DIAGNOSIS
Noises generated by the accessory drive belt are most noticeable at idle. Before replacing a belt to
resolve a noise condition, inspect all of the accessory drive pulleys for alignment, glazing, or
excessive end play.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1451
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1452
ACCESSORY DRIVE BELT DIAGNOSIS CHART
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1453
Drive Belt: Service and Repair
NOTE: The belt routing schematics are published from the latest information available at the time
of publication. If anything differs between these schematics and the Belt Routing Label, use the
schematics on Belt Routing Label. This label is located in the engine compartment.
CAUTION: Do not attempt to check belt tension with a belt tension gauge on vehicles equipped
with an automatic belt tensioner.
REMOVAL
Belt Tensioner-5.9L Diesel-Typical (non-A/C Shown)
Drive belts on diesel engines are equipped with a spring loaded automatic belt tensioner.
This belt tensioner will be used on all belt configurations, such as with or without air conditioning.
For more information, refer to Drive Belt Tensioner. 1. A 3/8 inch square hole is provided in the
automatic belt tensioner. Attach a 3/8 inch drive-long handle ratchet to this hole. 2. Rotate ratchet
and tensioner assembly counterclockwise (as viewed from front) until tension has been relieved
from belt. 3. Remove belt from water pump pulley first. 4. Remove belt from vehicle.
INSTALLATION
Belt Routing-5.9L Diesel Engine-With A/C
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Drive Belt > Component Information > Technical Service Bulletins > Page 1454
Belt Routing-5.9L Diesel Engine-Without A/C
CAUTION: When installing the accessory drive belt, the belt must be routed correctly. If not, engine
may overheat due to water pump rotating in wrong direction. Refer to for correct engine belt
routing. The correct belt with correct length must be used.
1. Position drive belt over all pulleys except water pump pulley. 2. Attach a 3/8 inch ratchet to
tensioner. 3. Rotate ratchet and belt tensioner counterclockwise. Place belt over water pump
pulley. Let tensioner rotate back into place. Remove ratchet. Be
sure belt is properly seated on all pulleys.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Cleaner Fresh Air Duct/Hose > Component
Information > Service and Repair
Air Cleaner Fresh Air Duct/Hose: Service and Repair
AIR INTAKE / BOOST SYSTEM
The air intake system consists of the air cleaner/ housing assembly, turbocharger, charge air cooler
piping, charge air cooler, intake air grid heater, and the intake manifold.
Intake Air Circulation
Intake air is drawn through the air cleaner and into the turbocharger compressor housing.
Pressurized air from the turbocharger then flows forward through the charge air cooler located in
front of the radiator. From the charge air cooler the air flows back into the intake manifold. The
charge air cooler is a heat exchanger that uses air flow from vehicle motion to dissipate heat from
the intake air. As the turbocharger increases air pressure, the air temperature increases. Lowering
the intake air temperature increases engine efficiency and power.
CAUTION: The charge air cooler must be cleaned following turbocharger failure involving an oil
leak. Oil leaking from the turbocharger can cause engine runaway, possibly leading to engine
failure. Refer to Charge Air Cooler Removal and Installation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information >
Service and Repair
Air Filter Element: Service and Repair
Testing Air Cleaner Element
Do not attempt to unnecessarily remove the top of the air cleaner housing for air cleaner element
inspection on diesel engines.
Filter Minder - Location
The air cleaner (filter) housing is equipped with an air Filter Minder(R) gauge. This air flow
restriction gauge will determine when the air cleaner element is restricted and should be replaced.
Filter Minder
The Filter Minded consists of a diaphragm and calibrated spring sealed inside of a plastic housing.
A yellow colored disc attached to the diaphragm moves along a graduated scale on the side of the
Filter Minder. After the engine has been shut off, a ratcheting device located within the Filter Minder
will hold the yellow disc at the highest restriction that the air cleaner element has experienced. A
drop in air pressure due to an air cleaner element restriction moves the diaphragm and the yellow
disc will indicate the size of the air drop.
CAUTION: Certain engine degreasers or cleaners may discolor or damage the plastic housing of
the Filter Minder. Cover and tape the Filter Minder if any engine degreasers or cleaners are to be
used.
To test, turn the engine off. If the yellow disc has reached the red colored zone on the graduated
scale, the air cleaner element should be replaced. Refer to the proceeding removal/installation
paragraphs.
Resetting the Filter Minder: After the air cleaner (filter) element has been replaced, press the
rubber button on the top of the Filter Minder. This will allow the yellow colored disc to reset. After
the button has been pressed, the yellow disc should spring back to the UP position.
If the Filter Minder gauge has reached the red colored zone, and after an examination of the air
cleaner (filter) element, the element appears to be clean, the high reading may be due to a
temporary condition such as snow build-up at the air intake. Temporary high restrictions may also
occur if the
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Air Cleaner Housing > Air Filter Element > Component Information >
Service and Repair > Page 1463
air cleaner (filter) element has gotten wet such as during a heavy rain or snow. If this occurs, allow
the element to dry out during normal engine operation. Reset the rubber button on the top of the
Filter Minder and retest after the element has dried.
REMOVAL
1. Loosen air inlet tube clamp at air cleaner housing inlet. Remove this tube at air cleaner housing
cover. 2. The housing cover is equipped with four (4) spring clips and is hinged at front with plastic
tabs. Unlatch clips from top of air cleaner housing and
tilt housing cover up and forward for cover removal.
3. Remove air cleaner element from air cleaner housing.
INSTALLATION
1. Before installing a new air cleaner element, clean inside of air cleaner housing. 2. Position air
cleaner cover to tabs on front of air cleaner housing. Latch four spring clips to seal cover to
housing. 3. Install air inlet tube at air cleaner housing inlet. Note hose alignment notches at both
inlet hose and air cleaner cover. 4. Position tube clamp to inlet tube and tighten to 3 Nm (25 in.
lbs.) torque.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Specifications
Fluid Filter - A/T: Specifications
Fluid Filter Screws 35 in.lb
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Fluid Level Check
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair Fluid Level Check
For Transmission Fluid Services, refer to Automatic Transmission/Transaxle, Service and Repair,
Service Procedures.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Fluid Level Check > Page 1469
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair Fluid and Filter Replacement
For Transmission Fluid Services, refer to Automatic Transmission/Transaxle, Service and Repair,
Service Procedures.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fluid Filter - A/T > Component Information > Service and Repair >
Fluid Level Check > Page 1470
Fluid Filter - A/T: Service and Repair Transmission Fill Procedure
For Transmission Fluid Services, refer to Automatic Transmission/Transaxle, Service and Repair,
Service Procedures.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Specifications
Fuel Filter: Specifications
Fuel Drain Manifold "T" Fitting 12 Nm
Fuel Filter Canister Mounting Nut 14 Nm
Fuel Filter Drain Valve Mounting Screws 3-5 Nm
Fuel Filter Canister Bracket Bolts 24 Nm
Banjo Fittings at top of Filter/Separator 24 Nm
Fuel Pump Module Locknut 24-44 Nm
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1474
Fuel Filter: Locations
Fuel Filter/Water Separator Location
The fuel filter/water separator assembly is located on left side of engine above starter motor.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1475
Fuel Filter: Description and Operation
FUEL FILTER/WATER SEPARATOR
The fuel filter/water separator protects the fuel injection pump by removing water and contaminants
from the fuel. The construction of the filter/separator allows fuel to pass through it, but helps
prevent moisture (water) from doing so. Moisture collects at the bottom of the canister.
Fuel Filter/Water Separator Location
The fuel filter/water separator assembly is located on left side of engine above starter motor. The
assembly also includes the fuel heater and Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor.
For draining of water from canister, refer to Fuel Filter/Water Separator Removal/Installation.
A Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor is attached to side of canister. Refer to Water-In-Fuel Sensor
Description/Operation.
The fuel heater is installed into the top of the filter/separator housing. Refer to Fuel Heater
Description/Operation.
FUEL TANK MODULE
An electric fuel pump is not used in the fuel tank module for diesel powered engines. Fuel is
supplied by the engine mounted fuel transfer pump and the fuel injection pump.
Top View Of Fuel Tank Module
The fuel tank module is installed in the top of the fuel tank. The fuel tank module contains the
following components: Fuel reservoir
- A separate in-tank fuel filter
- Rollover valve
- Fuel gauge sending unit (fuel level sensor)
- Fuel supply line connection
- Fuel return line connection
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1476
- Auxiliary non-pressurized fuel supply fitting
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Filter/Water Separator Replacement
Fuel Filter: Service and Repair Fuel Filter/Water Separator Replacement
Fuel Filter/Water Separator/Drain Hose Location
The fuel filter/water separator assembly is located on left/rear side of engine above starter motor.
The assembly contains the fuel filter cartridge, Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor, and fuel heater.
REMOVAL
Drain Valve At Fuel Filter/water Separator
Draining water from filter canister: The canister drain valve serves two purposes. One is to partially
drain filter canister of excess water. The other is to completely drain canister for filter, heater or
water-in-fuel sensor replacement. The filter should be drained whenever water-in- fuel warning
lamp remains illuminated. (Note that lamp will be illuminated for approximately two seconds when
ignition key is initially placed in ON position for a bulb check).
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Filter/Water Separator Replacement > Page 1479
Fuel Filter/water Separator Components
1. A drain hose is located at bottom of drain valve. Place drain pan under drain hose. 2. With
engine not running, rotate drain valve handle forward to OPEN (DRAIN) position. Hold drain valve
open until all water and contaminants
have been removed and clean fuel exits drain hose.
3. If fuel filter, fuel heater or Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor is being replaced, drain canister
completely. Dispose of mixture in drain pan according to
applicable regulations.
4. After draining operation, rotate valve handle rearward to CLOSE position. If fuel filter, fuel heater
or WIF sensor is being replaced, proceed to
next step.
5. Remove drain hose at drain valve. 6. Disconnect Water-In-Fuel (WIF) sensor electrical
connector at sensor. The WIF sensor is located at side of filter canister. 7. Loosen filter canister nut
at top of header while lowering canister assembly from header. 8. Remove and discard seals and
center O-rings . 9. Remove filter element (cartridge) from canister.
10. Remove WIF sensor and its O-ring seal from canister . 11. Inspect WIF sensor probes.
Carefully clean contaminants from sensor probes with a cloth if necessary. Replace sensor if
probes are covered with
contaminants and will not clean up.
Fuel Heater Mounting Screws (Bottom View)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Filter/Water Separator Replacement > Page 1480
12. Fuel Heater: The fuel heater is located inside fuel filter housing (header). The heater mounting
plate, heating element, temperature sensor and
wiring harness are serviced as one assembly. a. Disconnect heater pigtail harness electrical
connector from main engine wiring harness near upper/rear of filter. b. The plastic electrical
connector at end of 2-wire pigtail harness will have to be removed from wiring harness before
attempting to pass harness
through filter header.
c. Note locations (colors) of wires in connector before removing connector. d. Remove clip retaining
wires to connector. e. Remove wires from connector. f.
Remove 3 fuel heater mounting screws.
g. Press down on heater sealing grommet to remove heater from filter canister header. h. Pass
wire harness through hole in filter header while removing heater from header.
INSTALLATION
1. Clean inside of canister and canister header. 2. Fuel Heater:
a. Lift fuel heater assembly into filter header while passing wire harness upward through hole in
header. Heater sealing grommet should protrude
at top of filter header.
b. Instal 3 fuel heater mounting screws and tighten to 2-3 Nm (15-20 in. lbs.) torque. c. Install 2
wires into electrical connector and install connector clip. d. Connect heater pigtail harness electrical
connector to main engine wiring harness.
3. Install new O-ring seal to WIF sensor. 4. Install WIF sensor to canister. tighten to 2-3 Nm (15-20
in. lbs.) torque. 5. If drain valve assembly is being replaced, tighten mounting screws to 3-5 Nm
(30-40 in. lbs.) torque. 6. Install new O-rings. 7. Install new seal between canister and canister
header.
If filter canister is not filled with clean diesel fuel before installation, manual air bleeding of fuel
system may be necessary (temporary rough engine running may occur). If necessary, refer to Air
Bleed Procedures.
8. Load filter into canister. 9. Fill filter canister with clean diesel fuel.
10. Apply a light film of clean diesel oil to all seals. 11. Position canister assembly to canister
header. Note locating tabs on canister should align into notch on canister header. 12. Install
canister nut and tighten to 14 Nm (10 ft. lbs.) torque. 13. Connect electrical connector to WIF
sensor. 14. Connect drain hose to bottom of drain valve. 15. Start engine and check for leaks.
Air Bleed Procedure
A certain amount of air becomes trapped in the fuel system when fuel system components on the
supply and/or high-pressure side are serviced or replaced. Primary air bleeding is accomplished
using the electric fuel transfer (lift) pump. If the vehicle has been allowed to run completely out of
fuel, the fuel injectors must also be bled as the fuel injection pump is not self-bleeding (priming).
Servicing or replacing components on the fuel return side will not require air bleeding.
WARNING: DO NOT BLEED AIR FROM THE FUEL SYSTEM OF A HOT ENGINE.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Filter/Water Separator Replacement > Page 1481
Fuel Supply Line Banjo Bolt
1. Loosen, but do not remove, banjo bolt holding low-pressure fuel supply line to side of fuel
injection pump. Place a shop towel around banjo fitting
to catch excess fuel.
The fuel transfer (lift) pump is self-priming: When the key is first turned on (without cranking
engine), the pump operates for approximately 2 seconds and then shuts off. The pump will also
operate for up to 25 seconds after the starter is engaged, and then disengaged and the engine is
not running. The pump shuts off immediately if the key is on and the engine stops running.
2. Turn key to CRANK position and quickly release key to ON position before engine starts. This
will operate fuel transfer pump for approximately
25 seconds.
3. If fuel is not present at fuel supply line after 25 seconds, turn key OFF. Repeat previous step
until fuel is exiting at fuel supply line. 4. tighten banjo bolt at fuel supply line to 24 Nm (18 ft. lbs.)
torque. Primary air bleeding is now completed. 5. Attempt to start engine. If engine will not start,
proceed to following steps. If engine does start, it may run erratically and be very noisy for a few
minutes. This is a normal condition.
6. Continue to next step if:
- The vehicle fuel tank has been allowed to run empty
- The fuel injection pump has been replaced
- High-pressure fuel lines have been replaced
- Vehicle has not been operated after an extended period
CAUTION: Do not engage the starter motor for more than 30 seconds at a time. Allow two minutes
between cranking intervals.
7. Perform previous air bleeding procedure steps using fuel transfer pump. Be sure fuel is present
at fuel supply line before proceeding. 8. Crank the engine for 30 seconds at a time to allow air
trapped in the injection pump to vent out the drain manifold.
WARNING: THE FUEL INJECTION PUMP SUPPLIES EXTREMELY HIGH FUEL PRESSURE TO
EACH INDIVIDUAL INJECTOR THROUGH THE HIGH-PRESSURE LINES. FUEL UNDER THIS
AMOUNT OF PRESSURE CAN PENETRATE THE SKIN AND CAUSE PERSONAL INJURY.
WEAR SAFETY GOGGLES AND ADEQUATE PROTECTIVE CLOTHING AND AVOID CONTACT
WITH FUEL SPRAY WHEN BLEEDING HIGH-PRESSURE FUEL LINES. ENGINE MAY START
WHILE CRANKING STARTER MOTOR.
9. Engine may start, may run erratically and be very noisy for a few minutes. This is a normal
condition.
10. Thoroughly clean area around injector fittings where they join injector connector tubes.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Filter/Water Separator Replacement > Page 1482
Bleeding High-Pressure Fuel Lines At Injectors
11. Bleed air by loosening high-pressure fuel line fittings at cylinders number 3, 4 and 5. 12.
Continue bleeding injectors until engine runs smoothly. It may take a few minutes for engine to run
smooth. 13. Tighten fuel line(s) at injector(s) to 38 Nm (28 ft. lbs.) torque.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Fuel Filter > Component Information > Service and Repair > Fuel
Filter/Water Separator Replacement > Page 1483
Fuel Filter: Service and Repair Fuel Tank Module Replacement
REMOVAL
1. Drain and remove fuel tank. Refer to Fuel Tank Removal/Installation. 2. Thoroughly clean area
around tank module at top of tank.
Locknut Removal/Installation - Typical Module
3. The plastic fuel tank module locknut is threaded onto fuel tank. Install Special Tool 6856 to
locknut and remove locknut. The fuel tank module
will spring up when locknut is removed.
4. Remove module from fuel tank.
INSTALLATION
CAUTION: Whenever the fuel tank module is serviced, the rubber gasket must be replaced.
1. Thoroughly clean locknut and locknut threads at top of tank. 2. Using new gasket, carefully
position fuel tank module into opening in fuel tank. 3. Position locknut over top of fuel tank module.
Install locknut finger tight. 4. When looking down at tank from drivers side of tank, the arrow at top
of module should be aligned between two marks stamped into tank
(approximately 2 o'clock position). The fuel line connectors, roll over valve and fuel gauge electrical
connector should all be pointed to drivers side of vehicle. Rotate and align module/tank marks if
necessary before tightening locknut. This step must be performed to prevent the module's float
from contacting side of fuel tank.
5. Tighten locknut to 24-44 Nm (18-32 ft. lbs.) torque. 6. Install fuel tank. Refer to Fuel Tank
Removal/ Installation.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Engine - Some Oil Filters May Cause Damage
Oil Filter: Technical Service Bulletins Engine - Some Oil Filters May Cause Damage
NUMBER: 09-004-01
GROUP: Engine
DATE: May 18,2001
SUBJECT: Engine Lubrication
MODELS: 1989 - 1993
(AD) Ram Truck
1994 - 2001 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN INVOLVES 1989-2001 MY 2500 AND 3500 RAM TRUCKS EQUIPPED WITH
THE 5.9L CUMMINS DIESEL ENGINE.
DISCUSSION: Customer may complain of high oil consumption, grey oil smoke coming out of the
exhaust or breather tube, or mechanical knocking. Neoprene compounds used internally in the
manufacture of oil filters not recommended by DaimlerChrysler may separate from the filter, lodge
in the piston cooling nozzle, and can fail the engine.
NOTE:
THIS IS NOT AN ENGINE DEFECT.
(See the table for a list of oil filters recommended by DaimlerChrysler for use with the 5.9L
Cummins diesel engine.)
NOTE:
SECTION 2.7 OF THE TRUCK WARRANTY MANUAL STATES "DAIMLERCHRYSLER MOTORS
CORPORATION IS NOT RESPONSIBLE FOR FAILURES RESULTING FROM IMPROPER
REPAIR OR THE USE OF PARTS WHICH ARE NOT GENUINE DAIMLERCHRYSLER MOTORS
CORPORATION / MOPAR OR DIAMLERCHRYSLER MOTORS CORPORATION / MOPAR
APPROVED PARTS." DAMAGES CAUSED BY THE USE OF OIL FILTERS NOT APPROVED BY
DAIMLERCHRYSLER MAY NOT BE COVERED BY THE NEW VEHICLE WARRANTY.
DAIMLERCHRYSLER RECOMMENDS THE FOLLOWING OIL FILTERS. DO NOT USE ANY OIL
FILTER CONTAINING NEOPRENE. PLEASE SHARE THIS WITH YOUR CUSTOMERS.
RECOMMENDED OIL FILTERS FOR USE WITH CUMMINS 5.9L DIESEL ENGINE:
POLICY: Information Only
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Specifications >
Mechanical Specifications
Oil Filter: Mechanical Specifications
Oil Filter Gasket 3/4 Turn After Gasket Contact Oil Pan Bolts 18 ft.lb
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Specifications >
Mechanical Specifications > Page 1490
Oil Filter: Pressure, Vacuum and Temperature Specifications
Difference Pressure to Open Filter Bypass 25 psi
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Filters > Oil Filter, Engine > Component Information > Specifications > Page
1491
Oil Filter: Service and Repair
All Dodge Ram engines are equipped with a high quality full-flow, disposable type oil filter. Chrysler
Corporation recommends a Mopar(R), or equivalent, oil filter be used.
OIL FILTER REMOVAL
1. Position a drain pan under the oil filter. 2. Using a suitable oil filter wrench, loosen filter.
Oil Filter Removal-Typical
3. Rotate the oil filter counterclockwise to remove it from the cylinder block oil filter boss. 4. When
filter separates from adapter nipple, tip gasket end upward to minimize oil spill. Remove filter from
vehicle.
Oil Filter Sealing Surface-Typical
5. With a wiping cloth, clean the gasket sealing surface of oil and grime.
OIL FILTER INSTALLATION
1. Lightly lubricate oil filter gasket with engine oil or chassis grease. 2. Thread filter onto adapter
nipple. When gasket makes contact with sealing surface, hand tighten filter one full turn, do not
over tighten. 3. Add oil, verify crankcase oil level, and start engine. Inspect for oil leaks.
USED ENGINE OIL DISPOSAL
Care should be exercised when disposing of used engine oil after it has been drained from a
vehicle's engine.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Coolant Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Coolant Line/Hose: > 09-04-99 > Jul > 99 > Engine Coolant Hose - Whistle/Squeal/Howl
Noise
Coolant Line/Hose: Customer Interest Engine Coolant Hose - Whistle/Squeal/Howl Noise
NUMBER: 09-04-99
GROUP: Engine
DATE: Jul. 16, 1999
SUBJECT: Hard To Diagnose Noise Coming From The Engine Turbocharger Area
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacement of the engine heater coolant supply hose
connector.
MODELS: 1998 - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A CUMMINS 5.9L - 24V DIESEL
ENGINE BUILT PRIOR TO ENGINE SERIAL NUMBER (ESN) 56587424. THE ESN IS LOCATED
ON THE ENGINE DATA PLATE WHICH IS LOCATED ON THE FRONT LEFT SIDE OF THE
ENGINE, AFFIXED TO THE GEAR HOUSING.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: A noise may be present which on initial investigation may sound like a
noisy turbocharger bearing. The sound of the noise may be described as a whistle, a squeal, a
howl, a moan, or a gurgle. The noise will be more noticeable as engine is operated between 1,500
and 2,200 engine rpm's. The noise is usually heard in the cab, louder on the passenger side or
seems to come from the dash vents.
The noise may be caused by the coolant supply hose connector. The connector is located on the
cylinder head next to the turbocharger. The connector is used to supply coolant to the heater hose.
DIAGNOSIS:
1). Set the parking brake. Place the transmission in the park or neutral position.
2). Start engine and achieve operating temperature until the thermostat is open.
3). Increase the engine speed until the noise is heard (1,500 to 2,200 rpm). You may need to sit
inside the vehicle to hear the noise.
4). With the noise present, clamp off the heater hose to prevent coolant from flowing through the
connector.
5). If the noise is no longer present, then perform the Repair Procedure.
6). Stop the engine. Make certain the cooling system has cooled sufficiently to allow repair.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 05011901AC Connector, Hose
AR(1) 04267020AB Antifreeze/Coolant
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
THIS REPAIR IS COMPATIBLE WITH DAIMLERCHRYSLER'S MOBILE SERVICE PROGRAM
AND DOES NOT REQUIRE HOISTS OR OTHER FULL SERVICE FACILITY SPECIAL
EQUIPMENT.
1. Stop the engine. Make certain the cooling system has cooled sufficiently to allow this repair.
NOTE:
HOT, PRESSURIZED COOLANT CAN CAUSE INJURY BY SCALDING.
2. Remove any cooling system pressure.
NOTE:
HOT, PRESSURIZED COOLANT CAN CAUSE INJURY BY SCALDING. USING A RAG TO
COVER THE RADIATOR PRESSURE CAP, OPEN THE RADIATOR CAP SLOWLY TO THE
FIRST STOP. THIS WILL ALLOW ANY BUILT-UP PRESSURE TO VENT TO THE
RESERVE/OVERFLOW TANK. AFTER PRESSURE BUILD-UP HAS BEEN RELEASED,
REMOVE CAP FROM THE FILLER NECK.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Coolant Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Customer Interest for Coolant Line/Hose: > 09-04-99 > Jul > 99 > Engine Coolant Hose - Whistle/Squeal/Howl
Noise > Page 1501
3. With a large clean container, drain sufficient coolant from the cooling system to prevent coolant
loss when removing the heater hose. The heater hose may be clamped oft to prevent further
coolant loss.
4. Remove the heater hose clamp and heater hose from the connector.
5. Replace the connector (p/n 05011901AC). Tighten the connector to 42 Nm (31 ft.lbs.).
6. Install the heater hose and hose clamp onto the connector.
7. Add engine coolant that was previously drained from the engine.
8. Start the engine. Add additional coolant as required.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 24-46-10-97 0.4 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8- New Part
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Coolant Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant Line/Hose: > 09-04-99 > Jul > 99 > Engine Coolant Hose Whistle/Squeal/Howl Noise
Coolant Line/Hose: All Technical Service Bulletins Engine Coolant Hose - Whistle/Squeal/Howl
Noise
NUMBER: 09-04-99
GROUP: Engine
DATE: Jul. 16, 1999
SUBJECT: Hard To Diagnose Noise Coming From The Engine Turbocharger Area
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves replacement of the engine heater coolant supply hose
connector.
MODELS: 1998 - 1999 (BR/BE) Ram Truck
NOTE:
THIS BULLETIN APPLIES TO VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH A CUMMINS 5.9L - 24V DIESEL
ENGINE BUILT PRIOR TO ENGINE SERIAL NUMBER (ESN) 56587424. THE ESN IS LOCATED
ON THE ENGINE DATA PLATE WHICH IS LOCATED ON THE FRONT LEFT SIDE OF THE
ENGINE, AFFIXED TO THE GEAR HOUSING.
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: A noise may be present which on initial investigation may sound like a
noisy turbocharger bearing. The sound of the noise may be described as a whistle, a squeal, a
howl, a moan, or a gurgle. The noise will be more noticeable as engine is operated between 1,500
and 2,200 engine rpm's. The noise is usually heard in the cab, louder on the passenger side or
seems to come from the dash vents.
The noise may be caused by the coolant supply hose connector. The connector is located on the
cylinder head next to the turbocharger. The connector is used to supply coolant to the heater hose.
DIAGNOSIS:
1). Set the parking brake. Place the transmission in the park or neutral position.
2). Start engine and achieve operating temperature until the thermostat is open.
3). Increase the engine speed until the noise is heard (1,500 to 2,200 rpm). You may need to sit
inside the vehicle to hear the noise.
4). With the noise present, clamp off the heater hose to prevent coolant from flowing through the
connector.
5). If the noise is no longer present, then perform the Repair Procedure.
6). Stop the engine. Make certain the cooling system has cooled sufficiently to allow repair.
PARTS REQUIRED:
1 05011901AC Connector, Hose
AR(1) 04267020AB Antifreeze/Coolant
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
THIS REPAIR IS COMPATIBLE WITH DAIMLERCHRYSLER'S MOBILE SERVICE PROGRAM
AND DOES NOT REQUIRE HOISTS OR OTHER FULL SERVICE FACILITY SPECIAL
EQUIPMENT.
1. Stop the engine. Make certain the cooling system has cooled sufficiently to allow this repair.
NOTE:
HOT, PRESSURIZED COOLANT CAN CAUSE INJURY BY SCALDING.
2. Remove any cooling system pressure.
NOTE:
HOT, PRESSURIZED COOLANT CAN CAUSE INJURY BY SCALDING. USING A RAG TO
COVER THE RADIATOR PRESSURE CAP, OPEN THE RADIATOR CAP SLOWLY TO THE
FIRST STOP. THIS WILL ALLOW ANY BUILT-UP PRESSURE TO VENT TO THE
RESERVE/OVERFLOW TANK. AFTER PRESSURE BUILD-UP HAS BEEN RELEASED,
REMOVE CAP FROM THE FILLER NECK.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Coolant Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Coolant Line/Hose: > 09-04-99 > Jul > 99 > Engine Coolant Hose Whistle/Squeal/Howl Noise > Page 1507
3. With a large clean container, drain sufficient coolant from the cooling system to prevent coolant
loss when removing the heater hose. The heater hose may be clamped oft to prevent further
coolant loss.
4. Remove the heater hose clamp and heater hose from the connector.
5. Replace the connector (p/n 05011901AC). Tighten the connector to 42 Nm (31 ft.lbs.).
6. Install the heater hose and hose clamp onto the connector.
7. Add engine coolant that was previously drained from the engine.
8. Start the engine. Add additional coolant as required.
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE:
Labor Operation No: 24-46-10-97 0.4 Hrs.
FAILURE CODE: P8- New Part
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Coolant Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical Service
Bulletins > Page 1508
Coolant Line/Hose: Description and Operation
Rubber hoses route coolant to and from the radiator, intake manifold and heater core. Radiator
lower hoses are spring-reinforced to prevent collapse from water pump suction at moderate and
high engine speeds. Inspect the hoses at regular intervals. Replace hoses that are cracked, feel
brittle when squeezed or swell excessively when system is pressurized. The use of molded
replacement hoses is recommended. When performing a hose inspection, inspect radiator lower
hose for proper position and condition of spring.
Hose Clamp Tool - Typical
WARNING: CONSTANT TENSION HOSE CLAMPS ARE USED ON MOST COOLING SYSTEM
HOSES. WHEN REMOVING OR INSTALLING, USE ONLY TOOLS DESIGNED FOR SERVICING
THIS TYPE OF CLAMP, SUCH AS SPECIAL CLAMP TOOL (NUMBER 6094). SNAP-ON CLAMP
TOOL (NUMBER HPC-20) MAY BE USED FOR LARGER CLAMPS. ALWAYS WEAR SAFETY
GLASSES WHEN SERVICING CONSTANT TENSION CLAMPS.
Clamp Number/Letter Location
CAUTION: A number or letter is stamped into the tongue of constant tension clamps. If
replacement is necessary, use only an original equipment clamp with a matching number or letter.
Ordinary worm gear type hose clamps (when equipped) can be removed with a straight screwdriver
or a hex socket. To prevent damage to hoses or clamps, the hose clamps should be tightened to 4
Nm (34 inch lbs.) torque. Do not over tighten hose clamps. For all vehicles: In areas where specific
routing clamps are not provided, be sure that hoses are positioned with sufficient clearance. Check
clearance from exhaust manifolds and pipe, fan blades, drive belts and sway bars. Improperly
positioned hoses can be damaged, resulting in coolant loss and engine overheating.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Specifications
Hose/Line HVAC: Specifications
High psi control = switch opens 450 - 490 psi, resets < 270 - 330 psi = mounted on discharge line
near compressor
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Locations > A/C
Discharge Hose/Line
Suction And Discharge Line Remove/Install
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Locations > A/C
Discharge Hose/Line > Page 1514
Liquid Line Remove/Install
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Locations > A/C
Discharge Hose/Line > Page 1515
Hose/Line HVAC: Locations A/C Refrigerant Hose/Line
The low pressure hose (Blue with Black stripe) attaches to the suction service port located on the
suction line, near the accumulator outlet.
The high pressure hose (Red with Black stripe) attaches to the discharge service port located on
the liquid line between the condenser and the evaporator, near the front of the engine
compartment.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1516
Hose/Line HVAC: Description and Operation
Refrigerant Hoses/Lines/Tubes Precautions
Kinks or sharp bends in the refrigerant pluming will reduce the capacity of the entire system. High
pressures are produced in the system when it is operating. Extreme care must be exercised to
make sure that all refrigerant system connections are pressure tight.
A good rule for the flexible hose refrigerant lines is to keep the radius of all bends at least ten times
the diameter of the hose. Sharp bends will reduce the flow of refrigerant. The flexible hose lines
should be routed so they are at least 80 millimeters (3 inches) from the exhaust manifold. It is a
good practice to inspect all flexible refrigerant system hose lines at least once a year to make sure
they are in good condition and properly routed.
There are two types of refrigerant fittings: All fittings with 0-rings need to be coated with refrigerant oil before installation. Use only 0-rings
that are the correct size and approved for use with R-134a refrigerant. Failure to do so may result
in a leak.
- Unified plumbing connections with gaskets cannot be serviced with 0-rings. The gaskets are not
reusable and new gaskets do not require lubrication before installing.
Using the proper tools when making a refrigerant plumbing connection is very important. Improper
tools or improper use of the tools can damage the refrigerant fittings. Always use two wrenches
when loosening or tightening tube fittings. Use one wrench to hold one side of the connection
stationary, while loosening or tightening the other side of the connection with a second wrench.
The refrigerant must be recovered completely from the system before opening any fitting or
connection. Open the fittings with caution, even after the refrigerant has been recovered. If any
pressure is noticed as a fitting is loosened, tighten the fitting and recover the refrigerant from the
system again.
Do not discharge refrigerant into the atmosphere. Use an R-134a refrigerant recovery/recycling
device that meets SAE Standard J2210.
The refrigerant system will remain chemically stable as long as pure, moisture-free R-134a
refrigerant and refrigerant oil is used. Dirt, moisture, or air can upset this chemical stability
Operational troubles or serious damage can occur if foreign material is present in the refrigerant
system.
When it is necessary to open the refrigerant system, have everything needed to service the system
ready The refrigerant system should not be left open to the atmosphere any longer than necessary.
Cap or plug all lines and fittings as soon as they are opened to prevent the entrance of dirt and
moisture All lines and components in parts stock should be capped or sealed until they are to be
installed.
All tools, including the refrigerant recycling equipment, the manifold gauge set, and test hoses
should be kept clean and dry All tools and equipment must be designed for R-134a refrigerant.
Refrigerant Line The refrigerant lines and hoses are used to carry the refrigerant between the
various air conditioning system components. A barrier hose design with a nylon tube inner hose
liner is used for the R-134a air conditioning system on this vehicle. This nylon liner helps to further
contain the R-134a refrigerant, which has a smaller molecular structure than R-12 refrigerant. The
ends of the refrigerant hoses are made from lightweight aluminum or steel, and use braze-less
fittings.
Any kinks or sharp bends in the refrigerant plumbing will reduce the capacity of the entire air
conditioning system. Kinks and sharp bends reduce the flow of refrigerant in the system. A good
rule for the flexible hose refrigerant lines is to keep the radius of all bends at least ten times the
diameter of the hose. In addition, the flexible hose refrigerant lines should be routed so they are at
least 80 millimeters (3 inches) from the exhaust manifold.
High pressures are produced in the refrigerant system when the air conditioning compressor is
operating. Extreme care must be exercised to make sure that each of the refrigerant system
connections is pressure-tight and leak free. It is a good practice to inspect all flexible hose
refrigerant lines at least once a year to make sure they are in good condition and properly routed.
The refrigerant lines and hoses are coupled with other components of the HVAC system with
peanut- block style fittings. A status seal type flat steel gasket with a captured compressible O-ring,
is used to mate plumbing lines with A/C components to ensure the integrity of the refrigerant
system.
The refrigerant lines and hoses cannot be repaired and, if faulty or damaged, they must be
replaced.
Low Pressure Gauge Hose The low pressure hose (Blue with Black stripe) attaches to the suction
service port. This port is located on the suction line, near the accumulator outlet.
High Pressure Gauge Hose The high pressure hose (Red with Black stripe) attaches to the
discharge service port. This port is located on the liquid line between the condenser and the
evaporator, near the front of the engine compartment.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Locations > Page 1517
Recovery/Recycling/Evacuation/Charging Hose The center manifold hose (Yellow, or White, with
Black stripe) is used to recover evacuate, and charge the refrigerant system. When the low or high
pressure valves on the manifold gauge set are opened, the refrigerant in the system will escape
through this hose.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement
Any kinks or sharp bends in the refrigerant plumbing will reduce the capacity of the entire air
conditioning system. Kinks and sharp bends reduce the flow of refrigerant in the system. A good
rule for the flexible hose refrigerant lines is to keep the radius of all bends at least ten times the
diameter of the hose. In addition, the flexible hose refrigerant lines should be routed so they are at
least 80 millimeters (3 inches) from the exhaust manifold.
High pressures are produced in the refrigerant system when the air conditioning compressor is
operating. Extreme care must be exercised to make sure that each of the refrigerant system
connections is pressure-tight and leak free. It is a good practice to inspect all flexible hose
refrigerant lines at least once a year to make sure they are in good condition and properly routed.
WARNING: REVIEW THE WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS BEFORE PERFORMING THE
FOLLOWING OPERATION.
REMOVAL 1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the
refrigerant system. Refer to: Heating and Air Conditioning, Service and Repair, Refrigerant
Recovery, See:
Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant Recovery
3. Unplug the wire harness connector from the high pressure cut-off switch. 4. Disconnect the
suction line refrigerant line coupler at the accumulator. Install plugs in, or tape over all of the
opened refrigerant line fittings. 5. Remove the nut that secures the block fitting to the stud on the
condenser inlet and disconnect the discharge line from the condenser. Install plugs
in, or tape over all of the opened refrigerant line fittings.
Suction And Discharge Line Remove/Install
6. Remove the screw that secures the refrigerant line manifold to the compressor. Install plugs in,
or tape over all of the opened refrigerant line
fittings.
7. Remove the suction and discharge line assembly from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION 1. Remove the tape or plugs from all of the refrigerant line fittings. Connect the
suction line refrigerant line coupler to the accumulator. 2. Install a new gasket and the discharge
line block fitting over the stud on the condenser inlet. Tighten the mounting nut to 20 Nm (180 in
lbs). 3. Install the refrigerant line manifold to the compressor. Tighten the mounting screw to 22 Nm
(200 in lbs). 4. Plug in the wire harness connector to the high pressure cut-off switch. 5. Connect
the battery negative cable. 6. Evacuate the refrigerant system. Refer to: Heating and Air
Conditioning, Service and Repair, Refrigerant System Evacuate, See: Heating
and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate
7. Charge the refrigerant system. Refer to: Heating and Air Conditioning, Service and Repair,
Refrigerant System Charge, See: Heating and
Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 1520
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Liquid Hose/Line Replacement
Any kinks or sharp bends in the refrigerant plumbing will reduce the capacity of the entire air
conditioning system. Kinks and sharp bends reduce the flow of refrigerant in the system. High
pressures are produced in the refrigerant system when the air conditioning compressor is
operating. Extreme care must be exercised to make sure that each of the refrigerant system
connections is pressure-tight and leak free.
WARNING: REVIEW THE WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS BEFORE PERFORMING THE
FOLLOWING OPERATION.
REMOVAL 1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the
refrigerant system. Refer to: Heating and Air Conditioning, Service and Repair, Refrigerant
Recovery, See:
Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant Recovery
3. Disconnect the liquid line refrigerant line couplers at the condenser outlet and the evaporator
inlet. Install plugs in, or tape over all of the opened
refrigerant line fittings.
Liquid Line Remove/Install
4. Disengage any clips that secure the liquid line to the inner fender shield and the dash panel. 5.
Remove the liquid line from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION 1. Install the liquid line into any clips on the inner fender shield and the dash panel.
2. Remove the tape or plugs from the refrigerant line fittings on the liquid line, the condenser outlet,
and the evaporator inlet. Connect the liquid line
to the condenser and the evaporator.
3. Connect the battery negative cable. 4. Evacuate the refrigerant system. Refer to: Heating and Air
Conditioning, Service and Repair, Refrigerant System Evacuate, See: Heating
and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate
5. Charge the refrigerant system. Refer to: Heating and Air Conditioning, Service and Repair,
Refrigerant System Charge, See: Heating and
Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Hose/Line HVAC > Component Information > Service and Repair >
A/C Discharge Hose/Line Replacement > Page 1521
Hose/Line HVAC: Service and Repair A/C Suction Hose/Line Replacement
Any kinks or sharp bends in the refrigerant plumbing will reduce the capacity of the entire air
conditioning system. Kinks and sharp bends reduce the flow of refrigerant in the system. A good
rule for the flexible hose refrigerant lines is to keep the radius of all bends at least ten times the
diameter of the hose. In addition, the flexible hose refrigerant lines should be routed so they are at
least 80 millimeters (3 inches) from the exhaust manifold.
High pressures are produced in the refrigerant system when the air conditioning compressor is
operating. Extreme care must be exercised to make sure that each of the refrigerant system
connections is pressure-tight and leak free. It is a good practice to inspect all flexible hose
refrigerant lines at least once a year to make sure they are in good condition and properly routed.
WARNING: REVIEW THE WARNINGS AND CAUTIONS BEFORE PERFORMING THE
FOLLOWING OPERATION.
REMOVAL 1. Disconnect and isolate the battery negative cable. 2. Recover the refrigerant from the
refrigerant system. Refer to: Heating and Air Conditioning, Service and Repair, Refrigerant
Recovery, See:
Heating and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant Recovery
3. Unplug the wire harness connector from the high pressure cut-off switch. 4. Disconnect the
suction line refrigerant line coupler at the accumulator. Install plugs in, or tape over all of the
opened refrigerant line fittings. 5. Remove the nut that secures the block fitting to the stud on the
condenser inlet and disconnect the discharge line from the condenser. Install plugs
in, or tape over all of the opened refrigerant line fittings.
Suction And Discharge Line Remove/Install
6. Remove the screw that secures the refrigerant line manifold to the compressor. Install plugs in,
or tape over all of the opened refrigerant line
fittings.
7. Remove the suction and discharge line assembly from the vehicle.
INSTALLATION 1. Remove the tape or plugs from all of the refrigerant line fittings. Connect the
suction line refrigerant line coupler to the accumulator. 2. Install a new gasket and the discharge
line block fitting over the stud on the condenser inlet. Tighten the mounting nut to 20 Nm (180 in
lbs). 3. Install the refrigerant line manifold to the compressor. Tighten the mounting screw to 22 Nm
(200 in lbs). 4. Plug in the wire harness connector to the high pressure cut-off switch. 5. Connect
the battery negative cable. 6. Evacuate the refrigerant system. Refer to: Heating and Air
Conditioning, Service and Repair, Refrigerant System Evacuate, See: Heating
and Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Evacuate
7. Charge the refrigerant system. Refer to: Heating and Air Conditioning, Service and Repair,
Refrigerant System Charge, See: Heating and
Air Conditioning/Service and Repair/Refrigerant System Charge
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Customer Interest for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 19-003-02 > Apr > 02 > Power Steering - Hissing
Sound
Power Steering Line/Hose: Customer Interest Power Steering - Hissing Sound
NUMBER: 19-003-02
GROUP: Steering
DATE: April 15, 2002
SUBJECT: Hissing Sound Coming From The Power Steering System On Vehicles Equipped With
Hydroboost Brakes
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves Replacing the power steering hoses connecting the Hydroboost
to the power steering pump and gear.
MODELS: 1997 - 2002 BR/BE Ram Truck
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: A hissing sound may be present in the power steering system during
steering maneuvers or straight ahead driving.
DIAGNOSIS: If the vehicle exhibits the condition perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Drain the power steering fluid from the system.
2. Remove the pressure hose from the power steering pump to the Hydroboost.
3. Install the new hose, p/n 05086529AA.
4. Remove the pressure hose from the Hydroboost to the steering gear.
5. Install the new hose, p/n 05086532AA.
6. Check the routing of the hoses to ensure no interference problems exist. Use tie straps to secure
the hoses if necessary.
7. Fill the system with power steering fluid and operate the steering system to purge any air from
the system
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE
FAILURE CODE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > All Technical Service Bulletins for Power Steering Line/Hose: > 19-003-02 > Apr > 02 > Power Steering Hissing Sound
Power Steering Line/Hose: All Technical Service Bulletins Power Steering - Hissing Sound
NUMBER: 19-003-02
GROUP: Steering
DATE: April 15, 2002
SUBJECT: Hissing Sound Coming From The Power Steering System On Vehicles Equipped With
Hydroboost Brakes
OVERVIEW: This bulletin involves Replacing the power steering hoses connecting the Hydroboost
to the power steering pump and gear.
MODELS: 1997 - 2002 BR/BE Ram Truck
SYMPTOM/CONDITION: A hissing sound may be present in the power steering system during
steering maneuvers or straight ahead driving.
DIAGNOSIS: If the vehicle exhibits the condition perform the Repair Procedure.
PARTS REQUIRED
REPAIR PROCEDURE:
1. Drain the power steering fluid from the system.
2. Remove the pressure hose from the power steering pump to the Hydroboost.
3. Install the new hose, p/n 05086529AA.
4. Remove the pressure hose from the Hydroboost to the steering gear.
5. Install the new hose, p/n 05086532AA.
6. Check the routing of the hoses to ensure no interference problems exist. Use tie straps to secure
the hoses if necessary.
7. Fill the system with power steering fluid and operate the steering system to purge any air from
the system
POLICY: Reimbursable within the provisions of the warranty.
TIME ALLOWANCE
FAILURE CODE
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Hoses > Power Steering Line/Hose > Component Information > Technical
Service Bulletins > Page 1535
Power Steering Line/Hose: Specifications
Pressure Line ......................................................................................................................................
...................................................... 31 Nm (23 ft. lbs.) Return Line .....................................................
.......................................................................................................................................... 31 Nm (23
ft. lbs.)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Specifications
Brake Fluid: Specifications
BRAKE FLUID
Specification ........................................................................................................................................
.................................................................. DOT 3
Standard ..............................................................................................................................................
........................................................... SAE J1703
NOTE: The brake fluid used in this vehicle must conform to DOT 3 specifications and SAE J1703
standards. No other type of brake fluid is recommended or approved for usage in the vehicle brake
system. Use only Mopar brake fluid or an equivalent from a tightly sealed container.
CAUTION: Never use reclaimed brake fluid or fluid from a container which has been left open. An
open container of brake fluid will absorb moisture from the air and contaminate the fluid.
CAUTION: Never use any type of a petroleum based fluid in the brake hydraulic system. Use of
such type fluids will result in seal damage of the vehicle brake hydraulic system causing a failure of
the vehicle brake system. Petroleum based fluids would be items such as engine oil, transmission
fluid, power steering fluid, etc.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1540
Brake Fluid: Service Precautions
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
WARNING: Brake fluid may be irritating to the skin or eyes. In case of contact, take the following
actions:
* Eye Contact-rinse eyes thoroughly with water.
* Skin Contact-wash skin with soap and water.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1541
Brake Fluid: Testing and Inspection
CAUTION:
The hydraulic fluid used in automotive brake systems is hygroscopic. This means that the hydraulic
fluid tends to absorb moisture from the atmosphere over periods of time. As hydraulic brake fluid
absorbs moisture, it effects the function of the vehicles hydraulic brake system. For this reason, the
vehicle's hydraulic brake fluid should be drained and replaced using fresh clean hydraulic brake
fluid every two years. When replacing hydraulic brake fluid, use only Mopar brake fluid or an
equivalent from a sealed container. Brake fluid must conform to DOT 3 specifications.
BRAKE FLUID CONTAMINATION
Indications of fluid contamination are swollen or deteriorated rubber parts. Swelling indicates the
presence of petroleum in the brake fluid.
To test for contamination, put a small amount of drained brake fluid in clear glass jar. If the fluid
separates into layers, there is mineral oil or other fluid contamination of the brake fluid.
If the brake fluid is contaminated, drain and thoroughly flush the brake system. Replace all the
rubber parts or components containing rubber coming into contact with the brake fluid. This
includes the master cylinder, proportioning valves, caliper seals, wheel cylinder seals, ABS
hydraulic control unit (HCU), and all hydraulic fluid hoses.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Brake Fluid > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1542
Brake Fluid: Service and Repair
FLUID LEVEL
Always clean the master cylinder reservoir and caps before checking fluid level. If not cleaned, dirt
could enter the fluid.
Brake Fluid Level Inspection
The fluid fill level is indicated on the side of the master cylinder reservoir.
The correct fluid level is to the FULL indicator on the side of the reservoir. If necessary, add fluid to
the proper level.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications
Coolant: Capacity Specifications
Cooling System Capacity ....................................................................................................................
......................................................... 24.5 L (26 qts)
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Capacity
Specifications > Page 1547
Coolant: Fluid Type Specifications
The required ethylene-glycol (antifreeze) and water mixture depends upon the climate and vehicle
operating conditions. The recommended mixture of 50/50 ethylene-glycol and water will provide
protection against freezing to -37° C (-35° F). The antifreeze concentration must always be a
minimum of 44%, year round, in all climates. If percentage is lower than 44%, engine parts may be
eroded by cavitation, and cooling system components may be severely damaged by corrosion.
Maximum protection against freezing is provided with a 68% antifreeze concentration, which
prevents freezing down to -67.7° C (-90° F). A higher percentage will freeze at a warmer
temperature. Also, a higher percentage of antifreeze can cause the engine to overheat because the
specific heat of antifreeze is lower than that of water.
100 Percent Ethylene-Glycol Should Not Be Used
Use of 100 Percent Ethylene-Glycol will cause formation of additive deposits in the system, as the
corrosive inhibitive additives in ethylene-glycol require the presence of water to dissolve. The
deposits act as insulation, causing temperatures to rise as high as 149° C (300° F). this
temperature is hot enough to melt plastic and soften solder. The increased temperature can result
in engine detonation. In addition, 100 % ethylene-glycol freezes at 22° C (-8° F).
Propylene-Glycol Formulations Should Not Be Used
Propylene-glycol formulations do not meet the required specifications. It's overall effective
temperature range is smaller than that of ethylene-glycol. The freeze point of 50/50
propylene-glycol and water is -32° C (-26° F), 5 degrees higher than ethylene-glycol's freeze point.
The boiling point (protection against summer boil-over) of propylene-glycol is 125° C (257° F) at
96.5 kPa (14 PSI), compared to 128° C (263° F) for ethylene-glycol. Use of propylene-glycol can
result in boil-over and freeze up. Propylene-Glycol also has a poorer heat transfer characteristics
than ethylene-glycol. This can increase cylinder head temperatures under certain conditions.
Propylene-Glycol/Ethylene-Glycol Mixtures Should Not Be Used
Propylene-glycol/ethylene-glycol mixtures can cause the destabilization of various corrosion
inhibitors, causing damage to the coling system components. Also, once ethylene-glycol and
propylene-glycol based coolants are mixed in the vehicle, conventional methods of determining the
freeze point will not be accurate. Both the refractive index and specific gravity differ between the
ethylene-glycol and propylene-glycol.
CAUTION: Richer antifreeze mixtures cannot be measured with normal field equipment and can
cause problems associated with 100 percent ethylene-glycol.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1548
Coolant: Service Precautions
DO NOT mix green colored coolant with orange colored coolant.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1549
Coolant: Description and Operation
The cooling system is designed around the coolant. Coolant flows through the engine water jacket
absorbing heat produced during engine operation. The coolant carries the heat to radiator and
heater core. Here it is transferred to the ambient air passing through the radiator and heater core
fins. The coolant also removes heat from the automatic transmission fluid in vehicles equipped with
an automatic transmission.
COOLANT PERFORMANCE
ETHYLENE-GLYCOL MIXTURES The required ethyleneglycol (antifreeze) and water mixture
depends upon the climate and vehicle operating conditions. The recommended mixture of 50/50
ethyleneglycol and water will provide protection against freezing to -37°C 05° F). The antifreeze
concentration must always be a minimum of 44 percent, year-round in all climates. If percentage is
lower than 44 percent, engine parts may be eroded by cavitation, and cooling system components
may be severely damaged by corrosion. Maximum protection against freezing is provided with a 68
percent antifreeze concentration, which prevents freezing down to -67.7°C (-90°F). A higher
percentage will freeze at a warmer temperature. Also, a higher percentage of antifreeze can cause
the engine to overheat because the specific heat of antifreeze is lower than that of water.
100 Percent Ethyleneglycol-Should Not Be Used in Chrysler Vehicles Use of 100 percent
ethyleneglycol will cause formation of additive deposits in the system, as the corrosion inhibitive
additives in ethyleneglycol require the presence of water to dissolve. The deposits act as insulation,
causing temperatures to rise to as high as 149°C (300)°F). This temperature is hot enough to melt
plastic and soften solder. The increased temperature can result in engine detonation. In addition,
100 percent ethyleneglycol freezes at 22°C (-8°F).
Propyleneglycol Formulations-Should Not Be Used in Chrysler Vehicles Propyleneglycol
formulations do not meet Chrysler coolant specifications. It's overall effective temperature range is
smaller than that of ethyleneglycol. The freeze point of 50/50 propyleneglycol and water is -32°C
(-26°F). 5°C higher than ethyleneglycol's freeze point. The boiling point (protection against summer
boil-over) of propyleneglycol is 125°C (257°F ) at 96.5 kPa (14 psi), compared to 128°C (263°F) for
ethyleneglycol. Use of propyleneglycol can result in boil-over or freeze-up in Chrysler vehicles,
which are designed for ethyleneglycol. Propylene glycol also has poorer heat transfer
characteristics than ethylene glycol. This can increase cylinder head temperatures under certain
conditions.
Propyleneglycol/Ethyleneglycol Mixtures-Should Not Be Used in Chrysler Vehicles
Propyleneglycol/Ethyleneglycol Mixtures can cause the destabilization of various corrosion
inhibitors, causing damage to the various cooling system components. Also, once ethyleneglycol
and propyleneglycol based coolants are mixed in the vehicle, conventional methods of determining
freeze point will not be accurate. Both the refractive index and specific gravity differ between
ethylene glycol and propylene glycol.
CAUTION: Richer antifreeze mixtures cannot be measured with normal field equipment and can
cause problems associated with 100 percent ethyleneglycol.
COOLANT SELECTION-ADDITIVES
The presence of aluminum components in the cooling system requires strict corrosion protection.
Maintain coolant at specified level with a mixture of ethyleneglycol based antifreeze and water.
Only use an antifreeze containing ALUGARD 340 - 2mm such as Mopar Antifreeze. If coolant
becomes contaminated or looses color, drain and flush cooling system and fill with correctly mixed
solution.
CAUTION: Do not use coolant additives that are claimed to improve engine cooling.
Dodge Ram 2500 4wd Workshop Manual (Truck L6-5.9L DSL Turbo VIN 6 (1999))
Dodge Workshop Manuals > Maintenance > Fluids > Coolant > Component Information > Specifications > Page 1550
Coolant: Service and Repair
Refer to Cooling System, Service and Repair for applicable service procedures.